1 <?xml version='
1.0' encoding='ISO-
8859-
1'
?>
2 <!-- Converted to DocBook by Hans Schou 2004-03-29 -->
6 * replace '. . .' with something else
10 <!DOCTYPE book PUBLIC
"-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN"
11 "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd"
14 <!ENTITY translationblock
"">
19 <book id=
"index" lang=
"en">
21 <title>Free Culture
</title>
23 <abbrev>"freeculture"</abbrev>
25 <subtitle>Version
2004-
02-
10</subtitle>
29 <firstname>Lawrence
</firstname>
30 <surname>Lessig
</surname>
38 This version of Free Culture is licensed
39 under a Creative Commons license. This license permits
40 non-commercial use of this work,
41 so long as attribution is given.
42 For more information about the license,
43 click the icon above, or visit
44 <ulink url=
"http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/1.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/
1.0/
</ulink>
49 <title>ABOUT THE AUTHOR
</title>
52 (
<ulink url=
"http://www.lessig.org/">http://www.lessig.org
</ulink>),
53 professor of law and a John A. Wilson Distinguished Faculty Scholar
54 at Stanford Law School, is founder of the Stanford Center for Internet
55 and Society and is chairman of the Creative Commons
56 (
<ulink url=
"http://creativecommons.org/">http://creativecommons.org
</ulink>).
57 The author of The Future of Ideas (Random House,
2001) and Code: And
58 Other Laws of Cyberspace (Basic Books,
1999), Lessig is a member of
59 the boards of the Public Library of Science, the Electronic Frontier
60 Foundation, and Public Knowledge. He was the winner of the Free
61 Software Foundation's Award for the Advancement of Free Software,
62 twice listed in BusinessWeek's "e.biz
25," and named one of Scientific
63 American's "
50 visionaries." A graduate of the University of
64 Pennsylvania, Cambridge University, and Yale Law School, Lessig
65 clerked for Judge Richard Posner of the U.S. Seventh Circuit Court of
76 You can buy a copy of this book by clicking on one of the links below:
78 <itemizedlist mark=
"number" spacing=
"compact">
79 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.amazon.com/">Amazon
</ulink></para></listitem>
80 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.barnesandnoble.com/">B
&N
</ulink></para></listitem>
81 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.penguin.com/">Penguin
</ulink></para></listitem>
82 <!-- <ulink url="">Local Bookstore</ulink> -->
88 ALSO BY LAWRENCE LESSIG
89 <sbr/>The Future of Ideas: The Fate of the Commons
91 <sbr/>Code: And Other Laws of Cyberspace
100 <!-- PAGE BREAK 5 -->
106 HOW BIG MEDIA USES TECHNOLOGY AND
107 THE LAW TO LOCK DOWN CULTURE
108 AND CONTROL CREATIVITY
115 <!-- PAGE BREAK 6 -->
118 <sbr/>a member of Penguin Group (USA) Inc.
375 Hudson Street New
120 <sbr/>Copyright
© Lawrence Lessig,
121 <sbr/>All rights reserved
122 <sbr/>Excerpt from an editorial titled "The Coming of Copyright Perpetuity,"
123 The New York Times, January
16,
2003. Copyright
© 2003 by The New York Times Co.
124 Reprinted with permission.
125 <sbr/>Cartoon by Paul Conrad on page
159. Copyright Tribune Media Services, Inc.
126 <sbr/>All rights reserved. Reprinted with permission.
127 <sbr/>Diagram on page
164 courtesy of the office of FCC Commissioner, Michael J. Copps.
128 <sbr/>Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data
129 <sbr/>Lessig, Lawrence.
130 Free culture : how big media uses technology and the law to lock down
131 culture and control creativity / Lawrence Lessig.
133 <sbr/>Includes index.
134 <sbr/>ISBN
1-
59420-
006-
8 (hardcover)
135 <sbr/>1. Intellectual property
—United States.
2. Mass media
—United States.
136 <sbr/>3. Technological innovations
—United States.
4. Art
—United States. I. Title.
138 <sbr/>343.7309'
9—dc22
139 <sbr/>This book is printed on acid-free paper.
140 <sbr/>Printed in the United States of America
141 <sbr/>1 3 5 7 9 10 8 6 4
142 <sbr/>Designed by Marysarah Quinn
150 Without limiting the rights under copyright reserved above, no part of
151 this publication may be reproduced, stored in or introduced into a
152 retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means
153 (electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise),
154 without the prior written permission of both the copyright owner and
155 the above publisher of this book. The scanning, uploading, and
156 distribution of this book via the Internet or via any other means
157 without the permission of the publisher is illegal and punishable by
158 law. Please purchase only authorized electronic editions and do not
159 participate in or encourage electronic piracy of copyrighted
160 materials. Your support of the author's rights is appreciated.
162 <!-- PAGE BREAK 7 -->
165 To Eric Eldred
—whose work first drew me to this cause, and for whom
169 <figure id=
"CreativeCommons">
170 <title>Creative Commons, Some rights reserved
</title>
171 <graphic fileref=
"images/cc.png"></graphic>
177 <title>List of figures
</title>
184 1 CHAPTER ONE: Creators
185 1 CHAPTER TWO: "Mere Copyists"
186 1 CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs
187 1 CHAPTER FOUR: "Pirates"
192 1 CHAPTER FIVE: "Piracy"
196 1 CHAPTER SIX: Founders
197 1 CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders
198 1 CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers
199 1 CHAPTER NINE: Collectors
200 1 CHAPTER TEN: "Property"
201 2 Why Hollywood Is Right
205 2 Law and Architecture: Reach
206 2 Architecture and Law: Force
207 2 Market: Concentration
210 1 CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera
211 1 CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms
212 2 Constraining Creators
213 2 Constraining Innovators
214 2 Corrupting Citizens
216 1 CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred
217 1 CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II
221 2 Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples
222 2 Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea
224 2 1. More Formalities
225 3 Registration and Renewal
228 2 3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use
229 2 4. Liberate the Music- -Again
230 2 5. Fire Lots of Lawyers 304
236 <!-- PAGE BREAK 11 -->
239 <chapter id=
"c-preface">
240 <title>PREFACE
</title>
242 At the end of his review of my first book, Code: And Other Laws of
243 Cyberspace, David Pogue, a brilliant writer and author of countless
244 technical and computer-related texts, wrote this:
248 Unlike actual law, Internet software has no capacity to punish. It
249 doesn't affect people who aren't online (and only a tiny minority
250 of the world population is). And if you don't like the Internet's
251 system, you can always flip off the modem.
<footnote id=
"preface01"><para>
252 David Pogue, "Don't Just Chat, Do Something," New York Times,
30 January
2000.
257 Pogue was skeptical of the core argument of the book
—that
259 or "code," functioned as a kind of law
—and his review suggested
260 the happy thought that if life in cyberspace got bad, we could always
261 "drizzle, drazzle, druzzle, drome"-like simply flip a switch and be back
262 home. Turn off the modem, unplug the computer, and any troubles
263 that exist in that space wouldn't "affect" us anymore.
266 Pogue might have been right in
1999—I'm skeptical, but maybe.
267 But even if he was right then, the point is not right now: Free Culture
268 is about the troubles the Internet causes even after the modem is turned
269 <!-- PAGE BREAK 12 -->
270 off. It is an argument about how the battles that now rage regarding life
271 on-line have fundamentally affected "people who aren't online." There
272 is no switch that will insulate us from the Internet's effect.
275 But unlike Code, the argument here is not much about the Internet
276 itself. It is instead about the consequence of the Internet to a part of
277 our tradition that is much more fundamental, and, as hard as this is for
278 a geek-wanna-be to admit, much more important.
281 That tradition is the way our culture gets made. As I explain in the
282 pages that follow, we come from a tradition of "free culture"
—not
283 "free" as in "free beer" (to borrow a phrase from the founder of the
284 freesoftware movement
<footnote>
286 Richard M. Stallman, Free Software, Free Societies
57 (Joshua Gay, ed.
2002).
287 </para></footnote>), but "free" as in "free speech," "free markets," "free
288 trade," "free enterprise," "free will," and "free elections." A free
289 culture supports and protects creators and innovators. It does this
290 directly by granting intellectual property rights. But it does so
291 indirectly by limiting the reach of those rights, to guarantee that
292 follow-on creators and innovators remain as free as possible from the
293 control of the past. A free culture is not a culture without property,
294 just as a free market is not a market in which everything is free. The
295 opposite of a free culture is a "permission culture"
—a culture in
296 which creators get to create only with the permission of the powerful,
297 or of creators from the past.
300 If we understood this change, I believe we would resist it. Not "we"
301 on the Left or "you" on the Right, but we who have no stake in the
302 particular industries of culture that defined the twentieth century.
303 Whether you are on the Left or the Right, if you are in this sense
304 disinterested, then the story I tell here will trouble you. For the
305 changes I describe affect values that both sides of our political
306 culture deem fundamental.
308 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace
</primary></indexterm>
310 We saw a glimpse of this bipartisan outrage in the early summer of
311 2003. As the FCC considered changes in media ownership rules that
312 would relax limits on media concentration, an extraordinary coalition
313 generated more than
700,
000 letters to the FCC opposing the change.
314 As William Safire described marching "uncomfortably alongside CodePink
315 Women for Peace and the National Rifle Association, between liberal
316 Olympia Snowe and conservative Ted Stevens," he formulated perhaps
317 most simply just what was at stake: the concentration of power. And as
322 Does that sound unconservative? Not to me. The concentration of
323 power
—political, corporate, media, cultural
—should be anathema to
324 conservatives. The diffusion of power through local control, thereby
325 encouraging individual participation, is the essence of federalism and
326 the greatest expression of democracy.
<footnote><para> William Safire,
327 "The Great Media Gulp," New York Times,
22 May
2003.
332 This idea is an element of the argument of Free Culture, though my
333 focus is not just on the concentration of power produced by
334 concentrations in ownership, but more importantly, if because less
335 visibly, on the concentration of power produced by a radical change in
336 the effective scope of the law. The law is changing; that change is
337 altering the way our culture gets made; that change should worry
338 you
—whether or not you care about the Internet, and whether you're on
339 Safire's left or on his right. The inspiration for the title and for
340 much of the argument of this book comes from the work of Richard
341 Stallman and the Free Software Foundation. Indeed, as I reread
342 Stallman's own work, especially the essays in Free Software, Free
343 Society, I realize that all of the theoretical insights I develop here
344 are insights Stallman described decades ago. One could thus well argue
345 that this work is "merely" derivative.
348 I accept that criticism, if indeed it is a criticism. The work of a
349 lawyer is always derivative, and I mean to do nothing more in this
350 book than to remind a culture about a tradition that has always been
351 its own. Like Stallman, I defend that tradition on the basis of
352 values. Like Stallman, I believe those are the values of freedom. And
353 like Stallman, I believe those are values of our past that will need
354 to be defended in our future. A free culture has been our past, but it
355 will only be our future if we change the path we are on right now.
357 <!-- PAGE BREAK 14 -->
358 Like Stallman's arguments for free software, an argument for free
359 culture stumbles on a confusion that is hard to avoid, and even harder
360 to understand. A free culture is not a culture without property; it is not
361 a culture in which artists don't get paid. A culture without property, or
362 in which creators can't get paid, is anarchy, not freedom. Anarchy is not
366 Instead, the free culture that I defend in this book is a balance
367 between anarchy and control. A free culture, like a free market, is
368 filled with property. It is filled with rules of property and contract
369 that get enforced by the state. But just as a free market is perverted
370 if its property becomes feudal, so too can a free culture be queered
371 by extremism in the property rights that define it. That is what I
372 fear about our culture today. It is against that extremism that this
377 <!-- PAGE BREAK 15 -->
379 <!-- PAGE BREAK 16 -->
380 <chapter id=
"c-introduction">
381 <title>INTRODUCTION
</title>
383 On December
17,
1903, on a windy North Carolina beach for just
384 shy of one hundred seconds, the Wright brothers demonstrated that a
385 heavier-than-air, self-propelled vehicle could fly. The moment was electric
386 and its importance widely understood. Almost immediately, there
387 was an explosion of interest in this newfound technology of manned
388 flight, and a gaggle of innovators began to build upon it.
391 At the time the Wright brothers invented the airplane, American
392 law held that a property owner presumptively owned not just the surface
393 of his land, but all the land below, down to the center of the earth,
394 and all the space above, to "an indefinite extent, upwards."
<footnote><para>
395 St. George Tucker, Blackstone's Commentaries
3 (South Hackensack, N.J.:
396 Rothman Reprints,
1969),
18.
399 years, scholars had puzzled about how best to interpret the idea that
400 rights in land ran to the heavens. Did that mean that you owned the
401 stars? Could you prosecute geese for their willful and regular trespass?
404 Then came airplanes, and for the first time, this principle of American
405 law
—deep within the foundations of our tradition, and acknowledged
406 by the most important legal thinkers of our past
—mattered. If
407 my land reaches to the heavens, what happens when United flies over
408 my field? Do I have the right to banish it from my property? Am I allowed
409 to enter into an exclusive license with Delta Airlines? Could we
410 set up an auction to decide how much these rights are worth?
412 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
413 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
415 In
1945, these questions became a federal case. When North Carolina
416 farmers Thomas Lee and Tinie Causby started losing chickens
417 because of low-flying military aircraft (the terrified chickens apparently
418 flew into the barn walls and died), the Causbys filed a lawsuit saying
419 that the government was trespassing on their land. The airplanes,
420 of course, never touched the surface of the Causbys' land. But if, as
421 Blackstone, Kent, and Coke had said, their land reached to "an indefinite
422 extent, upwards," then the government was trespassing on their
423 property, and the Causbys wanted it to stop.
425 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
426 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
428 The Supreme Court agreed to hear the Causbys' case. Congress had
429 declared the airways public, but if one's property really extended to the
430 heavens, then Congress's declaration could well have been an unconstitutional
431 "taking" of property without compensation. The Court acknowledged
432 that "it is ancient doctrine that common law ownership of
433 the land extended to the periphery of the universe." But Justice Douglas
434 had no patience for ancient doctrine. In a single paragraph, hundreds of
435 years of property law were erased. As he wrote for the Court,
439 [The] doctrine has no place in the modern world. The air is a
440 public highway, as Congress has declared. Were that not true,
441 every transcontinental flight would subject the operator to countless
442 trespass suits. Common sense revolts at the idea. To recognize
443 such private claims to the airspace would clog these highways,
444 seriously interfere with their control and development in the public
445 interest, and transfer into private ownership that to which only
446 the public has a just claim.
<footnote>
447 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
448 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
450 United States v. Causby, U.S.
328 (
1946):
256,
261. The Court did find
451 that there could be a "taking" if the government's use of its land
452 effectively destroyed the value of the Causbys' land. This example was
453 suggested to me by Keith Aoki's wonderful piece, "(Intellectual)
454 Property and Sovereignty: Notes Toward a Cultural Geography of
455 Authorship," Stanford Law Review
48 (
1996):
1293,
1333. See also Paul
456 Goldstein, Real Property (Mineola, N.Y.: Foundation Press,
1984),
462 "Common sense revolts at the idea."
465 This is how the law usually works. Not often this abruptly or
466 impatiently, but eventually, this is how it works. It was Douglas's style not to
467 dither. Other justices would have blathered on for pages to reach the
468 <!-- PAGE BREAK 18 -->
469 conclusion that Douglas holds in a single line: "Common sense revolts
470 at the idea." But whether it takes pages or a few words, it is the special
471 genius of a common law system, as ours is, that the law adjusts to the
472 technologies of the time. And as it adjusts, it changes. Ideas that were
473 as solid as rock in one age crumble in another.
475 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
476 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
478 Or at least, this is how things happen when there's no one powerful
479 on the other side of the change. The Causbys were just farmers. And
480 though there were no doubt many like them who were upset by the
481 growing traffic in the air (though one hopes not many chickens flew
482 themselves into walls), the Causbys of the world would find it very
483 hard to unite and stop the idea, and the technology, that the Wright
484 brothers had birthed. The Wright brothers spat airplanes into the
485 technological meme pool; the idea then spread like a virus in a chicken
486 coop; farmers like the Causbys found themselves surrounded by "what
487 seemed reasonable" given the technology that the Wrights had produced.
488 They could stand on their farms, dead chickens in hand, and
489 shake their fists at these newfangled technologies all they wanted.
490 They could call their representatives or even file a lawsuit. But in the
491 end, the force of what seems "obvious" to everyone else
—the power of
492 "common sense"
—would prevail. Their "private interest" would not be
493 allowed to defeat an obvious public gain.
496 Edwin Howard Armstrong is one of America's forgotten inventor
497 geniuses. He came to the great American inventor scene just after the
498 titans Thomas Edison and Alexander Graham Bell. But his work in
499 the area of radio technology was perhaps the most important of any
500 single inventor in the first fifty years of radio. He was better educated
501 than Michael Faraday, who as a bookbinder's apprentice had discovered
502 electric induction in
1831. But he had the same intuition about
503 how the world of radio worked, and on at least three occasions,
504 Armstrong invented profoundly important technologies that advanced our
505 understanding of radio.
506 <!-- PAGE BREAK 19 -->
509 On the day after Christmas,
1933, four patents were issued to Armstrong
510 for his most significant invention
—FM radio. Until then, consumer radio
511 had been amplitude-modulated (AM) radio. The theorists
512 of the day had said that frequency-modulated (FM) radio could never
513 work. They were right about FM radio in a narrow band of spectrum.
514 But Armstrong discovered that frequency-modulated radio in a wide
515 band of spectrum would deliver an astonishing fidelity of sound, with
516 much less transmitter power and static.
519 On November
5,
1935, he demonstrated the technology at a meeting
520 of the Institute of Radio Engineers at the Empire State Building in
521 New York City. He tuned his radio dial across a range of AM stations,
522 until the radio locked on a broadcast that he had arranged from
524 miles away. The radio fell totally silent, as if dead, and then with a
525 clarity no one else in that room had ever heard from an electrical
527 it produced the sound of an announcer's voice: "This is amateur
528 station W2AG at Yonkers, New York, operating on frequency
530 at two and a half meters."
533 The audience was hearing something no one had thought possible:
537 A glass of water was poured before the microphone in Yonkers; it
538 sounded like a glass of water being poured. . . . A paper was
539 crumpled and torn; it sounded like paper and not like a crackling
540 forest fire. . . . Sousa marches were played from records and a
542 solo and guitar number were performed. . . . The music was
543 projected with a live-ness rarely if ever heard before from a radio
544 "music box."
<footnote><para>
545 Lawrence Lessing, Man of High Fidelity: Edwin Howard Armstrong
546 (Philadelphia: J. B. Lipincott Company,
1956),
209.
551 As our own common sense tells us, Armstrong had discovered a
552 vastly superior radio technology. But at the time of his invention,
554 was working for RCA. RCA was the dominant player in the
555 then dominant AM radio market. By
1935, there were a thousand radio
556 stations across the United States, but the stations in large cities were all
557 owned by a handful of networks.
558 <!-- PAGE BREAK 20 -->
561 RCA's president, David Sarnoff, a friend of Armstrong's, was eager
562 that Armstrong discover a way to remove static from AM radio. So
563 Sarnoff was quite excited when Armstrong told him he had a device
564 that removed static from "radio." But when Armstrong demonstrated
565 his invention, Sarnoff was not pleased.
569 I thought Armstrong would invent some kind of a filter to remove
570 static from our AM radio. I didn't think he'd start a revolution
—
571 start up a whole damn new industry to compete with RCA.
<footnote><para>
572 See "Saints: The Heroes and Geniuses of the Electronic Era," First
574 Church of America, at www.webstationone.com/fecha, available at
576 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
1</ulink>.
581 Armstrong's invention threatened RCA's AM empire, so the company
582 launched a campaign to smother FM radio. While FM may have been a
583 superior technology, Sarnoff was a superior tactician. As one author
588 The forces for FM, largely engineering, could not overcome the weight
589 of strategy devised by the sales, patent, and legal offices to subdue
590 this threat to corporate position. For FM, if allowed to develop
591 unrestrained, posed . . . a complete reordering of radio power
592 . . . and the eventual overthrow of the carefully restricted AM system
593 on which RCA had grown to power.
<footnote><para>Lessing,
226.
598 RCA at first kept the technology in house, insisting that further
599 tests were needed. When, after two years of testing, Armstrong grew
600 impatient, RCA began to use its power with the government to stall
601 FM radio's deployment generally. In
1936, RCA hired the former head
602 of the FCC and assigned him the task of assuring that the FCC assign
603 spectrum in a way that would castrate FM
—principally by moving FM
604 radio to a different band of spectrum. At first, these efforts failed. But
605 when Armstrong and the nation were distracted by World War II,
606 RCA's work began to be more successful. Soon after the war ended, the
607 FCC announced a set of policies that would have one clear effect: FM
608 radio would be crippled. As Lawrence Lessing described it,
610 <!-- PAGE BREAK 21 -->
613 The series of body blows that FM radio received right after the
614 war, in a series of rulings manipulated through the FCC by the
615 big radio interests, were almost incredible in their force and
616 deviousness.
<footnote><para>
621 <indexterm><primary>AT
&T
</primary></indexterm>
623 To make room in the spectrum for RCA's latest gamble, television,
624 FM radio users were to be moved to a totally new spectrum band. The
625 power of FM radio stations was also cut, meaning FM could no longer
626 be used to beam programs from one part of the country to another.
627 (This change was strongly supported by AT
&T, because the loss of
628 FM relaying stations would mean radio stations would have to buy
629 wired links from AT
&T.) The spread of FM radio was thus choked, at
633 Armstrong resisted RCA's efforts. In response, RCA resisted
634 Armstrong's patents. After incorporating FM technology into the
635 emerging standard for television, RCA declared the patents
636 invalid
—baselessly, and almost fifteen years after they were
637 issued. It thus refused to pay him royalties. For six years, Armstrong
638 fought an expensive war of litigation to defend the patents. Finally,
639 just as the patents expired, RCA offered a settlement so low that it
640 would not even cover Armstrong's lawyers' fees. Defeated, broken, and
641 now broke, in
1954 Armstrong wrote a short note to his wife and then
642 stepped out of a thirteenth-story window to his death.
645 This is how the law sometimes works. Not often this tragically, and
646 rarely with heroic drama, but sometimes, this is how it works. From
647 the beginning, government and government agencies have been subject to
648 capture. They are more likely captured when a powerful interest is
649 threatened by either a legal or technical change. That powerful
650 interest too often exerts its influence within the government to get
651 the government to protect it. The rhetoric of this protection is of
652 course always public spirited; the reality is something
653 different. Ideas that were as solid as rock in one age, but that, left
654 to themselves, would crumble in
655 <!-- PAGE BREAK 22 -->
656 another, are sustained through this subtle corruption of our political
657 process. RCA had what the Causbys did not: the power to stifle the
659 of technological change.
662 There's no single inventor of the Internet. Nor is there any good
663 date upon which to mark its birth. Yet in a very short time, the
665 has become part of ordinary American life. According to the Pew
666 Internet and American Life Project,
58 percent of Americans had
668 to the Internet in
2002, up from
49 percent two years before.
<footnote><para>
669 Amanda Lenhart, "The Ever-Shifting Internet Population: A New Look
670 at Internet Access and the Digital Divide," Pew Internet and American
671 Life Project,
15 April
2003:
6, available at
672 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
2</ulink>.
674 That number could well exceed two thirds of the nation by the end
678 As the Internet has been integrated into ordinary life, it has
679 changed things. Some of these changes are technical
—the Internet has
680 made communication faster, it has lowered the cost of gathering data,
681 and so on. These technical changes are not the focus of this book. They
682 are important. They are not well understood. But they are the sort of
683 thing that would simply go away if we all just switched the Internet off.
684 They don't affect people who don't use the Internet, or at least they
685 don't affect them directly. They are the proper subject of a book about
686 the Internet. But this is not a book about the Internet.
689 Instead, this book is about an effect of the Internet beyond the
691 itself: an effect upon how culture is made. My claim is that the
692 Internet has induced an important and unrecognized change in that
693 process. That change will radically transform a tradition that is as old as
694 the Republic itself. Most, if they recognized this change, would reject
695 it. Yet most don't even see the change that the Internet has introduced.
698 We can glimpse a sense of this change by distinguishing between
699 commercial and noncommercial culture, and by mapping the law's
701 of each. By "commercial culture" I mean that part of our culture
702 that is produced and sold or produced to be sold. By "noncommercial
703 culture" I mean all the rest. When old men sat around parks or on
704 <!-- PAGE BREAK 23 -->
705 street corners telling stories that kids and others consumed, that was
706 noncommercial culture. When Noah Webster published his "Reader,"
707 or Joel Barlow his poetry, that was commercial culture.
710 At the beginning of our history, and for just about the whole of our
711 tradition, noncommercial culture was essentially unregulated. Of
712 course, if your stories were lewd, or if your song disturbed the peace,
713 then the law might intervene. But the law was never directly concerned
714 with the creation or spread of this form of culture, and it left this
716 "free." The ordinary ways in which ordinary individuals shared and
717 transformed their culture
—telling stories, reenacting scenes from plays
718 or TV, participating in fan clubs, sharing music, making tapes
—were
719 left alone by the law.
722 The focus of the law was on commercial creativity. At first slightly,
723 then quite extensively, the law protected the incentives of creators by
724 granting them exclusive rights to their creative work, so that they could
725 sell those exclusive rights in a commercial
726 marketplace.
<footnote>
727 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
729 This is not the only purpose of copyright, though it is the overwhelmingly
730 primary purpose of the copyright established in the federal constitution.
731 State copyright law historically protected not just the commercial interest in
732 publication, but also a privacy interest. By granting authors the exclusive
733 right to first publication, state copyright law gave authors the power to
734 control the spread of facts about them. See Samuel D. Warren and Louis
735 D. Brandeis, "The Right to Privacy," Harvard Law Review
4 (
1890):
193,
739 course, an important part of creativity and culture, and it has become
740 an increasingly important part in America. But in no sense was it
742 within our tradition. It was instead just one part, a controlled
743 part, balanced with the free.
746 This rough divide between the free and the controlled has now
747 been erased.
<footnote><para>
748 See Jessica Litman, Digital Copyright (New York: Prometheus Books,
751 The Internet has set the stage for this erasure and,
752 pushed by big media, the law has now affected it. For the first time in
753 our tradition, the ordinary ways in which individuals create and share
754 culture fall within the reach of the regulation of the law, which has
756 to draw within its control a vast amount of culture and
758 that it never reached before. The technology that preserved the
759 balance of our history
—between uses of our culture that were free and
760 uses of our culture that were only upon permission
—has been undone.
761 The consequence is that we are less and less a free culture, more and
762 more a permission culture.
764 <!-- PAGE BREAK 24 -->
766 This change gets justified as necessary to protect commercial
768 And indeed, protectionism is precisely its motivation. But the
769 protectionism that justifies the changes that I will describe below is not
770 the limited and balanced sort that has defined the law in the past. This
771 is not a protectionism to protect artists. It is instead a protectionism
772 to protect certain forms of business. Corporations threatened by the
773 potential of the Internet to change the way both commercial and
774 noncommercial culture are made and shared have united to induce
775 lawmakers to use the law to protect them. It is the story of RCA and
776 Armstrong; it is the dream of the Causbys.
779 For the Internet has unleashed an extraordinary possibility for many
780 to participate in the process of building and cultivating a culture that
781 reaches far beyond local boundaries. That power has changed the
783 for making and cultivating culture generally, and that change
784 in turn threatens established content industries. The Internet is thus to
785 the industries that built and distributed content in the twentieth
787 what FM radio was to AM radio, or what the truck was to the
788 railroad industry of the nineteenth century: the beginning of the end,
789 or at least a substantial transformation. Digital technologies, tied to the
790 Internet, could produce a vastly more competitive and vibrant market
791 for building and cultivating culture; that market could include a much
792 wider and more diverse range of creators; those creators could produce
793 and distribute a much more vibrant range of creativity; and depending
794 upon a few important factors, those creators could earn more on average
795 from this system than creators do today
—all so long as the RCAs of our
796 day don't use the law to protect themselves against this competition.
799 Yet, as I argue in the pages that follow, that is precisely what is
801 in our culture today. These modern-day equivalents of the early
802 twentieth-century radio or nineteenth-century railroads are using their
803 power to get the law to protect them against this new, more efficient,
804 more vibrant technology for building culture. They are succeeding in
805 their plan to remake the Internet before the Internet remakes them.
808 It doesn't seem this way to many. The battles over copyright and the
809 <!-- PAGE BREAK 25 -->
810 Internet seem remote to most. To the few who follow them, they seem
811 mainly about a much simpler brace of questions
—whether "piracy" will
812 be permitted, and whether "property" will be protected. The "war" that
813 has been waged against the technologies of the Internet
—what
815 Picture Association of America (MPAA) president Jack Valenti
816 calls his "own terrorist war"
<footnote><para>
817 Amy Harmon, "Black Hawk Download: Moving Beyond Music, Pirates
818 Use New Tools to Turn the Net into an Illicit Video Club," New York
819 Times,
17 January
2002.
820 </para></footnote>—has been framed as a battle about the
821 rule of law and respect for property. To know which side to take in this
822 war, most think that we need only decide whether we're for property or
826 If those really were the choices, then I would be with Jack Valenti
827 and the content industry. I, too, am a believer in property, and
829 in the importance of what Mr. Valenti nicely calls "creative
831 I believe that "piracy" is wrong, and that the law, properly tuned,
832 should punish "piracy," whether on or off the Internet.
835 But those simple beliefs mask a much more fundamental question
836 and a much more dramatic change. My fear is that unless we come to see
837 this change, the war to rid the world of Internet "pirates" will also rid our
838 culture of values that have been integral to our tradition from the start.
841 These values built a tradition that, for at least the first
180 years of
842 our Republic, guaranteed creators the right to build freely upon their
843 past, and protected creators and innovators from either state or private
844 control. The First Amendment protected creators against state control.
845 And as Professor Neil Netanel powerfully argues,
<footnote>
846 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock
</primary></indexterm>
848 Neil W. Netanel, "Copyright and a Democratic Civil Society," Yale Law
849 Journal
106 (
1996):
283.
851 copyright law, properly balanced, protected creators against private
852 control. Our tradition was thus neither Soviet nor the tradition of
853 patrons. It instead carved out a wide berth within which creators
854 could cultivate and extend our culture.
857 Yet the law's response to the Internet, when tied to changes in the
858 technology of the Internet itself, has massively increased the
859 effective regulation of creativity in America. To build upon or
860 critique the culture around us one must ask, Oliver Twist
–like,
861 for permission first. Permission is, of course, often
862 granted
—but it is not often granted to the critical or the
863 independent. We have built a kind of cultural nobility; those within
864 the noble class live easily; those outside it don't. But it is
865 nobility of any form that is alien to our tradition.
867 <!-- PAGE BREAK 26 -->
869 The story that follows is about this war. Is it not about the
871 of technology" to ordinary life. I don't believe in gods, digital or
872 otherwise. Nor is it an effort to demonize any individual or group, for
873 neither do I believe in a devil, corporate or otherwise. It is not a
875 tale. Nor is it a call to jihad against an industry.
878 It is instead an effort to understand a hopelessly destructive war
880 by the technologies of the Internet but reaching far beyond its
881 code. And by understanding this battle, it is an effort to map peace.
882 There is no good reason for the current struggle around Internet
884 to continue. There will be great harm to our tradition and
885 culture if it is allowed to continue unchecked. We must come to
887 the source of this war. We must resolve it soon.
889 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
890 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
892 Like the Causbys' battle, this war is, in part, about "property." The
893 property of this war is not as tangible as the Causbys', and no
894 innocent chicken has yet to lose its life. Yet the ideas surrounding
895 this "property" are as obvious to most as the Causbys' claim about the
896 sacredness of their farm was to them. We are the Causbys. Most of us
897 take for granted the extraordinarily powerful claims that the owners
898 of "intellectual property" now assert. Most of us, like the Causbys,
899 treat these claims as obvious. And hence we, like the Causbys, object
900 when a new technology interferes with this property. It is as plain to
901 us as it was to them that the new technologies of the Internet are
902 "trespassing" upon legitimate claims of "property." It is as plain to
903 us as it was to them that the law should intervene to stop this
906 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
907 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
909 And thus, when geeks and technologists defend their Armstrong or
910 Wright brothers technology, most of us are simply unsympathetic.
911 Common sense does not revolt. Unlike in the case of the unlucky
912 Causbys, common sense is on the side of the property owners in this
914 <!-- PAGE BREAK 27 -->
915 the lucky Wright brothers, the Internet has not inspired a revolution
919 My hope is to push this common sense along. I have become
921 amazed by the power of this idea of intellectual property
922 and, more importantly, its power to disable critical thought by policy
923 makers and citizens. There has never been a time in our history when
924 more of our "culture" was as "owned" as it is now. And yet there has
925 never been a time when the concentration of power to control the uses
926 of culture has been as unquestioningly accepted as it is now.
930 Is it because we have come to understand a truth about the value
931 and importance of absolute property over ideas and culture? Is it
933 we have discovered that our tradition of rejecting such an
938 Or is it because the idea of absolute property over ideas and culture
939 benefits the RCAs of our time and fits our own unreflective intuitions?
942 Is the radical shift away from our tradition of free culture an instance
943 of America correcting a mistake from its past, as we did after a bloody
944 war with slavery, and as we are slowly doing with inequality? Or is the
945 radical shift away from our tradition of free culture yet another example
946 of a political system captured by a few powerful special interests?
949 Does common sense lead to the extremes on this question because
950 common sense actually believes in these extremes? Or does common
951 sense stand silent in the face of these extremes because, as with
953 versus RCA, the more powerful side has ensured that it has the
956 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
957 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
959 I don't mean to be mysterious. My own views are resolved. I believe it
960 was right for common sense to revolt against the extremism of the
961 Causbys. I believe it would be right for common sense to revolt
962 against the extreme claims made today on behalf of "intellectual
963 property." What the law demands today is increasingly as silly as a
964 sheriff arresting an airplane for trespass. But the consequences of
965 this silliness will be much more profound.
966 <!-- PAGE BREAK 28 -->
969 The struggle that rages just now centers on two ideas: "piracy" and
970 "property." My aim in this book's next two parts is to explore these two
974 My method is not the usual method of an academic. I don't want to
975 plunge you into a complex argument, buttressed with references to
977 French theorists
—however natural that is for the weird sort we
978 academics have become. Instead I begin in each part with a collection
979 of stories that set a context within which these apparently simple ideas
980 can be more fully understood.
983 The two sections set up the core claim of this book: that while the
984 Internet has indeed produced something fantastic and new, our
986 pushed by big media to respond to this "something new," is
987 destroying something very old. Rather than understanding the changes
988 the Internet might permit, and rather than taking time to let "common
989 sense" resolve how best to respond, we are allowing those most
991 by the changes to use their power to change the law
—and more
992 importantly, to use their power to change something fundamental about
993 who we have always been.
996 We allow this, I believe, not because it is right, and not because
997 most of us really believe in these changes. We allow it because the
998 interests most threatened are among the most powerful players in our
999 depressingly compromised process of making law. This book is the story
1000 of one more consequence of this form of corruption
—a consequence
1001 to which most of us remain oblivious.
1004 <!-- PAGE BREAK 29 -->
1005 <chapter id=
"c-piracy">
1006 <title>"PIRACY"</title>
1008 <!-- PAGE BREAK 30 -->
1010 Since the inception of the law regulating creative property, there
1011 has been a war against "piracy." The precise contours of this concept,
1012 "piracy," are hard to sketch, but the animating injustice is easy to
1014 As Lord Mansfield wrote in a case that extended the reach of
1015 English copyright law to include sheet music,
1019 A person may use the copy by playing it, but he has no right to
1020 rob the author of the profit, by multiplying copies and disposing
1021 of them for his own use.
<footnote><para>
1023 Bach v. Longman,
98 Eng. Rep.
1274 (
1777) (Mansfield).
1028 Today we are in the middle of another "war" against "piracy." The
1029 Internet has provoked this war. The Internet makes possible the
1031 spread of content. Peer-to-peer (p2p) file sharing is among the
1032 most efficient of the efficient technologies the Internet enables. Using
1033 distributed intelligence, p2p systems facilitate the easy spread of
1035 in a way unimagined a generation ago.
1036 <!-- PAGE BREAK 31 -->
1039 This efficiency does not respect the traditional lines of copyright.
1040 The network doesn't discriminate between the sharing of copyrighted
1041 and uncopyrighted content. Thus has there been a vast amount of
1043 of copyrighted content. That sharing in turn has excited the war, as
1044 copyright owners fear the sharing will "rob the author of the profit."
1047 The warriors have turned to the courts, to the legislatures, and
1049 to technology to defend their "property" against this "piracy."
1050 A generation of Americans, the warriors warn, is being raised to
1052 that "property" should be "free." Forget tattoos, never mind body
1053 piercing
—our kids are becoming thieves!
1056 There's no doubt that "piracy" is wrong, and that pirates should be
1057 punished. But before we summon the executioners, we should put this
1058 notion of "piracy" in some context. For as the concept is increasingly
1059 used, at its core is an extraordinary idea that is almost certainly wrong.
1062 The idea goes something like this:
1066 Creative work has value; whenever I use, or take, or build upon
1067 the creative work of others, I am taking from them something of
1068 value. Whenever I take something of value from someone else, I
1069 should have their permission. The taking of something of value
1070 from someone else without permission is wrong. It is a form of
1075 This view runs deep within the current debates. It is what NYU law
1076 professor Rochelle Dreyfuss criticizes as the "if value, then right"
1077 theory of creative property
<footnote><para>
1079 See Rochelle Dreyfuss, "Expressive Genericity: Trademarks as Language
1080 in the Pepsi Generation," Notre Dame Law Review
65 (
1990):
397.
1082 —if there is value, then someone must have a
1083 right to that value. It is the perspective that led a composers' rights
1084 organization, ASCAP, to sue the Girl Scouts for failing to pay for the
1085 songs that girls sang around Girl Scout campfires.
<footnote><para>
1087 Lisa Bannon, "The Birds May Sing, but Campers Can't Unless They Pay
1088 Up," Wall Street Journal,
21 August
1996, available at
1089 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
3</ulink>; Jonathan
1090 Zittrain, "Calling Off the Copyright War: In Battle of Property vs. Free
1091 Speech, No One Wins," Boston Globe,
24 November
2002.
1093 There was "value" (the songs) so there must have been a
1094 "right"
—even against the Girl Scouts.
1096 <indexterm><primary>ASCAP
</primary></indexterm>
1098 This idea is certainly a possible understanding of how creative
1099 property should work. It might well be a possible design for a system
1100 <!-- PAGE BREAK 32 -->
1101 of law protecting creative property. But the "if value, then right" theory
1102 of creative property has never been America's theory of creative
1104 It has never taken hold within our law.
1107 Instead, in our tradition, intellectual property is an instrument. It
1108 sets the groundwork for a richly creative society but remains
1109 subservient to the value of creativity. The current debate has this
1110 turned around. We have become so concerned with protecting the
1111 instrument that we are losing sight of the value.
1114 The source of this confusion is a distinction that the law no longer
1115 takes care to draw
—the distinction between republishing someone's
1116 work on the one hand and building upon or transforming that work on
1117 the other. Copyright law at its birth had only publishing as its concern;
1118 copyright law today regulates both.
1121 Before the technologies of the Internet, this conflation didn't matter
1122 all that much. The technologies of publishing were expensive; that
1123 meant the vast majority of publishing was commercial. Commercial
1124 entities could bear the burden of the law
—even the burden of the
1125 Byzantine complexity that copyright law has become. It was just one
1126 more expense of doing business.
1128 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
1130 But with the birth of the Internet, this natural limit to the reach of
1131 the law has disappeared. The law controls not just the creativity of
1132 commercial creators but effectively that of anyone. Although that
1133 expansion would not matter much if copyright law regulated only
1134 "copying," when the law regulates as broadly and obscurely as it does,
1135 the extension matters a lot. The burden of this law now vastly
1136 outweighs any original benefit
—certainly as it affects
1137 noncommercial creativity, and increasingly as it affects commercial
1138 creativity as well. Thus, as we'll see more clearly in the chapters
1139 below, the law's role is less and less to support creativity, and more
1140 and more to protect certain industries against competition. Just at
1141 the time digital technology could unleash an extraordinary range of
1142 commercial and noncommercial creativity, the law burdens this
1143 creativity with insanely complex and vague rules and with the threat
1144 of obscenely severe penalties. We may
1145 <!-- PAGE BREAK 33 -->
1146 be seeing, as Richard Florida writes, the "Rise of the Creative Class."
<footnote>
1147 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
1150 In The Rise of the Creative Class (New York: Basic Books,
2002),
1151 Richard Florida documents a shift in the nature of labor toward a
1152 labor of creativity. His work, however, doesn't directly address the
1153 legal conditions under which that creativity is enabled or stifled. I
1154 certainly agree with him about the importance and significance of this
1155 change, but I also believe the conditions under which it will be
1156 enabled are much more tenuous.
1158 Unfortunately, we are also seeing an extraordinary rise of regulation of
1159 this creative class.
1162 These burdens make no sense in our tradition. We should begin by
1163 understanding that tradition a bit more and by placing in their proper
1164 context the current battles about behavior labeled "piracy."
1167 <!-- PAGE BREAK 34 -->
1168 <sect1 id=
"creators">
1169 <title>CHAPTER ONE: Creators
</title>
1171 In
1928, a cartoon character was born. An early Mickey Mouse
1172 made his debut in May of that year, in a silent flop called Plane Crazy.
1173 In November, in New York City's Colony Theater, in the first widely
1174 distributed cartoon synchronized with sound, Steamboat Willie brought
1175 to life the character that would become Mickey Mouse.
1178 Synchronized sound had been introduced to film a year earlier in the
1179 movie The Jazz Singer. That success led Walt Disney to copy the
1180 technique and mix sound with cartoons. No one knew whether it would
1181 work or, if it did work, whether it would win an audience. But when
1182 Disney ran a test in the summer of
1928, the results were unambiguous.
1183 As Disney describes that first experiment,
1187 A couple of my boys could read music, and one of them could play
1188 a mouth organ. We put them in a room where they could not see
1189 the screen and arranged to pipe their sound into the room where
1190 our wives and friends were going to see the picture.
1191 <!-- PAGE BREAK 35 -->
1194 The boys worked from a music and sound-effects score. After several
1195 false starts, sound and action got off with the gun. The mouth
1196 organist played the tune, the rest of us in the sound department
1197 bammed tin pans and blew slide whistles on the beat. The
1198 synchronization was pretty close.
1201 The effect on our little audience was nothing less than
1203 They responded almost instinctively to this union of sound
1204 and motion. I thought they were kidding me. So they put me in
1205 the audience and ran the action again. It was terrible, but it was
1206 wonderful! And it was something new!
<footnote><para>
1208 Leonard Maltin, Of Mice and Magic: A History of American Animated
1210 (New York: Penguin Books,
1987),
34–35.
1215 Disney's then partner, and one of animation's most extraordinary
1216 talents, Ub Iwerks, put it more strongly: "I have never been so thrilled
1217 in my life. Nothing since has ever equaled it."
1220 Disney had created something very new, based upon something relatively
1221 new. Synchronized sound brought life to a form of creativity that had
1222 rarely
—except in Disney's hands
—been anything more than
1223 filler for other films. Throughout animation's early history, it was
1224 Disney's invention that set the standard that others struggled to
1225 match. And quite often, Disney's great genius, his spark of
1226 creativity, was built upon the work of others.
1229 This much is familiar. What you might not know is that
1928 also
1230 marks another important transition. In that year, a comic (as opposed
1231 to cartoon) genius created his last independently produced silent film.
1232 That genius was Buster Keaton. The film was Steamboat Bill, Jr.
1235 Keaton was born into a vaudeville family in
1895. In the era of
1236 silent film, he had mastered using broad physical comedy as a way to
1237 spark uncontrollable laughter from his audience. Steamboat Bill, Jr. was
1238 a classic of this form, famous among film buffs for its incredible stunts.
1239 The film was classic Keaton
—wildly popular and among the best of its
1243 Steamboat Bill, Jr. appeared before Disney's cartoon Steamboat Willie.
1244 <!-- PAGE BREAK 36 -->
1245 The coincidence of titles is not coincidental. Steamboat Willie is a
1246 direct cartoon parody of Steamboat Bill,
<footnote><para>
1248 I am grateful to David Gerstein and his careful history, described at
1249 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
4</ulink>.
1250 According to Dave Smith of the Disney Archives, Disney paid royalties to
1251 use the music for five songs in Steamboat Willie: "Steamboat Bill," "The
1252 Simpleton" (Delille), "Mischief Makers" (Carbonara), "Joyful Hurry No.
1"
1253 (Baron), and "Gawky Rube" (Lakay). A sixth song, "The Turkey in the
1254 Straw," was already in the public domain. Letter from David Smith to
1255 Harry Surden,
10 July
2003, on file with author.
1257 and both are built upon a common song as a source. It is not just from
1258 the invention of synchronized sound in The Jazz Singer that we get
1259 Steamboat Willie. It is also from Buster Keaton's invention of
1260 Steamboat Bill, Jr., itself inspired by the song "Steamboat Bill,"
1261 that we get Steamboat Willie, and then from Steamboat Willie, Mickey
1265 This "borrowing" was nothing unique, either for Disney or for the
1266 industry. Disney was always parroting the feature-length mainstream
1267 films of his day.
<footnote><para>
1269 He was also a fan of the public domain. See Chris Sprigman, "The Mouse
1270 that Ate the Public Domain," Findlaw,
5 March
2002, at
1271 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
5</ulink>.
1273 So did many others. Early cartoons are filled with
1274 knockoffs
—slight variations on winning themes; retellings of
1275 ancient stories. The key to success was the brilliance of the
1276 differences. With Disney, it was sound that gave his animation its
1277 spark. Later, it was the quality of his work relative to the
1278 production-line cartoons with which he competed. Yet these additions
1279 were built upon a base that was borrowed. Disney added to the work of
1280 others before him, creating something new out of something just barely
1284 Sometimes this borrowing was slight. Sometimes it was significant.
1285 Think about the fairy tales of the Brothers Grimm. If you're as
1286 oblivious as I was, you're likely to think that these tales are happy,
1287 sweet stories, appropriate for any child at bedtime. In fact, the
1288 Grimm fairy tales are, well, for us, grim. It is a rare and perhaps
1289 overly ambitious parent who would dare to read these bloody,
1290 moralistic stories to his or her child, at bedtime or anytime.
1293 Disney took these stories and retold them in a way that carried them
1294 into a new age. He animated the stories, with both characters and
1295 light. Without removing the elements of fear and danger altogether, he
1296 made funny what was dark and injected a genuine emotion of compassion
1297 where before there was fear. And not just with the work of the
1298 Brothers Grimm. Indeed, the catalog of Disney work drawing upon the
1299 work of others is astonishing when set together: Snow White (
1937),
1300 Fantasia (
1940), Pinocchio (
1940), Dumbo (
1941), Bambi (
1942), Song of
1301 the South (
1946), Cinderella (
1950), Alice in Wonderland (
1951), Robin
1302 Hood (
1952), Peter Pan (
1953), Lady and the Tramp
1303 <!-- PAGE BREAK 37 -->
1304 (
1955), Mulan (
1998), Sleeping Beauty (
1959),
101 Dalmatians (
1961),
1305 The Sword in the Stone (
1963), and The Jungle Book (
1967)
—not to
1306 mention a recent example that we should perhaps quickly forget,
1307 Treasure Planet (
2003). In all of these cases, Disney (or Disney,
1308 Inc.) ripped creativity from the culture around him, mixed that
1309 creativity with his own extraordinary talent, and then burned that mix
1310 into the soul of his culture. Rip, mix, and burn.
1313 This is a kind of creativity. It is a creativity that we should
1314 remember and celebrate. There are some who would say that there is no
1315 creativity except this kind. We don't need to go that far to recognize
1316 its importance. We could call this "Disney creativity," though that
1317 would be a bit misleading. It is, more precisely, "Walt Disney
1318 creativity"
—a form of expression and genius that builds upon the
1319 culture around us and makes it something different.
1321 <para> In
1928, the culture that Disney was free to draw upon was
1322 relatively fresh. The public domain in
1928 was not very old and was
1323 therefore quite vibrant. The average term of copyright was just around
1324 thirty years
—for that minority of creative work that was in fact
1325 copyrighted.
<footnote><para>
1327 Until
1976, copyright law granted an author the possibility of two terms: an
1328 initial term and a renewal term. I have calculated the "average" term by
1330 the weighted average of total registrations for any particular year,
1331 and the proportion renewing. Thus, if
100 copyrights are registered in year
1332 1, and only
15 are renewed, and the renewal term is
28 years, then the
1334 term is
32.2 years. For the renewal data and other relevant data, see the
1335 Web site associated with this book, available at
1336 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
6</ulink>.
1338 That means that for thirty years, on average, the authors or
1339 copyright holders of a creative work had an "exclusive right" to control
1340 certain uses of the work. To use this copyrighted work in limited ways
1341 required the permission of the copyright owner.
1344 At the end of a copyright term, a work passes into the public domain.
1345 No permission is then needed to draw upon or use that work. No
1346 permission and, hence, no lawyers. The public domain is a "lawyer-free
1347 zone." Thus, most of the content from the nineteenth century was free
1348 for Disney to use and build upon in
1928. It was free for
1349 anyone
— whether connected or not, whether rich or not, whether
1350 approved or not
—to use and build upon.
1353 This is the ways things always were
—until quite recently. For most
1354 of our history, the public domain was just over the horizon. From
1355 until
1978, the average copyright term was never more than thirty-two
1356 years, meaning that most culture just a generation and a half old was
1358 <!-- PAGE BREAK 38 -->
1359 free for anyone to build upon without the permission of anyone else.
1360 Today's equivalent would be for creative work from the
1960s and
1970s
1361 to now be free for the next Walt Disney to build upon without
1362 permission. Yet today, the public domain is presumptive only for
1363 content from before the Great Depression.
1366 Of course, Walt Disney had no monopoly on "Walt Disney creativity."
1367 Nor does America. The norm of free culture has, until recently, and
1368 except within totalitarian nations, been broadly exploited and quite
1372 Consider, for example, a form of creativity that seems strange to many
1373 Americans but that is inescapable within Japanese culture: manga, or
1374 comics. The Japanese are fanatics about comics. Some
40 percent of
1375 publications are comics, and
30 percent of publication revenue derives
1376 from comics. They are everywhere in Japanese society, at every
1377 magazine stand, carried by a large proportion of commuters on Japan's
1378 extraordinary system of public transportation.
1381 Americans tend to look down upon this form of culture. That's an
1382 unattractive characteristic of ours. We're likely to misunderstand
1383 much about manga, because few of us have ever read anything close to
1384 the stories that these "graphic novels" tell. For the Japanese, manga
1385 cover every aspect of social life. For us, comics are "men in tights."
1386 And anyway, it's not as if the New York subways are filled with
1387 readers of Joyce or even Hemingway. People of different cultures
1388 distract themselves in different ways, the Japanese in this
1389 interestingly different way.
1392 But my purpose here is not to understand manga. It is to describe a
1393 variant on manga that from a lawyer's perspective is quite odd, but
1394 from a Disney perspective is quite familiar.
1397 This is the phenomenon of doujinshi. Doujinshi are also comics, but
1398 they are a kind of copycat comic. A rich ethic governs the creation of
1399 doujinshi. It is not doujinshi if it is just a copy; the artist must make a
1400 contribution to the art he copies, by transforming it either subtly or
1401 <!-- PAGE BREAK 39 -->
1402 significantly. A doujinshi comic can thus take a mainstream comic and
1403 develop it differently
—with a different story line. Or the comic can
1404 keep the character in character but change its look slightly. There is no
1405 formula for what makes the doujinshi sufficiently "different." But they
1406 must be different if they are to be considered true doujinshi. Indeed,
1407 there are committees that review doujinshi for inclusion within shows
1408 and reject any copycat comic that is merely a copy.
1411 These copycat comics are not a tiny part of the manga market. They are
1412 huge. More than
33,
000 "circles" of creators from across Japan produce
1413 these bits of Walt Disney creativity. More than
450,
000 Japanese come
1414 together twice a year, in the largest public gathering in the country,
1415 to exchange and sell them. This market exists in parallel to the
1416 mainstream commercial manga market. In some ways, it obviously
1417 competes with that market, but there is no sustained effort by those
1418 who control the commercial manga market to shut the doujinshi market
1419 down. It flourishes, despite the competition and despite the law.
1422 The most puzzling feature of the doujinshi market, for those trained
1423 in the law, at least, is that it is allowed to exist at all. Under
1424 Japanese copyright law, which in this respect (on paper) mirrors
1425 American copyright law, the doujinshi market is an illegal
1426 one. Doujinshi are plainly "derivative works." There is no general
1427 practice by doujinshi artists of securing the permission of the manga
1428 creators. Instead, the practice is simply to take and modify the
1429 creations of others, as Walt Disney did with Steamboat Bill, Jr. Under
1430 both Japanese and American law, that "taking" without the permission
1431 of the original copyright owner is illegal. It is an infringement of
1432 the original copyright to make a copy or a derivative work without the
1433 original copyright owner's permission.
1436 Yet this illegal market exists and indeed flourishes in Japan, and in
1437 the view of many, it is precisely because it exists that Japanese manga
1438 flourish. As American graphic novelist Judd Winick said to me, "The
1439 early days of comics in America are very much like what's going on
1440 in Japan now. . . . American comics were born out of copying each
1442 <!-- PAGE BREAK 40 -->
1443 other. . . . That's how [the artists] learn to draw
—by going into comic
1444 books and not tracing them, but looking at them and copying them"
1445 and building from them.
<footnote><para>
1447 For an excellent history, see Scott McCloud, Reinventing Comics (New
1448 York: Perennial,
2000).
1452 American comics now are quite different, Winick explains, in part
1453 because of the legal difficulty of adapting comics the way doujinshi are
1454 allowed. Speaking of Superman, Winick told me, "there are these rules
1455 and you have to stick to them." There are things Superman "cannot"
1456 do. "As a creator, it's frustrating having to stick to some parameters
1457 which are fifty years old."
1460 The norm in Japan mitigates this legal difficulty. Some say it is
1461 precisely the benefit accruing to the Japanese manga market that
1462 explains the mitigation. Temple University law professor Salil Mehra,
1463 for example, hypothesizes that the manga market accepts these
1464 technical violations because they spur the manga market to be more
1465 wealthy and productive. Everyone would be worse off if doujinshi were
1466 banned, so the law does not ban doujinshi.
<footnote><para>
1468 See Salil K. Mehra, "Copyright and Comics in Japan: Does Law Explain
1469 Why All the Comics My Kid Watches Are Japanese Imports?" Rutgers Law
1470 Review
55 (
2002):
155,
182. "[T]here might be a collective economic
1471 rationality that would lead manga and anime artists to forgo bringing
1472 legal actions for infringement. One hypothesis is that all manga
1473 artists may be better off collectively if they set aside their
1474 individual self-interest and decide not to press their legal
1475 rights. This is essentially a prisoner's dilemma solved."
1479 The problem with this story, however, as Mehra plainly acknowledges,
1480 is that the mechanism producing this laissez faire response is not
1481 clear. It may well be that the market as a whole is better off if
1482 doujinshi are permitted rather than banned, but that doesn't explain
1483 why individual copyright owners don't sue nonetheless. If the law has
1484 no general exception for doujinshi, and indeed in some cases
1485 individual manga artists have sued doujinshi artists, why is there not
1486 a more general pattern of blocking this "free taking" by the doujinshi
1490 I spent four wonderful months in Japan, and I asked this question
1491 as often as I could. Perhaps the best account in the end was offered by
1492 a friend from a major Japanese law firm. "We don't have enough
1493 lawyers," he told me one afternoon. There "just aren't enough resources
1494 to prosecute cases like this."
1497 This is a theme to which we will return: that regulation by law is a
1498 function of both the words on the books and the costs of making those
1499 words have effect. For now, focus on the obvious question that is
1500 begged: Would Japan be better off with more lawyers? Would manga
1501 <!-- PAGE BREAK 41 -->
1502 be richer if doujinshi artists were regularly prosecuted? Would the
1503 Japanese gain something important if they could end this practice of
1504 uncompensated sharing? Does piracy here hurt the victims of the
1505 piracy, or does it help them? Would lawyers fighting this piracy help
1506 their clients or hurt them?
1507 Let's pause for a moment.
1510 If you're like I was a decade ago, or like most people are when they
1511 first start thinking about these issues, then just about now you should
1512 be puzzled about something you hadn't thought through before.
1515 We live in a world that celebrates "property." I am one of those
1516 celebrants. I believe in the value of property in general, and I also
1517 believe in the value of that weird form of property that lawyers call
1518 "intellectual property."
<footnote><para>
1520 The term intellectual property is of relatively recent origin. See Siva
1522 Copyrights and Copywrongs,
11 (New York: New York
1524 Press,
2001). See also Lawrence Lessig, The Future of Ideas (New York:
1525 Random House,
2001),
293 n.
26. The term accurately describes a set of
1526 "property" rights
—copyright, patents, trademark, and trade-secret
—but the
1527 nature of those rights is very different.
1529 A large, diverse society cannot survive without
1531 a large, diverse, and modern society cannot flourish without
1532 intellectual property.
1535 But it takes just a second's reflection to realize that there is
1536 plenty of value out there that "property" doesn't capture. I don't
1537 mean "money can't buy you love," but rather, value that is plainly
1538 part of a process of production, including commercial as well as
1539 noncommercial production. If Disney animators had stolen a set of
1540 pencils to draw Steamboat Willie, we'd have no hesitation in
1541 condemning that taking as wrong
— even though trivial, even if
1542 unnoticed. Yet there was nothing wrong, at least under the law of the
1543 day, with Disney's taking from Buster Keaton or from the Brothers
1544 Grimm. There was nothing wrong with the taking from Keaton because
1545 Disney's use would have been considered "fair." There was nothing
1546 wrong with the taking from the Grimms because the Grimms' work was in
1550 Thus, even though the things that Disney took
—or more generally,
1551 the things taken by anyone exercising Walt Disney creativity
—are
1552 valuable, our tradition does not treat those takings as wrong. Some
1554 <!-- PAGE BREAK 42 -->
1555 things remain free for the taking within a free culture, and that
1559 The same with the doujinshi culture. If a doujinshi artist broke into
1560 a publisher's office and ran off with a thousand copies of his latest
1561 work
—or even one copy
—without paying, we'd have no hesitation in
1562 saying the artist was wrong. In addition to having trespassed, he would
1563 have stolen something of value. The law bans that stealing in whatever
1564 form, whether large or small.
1567 Yet there is an obvious reluctance, even among Japanese lawyers, to
1568 say that the copycat comic artists are "stealing." This form of Walt
1569 Disney creativity is seen as fair and right, even if lawyers in
1570 particular find it hard to say why.
1573 It's the same with a thousand examples that appear everywhere once you
1574 begin to look. Scientists build upon the work of other scientists
1575 without asking or paying for the privilege. ("Excuse me, Professor
1576 Einstein, but may I have permission to use your theory of relativity
1577 to show that you were wrong about quantum physics?") Acting companies
1578 perform adaptations of the works of Shakespeare without securing
1579 permission from anyone. (Does anyone believe Shakespeare would be
1580 better spread within our culture if there were a central Shakespeare
1581 rights clearinghouse that all productions of Shakespeare must appeal
1582 to first?) And Hollywood goes through cycles with a certain kind of
1583 movie: five asteroid films in the late
1990s; two volcano disaster
1587 Creators here and everywhere are always and at all times building
1588 upon the creativity that went before and that surrounds them now.
1589 That building is always and everywhere at least partially done without
1590 permission and without compensating the original creator. No society,
1591 free or controlled, has ever demanded that every use be paid for or that
1592 permission for Walt Disney creativity must always be sought. Instead,
1593 every society has left a certain bit of its culture free for the taking
—free
1594 societies more fully than unfree, perhaps, but all societies to some degree.
1595 <!-- PAGE BREAK 43 -->
1598 The hard question is therefore not whether a culture is free. All
1599 cultures are free to some degree. The hard question instead is "How
1600 free is this culture?" How much, and how broadly, is the culture free
1601 for others to take and build upon? Is that freedom limited to party
1602 members? To members of the royal family? To the top ten corporations
1603 on the New York Stock Exchange? Or is that freedom spread broadly? To
1604 artists generally, whether affiliated with the Met or not? To
1605 musicians generally, whether white or not? To filmmakers generally,
1606 whether affiliated with a studio or not?
1609 Free cultures are cultures that leave a great deal open for others to
1610 build upon; unfree, or permission, cultures leave much less. Ours was a
1611 free culture. It is becoming much less so.
1614 <!-- PAGE BREAK 44 -->
1616 <sect1 id=
"mere-copyists">
1617 <title>CHAPTER TWO: "Mere Copyists"
</title>
1618 <indexterm><primary>Daguerre, Louis
</primary></indexterm>
1620 In
1839, Louis Daguerre invented the first practical technology for
1621 producing what we would call "photographs." Appropriately enough, they
1622 were called "daguerreotypes." The process was complicated and
1623 expensive, and the field was thus limited to professionals and a few
1624 zealous and wealthy amateurs. (There was even an American Daguerre
1625 Association that helped regulate the industry, as do all such
1626 associations, by keeping competition down so as to keep prices up.)
1629 Yet despite high prices, the demand for daguerreotypes was strong.
1630 This pushed inventors to find simpler and cheaper ways to make
1631 "automatic pictures." William Talbot soon discovered a process for
1632 making "negatives." But because the negatives were glass, and had to
1633 be kept wet, the process still remained expensive and cumbersome. In
1634 the
1870s, dry plates were developed, making it easier to separate the
1635 taking of a picture from its developing. These were still plates of
1636 glass, and thus it was still not a process within reach of most
1640 The technological change that made mass photography possible
1641 didn't happen until
1888, and was the creation of a single man. George
1642 <!-- PAGE BREAK 45 -->
1643 Eastman, himself an amateur photographer, was frustrated by the
1644 technology of photographs made with plates. In a flash of insight (so
1645 to speak), Eastman saw that if the film could be made to be flexible,
1646 it could be held on a single spindle. That roll could then be sent to
1647 a developer, driving the costs of photography down substantially. By
1648 lowering the costs, Eastman expected he could dramatically broaden the
1649 population of photographers.
1652 Eastman developed flexible, emulsion-coated paper film and placed
1653 rolls of it in small, simple cameras: the Kodak. The device was
1654 marketed on the basis of its simplicity. "You press the button and we
1655 do the rest."
<footnote><para>
1657 Reese V. Jenkins, Images and Enterprise (Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press,
1975),
112.
1658 </para></footnote> As he described in The Kodak Primer:
1662 The principle of the Kodak system is the separation of the work that
1663 any person whomsoever can do in making a photograph, from the work
1664 that only an expert can do. . . . We furnish anybody, man, woman or
1665 child, who has sufficient intelligence to point a box straight and
1666 press a button, with an instrument which altogether removes from the
1667 practice of photography the necessity for exceptional facilities or,
1668 in fact, any special knowledge of the art. It can be employed without
1669 preliminary study, without a darkroom and without
1670 chemicals.
<footnote>
1671 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian
</primary></indexterm>
1674 Brian Coe, The Birth of Photography (New York: Taplinger Publishing,
1680 For $
25, anyone could make pictures. The camera came preloaded
1681 with film, and when it had been used, the camera was returned to an
1682 Eastman factory, where the film was developed. Over time, of course,
1683 the cost of the camera and the ease with which it could be used both
1684 improved. Roll film thus became the basis for the explosive growth of
1685 popular photography. Eastman's camera first went on sale in
1888; one
1686 year later, Kodak was printing more than six thousand negatives a day.
1687 From
1888 through
1909, while industrial production was rising by
4.7
1688 percent, photographic equipment and material sales increased by
1689 percent.
<footnote><para>
1692 </para></footnote> Eastman Kodak's sales during the same period experienced
1693 an average annual increase of over
17 percent.
<footnote><para>
1695 Based on a chart in Jenkins, p.
178.
1698 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian
</primary></indexterm>
1701 <!-- PAGE BREAK 46 -->
1702 The real significance of Eastman's invention, however, was not
1703 economic. It was social. Professional photography gave individuals a
1704 glimpse of places they would never otherwise see. Amateur photography
1705 gave them the ability to record their own lives in a way they had
1706 never been able to do before. As author Brian Coe notes, "For the
1707 first time the snapshot album provided the man on the street with a
1708 permanent record of his family and its activities. . . . For the first
1709 time in history there exists an authentic visual record of the
1710 appearance and activities of the common man made without [literary]
1711 interpretation or bias."
<footnote><para>
1717 In this way, the Kodak camera and film were technologies of
1718 expression. The pencil or paintbrush was also a technology of
1719 expression, of course. But it took years of training before they could
1720 be deployed by amateurs in any useful or effective way. With the
1721 Kodak, expression was possible much sooner and more simply. The
1722 barrier to expression was lowered. Snobs would sneer at its "quality";
1723 professionals would discount it as irrelevant. But watch a child study
1724 how best to frame a picture and you get a sense of the experience of
1725 creativity that the Kodak enabled. Democratic tools gave ordinary
1726 people a way to express themselves more easily than any tools could
1730 What was required for this technology to flourish? Obviously,
1731 Eastman's genius was an important part. But also important was the
1732 legal environment within which Eastman's invention grew. For early in
1733 the history of photography, there was a series of judicial decisions
1734 that could well have changed the course of photography substantially.
1735 Courts were asked whether the photographer, amateur or professional,
1736 required permission before he could capture and print whatever image
1737 he wanted. Their answer was no.
<footnote><para>
1739 For illustrative cases, see, for example, Pavesich v. N.E. Life Ins. Co.,
50 S.E.
1743 The arguments in favor of requiring permission will sound surprisingly
1744 familiar. The photographer was "taking" something from the person or
1745 building whose photograph he shot
—pirating something of
1746 value. Some even thought he was taking the target's soul. Just as
1747 Disney was not free to take the pencils that his animators used to
1749 <!-- PAGE BREAK 47 -->
1750 Mickey, so, too, should these photographers not be free to take images
1751 that they thought valuable.
1753 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
1755 On the other side was an argument that should be familiar, as well.
1756 Sure, there may be something of value being used. But citizens should
1757 have the right to capture at least those images that stand in public view.
1758 (Louis Brandeis, who would become a Supreme Court Justice, thought
1759 the rule should be different for images from private spaces.
<footnote>
1760 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
1761 <indexterm><primary>Warren, Samuel D.
</primary></indexterm>
1764 Samuel D. Warren and Louis D. Brandeis, "The Right to Privacy,"
1765 Harvard Law Review
4 (
1890):
193.
1766 </para></footnote>) It may be that this means that the photographer
1767 gets something for nothing. Just as Disney could take inspiration from
1768 Steamboat Bill, Jr. or the Brothers Grimm, the photographer should be
1769 free to capture an image without compensating the source.
1772 Fortunately for Mr. Eastman, and for photography in general, these
1773 early decisions went in favor of the pirates. In general, no
1774 permission would be required before an image could be captured and
1775 shared with others. Instead, permission was presumed. Freedom was the
1776 default. (The law would eventually craft an exception for famous
1777 people: commercial photographers who snap pictures of famous people
1778 for commercial purposes have more restrictions than the rest of
1779 us. But in the ordinary case, the image can be captured without
1780 clearing the rights to do the capturing.
<footnote><para>
1782 See Melville B. Nimmer, "The Right of Publicity," Law and Contemporary
1783 Problems
19 (
1954):
203; William L. Prosser, "Privacy," California Law
1784 Review
48 (
1960)
398–407; White v. Samsung Electronics America,
1785 Inc.,
971 F.
2d
1395 (
9th Cir.
1992), cert. denied,
508 U.S.
951
1790 We can only speculate about how photography would have developed had
1791 the law gone the other way. If the presumption had been against the
1792 photographer, then the photographer would have had to demonstrate
1793 permission. Perhaps Eastman Kodak would have had to demonstrate
1794 permission, too, before it developed the film upon which images were
1795 captured. After all, if permission were not granted, then Eastman
1796 Kodak would be benefiting from the "theft" committed by the
1797 photographer. Just as Napster benefited from the copyright
1798 infringements committed by Napster users, Kodak would be benefiting
1799 from the "image-right" infringement of its photographers. We could
1800 imagine the law then requiring that some form of permission be
1801 demonstrated before a company developed pictures. We could imagine a
1802 system developing to demonstrate that permission.
1806 <!-- PAGE BREAK 48 -->
1807 But though we could imagine this system of permission, it would be
1808 very hard to see how photography could have flourished as it did if
1809 the requirement for permission had been built into the rules that
1810 govern it. Photography would have existed. It would have grown in
1811 importance over time. Professionals would have continued to use the
1812 technology as they did
—since professionals could have more
1813 easily borne the burdens of the permission system. But the spread of
1814 photography to ordinary people would not have occurred. Nothing like
1815 that growth would have been realized. And certainly, nothing like that
1816 growth in a democratic technology of expression would have been
1817 realized. If you drive through San Francisco's Presidio, you might
1818 see two gaudy yellow school buses painted over with colorful and
1819 striking images, and the logo "Just Think!" in place of the name of a
1820 school. But there's little that's "just" cerebral in the projects that
1821 these busses enable. These buses are filled with technologies that
1822 teach kids to tinker with film. Not the film of Eastman. Not even the
1823 film of your VCR. Rather the "film" of digital cameras. Just Think!
1824 is a project that enables kids to make films, as a way to understand
1825 and critique the filmed culture that they find all around them. Each
1826 year, these busses travel to more than thirty schools and enable three
1827 hundred to five hundred children to learn something about media by
1828 doing something with media. By doing, they think. By tinkering, they
1832 These buses are not cheap, but the technology they carry is
1833 increasingly so. The cost of a high-quality digital video system has
1834 fallen dramatically. As one analyst puts it, "Five years ago, a good
1835 real-time digital video editing system cost $
25,
000. Today you can get
1836 professional quality for $
595."
<footnote><para>
1838 H. Edward Goldberg, "Essential Presentation Tools: Hardware and
1840 You Need to Create Digital Multimedia Presentations," cadalyst,
1841 February
2002, available at
1842 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
7</ulink>.
1844 These buses are filled with technology that
1845 would have cost hundreds of thousands just ten years ago. And it is
1846 now feasible to imagine not just buses like this, but classrooms across
1847 the country where kids are learning more and more of something
1848 teachers call "media literacy."
1851 <!-- PAGE BREAK 49 -->
1852 "Media literacy," as Dave Yanofsky, the executive director of Just
1853 Think!, puts it, "is the ability . . . to understand, analyze, and
1854 deconstruct media images. Its aim is to make [kids] literate about the
1855 way media works, the way it's constructed, the way it's delivered, and
1856 the way people access it."
1859 This may seem like an odd way to think about "literacy." For most
1860 people, literacy is about reading and writing. Faulkner and Hemingway
1861 and noticing split infinitives are the things that "literate" people know
1865 Maybe. But in a world where children see on average
390 hours of
1866 television commercials per year, or between
20,
000 and
45,
000
1867 commercials generally,
<footnote><para>
1869 Judith Van Evra, Television and Child Development (Hillsdale, N.J.:
1870 Lawrence Erlbaum Associates,
1990); "Findings on Family and TV
1871 Study," Denver Post,
25 May
1997, B6.
1873 it is increasingly important to understand the
1874 "grammar" of media. For just as there is a grammar for the written
1875 word, so, too, is there one for media. And just as kids learn how to write
1876 by writing lots of terrible prose, kids learn how to write media by
1878 lots of (at least at first) terrible media.
1881 A growing field of academics and activists sees this form of literacy
1882 as crucial to the next generation of culture. For though anyone who has
1883 written understands how difficult writing is
—how difficult it is to
1885 the story, to keep a reader's attention, to craft language to be
1886 understandable
—few of us have any real sense of how difficult media
1887 is. Or more fundamentally, few of us have a sense of how media works,
1888 how it holds an audience or leads it through a story, how it triggers
1889 emotion or builds suspense.
1892 It took filmmaking a generation before it could do these things well.
1893 But even then, the knowledge was in the filming, not in writing about
1894 the film. The skill came from experiencing the making of a film, not
1895 from reading a book about it. One learns to write by writing and then
1896 reflecting upon what one has written. One learns to write with images
1897 by making them and then reflecting upon what one has created.
1899 <indexterm><primary>Crichton, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
1901 This grammar has changed as media has changed. When it was just film,
1902 as Elizabeth Daley, executive director of the University of Southern
1903 California's Annenberg Center for Communication and dean of the
1905 <!-- PAGE BREAK 50 -->
1906 USC School of Cinema-Television, explained to me, the grammar was
1907 about "the placement of objects, color, . . . rhythm, pacing, and
1909 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
1910 <indexterm><primary>Daley, Elizabeth
</primary></indexterm>
1913 Interview with Elizabeth Daley and Stephanie Barish,
13 December
1916 But as computers open up an interactive space where a story is
1917 "played" as well as experienced, that grammar changes. The simple
1918 control of narrative is lost, and so other techniques are necessary. Author
1919 Michael Crichton had mastered the narrative of science fiction.
1920 But when he tried to design a computer game based on one of his
1921 works, it was a new craft he had to learn. How to lead people through
1922 a game without their feeling they have been led was not obvious, even
1923 to a wildly successful author.
<footnote><para>
1925 See Scott Steinberg, "Crichton Gets Medieval on PCs," E!online,
4
1926 November
2000, available at
1927 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
8</ulink>; "Timeline,"
22 November
2000,
1929 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
9</ulink>.
1932 <indexterm><primary>computer games
</primary></indexterm>
1934 This skill is precisely the craft a filmmaker learns. As Daley
1935 describes, "people are very surprised about how they are led through a
1936 film. [I]t is perfectly constructed to keep you from seeing it, so you
1937 have no idea. If a filmmaker succeeds you do not know how you were
1938 led." If you know you were led through a film, the film has failed.
1941 Yet the push for an expanded literacy
—one that goes beyond text
1942 to include audio and visual elements
—is not about making better
1943 film directors. The aim is not to improve the profession of
1944 filmmaking at all. Instead, as Daley explained,
1948 From my perspective, probably the most important digital divide
1949 is not access to a box. It's the ability to be empowered with the
1950 language that that box works in. Otherwise only a very few people
1951 can write with this language, and all the rest of us are reduced to
1956 "Read-only." Passive recipients of culture produced elsewhere.
1957 Couch potatoes. Consumers. This is the world of media from the
1961 The twenty-first century could be different. This is the crucial point:
1962 It could be both read and write. Or at least reading and better
1964 the craft of writing. Or best, reading and understanding the
1965 tools that enable the writing to lead or mislead. The aim of any literacy,
1966 <!-- PAGE BREAK 51 -->
1967 and this literacy in particular, is to "empower people to choose the
1969 language for what they need to create or express."
<footnote>
1970 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
1973 Interview with Daley and Barish.
1974 </para></footnote> It is to enable
1975 students "to communicate in the language of the twenty-first century."
<footnote><para>
1980 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
1982 As with any language, this language comes more easily to some than to
1983 others. It doesn't necessarily come more easily to those who excel in
1984 written language. Daley and Stephanie Barish, director of the
1985 Institute for Multimedia Literacy at the Annenberg Center, describe
1986 one particularly poignant example of a project they ran in a high
1987 school. The high school was a very poor inner-city Los Angeles
1988 school. In all the traditional measures of success, this school was a
1989 failure. But Daley and Barish ran a program that gave kids an
1990 opportunity to use film to express meaning about something the
1991 students know something about
—gun violence.
1994 The class was held on Friday afternoons, and it created a relatively
1995 new problem for the school. While the challenge in most classes was
1996 getting the kids to come, the challenge in this class was keeping them
1997 away. The "kids were showing up at
6 A.M. and leaving at
5 at night,"
1998 said Barish. They were working harder than in any other class to do
1999 what education should be about
—learning how to express themselves.
2002 Using whatever "free web stuff they could find," and relatively simple
2003 tools to enable the kids to mix "image, sound, and text," Barish said
2004 this class produced a series of projects that showed something about
2005 gun violence that few would otherwise understand. This was an issue
2006 close to the lives of these students. The project "gave them a tool
2007 and empowered them to be able to both understand it and talk about
2008 it," Barish explained. That tool succeeded in creating
2009 expression
—far more successfully and powerfully than could have
2010 been created using only text. "If you had said to these students, `you
2011 have to do it in text,' they would've just thrown their hands up and
2012 gone and done something else," Barish described, in part, no doubt,
2013 because expressing themselves in text is not something these students
2014 can do well. Yet neither is text a form in which these ideas can be
2015 expressed well. The power of this message depended upon its connection
2016 to this form of expression.
2020 <!-- PAGE BREAK 52 -->
2021 "But isn't education about teaching kids to write?" I asked. In part,
2022 of course, it is. But why are we teaching kids to write? Education,
2024 explained, is about giving students a way of "constructing
2026 To say that that means just writing is like saying teaching writing
2027 is only about teaching kids how to spell. Text is one part
—and
2029 not the most powerful part
—of constructing meaning. As Daley
2030 explained in the most moving part of our interview,
2034 What you want is to give these students ways of constructing
2035 meaning. If all you give them is text, they're not going to do it.
2036 Because they can't. You know, you've got Johnny who can look at a
2037 video, he can play a video game, he can do graffiti all over your
2038 walls, he can take your car apart, and he can do all sorts of other
2039 things. He just can't read your text. So Johnny comes to school and
2040 you say, "Johnny, you're illiterate. Nothing you can do matters."
2041 Well, Johnny then has two choices: He can dismiss you or he [can]
2042 dismiss himself. If his ego is healthy at all, he's going to dismiss
2043 you. [But i]nstead, if you say, "Well, with all these things that you
2044 can do, let's talk about this issue. Play for me music that you think
2045 reflects that, or show me images that you think reflect that, or draw
2046 for me something that reflects that." Not by giving a kid a video
2047 camera and . . . saying, "Let's go have fun with the video camera and
2048 make a little movie." But instead, really help you take these elements
2049 that you understand, that are your language, and construct meaning
2050 about the topic. . . .
2053 That empowers enormously. And then what happens, of
2054 course, is eventually, as it has happened in all these classes, they
2055 bump up against the fact, "I need to explain this and I really need
2056 to write something." And as one of the teachers told Stephanie,
2057 they would rewrite a paragraph
5,
6,
7,
8 times, till they got it right.
2060 Because they needed to. There was a reason for doing it. They
2061 needed to say something, as opposed to just jumping through
2062 your hoops. They actually needed to use a language that they
2063 <!-- PAGE BREAK 53 -->
2064 didn't speak very well. But they had come to understand that they
2065 had a lot of power with this language."
2069 When two planes crashed into the World Trade Center, another into the
2070 Pentagon, and a fourth into a Pennsylvania field, all media around the
2071 world shifted to this news. Every moment of just about every day for
2072 that week, and for weeks after, television in particular, and media
2073 generally, retold the story of the events we had just witnessed. The
2074 telling was a retelling, because we had seen the events that were
2075 described. The genius of this awful act of terrorism was that the
2076 delayed second attack was perfectly timed to assure that the whole
2077 world would be watching.
2080 These retellings had an increasingly familiar feel. There was music
2081 scored for the intermissions, and fancy graphics that flashed across
2082 the screen. There was a formula to interviews. There was "balance,"
2083 and seriousness. This was news choreographed in the way we have
2084 increasingly come to expect it, "news as entertainment," even if the
2085 entertainment is tragedy.
2087 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
2088 <indexterm><primary>CBS
</primary></indexterm>
2090 But in addition to this produced news about the "tragedy of September
2091 11," those of us tied to the Internet came to see a very different
2092 production as well. The Internet was filled with accounts of the same
2093 events. Yet these Internet accounts had a very different flavor. Some
2094 people constructed photo pages that captured images from around the
2095 world and presented them as slide shows with text. Some offered open
2096 letters. There were sound recordings. There was anger and frustration.
2097 There were attempts to provide context. There was, in short, an
2098 extraordinary worldwide barn raising, in the sense Mike Godwin uses
2099 the term in his book Cyber Rights, around a news event that had
2100 captured the attention of the world. There was ABC and CBS, but there
2101 was also the Internet.
2104 I don't mean simply to praise the Internet
—though I do think the
2105 people who supported this form of speech should be praised. I mean
2106 instead to point to a significance in this form of speech. For like a
2107 Kodak, the Internet enables people to capture images. And like in a
2109 <!-- PAGE BREAK 54 -->
2110 by a student on the "Just Think!" bus, the visual images could be mixed
2114 But unlike any technology for simply capturing images, the Internet
2115 allows these creations to be shared with an extraordinary number of
2116 people, practically instantaneously. This is something new in our
2117 tradition
—not just that culture can be captured mechanically,
2118 and obviously not just that events are commented upon critically, but
2119 that this mix of captured images, sound, and commentary can be widely
2120 spread practically instantaneously.
2123 September
11 was not an aberration. It was a beginning. Around
2124 the same time, a form of communication that has grown dramatically
2125 was just beginning to come into public consciousness: the Web-log, or
2126 blog. The blog is a kind of public diary, and within some cultures, such
2127 as in Japan, it functions very much like a diary. In those cultures, it
2128 records private facts in a public way
—it's a kind of electronic Jerry
2129 Springer, available anywhere in the world.
2132 But in the United States, blogs have taken on a very different
2133 character. There are some who use the space simply to talk about
2134 their private life. But there are many who use the space to engage in
2135 public discourse. Discussing matters of public import, criticizing
2136 others who are mistaken in their views, criticizing politicians about
2137 the decisions they make, offering solutions to problems we all see:
2138 blogs create the sense of a virtual public meeting, but one in which
2139 we don't all hope to be there at the same time and in which
2140 conversations are not necessarily linked. The best of the blog entries
2141 are relatively short; they point directly to words used by others,
2142 criticizing with or adding to them. They are arguably the most
2143 important form of unchoreographed public discourse that we have.
2146 That's a strong statement. Yet it says as much about our democracy as
2147 it does about blogs. This is the part of America that is most
2148 difficult for those of us who love America to accept: Our democracy
2149 has atrophied. Of course we have elections, and most of the time the
2150 courts allow those elections to count. A relatively small number of
2152 <!-- PAGE BREAK 55 -->
2153 in those elections. The cycle of these elections has become totally
2154 professionalized and routinized. Most of us think this is democracy.
2157 But democracy has never just been about elections. Democracy
2158 means rule by the people, but rule means something more than mere
2159 elections. In our tradition, it also means control through reasoned
2160 discourse. This was the idea that captured the imagination of Alexis
2161 de Tocqueville, the nineteenth-century French lawyer who wrote the
2162 most important account of early "Democracy in America." It wasn't
2163 popular elections that fascinated him
—it was the jury, an
2164 institution that gave ordinary people the right to choose life or
2165 death for other citizens. And most fascinating for him was that the
2166 jury didn't just vote about the outcome they would impose. They
2167 deliberated. Members argued about the "right" result; they tried to
2168 persuade each other of the "right" result, and in criminal cases at
2169 least, they had to agree upon a unanimous result for the process to
2170 come to an end.
<footnote><para>
2172 See, for example, Alexis de Tocqueville, Democracy in America, bk.
1, trans.
2173 Henry Reeve (New York: Bantam Books,
2000), ch.
16.
2177 Yet even this institution flags in American life today. And in its
2178 place, there is no systematic effort to enable citizen deliberation. Some
2179 are pushing to create just such an institution.
<footnote><para>
2181 Bruce Ackerman and James Fishkin, "Deliberation Day," Journal of
2183 Philosophy
10 (
2) (
2002):
129.
2185 And in some towns in
2186 New England, something close to deliberation remains. But for most
2187 of us for most of the time, there is no time or place for "democratic
2192 More bizarrely, there is generally not even permission for it to
2194 We, the most powerful democracy in the world, have developed a
2195 strong norm against talking about politics. It's fine to talk about
2197 with people you agree with. But it is rude to argue about politics
2198 with people you disagree with. Political discourse becomes isolated,
2199 and isolated discourse becomes more extreme.
<footnote><para>
2201 Cass Sunstein, Republic.com (Princeton: Princeton University Press,
2001),
2202 65–80,
175,
182,
183,
192.
2203 </para></footnote> We say what our
2204 friends want to hear, and hear very little beyond what our friends say.
2207 Enter the blog. The blog's very architecture solves one part of this
2208 problem. People post when they want to post, and people read when
2209 they want to read. The most difficult time is synchronous time.
2211 that enable asynchronous communication, such as e-mail,
2212 increase the opportunity for communication. Blogs allow for public
2214 <!-- PAGE BREAK 56 -->
2215 discourse without the public ever needing to gather in a single public
2219 But beyond architecture, blogs also have solved the problem of
2220 norms. There's no norm (yet) in blog space not to talk about politics.
2221 Indeed, the space is filled with political speech, on both the right and
2222 the left. Some of the most popular sites are conservative or libertarian,
2223 but there are many of all political stripes. And even blogs that are not
2224 political cover political issues when the occasion merits.
2227 The significance of these blogs is tiny now, though not so tiny. The
2228 name Howard Dean may well have faded from the
2004 presidential
2229 race but for blogs. Yet even if the number of readers is small, the
2231 is having an effect.
2234 One direct effect is on stories that had a different life cycle in the
2235 mainstream media. The Trent Lott affair is an example. When Lott
2236 "misspoke" at a party for Senator Strom Thurmond, essentially
2238 Thurmond's segregationist policies, he calculated correctly that this
2239 story would disappear from the mainstream press within forty-eight
2240 hours. It did. But he didn't calculate its life cycle in blog space. The
2241 bloggers kept researching the story. Over time, more and more
2243 of the same "misspeaking" emerged. Finally, the story broke
2244 back into the mainstream press. In the end, Lott was forced to resign
2245 as senate majority leader.
<footnote><para>
2247 Noah Shachtman, "With Incessant Postings, a Pundit Stirs the Pot," New
2248 York Times,
16 January
2003, G5.
2252 This different cycle is possible because the same commercial pressures
2253 don't exist with blogs as with other ventures. Television and
2254 newspapers are commercial entities. They must work to keep attention.
2255 If they lose readers, they lose revenue. Like sharks, they must move
2259 But bloggers don't have a similar constraint. They can obsess, they
2260 can focus, they can get serious. If a particular blogger writes a
2261 particularly interesting story, more and more people link to that
2262 story. And as the number of links to a particular story increases, it
2263 rises in the ranks of stories. People read what is popular; what is
2264 popular has been selected by a very democratic process of
2265 peer-generated rankings.
2268 There's a second way, as well, in which blogs have a different cycle
2269 <!-- PAGE BREAK 57 -->
2270 from the mainstream press. As Dave Winer, one of the fathers of this
2271 movement and a software author for many decades, told me, another
2272 difference is the absence of a financial "conflict of interest." "I think you
2273 have to take the conflict of interest" out of journalism, Winer told me.
2274 "An amateur journalist simply doesn't have a conflict of interest, or the
2275 conflict of interest is so easily disclosed that you know you can sort of
2276 get it out of the way."
2278 <indexterm><primary>CNN
</primary></indexterm>
2280 These conflicts become more important as media becomes more
2281 concentrated (more on this below). A concentrated media can hide more
2282 from the public than an unconcentrated media can
—as CNN admitted
2283 it did after the Iraq war because it was afraid of the consequences to
2284 its own employees.
<footnote><para>
2286 Telephone interview with David Winer,
16 April
2003.
2288 It also needs to sustain a more coherent
2289 account. (In the middle of the Iraq war, I read a post on the Internet
2290 from someone who was at that time listening to a satellite uplink with
2291 a reporter in Iraq. The New York headquarters was telling the reporter
2292 over and over that her account of the war was too bleak: She needed to
2293 offer a more optimistic story. When she told New York that wasn't
2294 warranted, they told her that they were writing "the story.")
2296 <para> Blog space gives amateurs a way to enter the
2297 debate
—"amateur" not in the sense of inexperienced, but in the
2298 sense of an Olympic athlete, meaning not paid by anyone to give their
2299 reports. It allows for a much broader range of input into a story, as
2300 reporting on the Columbia disaster revealed, when hundreds from across
2301 the southwest United States turned to the Internet to retell what they
2302 had seen.
<footnote><para>
2304 John Schwartz, "Loss of the Shuttle: The Internet; A Wealth of
2305 Information Online," New York Times,
2 February
2003, A28; Staci
2306 D. Kramer, "Shuttle Disaster Coverage Mixed, but Strong Overall,"
2307 Online Journalism Review,
2 February
2003, available at
2308 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
10</ulink>.
2310 And it drives readers to read across the range of accounts and
2311 "triangulate," as Winer puts it, the truth. Blogs, Winer says, are
2312 "communicating directly with our constituency, and the middle man is
2313 out of it"
—with all the benefits, and costs, that might entail.
2316 Winer is optimistic about the future of journalism infected
2317 with blogs. "It's going to become an essential skill," Winer predicts,
2318 for public figures and increasingly for private figures as well. It's
2319 not clear that "journalism" is happy about this
—some journalists
2320 have been told to curtail their blogging.
<footnote>
2321 <indexterm><primary>CNN
</primary></indexterm>
2324 See Michael Falcone, "Does an Editor's Pencil Ruin a Web Log?" New
2325 York Times,
29 September
2003, C4. ("Not all news organizations have
2326 been as accepting of employees who blog. Kevin Sites, a CNN
2327 correspondent in Iraq who started a blog about his reporting of the
2328 war on March
9, stopped posting
12 days later at his bosses'
2329 request. Last year Steve Olafson, a Houston Chronicle reporter, was
2330 fired for keeping a personal Web log, published under a pseudonym,
2331 that dealt with some of the issues and people he was covering.")
2333 But it is clear that we are still in transition. "A
2335 <!-- PAGE BREAK 58 -->
2336 lot of what we are doing now is warm-up exercises," Winer told me.
2337 There is a lot that must mature before this space has its mature effect.
2338 And as the inclusion of content in this space is the least infringing use
2339 of the Internet (meaning infringing on copyright), Winer said, "we will
2340 be the last thing that gets shut down."
2343 This speech affects democracy. Winer thinks that happens because
2344 "you don't have to work for somebody who controls, [for] a
2346 That is true. But it affects democracy in another way as well.
2347 As more and more citizens express what they think, and defend it in
2348 writing, that will change the way people understand public issues. It is
2349 easy to be wrong and misguided in your head. It is harder when the
2350 product of your mind can be criticized by others. Of course, it is a rare
2351 human who admits that he has been persuaded that he is wrong. But it
2352 is even rarer for a human to ignore when he has been proven wrong.
2353 The writing of ideas, arguments, and criticism improves democracy.
2354 Today there are probably a couple of million blogs where such writing
2355 happens. When there are ten million, there will be something
2360 John Seely Brown is the chief scientist of the Xerox Corporation.
2361 His work, as his Web site describes it, is "human learning and . . . the
2362 creation of knowledge ecologies for creating . . . innovation."
2365 Brown thus looks at these technologies of digital creativity a bit
2367 from the perspectives I've sketched so far. I'm sure he would be
2368 excited about any technology that might improve democracy. But his
2369 real excitement comes from how these technologies affect learning.
2372 As Brown believes, we learn by tinkering. When "a lot of us grew
2373 up," he explains, that tinkering was done "on motorcycle engines,
2375 engines, automobiles, radios, and so on." But digital
2377 enable a different kind of tinkering
—with abstract ideas though
2378 in concrete form. The kids at Just Think! not only think about how
2379 a commercial portrays a politician; using digital technology, they can
2380 <!-- PAGE BREAK 59 -->
2381 take the commercial apart and manipulate it, tinker with it to see how
2382 it does what it does. Digital technologies launch a kind of bricolage, or
2383 "free collage," as Brown calls it. Many get to add to or transform the
2384 tinkering of many others.
2387 The best large-scale example of this kind of tinkering so far is free
2388 software or open-source software (FS/OSS). FS/OSS is software whose
2389 source code is shared. Anyone can download the technology that makes
2390 a FS/OSS program run. And anyone eager to learn how a particular bit
2391 of FS/OSS technology works can tinker with the code.
2394 This opportunity creates a "completely new kind of learning
2396 as Brown describes. "As soon as you start doing that, you . . .
2397 unleash a free collage on the community, so that other people can start
2398 looking at your code, tinkering with it, trying it out, seeing if they can
2399 improve it." Each effort is a kind of apprenticeship. "Open source
2401 a major apprenticeship platform."
2404 In this process, "the concrete things you tinker with are abstract.
2405 They are code." Kids are "shifting to the ability to tinker in the
2407 and this tinkering is no longer an isolated activity that you're
2409 in your garage. You are tinkering with a community platform. . . .
2410 You are tinkering with other people's stuff. The more you tinker the
2411 more you improve." The more you improve, the more you learn.
2414 This same thing happens with content, too. And it happens in the
2415 same collaborative way when that content is part of the Web. As
2416 Brown puts it, "the Web [is] the first medium that truly honors
2418 forms of intelligence." Earlier technologies, such as the typewriter
2419 or word processors, helped amplify text. But the Web amplifies much
2420 more than text. "The Web . . . says if you are musical, if you are
2422 if you are visual, if you are interested in film . . . [then] there is a lot
2423 you can start to do on this medium. [It] can now amplify and honor
2424 these multiple forms of intelligence."
2426 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2428 Brown is talking about what Elizabeth Daley, Stephanie Barish,
2429 and Just Think! teach: that this tinkering with culture teaches as well
2431 <!-- PAGE BREAK 60 -->
2432 as creates. It develops talents differently, and it builds a different kind
2436 Yet the freedom to tinker with these objects is not guaranteed.
2437 Indeed, as we'll see through the course of this book, that freedom is
2438 increasingly highly contested. While there's no doubt that your father
2439 had the right to tinker with the car engine, there's great doubt that
2440 your child will have the right to tinker with the images she finds all
2441 around. The law and, increasingly, technology interfere with a
2442 freedom that technology, and curiosity, would otherwise ensure.
2445 These restrictions have become the focus of researchers and scholars.
2446 Professor Ed Felten of Princeton (whom we'll see more of in chapter
2447 10) has developed a powerful argument in favor of the "right to
2448 tinker" as it applies to computer science and to knowledge in
2449 general.
<footnote><para>
2451 See, for example, Edward Felten and Andrew Appel, "Technological Access
2452 Control Interferes with Noninfringing Scholarship," Communications
2453 of the Association for Computer Machinery
43 (
2000):
9.
2455 But Brown's concern is earlier, or younger, or more fundamental. It is
2456 about the learning that kids can do, or can't do, because of the law.
2459 "This is where education in the twenty-first century is going," Brown
2460 explains. We need to "understand how kids who grow up digital think
2464 "Yet," as Brown continued, and as the balance of this book will
2465 evince, "we are building a legal system that completely suppresses the
2466 natural tendencies of today's digital kids. . . . We're building an
2467 architecture that unleashes
60 percent of the brain [and] a legal
2468 system that closes down that part of the brain."
2471 We're building a technology that takes the magic of Kodak, mixes
2472 moving images and sound, and adds a space for commentary and an
2473 opportunity to spread that creativity everywhere. But we're building
2474 the law to close down that technology.
2477 "No way to run a culture," as Brewster Kahle, whom we'll meet in
2478 chapter
9, quipped to me in a rare moment of despondence.
2480 <!-- PAGE BREAK 61 -->
2482 <sect1 id=
"catalogs">
2483 <title>CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs
</title>
2485 In the fall of
2002, Jesse Jordan of Oceanside, New York, enrolled as
2486 a freshman at Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute, in Troy, New York.
2487 His major at RPI was information technology. Though he is not a
2488 programmer, in October Jesse decided to begin to tinker with search
2489 engine technology that was available on the RPI network.
2492 RPI is one of America's foremost technological research institutions.
2493 It offers degrees in fields ranging from architecture and engineering
2494 to information sciences. More than
65 percent of its five thousand
2495 undergraduates finished in the top
10 percent of their high school
2496 class. The school is thus a perfect mix of talent and experience to
2497 imagine and then build, a generation for the network age.
2500 RPI's computer network links students, faculty, and administration to
2501 one another. It also links RPI to the Internet. Not everything
2502 available on the RPI network is available on the Internet. But the
2503 network is designed to enable students to get access to the Internet,
2504 as well as more intimate access to other members of the RPI community.
2507 Search engines are a measure of a network's intimacy. Google
2508 <!-- PAGE BREAK 62 -->
2509 brought the Internet much closer to all of us by fantastically
2510 improving the quality of search on the network. Specialty search
2511 engines can do this even better. The idea of "intranet" search
2512 engines, search engines that search within the network of a particular
2513 institution, is to provide users of that institution with better
2514 access to material from that institution. Businesses do this all the
2515 time, enabling employees to have access to material that people
2516 outside the business can't get. Universities do it as well.
2519 These engines are enabled by the network technology itself.
2520 Microsoft, for example, has a network file system that makes it very
2521 easy for search engines tuned to that network to query the system for
2522 information about the publicly (within that network) available
2523 content. Jesse's search engine was built to take advantage of this
2524 technology. It used Microsoft's network file system to build an index
2525 of all the files available within the RPI network.
2528 Jesse's wasn't the first search engine built for the RPI network.
2529 Indeed, his engine was a simple modification of engines that others
2530 had built. His single most important improvement over those engines
2531 was to fix a bug within the Microsoft file-sharing system that could
2532 cause a user's computer to crash. With the engines that existed
2533 before, if you tried to access a file through a Windows browser that
2534 was on a computer that was off-line, your computer could crash. Jesse
2535 modified the system a bit to fix that problem, by adding a button that
2536 a user could click to see if the machine holding the file was still
2540 Jesse's engine went on-line in late October. Over the following six
2541 months, he continued to tweak it to improve its functionality. By
2542 March, the system was functioning quite well. Jesse had more than one
2543 million files in his directory, including every type of content that might
2544 be on users' computers.
2547 Thus the index his search engine produced included pictures,
2548 which students could use to put on their own Web sites; copies of notes
2549 or research; copies of information pamphlets; movie clips that
2551 might have created; university brochures
—basically anything that
2552 <!-- PAGE BREAK 63 -->
2553 users of the RPI network made available in a public folder of their
2557 But the index also included music files. In fact, one quarter of the
2558 files that Jesse's search engine listed were music files. But that
2559 means, of course, that three quarters were not, and
—so that this
2560 point is absolutely clear
—Jesse did nothing to induce people to
2561 put music files in their public folders. He did nothing to target the
2562 search engine to these files. He was a kid tinkering with a
2563 Google-like technology at a university where he was studying
2564 information science, and hence, tinkering was the aim. Unlike Google,
2565 or Microsoft, for that matter, he made no money from this tinkering;
2566 he was not connected to any business that would make any money from
2567 this experiment. He was a kid tinkering with technology in an
2568 environment where tinkering with technology was precisely what he was
2572 On April
3,
2003, Jesse was contacted by the dean of students at
2573 RPI. The dean informed Jesse that the Recording Industry Association
2574 of America, the RIAA, would be filing a lawsuit against him and three
2575 other students whom he didn't even know, two of them at other
2576 universities. A few hours later, Jesse was served with papers from
2577 the suit. As he read these papers and watched the news reports about
2578 them, he was increasingly astonished.
2581 "It was absurd," he told me. "I don't think I did anything
2582 wrong. . . . I don't think there's anything wrong with the search
2583 engine that I ran or . . . what I had done to it. I mean, I hadn't
2584 modified it in any way that promoted or enhanced the work of
2585 pirates. I just modified the search engine in a way that would make it
2586 easier to use"
—again, a search engine, which Jesse had not
2587 himself built, using the Windows filesharing system, which Jesse had
2588 not himself built, to enable members of the RPI community to get
2589 access to content, which Jesse had not himself created or posted, and
2590 the vast majority of which had nothing to do with music.
2593 But the RIAA branded Jesse a pirate. They claimed he operated a
2594 network and had therefore "willfully" violated copyright laws. They
2595 <!-- PAGE BREAK 64 -->
2597 that he pay them the damages for his wrong. For cases of
2598 "willful infringement," the Copyright Act specifies something lawyers
2599 call "statutory damages." These damages permit a copyright owner to
2600 claim $
150,
000 per infringement. As the RIAA alleged more than one
2601 hundred specific copyright infringements, they therefore demanded
2602 that Jesse pay them at least $
15,
000,
000.
2605 Similar lawsuits were brought against three other students: one
2606 other student at RPI, one at Michigan Technical University, and one at
2607 Princeton. Their situations were similar to Jesse's. Though each case
2608 was different in detail, the bottom line in each was exactly the same:
2609 huge demands for "damages" that the RIAA claimed it was entitled to.
2610 If you added up the claims, these four lawsuits were asking courts in
2611 the United States to award the plaintiffs close to $
100 billion
—six
2612 times the total profit of the film industry in
2001.
<footnote><para>
2614 Tim Goral, "Recording Industry Goes After Campus P-
2-P Networks:
2615 Suit Alleges $
97.8 Billion in Damages," Professional Media Group LCC
6
2616 (
2003):
5, available at
2003 WL
55179443.
2620 Jesse called his parents. They were supportive but a bit frightened.
2621 An uncle was a lawyer. He began negotiations with the RIAA. They
2622 demanded to know how much money Jesse had. Jesse had saved
2623 $
12,
000 from summer jobs and other employment. They demanded
2624 $
12,
000 to dismiss the case.
2627 The RIAA wanted Jesse to admit to doing something wrong. He
2628 refused. They wanted him to agree to an injunction that would
2629 essentially make it impossible for him to work in many fields of
2630 technology for the rest of his life. He refused. They made him
2631 understand that this process of being sued was not going to be
2632 pleasant. (As Jesse's father recounted to me, the chief lawyer on the
2633 case, Matt Oppenheimer, told Jesse, "You don't want to pay another
2634 visit to a dentist like me.") And throughout, the RIAA insisted it
2635 would not settle the case until it took every penny Jesse had saved.
2638 Jesse's family was outraged at these claims. They wanted to fight.
2639 But Jesse's uncle worked to educate the family about the nature of the
2640 American legal system. Jesse could fight the RIAA. He might even
2641 win. But the cost of fighting a lawsuit like this, Jesse was told, would be
2642 at least $
250,
000. If he won, he would not recover that money. If he
2643 <!-- PAGE BREAK 65 -->
2644 won, he would have a piece of paper saying he had won, and a piece of
2645 paper saying he and his family were bankrupt.
2648 So Jesse faced a mafia-like choice: $
250,
000 and a chance at winning,
2649 or $
12,
000 and a settlement.
2652 The recording industry insists this is a matter of law and morality.
2653 Let's put the law aside for a moment and think about the morality.
2654 Where is the morality in a lawsuit like this? What is the virtue in
2655 scapegoatism? The RIAA is an extraordinarily powerful lobby. The
2656 president of the RIAA is reported to make more than $
1 million a year.
2657 Artists, on the other hand, are not well paid. The average recording
2658 artist makes $
45,
900.
<footnote><para>
2660 Occupational Employment Survey, U.S. Dept. of Labor (
2001)
2661 (
27–2042—Musicians and Singers). See also National Endowment for
2662 the Arts, More Than One in a Blue Moon (
2000).
2664 There are plenty of ways for the RIAA to affect
2665 and direct policy. So where is the morality in taking money from a
2666 student for running a search engine?
<footnote><para>
2668 Douglas Lichtman makes a related point in "KaZaA and Punishment,"
2669 Wall Street Journal,
10 September
2003, A24.
2673 On June
23, Jesse wired his savings to the lawyer working for the
2674 RIAA. The case against him was then dismissed. And with this, this
2675 kid who had tinkered a computer into a $
15 million lawsuit became an
2680 I was definitely not an activist [before]. I never really meant to be
2681 an activist. . . . [But] I've been pushed into this. In no way did I
2682 ever foresee anything like this, but I think it's just completely
2683 absurd what the RIAA has done.
2687 Jesse's parents betray a certain pride in their reluctant activist. As
2688 his father told me, Jesse "considers himself very conservative, and so do
2689 I. . . . He's not a tree hugger. . . . I think it's bizarre that they would
2690 pick on him. But he wants to let people know that they're sending the
2691 wrong message. And he wants to correct the record."
2693 <!-- PAGE BREAK 66 -->
2695 <sect1 id=
"pirates">
2696 <title>CHAPTER FOUR: "Pirates"
</title>
2698 If "piracy" means using the creative property of others without
2699 their permission
—if "if value, then right" is true
—then the history of
2700 the content industry is a history of piracy. Every important sector of
2701 "big media" today
—film, records, radio, and cable TV
—was born of a
2702 kind of piracy so defined. The consistent story is how last generation's
2703 pirates join this generation's country club
—until now.
2708 The film industry of Hollywood was built by fleeing pirates.
<footnote><para>
2710 I am grateful to Peter DiMauro for pointing me to this extraordinary
2711 history. See also Siva Vaidhyanathan, Copyrights and Copywrongs,
87–93,
2712 which details Edison's "adventures" with copyright and patent.
2714 Creators and directors migrated from the East Coast to California in
2715 the early twentieth century in part to escape controls that patents
2716 granted the inventor of filmmaking, Thomas Edison. These controls were
2717 exercised through a monopoly "trust," the Motion Pictures Patents
2718 Company, and were based on Thomas Edison's creative
2719 property
—patents. Edison formed the MPPC to exercise the rights
2720 this creative property
2721 <!-- PAGE BREAK 67 -->
2722 gave him, and the MPPC was serious about the control it demanded.
2725 As one commentator tells one part of the story,
2729 A January
1909 deadline was set for all companies to comply with
2730 the license. By February, unlicensed outlaws, who referred to
2731 themselves as independents protested the trust and carried on
2732 business without submitting to the Edison monopoly. In the
2733 summer of
1909 the independent movement was in full-swing,
2734 with producers and theater owners using illegal equipment and
2735 imported film stock to create their own underground market.
2738 With the country experiencing a tremendous expansion in the number of
2739 nickelodeons, the Patents Company reacted to the independent movement
2740 by forming a strong-arm subsidiary known as the General Film Company
2741 to block the entry of non-licensed independents. With coercive tactics
2742 that have become legendary, General Film confiscated unlicensed
2743 equipment, discontinued product supply to theaters which showed
2744 unlicensed films, and effectively monopolized distribution with the
2745 acquisition of all U.S. film exchanges, except for the one owned by
2746 the independent William Fox who defied the Trust even after his
2747 license was revoked.
<footnote><para>
2749 J. A. Aberdeen, Hollywood Renegades: The Society of Independent Motion
2750 Picture Producers (Cobblestone Entertainment,
2000) and expanded texts
2751 posted at "The Edison Movie Monopoly: The Motion Picture Patents
2752 Company vs. the Independent Outlaws," available at
2753 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
11</ulink>. For a
2754 discussion of the economic motive behind both these limits and the
2755 limits imposed by Victor on phonographs, see Randal C. Picker, "From
2756 Edison to the Broadcast Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and Refusal and
2757 the Propertization of Copyright" (September
2002), University of
2758 Chicago Law School, James M. Olin Program in Law and Economics,
2759 Working Paper No.
159.
</para></footnote>
2763 The Napsters of those days, the "independents," were companies like
2764 Fox. And no less than today, these independents were vigorously
2765 resisted. "Shooting was disrupted by machinery stolen, and
2766 `accidents' resulting in loss of negatives, equipment, buildings and
2767 sometimes life and limb frequently occurred."
<footnote><para>
2769 Marc Wanamaker, "The First Studios," The Silents Majority, archived at
2770 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
12</ulink>.
2772 That led the independents to flee the East
2773 Coast. California was remote enough from Edison's reach that
2774 filmmakers there could pirate his inventions without fear of the
2775 law. And the leaders of Hollywood filmmaking, Fox most prominently,
2779 Of course, California grew quickly, and the effective enforcement
2780 of federal law eventually spread west. But because patents grant the
2781 patent holder a truly "limited" monopoly (just seventeen years at that
2783 <!-- PAGE BREAK 68 -->
2784 time), by the time enough federal marshals appeared, the patents had
2785 expired. A new industry had been born, in part from the piracy of
2786 Edison's creative property.
2789 <sect2 id=
"recordedmusic">
2790 <title>Recorded Music
</title>
2792 The record industry was born of another kind of piracy, though to see
2793 how requires a bit of detail about the way the law regulates music.
2796 At the time that Edison and Henri Fourneaux invented machines
2797 for reproducing music (Edison the phonograph, Fourneaux the player
2798 piano), the law gave composers the exclusive right to control copies of
2799 their music and the exclusive right to control public performances of
2800 their music. In other words, in
1900, if I wanted a copy of Phil Russel's
2801 1899 hit "Happy Mose," the law said I would have to pay for the right
2802 to get a copy of the musical score, and I would also have to pay for the
2803 right to perform it publicly.
2805 <indexterm><primary>Beatles
</primary></indexterm>
2807 But what if I wanted to record "Happy Mose," using Edison's phonograph
2808 or Fourneaux's player piano? Here the law stumbled. It was clear
2809 enough that I would have to buy any copy of the musical score that I
2810 performed in making this recording. And it was clear enough that I
2811 would have to pay for any public performance of the work I was
2812 recording. But it wasn't totally clear that I would have to pay for a
2813 "public performance" if I recorded the song in my own house (even
2814 today, you don't owe the Beatles anything if you sing their songs in
2815 the shower), or if I recorded the song from memory (copies in your
2816 brain are not
—yet
— regulated by copyright law). So if I
2817 simply sang the song into a recording device in the privacy of my own
2818 home, it wasn't clear that I owed the composer anything. And more
2819 importantly, it wasn't clear whether I owed the composer anything if I
2820 then made copies of those recordings. Because of this gap in the law,
2821 then, I could effectively pirate someone else's song without paying
2822 its composer anything.
2825 The composers (and publishers) were none too happy about
2826 <!-- PAGE BREAK 69 -->
2827 this capacity to pirate. As South Dakota senator Alfred Kittredge
2832 Imagine the injustice of the thing. A composer writes a song or an
2833 opera. A publisher buys at great expense the rights to the same and
2834 copyrights it. Along come the phonographic companies and companies who
2835 cut music rolls and deliberately steal the work of the brain of the
2836 composer and publisher without any regard for [their]
2837 rights.
<footnote><para>
2839 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright: Hearings on
2840 S.
6330 and H.R.
19853 Before the ( Joint) Committees on Patents,
59th
2841 Cong.
59,
1st sess. (
1906) (statement of Senator Alfred B. Kittredge,
2842 of South Dakota, chairman), reprinted in Legislative History of the
2843 Copyright Act, E. Fulton Brylawski and Abe Goldman, eds. (South
2844 Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints,
1976).
2849 The innovators who developed the technology to record other
2850 people's works were "sponging upon the toil, the work, the talent, and
2851 genius of American composers,"
<footnote><para>
2853 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
223
2854 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
2856 and the "music publishing industry"
2857 was thereby "at the complete mercy of this one pirate."
<footnote><para>
2859 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
226
2860 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
2863 Sousa put it, in as direct a way as possible, "When they make money
2864 out of my pieces, I want a share of it."
<footnote><para>
2866 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
23
2867 (statement of John Philip Sousa, composer).
2871 These arguments have familiar echoes in the wars of our day. So, too,
2872 do the arguments on the other side. The innovators who developed the
2873 player piano argued that "it is perfectly demonstrable that the
2874 introduction of automatic music players has not deprived any composer
2875 of anything he had before their introduction." Rather, the machines
2876 increased the sales of sheet music.
<footnote><para>
2878 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
283–84
2879 (statement of Albert Walker, representative of the Auto-Music
2881 Company of New York).
2882 </para></footnote> In any case, the innovators
2883 argued, the job of Congress was "to consider first the interest of [the
2884 public], whom they represent, and whose servants they are." "All talk
2885 about `theft,'" the general counsel of the American Graphophone
2886 Company wrote, "is the merest claptrap, for there exists no property in
2887 ideas musical, literary or artistic, except as defined by statute."
<footnote><para>
2889 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
376
2891 memorandum of Philip Mauro, general patent counsel of the
2893 Graphophone Company Association).
2897 The law soon resolved this battle in favor of the composer and
2898 the recording artist. Congress amended the law to make sure that
2899 composers would be paid for the "mechanical reproductions" of their
2900 music. But rather than simply granting the composer complete
2902 over the right to make mechanical reproductions, Congress gave
2903 recording artists a right to record the music, at a price set by Congress,
2904 once the composer allowed it to be recorded once. This is the part of
2906 <!-- PAGE BREAK 70 -->
2907 copyright law that makes cover songs possible. Once a composer
2909 a recording of his song, others are free to record the same
2910 song, so long as they pay the original composer a fee set by the law.
2913 American law ordinarily calls this a "compulsory license," but I will
2914 refer to it as a "statutory license." A statutory license is a license whose
2915 key terms are set by law. After Congress's amendment of the Copyright
2916 Act in
1909, record companies were free to distribute copies of
2918 so long as they paid the composer (or copyright holder) the fee set
2922 This is an exception within the law of copyright. When John Grisham
2923 writes a novel, a publisher is free to publish that novel only if Grisham
2924 gives the publisher permission. Grisham, in turn, is free to charge
2926 he wants for that permission. The price to publish Grisham is
2927 thus set by Grisham, and copyright law ordinarily says you have no
2928 permission to use Grisham's work except with permission of Grisham.
2930 <indexterm><primary>Beatles
</primary></indexterm>
2932 But the law governing recordings gives recording artists less. And
2933 thus, in effect, the law subsidizes the recording industry through a kind
2934 of piracy
—by giving recording artists a weaker right than it otherwise
2935 gives creative authors. The Beatles have less control over their creative
2936 work than Grisham does. And the beneficiaries of this less control are
2937 the recording industry and the public. The recording industry gets
2938 something of value for less than it otherwise would pay; the public gets
2939 access to a much wider range of musical creativity. Indeed, Congress
2940 was quite explicit about its reasons for granting this right. Its fear was
2941 the monopoly power of rights holders, and that that power would
2943 follow-on creativity.
<footnote><para>
2945 Copyright Law Revision: Hearings on S.
2499, S.
2900, H.R.
243, and
2946 H.R.
11794 Before the ( Joint) Committee on Patents,
60th Cong.,
1st
2947 sess.,
217 (
1908) (statement of Senator Reed Smoot, chairman), reprinted
2948 in Legislative History of the
1909 Copyright Act, E. Fulton Brylawski and
2949 Abe Goldman, eds. (South Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints,
1976).
2953 While the recording industry has been quite coy about this recently,
2954 historically it has been quite a supporter of the statutory license for
2955 records. As a
1967 report from the House Committee on the Judiciary
2960 the record producers argued vigorously that the compulsory
2961 <!-- PAGE BREAK 71 -->
2962 license system must be retained. They asserted that the record
2964 is a half-billion-dollar business of great economic
2966 in the United States and throughout the world; records
2967 today are the principal means of disseminating music, and this
2968 creates special problems, since performers need unhampered
2970 to musical material on nondiscriminatory terms. Historically,
2971 the record producers pointed out, there were no recording rights
2972 before
1909 and the
1909 statute adopted the compulsory license
2973 as a deliberate anti-monopoly condition on the grant of these
2974 rights. They argue that the result has been an outpouring of
2975 recorded music, with the public being given lower prices,
2977 quality, and a greater choice.
<footnote><para>
2979 Copyright Law Revision: Report to Accompany H.R.
2512, House Committee
2980 on the Judiciary,
90th Cong.,
1st sess., House Document no.
83, (
8
2981 March
1967). I am grateful to Glenn Brown for drawing my attention to
2982 this report.
</para></footnote>
2986 By limiting the rights musicians have, by partially pirating their
2988 work, the record producers, and the public, benefit.
2992 <title>Radio
</title>
2994 Radio was also born of piracy.
2997 When a radio station plays a record on the air, that constitutes a
2998 "public performance" of the composer's work.
<footnote><para>
3000 See
17 United States Code, sections
106 and
110. At the beginning, record
3001 companies printed "Not Licensed for Radio Broadcast" and other
3003 purporting to restrict the ability to play a record on a radio station.
3004 Judge Learned Hand rejected the argument that a warning attached to a
3005 record might restrict the rights of the radio station. See RCA
3007 Co. v. Whiteman,
114 F.
2d
86 (
2nd Cir.
1940). See also Randal C.
3008 Picker, "From Edison to the Broadcast Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and
3009 Refusal and the Propertization of Copyright," University of Chicago Law
3010 Review
70 (
2003):
281.
3012 As I described above,
3013 the law gives the composer (or copyright holder) an exclusive right to
3014 public performances of his work. The radio station thus owes the
3016 money for that performance.
3019 But when the radio station plays a record, it is not only performing
3020 a copy of the composer's work. The radio station is also performing a
3021 copy of the recording artist's work. It's one thing to have "Happy
3023 sung on the radio by the local children's choir; it's quite another to
3024 have it sung by the Rolling Stones or Lyle Lovett. The recording artist
3025 is adding to the value of the composition performed on the radio
3027 And if the law were perfectly consistent, the radio station would
3028 have to pay the recording artist for his work, just as it pays the
3030 of the music for his work.
3032 <!-- PAGE BREAK 72 -->
3035 But it doesn't. Under the law governing radio performances, the
3037 station does not have to pay the recording artist. The radio station
3038 need only pay the composer. The radio station thus gets a bit of
3040 for nothing. It gets to perform the recording artist's work for
3041 free, even if it must pay the composer something for the privilege of
3045 This difference can be huge. Imagine you compose a piece of
3047 Imagine it is your first. You own the exclusive right to authorize
3048 public performances of that music. So if Madonna wants to sing your
3049 song in public, she has to get your permission.
3052 Imagine she does sing your song, and imagine she likes it a lot. She
3053 then decides to make a recording of your song, and it becomes a top
3054 hit. Under our law, every time a radio station plays your song, you get
3055 some money. But Madonna gets nothing, save the indirect effect on
3056 the sale of her CDs. The public performance of her recording is not a
3057 "protected" right. The radio station thus gets to pirate the value of
3058 Madonna's work without paying her anything.
3061 No doubt, one might argue that, on balance, the recording artists
3062 benefit. On average, the promotion they get is worth more than the
3063 performance rights they give up. Maybe. But even if so, the law
3065 gives the creator the right to make this choice. By making the
3066 choice for him or her, the law gives the radio station the right to take
3067 something for nothing.
3070 <sect2 id=
"cabletv">
3071 <title>Cable TV
</title>
3074 Cable TV was also born of a kind of piracy.
3077 When cable entrepreneurs first started wiring communities with cable
3078 television in
1948, most refused to pay broadcasters for the content
3079 that they echoed to their customers. Even when the cable companies
3080 started selling access to television broadcasts, they refused to pay
3081 <!-- PAGE BREAK 73 -->
3082 for what they sold. Cable companies were thus Napsterizing
3083 broadcasters' content, but more egregiously than anything Napster ever
3084 did
— Napster never charged for the content it enabled others to
3087 <indexterm><primary>Anello, Douglas
</primary></indexterm>
3088 <indexterm><primary>Burdick, Quentin
</primary></indexterm>
3090 Broadcasters and copyright owners were quick to attack this theft.
3091 Rosel Hyde, chairman of the FCC, viewed the practice as a kind of
3092 "unfair and potentially destructive competition."
<footnote><para>
3094 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV: Hearing on S.
1006 Before the
3095 Subcommittee on Patents, Trademarks, and Copyrights of the Senate
3096 Committee on the Judiciary,
89th Cong.,
2nd sess.,
78 (
1966)
3097 (statement of Rosel H. Hyde, chairman of the Federal Communications
3100 There may have been a "public interest" in spreading the reach of cable
3101 TV, but as Douglas Anello, general counsel to the National Association
3102 of Broadcasters, asked Senator Quentin Burdick during testimony, "Does public
3103 interest dictate that you use somebody else's property?"
<footnote><para>
3105 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
116 (statement of Douglas A. Anello,
3106 general counsel of the National Association of Broadcasters).
3108 As another broadcaster put it,
3112 The extraordinary thing about the CATV business is that it is the
3113 only business I know of where the product that is being sold is not
3114 paid for.
<footnote><para>
3116 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
126 (statement of Ernest W. Jennes,
3117 general counsel of the Association of Maximum Service Telecasters, Inc.).
3122 Again, the demand of the copyright holders seemed reasonable enough:
3126 All we are asking for is a very simple thing, that people who now
3127 take our property for nothing pay for it. We are trying to stop
3128 piracy and I don't think there is any lesser word to describe it. I
3129 think there are harsher words which would fit it.
<footnote><para>
3131 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
169 (joint statement of Arthur B.
3132 Krim, president of United Artists Corp., and John Sinn, president of
3133 United Artists Television, Inc.).
3138 These were "free-ride[rs]," Screen Actor's Guild president Charlton
3139 Heston said, who were "depriving actors of
3140 compensation."
<footnote><para>
3142 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
209 (statement of Charlton Heston,
3143 president of the Screen Actors Guild).
3147 But again, there was another side to the debate. As Assistant Attorney
3148 General Edwin Zimmerman put it,
3152 Our point here is that unlike the problem of whether you have any
3153 copyright protection at all, the problem here is whether copyright
3154 holders who are already compensated, who already have a monopoly,
3155 should be permitted to extend that monopoly. . . . The
3157 <!-- PAGE BREAK 74 -->
3158 question here is how much compensation they should have and
3159 how far back they should carry their right to compensation.
<footnote><para>
3161 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
216 (statement of Edwin M.
3162 Zimmerman, acting assistant attorney general).
3167 Copyright owners took the cable companies to court. Twice the Supreme
3168 Court held that the cable companies owed the copyright owners nothing.
3171 It took Congress almost thirty years before it resolved the question
3172 of whether cable companies had to pay for the content they "pirated."
3173 In the end, Congress resolved this question in the same way that it
3174 resolved the question about record players and player pianos. Yes,
3175 cable companies would have to pay for the content that they broadcast;
3176 but the price they would have to pay was not set by the copyright
3177 owner. The price was set by law, so that the broadcasters couldn't
3178 exercise veto power over the emerging technologies of cable. Cable
3179 companies thus built their empire in part upon a "piracy" of the value
3180 created by broadcasters' content.
3183 These separate stories sing a common theme. If "piracy" means
3184 using value from someone else's creative property without permission
3185 from that creator
—as it is increasingly described
3186 today
<footnote><para>
3188 See, for example, National Music Publisher's Association, The Engine
3189 of Free Expression: Copyright on the Internet
—The Myth of Free
3190 Information, available at
3191 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
13</ulink>. "The
3192 threat of piracy
—the use of someone else's creative work without
3193 permission or compensation
—has grown with the Internet."
3195 — then every industry affected by copyright today is the product
3196 and beneficiary of a certain kind of piracy. Film, records, radio,
3197 cable TV. . . . The list is long and could well be expanded. Every
3198 generation welcomes the pirates from the last. Every
3199 generation
—until now.
3201 <!-- PAGE BREAK 75 -->
3205 <title>CHAPTER FIVE: "Piracy"
</title>
3207 There is piracy of copyrighted material. Lots of it. This piracy comes
3208 in many forms. The most significant is commercial piracy, the
3209 unauthorized taking of other people's content within a commercial
3210 context. Despite the many justifications that are offered in its
3211 defense, this taking is wrong. No one should condone it, and the law
3215 But as well as copy-shop piracy, there is another kind of "taking"
3216 that is more directly related to the Internet. That taking, too, seems
3217 wrong to many, and it is wrong much of the time. Before we paint this
3218 taking "piracy," however, we should understand its nature a bit more.
3219 For the harm of this taking is significantly more ambiguous than
3220 outright copying, and the law should account for that ambiguity, as it
3221 has so often done in the past.
3222 <!-- PAGE BREAK 76 -->
3224 <sect2 id=
"piracy-i">
3225 <title>Piracy I
</title>
3227 All across the world, but especially in Asia and Eastern Europe, there
3228 are businesses that do nothing but take others people's copyrighted
3229 content, copy it, and sell it
—all without the permission of a copyright
3230 owner. The recording industry estimates that it loses about $
4.6 billion
3231 every year to physical piracy
<footnote><para>
3233 See IFPI (International Federation of the Phonographic Industry), The
3234 Recording Industry Commercial Piracy Report
2003, July
2003, available at
3236 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
14</ulink>. See also Ben Hunt, "Companies Warned on Music Piracy Risk,"
3237 Financial Times,
14 February
2003,
11.
3239 (that works out to one in three CDs sold
3240 worldwide). The MPAA estimates that it loses $
3 billion annually
3241 worldwide to piracy.
3244 This is piracy plain and simple. Nothing in the argument of this
3245 book, nor in the argument that most people make when talking about
3246 the subject of this book, should draw into doubt this simple point:
3247 This piracy is wrong.
3250 Which is not to say that excuses and justifications couldn't be made
3251 for it. We could, for example, remind ourselves that for the first one
3252 hundred years of the American Republic, America did not honor
3254 copyrights. We were born, in this sense, a pirate nation. It might
3255 therefore seem hypocritical for us to insist so strongly that other
3257 nations treat as wrong what we, for the first hundred years of our
3258 existence, treated as right.
3261 That excuse isn't terribly strong. Technically, our law did not ban
3262 the taking of foreign works. It explicitly limited itself to American
3263 works. Thus the American publishers who published foreign works
3264 without the permission of foreign authors were not violating any rule.
3265 The copy shops in Asia, by contrast, are violating Asian law. Asian law
3266 does protect foreign copyrights, and the actions of the copy shops
3268 that law. So the wrong of piracy that they engage in is not just a
3269 moral wrong, but a legal wrong, and not just an internationally legal
3270 wrong, but a locally legal wrong as well.
3273 True, these local rules have, in effect, been imposed upon these
3274 countries. No country can be part of the world economy and choose
3275 <!-- PAGE BREAK 77 -->
3276 not to protect copyright internationally. We may have been born a
3278 nation, but we will not allow any other nation to have a similar
3282 If a country is to be treated as a sovereign, however, then its laws are
3283 its laws regardless of their source. The international law under which
3284 these nations live gives them some opportunities to escape the burden
3285 of intellectual property law.
<footnote><para>
3287 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite, Information Feudalism: Who
3288 Owns the Knowledge Economy? (New York: The New Press,
2003),
10–13,
3289 209. The Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights
3290 (TRIPS) agreement obligates member nations to create administrative
3291 and enforcement mechanisms for intellectual property rights, a costly
3292 proposition for developing countries. Additionally, patent rights may
3293 lead to higher prices for staple industries such as
3294 agriculture. Critics of TRIPS question the disparity between burdens
3295 imposed upon developing countries and benefits conferred to
3296 industrialized nations. TRIPS does permit governments to use patents
3297 for public, noncommercial uses without first obtaining the patent
3298 holder's permission. Developing nations may be able to use this to
3299 gain the benefits of foreign patents at lower prices. This is a
3300 promising strategy for developing nations within the TRIPS framework.
3301 </para></footnote> In my view, more developing nations should take
3302 advantage of that opportunity, but when they don't, then their laws
3303 should be respected. And under the laws of these nations, this piracy
3307 Alternatively, we could try to excuse this piracy by noting that in
3308 any case, it does no harm to the industry. The Chinese who get access
3309 to American CDs at
50 cents a copy are not people who would have
3310 bought those American CDs at $
15 a copy. So no one really has any
3311 less money than they otherwise would have had.
<footnote><para>
3313 For an analysis of the economic impact of copying technology, see Stan
3314 Liebowitz, Rethinking the Network Economy (New York: Amacom,
2002),
3315 144–90. "In some instances . . . the impact of piracy on the copyright holder's
3316 ability to appropriate the value of the work will be negligible. One obvious
3318 is the case where the individual engaging in pirating would not have
3319 purchased an original even if pirating were not an option." Ibid.,
149.
3323 This is often true (though I have friends who have purchased many
3324 thousands of pirated DVDs who certainly have enough money to pay
3325 for the content they have taken), and it does mitigate to some degree
3326 the harm caused by such taking. Extremists in this debate love to say,
3327 "You wouldn't go into Barnes
& Noble and take a book off of the shelf
3328 without paying; why should it be any different with on-line music?"
3329 The difference is, of course, that when you take a book from Barnes
&
3330 Noble, it has one less book to sell. By contrast, when you take an MP3
3331 from a computer network, there is not one less CD that can be sold.
3332 The physics of piracy of the intangible are different from the physics of
3333 piracy of the tangible.
3336 This argument is still very weak. However, although copyright is a
3337 property right of a very special sort, it is a property right. Like all
3339 rights, the copyright gives the owner the right to decide the terms
3340 under which content is shared. If the copyright owner doesn't want to
3341 sell, she doesn't have to. There are exceptions: important statutory
3343 that apply to copyrighted content regardless of the wish of the
3344 copyright owner. Those licenses give people the right to "take"
3346 content whether or not the copyright owner wants to sell. But
3348 <!-- PAGE BREAK 78 -->
3349 where the law does not give people the right to take content, it is
3350 wrong to take that content even if the wrong does no harm. If we have
3351 a property system, and that system is properly balanced to the
3353 of a time, then it is wrong to take property without the permission
3354 of a property owner. That is exactly what "property" means.
3357 Finally, we could try to excuse this piracy with the argument that
3358 the piracy actually helps the copyright owner. When the Chinese
3359 "steal" Windows, that makes the Chinese dependent on Microsoft.
3360 Microsoft loses the value of the software that was taken. But it gains
3361 users who are used to life in the Microsoft world. Over time, as the
3363 grows more wealthy, more and more people will buy software
3364 rather than steal it. And hence over time, because that buying will
3366 Microsoft, Microsoft benefits from the piracy. If instead of pirating
3367 Microsoft Windows, the Chinese used the free GNU/Linux operating
3368 system, then these Chinese users would not eventually be buying
3370 Without piracy, then, Microsoft would lose.
3373 This argument, too, is somewhat true. The addiction strategy is a
3374 good one. Many businesses practice it. Some thrive because of it. Law
3375 students, for example, are given free access to the two largest legal
3376 databases. The companies marketing both hope the students will
3378 so used to their service that they will want to use it and not the
3379 other when they become lawyers (and must pay high subscription fees).
3382 Still, the argument is not terribly persuasive. We don't give the
3384 a defense when he steals his first beer, merely because that will
3385 make it more likely that he will buy the next three. Instead, we
3387 allow businesses to decide for themselves when it is best to give
3388 their product away. If Microsoft fears the competition of GNU/Linux,
3389 then Microsoft can give its product away, as it did, for example, with
3390 Internet Explorer to fight Netscape. A property right means
3392 the property owner the right to say who gets access to what
—at
3393 least ordinarily. And if the law properly balances the rights of the
3395 owner with the rights of access, then violating the law is still
3399 <!-- PAGE BREAK 79 -->
3400 Thus, while I understand the pull of these justifications for piracy,
3401 and I certainly see the motivation, in my view, in the end, these efforts
3402 at justifying commercial piracy simply don't cut it. This kind of piracy
3403 is rampant and just plain wrong. It doesn't transform the content it
3404 steals; it doesn't transform the market it competes in. It merely gives
3405 someone access to something that the law says he should not have.
3406 Nothing has changed to draw that law into doubt. This form of piracy
3410 But as the examples from the four chapters that introduced this part
3411 suggest, even if some piracy is plainly wrong, not all "piracy" is. Or
3412 at least, not all "piracy" is wrong if that term is understood in the
3413 way it is increasingly used today. Many kinds of "piracy" are useful
3414 and productive, to produce either new content or new ways of doing
3415 business. Neither our tradition nor any tradition has ever banned all
3416 "piracy" in that sense of the term.
3419 This doesn't mean that there are no questions raised by the latest
3420 piracy concern, peer-to-peer file sharing. But it does mean that we
3421 need to understand the harm in peer-to-peer sharing a bit more before
3422 we condemn it to the gallows with the charge of piracy.
3425 For (
1) like the original Hollywood, p2p sharing escapes an overly
3426 controlling industry; and (
2) like the original recording industry, it
3427 simply exploits a new way to distribute content; but (
3) unlike cable
3428 TV, no one is selling the content that is shared on p2p services.
3431 These differences distinguish p2p sharing from true piracy. They
3432 should push us to find a way to protect artists while enabling this
3437 <sect2 id=
"piracy-ii">
3438 <title>Piracy II
</title>
3440 The key to the "piracy" that the law aims to quash is a use that "rob[s]
3441 the author of [his] profit."
<footnote><para>
3443 Bach v. Longman,
98 Eng. Rep.
1274 (
1777).
3445 This means we must determine whether
3446 and how much p2p sharing harms before we know how strongly the
3447 <!-- PAGE BREAK 80 -->
3448 law should seek to either prevent it or find an alternative to assure the
3449 author of his profit.
3452 Peer-to-peer sharing was made famous by Napster. But the inventors
3453 of the Napster technology had not made any major technological
3455 Like every great advance in innovation on the Internet (and,
3457 off the Internet as well
<footnote><para>
3459 See Clayton M. Christensen, The Innovator's Dilemma: The Revolutionary
3460 National Bestseller That Changed the Way We Do Business (New York:
3461 HarperBusiness,
2000). Professor Christensen examines why companies
3462 that give rise to and dominate a product area are frequently unable to come
3463 up with the most creative, paradigm-shifting uses for their own products.
3464 This job usually falls to outside innovators, who reassemble existing
3466 in inventive ways. For a discussion of Christensen's ideas, see
3467 Lawrence Lessig, Future,
89–92,
139.
3468 </para></footnote>), Shawn Fanning and crew had simply
3469 put together components that had been developed independently.
3472 The result was spontaneous combustion. Launched in July
1999,
3473 Napster amassed over
10 million users within nine months. After
3474 eighteen months, there were close to
80 million registered users of the
3475 system.
<footnote><para>
3477 See Carolyn Lochhead, "Silicon Valley Dream, Hollywood Nightmare,"
3478 San Francisco Chronicle,
24 September
2002, A1; "Rock 'n' Roll Suicide,"
3479 New Scientist,
6 July
2002,
42; Benny Evangelista, "Napster Names CEO,
3480 Secures New Financing," San Francisco Chronicle,
23 May
2003, C1;
3482 Wake-Up Call," Economist,
24 June
2000,
23; John Naughton,
3484 at War with the Internet" (London) Times,
26 July
2002,
18.
3486 Courts quickly shut Napster down, but other services emerged
3487 to take its place. (Kazaa is currently the most popular p2p service. It
3488 boasts over
100 million members.) These services' systems are different
3489 architecturally, though not very different in function: Each enables
3490 users to make content available to any number of other users. With a
3491 p2p system, you can share your favorite songs with your best friend
—
3492 or your
20,
000 best friends.
3495 According to a number of estimates, a huge proportion of
3497 have tasted file-sharing technology. A study by Ipsos-Insight in
3498 September
2002 estimated that
60 million Americans had downloaded
3499 music
—28 percent of Americans older than
12.
<footnote><para>
3501 See Ipsos-Insight, TEMPO: Keeping Pace with Online Music Distribution
3502 (September
2002), reporting that
28 percent of Americans aged twelve
3503 and older have downloaded music off of the Internet and
30 percent have
3504 listened to digital music files stored on their computers.
3507 group quoted in The New York Times estimated that
43 million citizens
3508 used file-sharing networks to exchange content in May
2003.
<footnote><para>
3510 Amy Harmon, "Industry Offers a Carrot in Online Music Fight," New
3511 York Times,
6 June
2003, A1.
3514 majority of these are not kids. Whatever the actual figure, a massive
3515 quantity of content is being "taken" on these networks. The ease and
3516 inexpensiveness of file-sharing networks have inspired millions to
3518 music in a way that they hadn't before.
3521 Some of this enjoying involves copyright infringement. Some of it
3522 does not. And even among the part that is technically copyright
3524 calculating the actual harm to copyright owners is more
3525 complicated than one might think. So consider
—a bit more carefully
3526 than the polarized voices around this debate usually do
—the kinds of
3527 sharing that file sharing enables, and the kinds of harm it entails.
3530 <!-- PAGE BREAK 81 -->
3531 File sharers share different kinds of content. We can divide these
3532 different kinds into four types.
3534 <orderedlist numeration=
"upperalpha">
3537 There are some who use sharing networks as substitutes for
3539 content. Thus, when a new Madonna CD is released,
3540 rather than buying the CD, these users simply take it. We might
3541 quibble about whether everyone who takes it would actually
3542 have bought it if sharing didn't make it available for free. Most
3543 probably wouldn't have, but clearly there are some who would.
3544 The latter are the target of category A: users who download
3550 There are some who use sharing networks to sample music before
3551 purchasing it. Thus, a friend sends another friend an MP3 of an
3552 artist he's not heard of. The other friend then buys CDs by that
3553 artist. This is a kind of targeted advertising, quite likely to
3555 If the friend recommending the album gains nothing from
3556 a bad recommendation, then one could expect that the
3558 will actually be quite good. The net effect of this
3559 sharing could increase the quantity of music purchased.
3563 There are many who use sharing networks to get access to
3565 content that is no longer sold or that they would not
3566 have purchased because the transaction costs off the Net are too
3567 high. This use of sharing networks is among the most
3569 for many. Songs that were part of your childhood but have
3570 long vanished from the marketplace magically appear again on
3571 the network. (One friend told me that when she discovered
3572 Napster, she spent a solid weekend "recalling" old songs. She
3573 was astonished at the range and mix of content that was
3575 For content not sold, this is still technically a violation of
3576 copyright, though because the copyright owner is not selling the
3577 content anymore, the economic harm is zero
—the same harm
3578 that occurs when I sell my collection of
1960s
45-rpm records to
3582 <!-- PAGE BREAK 82 -->
3584 Finally, there are many who use sharing networks to get access
3585 to content that is not copyrighted or that the copyright owner
3590 How do these different types of sharing balance out?
3593 Let's start with some simple but important points. From the
3595 of the law, only type D sharing is clearly legal. From the
3596 perspective of economics, only type A sharing is clearly harmful.
<footnote><para>
3598 See Liebowitz, Rethinking the Network Economy,
148–49.
3600 Type B sharing is illegal but plainly beneficial. Type C sharing is
3602 yet good for society (since more exposure to music is good) and
3603 harmless to the artist (since the work is not otherwise available). So
3604 how sharing matters on balance is a hard question to answer
—and
3606 much more difficult than the current rhetoric around the issue
3610 Whether on balance sharing is harmful depends importantly on
3611 how harmful type A sharing is. Just as Edison complained about
3613 composers complained about piano rolls, recording artists
3614 complained about radio, and broadcasters complained about cable TV,
3615 the music industry complains that type A sharing is a kind of "theft"
3616 that is "devastating" the industry.
3619 While the numbers do suggest that sharing is harmful, how
3621 is harder to reckon. It has long been the recording industry's
3623 to blame technology for any drop in sales. The history of cassette
3624 recording is a good example. As a study by Cap Gemini Ernst
&
3625 Young put it, "Rather than exploiting this new, popular technology, the
3626 labels fought it."
<footnote><para>
3628 See Cap Gemini Ernst
& Young, Technology Evolution and the Music
3630 Business Model Crisis (
2003),
3. This report describes the music
3632 effort to stigmatize the budding practice of cassette taping in the
3633 1970s, including an advertising campaign featuring a cassette-shape skull
3634 and the caption "Home taping is killing music."
3635 At the time digital audio tape became a threat, the Office of Technical
3636 Assessment conducted a survey of consumer behavior. In
1988,
40 percent
3637 of consumers older than ten had taped music to a cassette format. U.S.
3638 Congress, Office of Technology Assessment, Copyright and Home Copying:
3639 Technology Challenges the Law, OTA-CIT-
422 (Washington, D.C.: U.S.
3640 Government Printing Office, October
1989),
145–56.
3642 The labels claimed that every album taped was an
3643 album unsold, and when record sales fell by
11.4 percent in
1981, the
3644 industry claimed that its point was proved. Technology was the
3646 and banning or regulating technology was the answer.
3649 Yet soon thereafter, and before Congress was given an opportunity
3650 to enact regulation, MTV was launched, and the industry had a record
3651 turnaround. "In the end," Cap Gemini concludes, "the `crisis' . . . was
3652 not the fault of the tapers
—who did not [stop after MTV came into
3653 <!-- PAGE BREAK 83 -->
3654 being]
—but had to a large extent resulted from stagnation in musical
3655 innovation at the major labels."
<footnote><para>
3657 U.S. Congress, Copyright and Home Copying,
4.
3661 But just because the industry was wrong before does not mean it is
3662 wrong today. To evaluate the real threat that p2p sharing presents to
3663 the industry in particular, and society in general
—or at least
3664 the society that inherits the tradition that gave us the film
3665 industry, the record industry, the radio industry, cable TV, and the
3666 VCR
—the question is not simply whether type A sharing is
3667 harmful. The question is also how harmful type A sharing is, and how
3668 beneficial the other types of sharing are.
3671 We start to answer this question by focusing on the net harm, from
3672 the standpoint of the industry as a whole, that sharing networks cause.
3673 The "net harm" to the industry as a whole is the amount by which type
3674 A sharing exceeds type B. If the record companies sold more records
3675 through sampling than they lost through substitution, then sharing
3676 networks would actually benefit music companies on balance. They
3677 would therefore have little static reason to resist them.
3680 Could that be true? Could the industry as a whole be gaining
3682 of file sharing? Odd as that might sound, the data about CD
3683 sales actually suggest it might be close.
3686 In
2002, the RIAA reported that CD sales had fallen by
8.9
3688 from
882 million to
803 million units; revenues fell
6.7 percent.
<footnote><para>
3690 See Recording Industry Association of America,
2002 Yearend Statistics,
3692 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
15</ulink>. A later report indicates even greater losses. See
3693 Recording Industry Association of America, Some Facts About Music Piracy,
3694 25 June
2003, available at
3695 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
16</ulink>: "In the past four years, unit shipments
3696 of recorded music have fallen by
26 percent from
1.16 billion units in
3697 to
860 million units in
2002 in the United States (based on units shipped).
3698 In terms of sales, revenues are down
14 percent, from $
14.6 billion in
3699 to $
12.6 billion last year (based on U.S. dollar value of shipments). The
3701 industry worldwide has gone from a $
39 billion industry in
2000 down
3702 to a $
32 billion industry in
2002 (based on U.S. dollar value of shipments)."
3704 This confirms a trend over the past few years. The RIAA blames
3706 piracy for the trend, though there are many other causes that
3707 could account for this drop. SoundScan, for example, reports a more
3708 than
20 percent drop in the number of CDs released since
1999. That
3709 no doubt accounts for some of the decrease in sales. Rising prices could
3710 account for at least some of the loss. "From
1999 to
2001, the average
3711 price of a CD rose
7.2 percent, from $
13.04 to $
14.19."
<footnote>
3713 <indexterm><primary>Black, Jane
</primary></indexterm>
3715 Jane Black, "Big Music's Broken Record," BusinessWeek online,
13
3716 February
2003, available at
3717 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
17</ulink>.
3720 Competition from other forms of media could also account for some of the
3721 decline. As Jane Black of BusinessWeek notes, "The soundtrack to the film
3722 High Fidelity has a list price of $
18.98. You could get the whole movie
3723 [on DVD] for $
19.99."
<footnote><para>
3730 <!-- PAGE BREAK 84 -->
3731 But let's assume the RIAA is right, and all of the decline in CD
3732 sales is because of Internet sharing. Here's the rub: In the same period
3733 that the RIAA estimates that
803 million CDs were sold, the RIAA
3734 estimates that
2.1 billion CDs were downloaded for free. Thus,
3736 2.6 times the total number of CDs sold were downloaded for
3737 free, sales revenue fell by just
6.7 percent.
3740 There are too many different things happening at the same time to
3741 explain these numbers definitively, but one conclusion is unavoidable:
3742 The recording industry constantly asks, "What's the difference
3744 downloading a song and stealing a CD?"
—but their own
3746 reveal the difference. If I steal a CD, then there is one less CD to
3747 sell. Every taking is a lost sale. But on the basis of the numbers the
3748 RIAA provides, it is absolutely clear that the same is not true of
3749 downloads. If every download were a lost sale
—if every use of Kazaa
3750 "rob[bed] the author of [his] profit"
—then the industry would have
3751 suffered a
100 percent drop in sales last year, not a
7 percent drop. If
2.6
3752 times the number of CDs sold were downloaded for free, and yet sales
3753 revenue dropped by just
6.7 percent, then there is a huge difference
3755 "downloading a song and stealing a CD."
3758 These are the harms
—alleged and perhaps exaggerated but, let's
3760 real. What of the benefits? File sharing may impose costs on the
3761 recording industry. What value does it produce in addition to these
3765 One benefit is type C sharing
—making available content that is
3766 technically still under copyright but is no longer commercially
3768 This is not a small category of content. There are millions of
3769 tracks that are no longer commercially available.
<footnote><para>
3771 By one estimate,
75 percent of the music released by the major labels is no
3772 longer in print. See Online Entertainment and Copyright Law
—Coming
3773 Soon to a Digital Device Near You: Hearing Before the Senate
3775 on the Judiciary,
107th Cong.,
1st sess. (
3 April
2001) (prepared
3777 of the Future of Music Coalition), available at
3778 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
18</ulink>.
3782 that some of this content is not available because the artist
3783 producing the content doesn't want it to be made available, the vast
3784 majority of it is unavailable solely because the publisher or the
3786 has decided it no longer makes economic sense to the company to
3790 In real space
—long before the Internet
—the market had a simple
3791 <!-- PAGE BREAK 85 -->
3792 response to this problem: used book and record stores. There are
3794 of used book and used record stores in America today.
<footnote><para>
3796 While there are not good estimates of the number of used record stores in
3797 existence, in
2002, there were
7,
198 used book dealers in the United States,
3798 an increase of
20 percent since
1993. See Book Hunter Press, The Quiet
3799 Revolution: The Expansion of the Used Book Market (
2002), available at
3800 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
19</ulink>. Used records accounted for $
260 million in sales in
2002. See
3802 Association of Recording Merchandisers, "
2002 Annual Survey
3805 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
20</ulink>.
3808 stores buy content from owners, then sell the content they buy. And
3809 under American copyright law, when they buy and sell this content,
3810 even if the content is still under copyright, the copyright owner doesn't get
3811 a dime. Used book and record stores are commercial entities; their
3812 owners make money from the content they sell; but as with cable
3814 before statutory licensing, they don't have to pay the copyright
3815 owner for the content they sell.
3817 <indexterm><primary>Bernstein, Leonard
</primary></indexterm>
3819 Type C sharing, then, is very much like used book stores or used
3820 record stores. It is different, of course, because the person making
3821 the content available isn't making money from making the content
3822 available. It is also different, of course, because in real space,
3823 when I sell a record, I don't have it anymore, while in cyberspace,
3824 when someone shares my
1949 recording of Bernstein's "Two Love Songs,"
3825 I still have it. That difference would matter economically if the
3826 owner of the copyright were selling the record in competition to my
3827 sharing. But we're talking about the class of content that is not
3828 currently commercially available. The Internet is making it available,
3829 through cooperative sharing, without competing with the market.
3832 It may well be, all things considered, that it would be better if the
3833 copyright owner got something from this trade. But just because it may
3834 well be better, it doesn't follow that it would be good to ban used book
3835 stores. Or put differently, if you think that type C sharing should be
3836 stopped, do you think that libraries and used book stores should be
3840 Finally, and perhaps most importantly, file-sharing networks enable
3841 type D sharing to occur
—the sharing of content that copyright owners
3842 want to have shared or for which there is no continuing copyright. This
3843 sharing clearly benefits authors and society. Science fiction author
3844 Cory Doctorow, for example, released his first novel, Down and Out in
3845 the Magic Kingdom, both free on-line and in bookstores on the same
3847 <!-- PAGE BREAK 86 -->
3848 day. His (and his publisher's) thinking was that the on-line distribution
3849 would be a great advertisement for the "real" book. People would read
3850 part on-line, and then decide whether they liked the book or not. If
3851 they liked it, they would be more likely to buy it. Doctorow's content is
3852 type D content. If sharing networks enable his work to be spread, then
3853 both he and society are better off. (Actually, much better off: It is a
3857 Likewise for work in the public domain: This sharing benefits society
3858 with no legal harm to authors at all. If efforts to solve the problem
3859 of type A sharing destroy the opportunity for type D sharing, then we
3860 lose something important in order to protect type A content.
3863 The point throughout is this: While the recording industry
3864 understandably says, "This is how much we've lost," we must also ask,
3865 "How much has society gained from p2p sharing? What are the
3866 efficiencies? What is the content that otherwise would be
3870 For unlike the piracy I described in the first section of this
3871 chapter, much of the "piracy" that file sharing enables is plainly
3872 legal and good. And like the piracy I described in chapter
4, much of
3873 this piracy is motivated by a new way of spreading content caused by
3874 changes in the technology of distribution. Thus, consistent with the
3875 tradition that gave us Hollywood, radio, the recording industry, and
3876 cable TV, the question we should be asking about file sharing is how
3877 best to preserve its benefits while minimizing (to the extent
3878 possible) the wrongful harm it causes artists. The question is one of
3879 balance. The law should seek that balance, and that balance will be
3880 found only with time.
3883 "But isn't the war just a war against illegal sharing? Isn't the target
3884 just what you call type A sharing?"
3887 You would think. And we should hope. But so far, it is not. The
3889 of the war purportedly on type A sharing alone has been felt far
3890 beyond that one class of sharing. That much is obvious from the
3892 case itself. When Napster told the district court that it had
3894 a technology to block the transfer of
99.4 percent of identified
3895 <!-- PAGE BREAK 87 -->
3896 infringing material, the district court told counsel for Napster
99.4
3897 percent was not good enough. Napster had to push the infringements
3898 "down to zero."
<footnote><para>
3900 See Transcript of Proceedings, In Re: Napster Copyright Litigation at
34-
3901 35 (N.D. Cal.,
11 July
2001), nos. MDL-
00-
1369 MHP, C
99-
5183
3903 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
21</ulink>. For an account of the litigation and its toll on
3904 Napster, see Joseph Menn, All the Rave: The Rise and Fall of Shawn
3906 Napster (New York: Crown Business,
2003),
269–82.
3910 If
99.4 percent is not good enough, then this is a war on file-sharing
3911 technologies, not a war on copyright infringement. There is no way to
3912 assure that a p2p system is used
100 percent of the time in compliance
3913 with the law, any more than there is a way to assure that
100 percent of
3914 VCRs or
100 percent of Xerox machines or
100 percent of handguns
3915 are used in compliance with the law. Zero tolerance means zero p2p.
3916 The court's ruling means that we as a society must lose the benefits of
3917 p2p, even for the totally legal and beneficial uses they serve, simply to
3918 assure that there are zero copyright infringements caused by p2p.
3921 Zero tolerance has not been our history. It has not produced the
3922 content industry that we know today. The history of American law has
3923 been a process of balance. As new technologies changed the way
3925 was distributed, the law adjusted, after some time, to the new
3927 In this adjustment, the law sought to ensure the legitimate rights
3928 of creators while protecting innovation. Sometimes this has meant
3929 more rights for creators. Sometimes less.
3932 So, as we've seen, when "mechanical reproduction" threatened the
3933 interests of composers, Congress balanced the rights of composers
3934 against the interests of the recording industry. It granted rights to
3936 but also to the recording artists: Composers were to be paid, but
3937 at a price set by Congress. But when radio started broadcasting the
3938 recordings made by these recording artists, and they complained to
3939 Congress that their "creative property" was not being respected (since
3940 the radio station did not have to pay them for the creativity it
3942 Congress rejected their claim. An indirect benefit was enough.
3945 Cable TV followed the pattern of record albums. When the courts
3946 rejected the claim that cable broadcasters had to pay for the content
3947 they rebroadcast, Congress responded by giving broadcasters a right to
3948 compensation, but at a level set by the law. It likewise gave cable
3950 the right to the content, so long as they paid the statutory price.
3954 <!-- PAGE BREAK 88 -->
3955 This compromise, like the compromise affecting records and player
3956 pianos, served two important goals
—indeed, the two central goals of
3957 any copyright legislation. First, the law assured that new innovators
3958 would have the freedom to develop new ways to deliver content.
3960 the law assured that copyright holders would be paid for the
3962 that was distributed. One fear was that if Congress simply
3963 required cable TV to pay copyright holders whatever they demanded
3964 for their content, then copyright holders associated with broadcasters
3965 would use their power to stifle this new technology, cable. But if
3967 had permitted cable to use broadcasters' content for free, then it
3968 would have unfairly subsidized cable. Thus Congress chose a path that
3969 would assure compensation without giving the past (broadcasters)
3971 over the future (cable).
3973 <indexterm><primary>Betamax
</primary></indexterm>
3975 In the same year that Congress struck this balance, two major
3976 producers and distributors of film content filed a lawsuit against
3977 another technology, the video tape recorder (VTR, or as we refer to
3978 them today, VCRs) that Sony had produced, the Betamax. Disney's and
3979 Universal's claim against Sony was relatively simple: Sony produced a
3980 device, Disney and Universal claimed, that enabled consumers to engage
3981 in copyright infringement. Because the device that Sony built had a
3982 "record" button, the device could be used to record copyrighted movies
3983 and shows. Sony was therefore benefiting from the copyright
3984 infringement of its customers. It should therefore, Disney and
3985 Universal claimed, be partially liable for that infringement.
3988 There was something to Disney's and Universal's claim. Sony did
3989 decide to design its machine to make it very simple to record television
3990 shows. It could have built the machine to block or inhibit any direct
3991 copying from a television broadcast. Or possibly, it could have built the
3992 machine to copy only if there were a special "copy me" signal on the
3993 line. It was clear that there were many television shows that did not
3994 grant anyone permission to copy. Indeed, if anyone had asked, no
3995 doubt the majority of shows would not have authorized copying. And
3996 <!-- PAGE BREAK 89 -->
3997 in the face of this obvious preference, Sony could have designed its
3998 system to minimize the opportunity for copyright infringement. It did
3999 not, and for that, Disney and Universal wanted to hold it responsible
4000 for the architecture it chose.
4003 MPAA president Jack Valenti became the studios' most vocal
4004 champion. Valenti called VCRs "tapeworms." He warned, "When there are
4005 20,
30,
40 million of these VCRs in the land, we will be invaded by
4006 millions of `tapeworms,' eating away at the very heart and essence of
4007 the most precious asset the copyright owner has, his
4008 copyright."
<footnote><para>
4010 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders): Hearing on
4011 S.
1758 Before the Senate Committee on the Judiciary,
97th Cong.,
1st
4012 and
2nd sess.,
459 (
1982) (testimony of Jack Valenti, president, Motion
4013 Picture Association of America, Inc.).
4015 "One does not have to be trained in sophisticated marketing and
4016 creative judgment," he told Congress, "to understand the devastation
4017 on the after-theater marketplace caused by the hundreds of millions of
4018 tapings that will adversely impact on the future of the creative
4019 community in this country. It is simply a question of basic economics
4020 and plain common sense."
<footnote><para>
4022 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders),
475.
4024 Indeed, as surveys would later show,
4025 percent of VCR owners had movie libraries of ten videos or more
<footnote><para>
4027 Universal City Studios, Inc. v. Sony Corp. of America,
480 F. Supp.
429,
4030 — a use the Court would later hold was not "fair." By
4031 "allowing VCR owners to copy freely by the means of an exemption from
4032 copyright infringementwithout creating a mechanism to compensate
4033 copyrightowners," Valenti testified, Congress would "take from the
4034 owners the very essence of their property: the exclusive right to
4035 control who may use their work, that is, who may copy it and thereby
4036 profit from its reproduction."
<footnote><para>
4038 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders),
485 (testimony
4043 It took eight years for this case to be resolved by the Supreme
4044 Court. In the interim, the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals, which
4045 includes Hollywood in its jurisdiction
—leading Judge Alex Kozinski,
4046 who sits on that court, refers to it as the "Hollywood Circuit"
—held
4047 that Sony would be liable for the copyright infringement made possible
4048 by its machines. Under the Ninth Circuit's rule, this totally familiar
4049 technology
—which Jack Valenti had called "the Boston Strangler of the
4050 American film industry" (worse yet, it was a Japanese Boston Strangler
4051 of the American film industry)
—was an illegal
4052 technology.
<footnote><para>
4054 Universal City Studios, Inc. v. Sony Corp. of America,
659 F.
2d
963 (
9th Cir.
4059 But the Supreme Court reversed the decision of the Ninth Circuit.
4061 <!-- PAGE BREAK 90 -->
4062 And in its reversal, the Court clearly articulated its understanding of
4063 when and whether courts should intervene in such disputes. As the
4068 Sound policy, as well as history, supports our consistent deference
4069 to Congress when major technological innovations alter the
4071 for copyrighted materials. Congress has the constitutional
4073 and the institutional ability to accommodate fully the
4074 varied permutations of competing interests that are inevitably
4076 by such new technology.
<footnote><para>
4078 Sony Corp. of America v. Universal City Studios, Inc.,
464 U.S.
417,
431 (
1984).
4083 Congress was asked to respond to the Supreme Court's decision.
4084 But as with the plea of recording artists about radio broadcasts,
4086 ignored the request. Congress was convinced that American film
4087 got enough, this "taking" notwithstanding.
4088 If we put these cases together, a pattern is clear:
4092 <title>Table
</title>
4093 <tgroup cols=
"4" align=
"char">
4097 <entry>WHOSE VALUE WAS "PIRATED"
</entry>
4098 <entry>RESPONSE OF THE COURTS
</entry>
4099 <entry>RESPONSE OF CONGRESS
</entry>
4104 <entry>Recordings
</entry>
4105 <entry>Composers
</entry>
4106 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4107 <entry>Statutory license
</entry>
4110 <entry>Radio
</entry>
4111 <entry>Recording artists
</entry>
4113 <entry>Nothing
</entry>
4116 <entry>Cable TV
</entry>
4117 <entry>Broadcasters
</entry>
4118 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4119 <entry>Statutory license
</entry>
4123 <entry>Film creators
</entry>
4124 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4125 <entry>Nothing
</entry>
4132 In each case throughout our history, a new technology changed the
4133 way content was distributed.
<footnote><para>
4135 These are the most important instances in our history, but there are other
4136 cases as well. The technology of digital audio tape (DAT), for example,
4137 was regulated by Congress to minimize the risk of piracy. The remedy
4138 Congress imposed did burden DAT producers, by taxing tape sales and
4139 controlling the technology of DAT. See Audio Home Recording Act of
4140 1992 (Title
17 of the United States Code), Pub. L. No.
102-
563,
106 Stat.
4141 4237, codified at
17 U.S.C. §
1001. Again, however, this regulation did not
4142 eliminate the opportunity for free riding in the sense I've described. See
4143 Lessig, Future,
71. See also Picker, "From Edison to the Broadcast Flag,"
4144 University of Chicago Law Review
70 (
2003):
293–96.
4146 In each case, throughout our history,
4147 that change meant that someone got a "free ride" on someone else's
4151 In none of these cases did either the courts or Congress eliminate all
4152 free riding. In none of these cases did the courts or Congress insist that
4153 the law should assure that the copyright holder get all the value that his
4154 copyright created. In every case, the copyright owners complained of
4155 "piracy." In every case, Congress acted to recognize some of the
4157 in the behavior of the "pirates." In each case, Congress allowed
4158 some new technology to benefit from content made before. It balanced
4159 the interests at stake.
4160 <!-- PAGE BREAK 91 -->
4163 When you think across these examples, and the other examples that
4164 make up the first four chapters of this section, this balance makes
4165 sense. Was Walt Disney a pirate? Would doujinshi be better if creators
4166 had to ask permission? Should tools that enable others to capture and
4167 spread images as a way to cultivate or criticize our culture be better
4169 Is it really right that building a search engine should expose you
4170 to $
15 million in damages? Would it have been better if Edison had
4171 controlled film? Should every cover band have to hire a lawyer to get
4172 permission to record a song?
4175 We could answer yes to each of these questions, but our tradition
4176 has answered no. In our tradition, as the Supreme Court has stated,
4177 copyright "has never accorded the copyright owner complete control
4178 over all possible uses of his work."
<footnote><para>
4180 Sony Corp. of America v. Universal City Studios, Inc.,
464 U.S.
417,
4183 Instead, the particular uses that the
4184 law regulates have been defined by balancing the good that comes from
4185 granting an exclusive right against the burdens such an exclusive right
4186 creates. And this balancing has historically been done after a
4188 has matured, or settled into the mix of technologies that facilitate
4189 the distribution of content.
4192 We should be doing the same thing today. The technology of the
4193 Internet is changing quickly. The way people connect to the Internet
4194 (wires vs. wireless) is changing very quickly. No doubt the network
4195 should not become a tool for "stealing" from artists. But neither should
4196 the law become a tool to entrench one particular way in which artists
4197 (or more accurately, distributors) get paid. As I describe in some detail
4198 in the last chapter of this book, we should be securing income to artists
4199 while we allow the market to secure the most efficient way to promote
4200 and distribute content. This will require changes in the law, at least
4201 in the interim. These changes should be designed to balance the
4203 of the law against the strong public interest that innovation
4208 <!-- PAGE BREAK 92 -->
4209 This is especially true when a new technology enables a vastly
4211 mode of distribution. And this p2p has done. P2p technologies
4212 can be ideally efficient in moving content across a widely diverse
4214 Left to develop, they could make the network vastly more
4216 Yet these "potential public benefits," as John Schwartz writes in
4217 The New York Times, "could be delayed in the P2P fight."
<footnote><para>
4219 John Schwartz, "New Economy: The Attack on Peer-to-Peer Software
4220 Echoes Past Efforts," New York Times,
22 September
2003, C3.
4222 Yet when anyone begins to talk about "balance," the copyright
4224 raise a different argument. "All this hand waving about balance
4225 and incentives," they say, "misses a fundamental point. Our content,"
4226 the warriors insist, "is our property. Why should we wait for Congress
4227 to `rebalance' our property rights? Do you have to wait before calling
4228 the police when your car has been stolen? And why should Congress
4229 deliberate at all about the merits of this theft? Do we ask whether the
4230 car thief had a good use for the car before we arrest him?"
4233 "It is our property," the warriors insist. "And it should be protected
4234 just as any other property is protected."
4236 <!-- PAGE BREAK 93 -->
4240 <chapter id=
"c-property">
4241 <title>"PROPERTY"</title>
4244 <!-- PAGE BREAK 94 -->
4245 The copyright warriors are right: A copyright is a kind of
4246 property. It can be owned and sold, and the law protects against its
4247 theft. Ordinarily, the copyright owner gets to hold out for any price he
4248 wants. Markets reckon the supply and demand that partially determine
4249 the price she can get.
4252 But in ordinary language, to call a copyright a "property" right is a
4253 bit misleading, for the property of copyright is an odd kind of property.
4254 Indeed, the very idea of property in any idea or any expression is very
4255 odd. I understand what I am taking when I take the picnic table you
4256 put in your backyard. I am taking a thing, the picnic table, and after I
4257 take it, you don't have it. But what am I taking when I take the good
4258 idea you had to put a picnic table in the backyard
—by, for example,
4260 to Sears, buying a table, and putting it in my backyard? What is the
4261 thing I am taking then?
4264 The point is not just about the thingness of picnic tables versus
4265 ideas, though that's an important difference. The point instead is that
4266 <!-- PAGE BREAK 95 -->
4267 in the ordinary case
—indeed, in practically every case except for a
4269 range of exceptions
—ideas released to the world are free. I don't
4270 take anything from you when I copy the way you dress
—though I
4271 might seem weird if I did it every day, and especially weird if you are a
4272 woman. Instead, as Thomas Jefferson said (and as is especially true
4273 when I copy the way someone else dresses), "He who receives an idea
4274 from me, receives instruction himself without lessening mine; as he who
4275 lights his taper at mine, receives light without darkening me."
<footnote><para>
4277 Letter from Thomas Jefferson to Isaac McPherson (
13 August
1813) in
4278 The Writings of Thomas Jefferson, vol.
6 (Andrew A. Lipscomb and Albert
4279 Ellery Bergh, eds.,
1903),
330,
333–34.
4283 The exceptions to free use are ideas and expressions within the
4284 reach of the law of patent and copyright, and a few other domains that
4285 I won't discuss here. Here the law says you can't take my idea or
4287 without my permission: The law turns the intangible into
4291 But how, and to what extent, and in what form
—the details, in
4292 other words
—matter. To get a good sense of how this practice of
4294 the intangible into property emerged, we need to place this
4296 in its proper context.
<footnote><para>
4298 As the legal realists taught American law, all property rights are
4300 A property right is simply a right that an individual has against the
4301 world to do or not do certain things that may or may not attach to a
4303 object. The right itself is intangible, even if the object to which it is
4304 (metaphorically) attached is tangible. See Adam Mossoff, "What Is
4306 Putting the Pieces Back Together," Arizona Law Review
45 (
2003):
4311 My strategy in doing this will be the same as my strategy in the
4313 part. I offer four stories to help put the idea of "copyright
4315 is property" in context. Where did the idea come from? What are
4316 its limits? How does it function in practice? After these stories, the
4317 significance of this true statement
—"copyright material is property"
—
4318 will be a bit more clear, and its implications will be revealed as quite
4319 different from the implications that the copyright warriors would have
4323 <!-- PAGE BREAK 96 -->
4324 <sect1 id=
"founders">
4325 <title>CHAPTER SIX: Founders
</title>
4327 William Shakespeare wrote Romeo and Juliet in
1595. The play
4328 was first published in
1597. It was the eleventh major play that
4330 had written. He would continue to write plays through
1613,
4331 and the plays that he wrote have continued to define Anglo-American
4332 culture ever since. So deeply have the works of a sixteenth-century writer
4333 seeped into our culture that we often don't even recognize their source.
4334 I once overheard someone commenting on Kenneth Branagh's
4336 of Henry V: "I liked it, but Shakespeare is so full of clichés."
4339 In
1774, almost
180 years after Romeo and Juliet was written, the
4340 "copy-right" for the work was still thought by many to be the exclusive
4341 right of a single London publisher, Jacob Tonson.
<footnote><para>
4343 Jacob Tonson is typically remembered for his associations with prominent
4344 eighteenth-century literary figures, especially John Dryden, and for his
4345 handsome "definitive editions" of classic works. In addition to Romeo and
4346 Juliet, he published an astonishing array of works that still remain at the
4347 heart of the English canon, including collected works of Shakespeare, Ben
4348 Jonson, John Milton, and John Dryden. See Keith Walker, "Jacob Tonson,
4349 Bookseller," American Scholar
61:
3 (
1992):
424–31.
4352 most prominent of a small group of publishers called the Conger
<footnote><para>
4354 Lyman Ray Patterson, Copyright in Historical Perspective (Nashville:
4356 University Press,
1968),
151–52.
4359 controlled bookselling in England during the eighteenth century. The
4360 Conger claimed a perpetual right to control the "copy" of books that
4361 they had acquired from authors. That perpetual right meant that no
4362 <!-- PAGE BREAK 97 -->
4363 one else could publish copies of a book to which they held the
4365 Prices of the classics were thus kept high; competition to
4367 better or cheaper editions was eliminated.
4370 Now, there's something puzzling about the year
1774 to anyone who
4371 knows a little about copyright law. The better-known year in the history
4372 of copyright is
1710, the year that the British Parliament adopted the
4373 first "copyright" act. Known as the Statute of Anne, the act stated that
4374 all published works would get a copyright term of fourteen years,
4376 once if the author was alive, and that all works already
4378 by
1710 would get a single term of twenty-one additional years.
<footnote><para>
4380 As Siva Vaidhyanathan nicely argues, it is erroneous to call this a
4382 law." See Vaidhyanathan, Copyrights and Copywrongs,
40.
4384 Under this law, Romeo and Juliet should have been free in
1731. So why
4385 was there any issue about it still being under Tonson's control in
1774?
4388 The reason is that the English hadn't yet agreed on what a
4390 was
—indeed, no one had. At the time the English passed the
4391 Statute of Anne, there was no other legislation governing copyrights.
4392 The last law regulating publishers, the Licensing Act of
1662, had
4394 in
1695. That law gave publishers a monopoly over publishing, as
4395 a way to make it easier for the Crown to control what was published.
4396 But after it expired, there was no positive law that said that the
4398 or "Stationers," had an exclusive right to print books.
4401 There was no positive law, but that didn't mean that there was no
4402 law. The Anglo-American legal tradition looks to both the words of
4403 legislatures and the words of judges to know the rules that are to
4405 how people are to behave. We call the words from legislatures
4407 law." We call the words from judges "common law." The common
4408 law sets the background against which legislatures legislate; the
4410 ordinarily, can trump that background only if it passes a law to
4411 displace it. And so the real question after the licensing statutes had
4413 was whether the common law protected a copyright,
4415 of any positive law.
4418 This question was important to the publishers, or "booksellers," as
4419 they were called, because there was growing competition from foreign
4420 publishers. The Scottish, in particular, were increasingly publishing
4421 and exporting books to England. That competition reduced the profits
4423 <!-- PAGE BREAK 98 -->
4424 of the Conger, which reacted by demanding that Parliament pass a law
4425 to again give them exclusive control over publishing. That demand
4427 resulted in the Statute of Anne.
4430 The Statute of Anne granted the author or "proprietor" of a book
4431 an exclusive right to print that book. In an important limitation,
4433 and to the horror of the booksellers, the law gave the bookseller
4434 that right for a limited term. At the end of that term, the copyright
4436 and the work would then be free and could be published by
4437 anyone. Or so the legislature is thought to have believed.
4440 Now, the thing to puzzle about for a moment is this: Why would
4441 Parliament limit the exclusive right? Not why would they limit it to the
4442 particular limit they set, but why would they limit the right at all?
4445 For the booksellers, and the authors whom they represented, had a
4446 very strong claim. Take Romeo and Juliet as an example: That play was
4447 written by Shakespeare. It was his genius that brought it into the
4448 world. He didn't take anybody's property when he created this play
4449 (that's a controversial claim, but never mind), and by his creating this
4450 play, he didn't make it any harder for others to craft a play. So why is it
4451 that the law would ever allow someone else to come along and take
4452 Shakespeare's play without his, or his estate's, permission? What
4454 is there to allow someone else to "steal" Shakespeare's work?
4457 The answer comes in two parts. We first need to see something
4459 about the notion of "copyright" that existed at the time of the
4460 Statute of Anne. Second, we have to see something important about
4464 First, about copyright. In the last three hundred years, we have
4465 come to apply the concept of "copyright" ever more broadly. But in
4466 1710, it wasn't so much a concept as it was a very particular right. The
4467 copyright was born as a very specific set of restrictions: It forbade
4469 from reprinting a book. In
1710, the "copy-right" was a right to use
4470 a particular machine to replicate a particular work. It did not go
4472 that very narrow right. It did not control any more generally how
4473 <!-- PAGE BREAK 99 -->
4474 a work could be used. Today the right includes a large collection of
4476 on the freedom of others: It grants the author the exclusive
4477 right to copy, the exclusive right to distribute, the exclusive right to
4481 So, for example, even if the copyright to Shakespeare's works were
4482 perpetual, all that would have meant under the original meaning of the
4483 term was that no one could reprint Shakespeare's work without the
4485 of the Shakespeare estate. It would not have controlled
4487 for example, about how the work could be performed, whether
4488 the work could be translated, or whether Kenneth Branagh would be
4489 allowed to make his films. The "copy-right" was only an exclusive right
4490 to print
—no less, of course, but also no more.
4493 Even that limited right was viewed with skepticism by the British.
4494 They had had a long and ugly experience with "exclusive rights,"
4496 "exclusive rights" granted by the Crown. The English had fought
4497 a civil war in part about the Crown's practice of handing out
4498 monopolies
—especially
4499 monopolies for works that already existed. King Henry
4500 VIII granted a patent to print the Bible and a monopoly to Darcy to
4501 print playing cards. The English Parliament began to fight back
4502 against this power of the Crown. In
1656, it passed the Statute of
4504 limiting monopolies to patents for new inventions. And by
4505 1710, Parliament was eager to deal with the growing monopoly in
4509 Thus the "copy-right," when viewed as a monopoly right, was
4511 viewed as a right that should be limited. (However convincing
4512 the claim that "it's my property, and I should have it forever," try
4513 sounding convincing when uttering, "It's my monopoly, and I should
4514 have it forever.") The state would protect the exclusive right, but only
4515 so long as it benefited society. The British saw the harms from
4517 favors; they passed a law to stop them.
4520 Second, about booksellers. It wasn't just that the copyright was a
4521 monopoly. It was also that it was a monopoly held by the booksellers.
4522 Booksellers sound quaint and harmless to us. They were not viewed
4523 as harmless in seventeenth-century England. Members of the Conger
4524 <!-- PAGE BREAK 100 -->
4525 were increasingly seen as monopolists of the worst kind
—tools of the
4526 Crown's repression, selling the liberty of England to guarantee
4528 a monopoly profit. The attacks against these monopolists were
4529 harsh: Milton described them as "old patentees and monopolizers in
4530 the trade of book-selling"; they were "men who do not therefore labour
4531 in an honest profession to which learning is indetted."
<footnote><para>
4533 Philip Wittenberg, The Protection and Marketing of Literary Property (New
4534 York: J. Messner, Inc.,
1937),
31.
4538 Many believed the power the booksellers exercised over the spread
4539 of knowledge was harming that spread, just at the time the
4541 was teaching the importance of education and knowledge spread
4542 generally. The idea that knowledge should be free was a hallmark of the
4543 time, and these powerful commercial interests were interfering with
4547 To balance this power, Parliament decided to increase competition
4548 among booksellers, and the simplest way to do that was to spread the
4549 wealth of valuable books. Parliament therefore limited the term of
4550 copyrights, and thereby guaranteed that valuable books would become
4551 open to any publisher to publish after a limited time. Thus the setting
4552 of the term for existing works to just twenty-one years was a
4554 to fight the power of the booksellers. The limitation on terms was
4555 an indirect way to assure competition among publishers, and thus the
4556 construction and spread of culture.
4559 When
1731 (
1710 +
21) came along, however, the booksellers were
4560 getting anxious. They saw the consequences of more competition, and
4561 like every competitor, they didn't like them. At first booksellers simply
4562 ignored the Statute of Anne, continuing to insist on the perpetual right
4563 to control publication. But in
1735 and
1737, they tried to persuade
4564 Parliament to extend their terms. Twenty-one years was not enough,
4565 they said; they needed more time.
4568 Parliament rejected their requests. As one pamphleteer put it, in
4569 words that echo today,
4573 I see no Reason for granting a further Term now, which will not
4574 hold as well for granting it again and again, as often as the Old
4575 <!-- PAGE BREAK 101 -->
4576 ones Expire; so that should this Bill pass, it will in Effect be
4578 a perpetual Monopoly, a Thing deservedly odious in
4579 the Eye of the Law; it will be a great Cramp to Trade, a
4581 to Learning, no Benefit to the Authors, but a general
4582 Tax on the Publick; and all this only to increase the private Gain
4583 of the Booksellers.
<footnote><para>
4585 A Letter to a Member of Parliament concerning the Bill now depending
4586 in the House of Commons, for making more effectual an Act in the
4587 Eighth Year of the Reign of Queen Anne, entitled, An Act for the
4589 of Learning, by Vesting the Copies of Printed Books in the
4590 Authors or Purchasers of such Copies, during the Times therein
4592 (London,
1735), in Brief Amici Curiae of Tyler T. Ochoa et al.,
8,
4593 Eldred v. Ashcroft,
537 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618).
4598 Having failed in Parliament, the publishers turned to the courts in
4599 a series of cases. Their argument was simple and direct: The Statute of
4600 Anne gave authors certain protections through positive law, but those
4601 protections were not intended as replacements for the common law.
4602 Instead, they were intended simply to supplement the common law.
4603 Under common law, it was already wrong to take another person's
4605 "property" and use it without his permission. The Statute of Anne,
4606 the booksellers argued, didn't change that. Therefore, just because the
4607 protections of the Statute of Anne expired, that didn't mean the
4609 of the common law expired: Under the common law they had
4610 the right to ban the publication of a book, even if its Statute of Anne
4611 copyright had expired. This, they argued, was the only way to protect
4615 This was a clever argument, and one that had the support of some
4616 of the leading jurists of the day. It also displayed extraordinary
4618 Until then, as law professor Raymond Patterson has put it, "The
4619 publishers . . . had as much concern for authors as a cattle rancher has
4620 for cattle."
<footnote><para>
4622 Lyman Ray Patterson, "Free Speech, Copyright, and Fair Use," Vanderbilt
4623 Law Review
40 (
1987):
28. For a wonderfully compelling account, see
4624 Vaidhyanathan,
37–48.
4626 The bookseller didn't care squat for the rights of the
4628 His concern was the monopoly profit that the author's work gave.
4631 The booksellers' argument was not accepted without a fight.
4632 The hero of this fight was a Scottish bookseller named Alexander
4633 Donaldson.
<footnote><para>
4635 For a compelling account, see David Saunders, Authorship and Copyright
4636 (London: Routledge,
1992),
62–69.
4640 Donaldson was an outsider to the London Conger. He began his
4641 career in Edinburgh in
1750. The focus of his business was inexpensive
4642 reprints "of standard works whose copyright term had expired," at least
4643 under the Statute of Anne.
<footnote><para>
4645 Mark Rose, Authors and Owners (Cambridge: Harvard University Press,
4648 Donaldson's publishing house prospered
4649 <!-- PAGE BREAK 102 -->
4650 and became "something of a center for literary Scotsmen." "[A]mong
4651 them," Professor Mark Rose writes, was "the young James Boswell
4652 who, together with his friend Andrew Erskine, published an anthology
4653 of contemporary Scottish poems with Donaldson."
<footnote><para>
4659 When the London booksellers tried to shut down Donaldson's
4660 shop in Scotland, he responded by moving his shop to London, where
4661 he sold inexpensive editions "of the most popular English books, in
4663 of the supposed common law right of Literary Property."
<footnote><para>
4665 Lyman Ray Patterson, Copyright in Historical Perspective,
167 (quoting
4669 books undercut the Conger prices by
30 to
50 percent, and he rested
4670 his right to compete upon the ground that, under the Statute of Anne,
4671 the works he was selling had passed out of protection.
4674 The London booksellers quickly brought suit to block "piracy" like
4675 Donaldson's. A number of actions were successful against the "pirates,"
4676 the most important early victory being Millar v. Taylor.
4679 Millar was a bookseller who in
1729 had purchased the rights to James
4680 Thomson's poem "The Seasons." Millar complied with the requirements of
4681 the Statute of Anne, and therefore received the full protection of the
4682 statute. After the term of copyright ended, Robert Taylor began
4683 printing a competing volume. Millar sued, claiming a perpetual common
4684 law right, the Statute of Anne notwithstanding.
<footnote><para>
4686 Howard B. Abrams, "The Historic Foundation of American Copyright Law:
4687 Exploding the Myth of Common Law Copyright," Wayne Law Review
29
4692 Astonishingly to modern lawyers, one of the greatest judges in English
4693 history, Lord Mansfield, agreed with the booksellers. Whatever
4694 protection the Statute of Anne gave booksellers, it did not, he held,
4695 extinguish any common law right. The question was whether the common
4696 law would protect the author against subsequent "pirates."
4697 Mansfield's answer was yes: The common law would bar Taylor from
4698 reprinting Thomson's poem without Millar's permission. That common law
4699 rule thus effectively gave the booksellers a perpetual right to
4700 control the publication of any book assigned to them.
4703 Considered as a matter of abstract justice
—reasoning as if
4704 justice were just a matter of logical deduction from first
4705 principles
—Mansfield's conclusion might make some sense. But
4706 what it ignored was the larger issue that Parliament had struggled
4707 with in
1710: How best to limit
4708 <!-- PAGE BREAK 103 -->
4709 the monopoly power of publishers? Parliament's strategy was to offer a
4710 term for existing works that was long enough to buy peace in
1710, but
4711 short enough to assure that culture would pass into competition within
4712 a reasonable period of time. Within twenty-one years, Parliament
4713 believed, Britain would mature from the controlled culture that the
4714 Crown coveted to the free culture that we inherited.
4717 The fight to defend the limits of the Statute of Anne was not to end
4718 there, however, and it is here that Donaldson enters the mix.
4720 <indexterm><primary>Beckett, Thomas
</primary></indexterm>
4722 Millar died soon after his victory, so his case was not appealed. His
4723 estate sold Thomson's poems to a syndicate of printers that included
4724 Thomas Beckett.
<footnote><para>
4728 Donaldson then released an unauthorized edition
4729 of Thomson's works. Beckett, on the strength of the decision in Millar,
4730 got an injunction against Donaldson. Donaldson appealed the case to
4731 the House of Lords, which functioned much like our own Supreme
4732 Court. In February of
1774, that body had the chance to interpret the
4733 meaning of Parliament's limits from sixty years before.
4736 As few legal cases ever do, Donaldson v. Beckett drew an enormous
4737 amount of attention throughout Britain. Donaldson's lawyers argued
4738 that whatever rights may have existed under the common law, the Statute
4739 of Anne terminated those rights. After passage of the Statute of Anne,
4740 the only legal protection for an exclusive right to control publication
4741 came from that statute. Thus, they argued, after the term specified in
4742 the Statute of Anne expired, works that had been protected by the
4743 statute were no longer protected.
4746 The House of Lords was an odd institution. Legal questions were
4747 presented to the House and voted upon first by the "law lords,"
4748 members of special legal distinction who functioned much like the
4749 Justices in our Supreme Court. Then, after the law lords voted, the
4750 House of Lords generally voted.
4753 The reports about the law lords' votes are mixed. On some counts,
4754 it looks as if perpetual copyright prevailed. But there is no ambiguity
4755 <!-- PAGE BREAK 104 -->
4756 about how the House of Lords voted as whole. By a two-to-one majority
4757 (
22 to
11) they voted to reject the idea of perpetual copyrights.
4758 Whatever one's understanding of the common law, now a copyright was
4759 fixed for a limited time, after which the work protected by copyright
4760 passed into the public domain.
4762 <indexterm><primary>Bacon, Francis
</primary></indexterm>
4763 <indexterm><primary>Bunyan, John
</primary></indexterm>
4765 "The public domain." Before the case of Donaldson v. Beckett, there
4766 was no clear idea of a public domain in England. Before
1774, there
4767 was a strong argument that common law copyrights were perpetual.
4768 After
1774, the public domain was born. For the first time in
4769 Anglo-American history, the legal control over creative works expired,
4770 and the greatest works in English history
—including those of
4771 Shakespeare, Bacon, Milton, Johnson, and Bunyan
—were free of
4775 It is hard for us to imagine, but this decision by the House of Lords
4776 fueled an extraordinarily popular and political reaction. In Scotland,
4777 where most of the "pirate publishers" did their work, people
4778 celebrated the decision in the streets. As the Edinburgh Advertiser
4779 reported, "No private cause has so much engrossed the attention of the
4780 public, and none has been tried before the House of Lords in the
4781 decision of which so many individuals were interested." "Great
4782 rejoicing in Edinburgh upon victory over literary property: bonfires
4783 and illuminations."
<footnote><para>
4789 In London, however, at least among publishers, the reaction was
4790 equally strong in the opposite direction. The Morning Chronicle
4795 By the above decision . . . near
200,
000 pounds worth of what was
4796 honestly purchased at public sale, and which was yesterday thought
4797 property is now reduced to nothing. The Booksellers of London and
4798 Westminster, many of whom sold estates and houses to purchase
4799 Copy-right, are in a manner ruined, and those who after many years
4800 industry thought they had acquired a competency to provide for their
4801 families now find themselves without a shilling to devise to their
4802 successors.
<footnote><para>
4809 <!-- PAGE BREAK 105 -->
4810 "Ruined" is a bit of an exaggeration. But it is not an exaggeration to
4811 say that the change was profound. The decision of the House of Lords
4812 meant that the booksellers could no longer control how culture in
4813 England would grow and develop. Culture in England was thereafter
4814 free. Not in the sense that copyrights would not be respected, for of
4815 course, for a limited time after a work was published, the bookseller
4816 had an exclusive right to control the publication of that book. And
4817 not in the sense that books could be stolen, for even after a
4818 copyright expired, you still had to buy the book from someone. But
4819 free in the sense that the culture and its growth would no longer be
4820 controlled by a small group of publishers. As every free market does,
4821 this free market of free culture would grow as the consumers and
4822 producers chose. English culture would develop as the many English
4823 readers chose to let it develop
— chose in the books they bought
4824 and wrote; chose in the memes they repeated and endorsed. Chose in a
4825 competitive context, not a context in which the choices about what
4826 culture is available to people and how they get access to it are made
4827 by the few despite the wishes of the many.
4830 At least, this was the rule in a world where the Parliament is
4831 antimonopoly, resistant to the protectionist pleas of publishers. In a
4832 world where the Parliament is more pliant, free culture would be less
4835 <!-- PAGE BREAK 106 -->
4837 <sect1 id=
"recorders">
4838 <title>CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders
</title>
4840 Jon Else is a filmmaker. He is best known for his documentaries and
4841 has been very successful in spreading his art. He is also a teacher, and
4842 as a teacher myself, I envy the loyalty and admiration that his students
4843 feel for him. (I met, by accident, two of his students at a dinner party.
4847 Else worked on a documentary that I was involved in. At a break,
4848 he told me a story about the freedom to create with film in America
4852 In
1990, Else was working on a documentary about Wagner's Ring
4853 Cycle. The focus was stagehands at the San Francisco Opera.
4854 Stagehands are a particularly funny and colorful element of an opera.
4855 During a show, they hang out below the stage in the grips' lounge and
4856 in the lighting loft. They make a perfect contrast to the art on the
4860 During one of the performances, Else was shooting some stagehands
4861 playing checkers. In one corner of the room was a television set.
4862 Playing on the television set, while the stagehands played checkers
4863 and the opera company played Wagner, was The Simpsons. As Else judged
4864 <!-- PAGE BREAK 107 -->
4865 it, this touch of cartoon helped capture the flavor of what was special
4869 Years later, when he finally got funding to complete the film, Else
4870 attempted to clear the rights for those few seconds of The Simpsons.
4871 For of course, those few seconds are copyrighted; and of course, to use
4872 copyrighted material you need the permission of the copyright owner,
4873 unless "fair use" or some other privilege applies.
4876 Else called Simpsons creator Matt Groening's office to get permission.
4877 Groening approved the shot. The shot was a four-and-a-halfsecond image
4878 on a tiny television set in the corner of the room. How could it hurt?
4879 Groening was happy to have it in the film, but he told Else to contact
4880 Gracie Films, the company that produces the program.
4883 Gracie Films was okay with it, too, but they, like Groening, wanted
4884 to be careful. So they told Else to contact Fox, Gracie's parent company.
4885 Else called Fox and told them about the clip in the corner of the one
4886 room shot of the film. Matt Groening had already given permission,
4887 Else said. He was just confirming the permission with Fox.
4890 Then, as Else told me, "two things happened. First we discovered
4891 . . . that Matt Groening doesn't own his own creation
—or at
4892 least that someone [at Fox] believes he doesn't own his own creation."
4893 And second, Fox "wanted ten thousand dollars as a licensing fee for us
4894 to use this four-point-five seconds of . . . entirely unsolicited
4895 Simpsons which was in the corner of the shot."
4898 Else was certain there was a mistake. He worked his way up to someone
4899 he thought was a vice president for licensing, Rebecca Herrera. He
4900 explained to her, "There must be some mistake here. . . . We're
4901 asking for your educational rate on this." That was the educational
4902 rate, Herrera told Else. A day or so later, Else called again to
4903 confirm what he had been told.
4906 "I wanted to make sure I had my facts straight," he told me. "Yes, you
4907 have your facts straight," she said. It would cost $
10,
000 to use the
4908 clip of The Simpsons in the corner of a shot in a documentary film
4911 <!-- PAGE BREAK 108 -->
4912 Wagner's Ring Cycle. And then, astonishingly, Herrera told Else, "And
4913 if you quote me, I'll turn you over to our attorneys." As an assistant
4914 to Herrera told Else later on, "They don't give a shit. They just want
4918 Else didn't have the money to buy the right to replay what was playing
4919 on the television backstage at the San Francisco Opera. To reproduce
4920 this reality was beyond the documentary filmmaker's budget. At the
4921 very last minute before the film was to be released, Else digitally
4922 replaced the shot with a clip from another film that he had worked on,
4923 The Day After Trinity, from ten years before.
4926 There's no doubt that someone, whether Matt Groening or Fox, owns the
4927 copyright to The Simpsons. That copyright is their property. To use
4928 that copyrighted material thus sometimes requires the permission of
4929 the copyright owner. If the use that Else wanted to make of the
4930 Simpsons copyright were one of the uses restricted by the law, then he
4931 would need to get the permission of the copyright owner before he
4932 could use the work in that way. And in a free market, it is the owner
4933 of the copyright who gets to set the price for any use that the law
4934 says the owner gets to control.
4937 For example, "public performance" is a use of The Simpsons that the
4938 copyright owner gets to control. If you take a selection of favorite
4939 episodes, rent a movie theater, and charge for tickets to come see "My
4940 Favorite Simpsons," then you need to get permission from the copyright
4941 owner. And the copyright owner (rightly, in my view) can charge
4942 whatever she wants
—$
10 or $
1,
000,
000. That's her right, as set
4946 But when lawyers hear this story about Jon Else and Fox, their first
4947 thought is "fair use."
<footnote><para>
4949 For an excellent argument that such use is "fair use," but that
4950 lawyers don't permit recognition that it is "fair use," see Richard
4951 A. Posner with William F. Patry, "Fair Use and Statutory Reform in the
4952 Wake of Eldred " (draft on file with author), University of Chicago
4953 Law School,
5 August
2003.
4955 Else's use of just
4.5 seconds of an indirect shot of a Simpsons
4956 episode is clearly a fair use of The Simpsons
—and fair use does
4957 not require the permission of anyone.
4960 <!-- PAGE BREAK 109 -->
4961 So I asked Else why he didn't just rely upon "fair use." Here's his reply:
4965 The Simpsons fiasco was for me a great lesson in the gulf between what
4966 lawyers find irrelevant in some abstract sense, and what is crushingly
4967 relevant in practice to those of us actually trying to make and
4968 broadcast documentaries. I never had any doubt that it was "clearly
4969 fair use" in an absolute legal sense. But I couldn't rely on the
4970 concept in any concrete way. Here's why:
4972 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
4975 Before our films can be broadcast, the network requires that we buy
4976 Errors and Omissions insurance. The carriers require a detailed
4977 "visual cue sheet" listing the source and licensing status of each
4978 shot in the film. They take a dim view of "fair use," and a claim of
4979 "fair use" can grind the application process to a halt.
4983 I probably never should have asked Matt Groening in the first
4984 place. But I knew (at least from folklore) that Fox had a history of
4985 tracking down and stopping unlicensed Simpsons usage, just as George
4986 Lucas had a very high profile litigating Star Wars usage. So I decided
4987 to play by the book, thinking that we would be granted free or cheap
4988 license to four seconds of Simpsons. As a documentary producer working
4989 to exhaustion on a shoestring, the last thing I wanted was to risk
4990 legal trouble, even nuisance legal trouble, and even to defend a
4995 I did, in fact, speak with one of your colleagues at Stanford Law
4996 School . . . who confirmed that it was fair use. He also confirmed
4997 that Fox would "depose and litigate you to within an inch of your
4998 life," regardless of the merits of my claim. He made clear that it
4999 would boil down to who had the bigger legal department and the deeper
5000 pockets, me or them.
5001 <!-- PAGE BREAK 110 -->
5005 The question of fair use usually comes up at the end of the
5006 project, when we are up against a release deadline and out of
5012 In theory, fair use means you need no permission. The theory therefore
5013 supports free culture and insulates against a permission culture. But
5014 in practice, fair use functions very differently. The fuzzy lines of
5015 the law, tied to the extraordinary liability if lines are crossed,
5016 means that the effective fair use for many types of creators is
5017 slight. The law has the right aim; practice has defeated the aim.
5020 This practice shows just how far the law has come from its
5021 eighteenth-century roots. The law was born as a shield to protect
5022 publishers' profits against the unfair competition of a pirate. It has
5023 matured into a sword that interferes with any use, transformative or
5026 <!-- PAGE BREAK 111 -->
5028 <sect1 id=
"transformers">
5029 <title>CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers
</title>
5030 <indexterm><primary>Allen, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
5031 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5033 In
1993, Alex Alben was a lawyer working at Starwave, Inc. Starwave
5034 was an innovative company founded by Microsoft cofounder Paul Allen to
5035 develop digital entertainment. Long before the Internet became
5036 popular, Starwave began investing in new technology for delivering
5037 entertainment in anticipation of the power of networks.
5039 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5041 Alben had a special interest in new technology. He was intrigued by
5042 the emerging market for CD-ROM technology
—not to distribute
5043 film, but to do things with film that otherwise would be very
5044 difficult. In
1993, he launched an initiative to develop a product to
5045 build retrospectives on the work of particular actors. The first actor
5046 chosen was Clint Eastwood. The idea was to showcase all of the work of
5047 Eastwood, with clips from his films and interviews with figures
5048 important to his career.
5050 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5052 At that time, Eastwood had made more than fifty films, as an actor and
5053 as a director. Alben began with a series of interviews with Eastwood,
5054 asking him about his career. Because Starwave produced those
5055 interviews, it was free to include them on the CD.
5058 <!-- PAGE BREAK 112 -->
5059 That alone would not have made a very interesting product, so
5060 Starwave wanted to add content from the movies in Eastwood's career:
5061 posters, scripts, and other material relating to the films Eastwood
5062 made. Most of his career was spent at Warner Brothers, and so it was
5063 relatively easy to get permission for that content.
5065 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5067 Then Alben and his team decided to include actual film clips. "Our
5068 goal was that we were going to have a clip from every one of
5069 Eastwood's films," Alben told me. It was here that the problem
5070 arose. "No one had ever really done this before," Alben explained. "No
5071 one had ever tried to do this in the context of an artistic look at an
5074 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5076 Alben brought the idea to Michael Slade, the CEO of Starwave.
5077 Slade asked, "Well, what will it take?"
5079 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5081 Alben replied, "Well, we're going to have to clear rights from
5082 everyone who appears in these films, and the music and everything
5083 else that we want to use in these film clips." Slade said, "Great! Go
5086 <primary>artists
</primary>
5087 <secondary>publicity rights on images of
</secondary>
5091 Technically, the rights that Alben had to clear were mainly those of
5092 publicity
—rights an artist has to control the commercial
5093 exploitation of his image. But these rights, too, burden "Rip, Mix,
5094 Burn" creativity, as this chapter evinces.
5098 The problem was that neither Alben nor Slade had any idea what
5099 clearing those rights would mean. Every actor in each of the films
5100 could have a claim to royalties for the reuse of that film. But CD-
5101 ROMs had not been specified in the contracts for the actors, so there
5102 was no clear way to know just what Starwave was to do.
5105 I asked Alben how he dealt with the problem. With an obvious
5106 pride in his resourcefulness that obscured the obvious bizarreness of his
5107 tale, Alben recounted just what they did:
5111 So we very mechanically went about looking up the film clips. We made
5112 some artistic decisions about what film clips to include
—of
5113 course we were going to use the "Make my day" clip from Dirty
5114 Harry. But you then need to get the guy on the ground who's wiggling
5115 under the gun and you need to get his permission. And then you have
5116 to decide what you are going to pay him.
5119 <!-- PAGE BREAK 113 -->
5120 We decided that it would be fair if we offered them the
5122 rate for the right to reuse that performance. We're talking
5123 about a clip of less than a minute, but to reuse that performance
5124 in the CD-ROM the rate at the time was about $
600.
5125 So we had to identify the people
—some of them were hard to
5126 identify because in Eastwood movies you can't tell who's the guy
5127 crashing through the glass
—is it the actor or is it the stuntman?
5128 And then we just, we put together a team, my assistant and some
5129 others, and we just started calling people.
5132 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5134 Some actors were glad to help
—Donald Sutherland, for example,
5135 followed up himself to be sure that the rights had been cleared.
5136 Others were dumbfounded at their good fortune. Alben would ask,
5137 "Hey, can I pay you $
600 or maybe if you were in two films, you
5138 know, $
1,
200?" And they would say, "Are you for real? Hey, I'd love
5139 to get $
1,
200." And some of course were a bit difficult (estranged
5140 ex-wives, in particular). But eventually, Alben and his team had
5141 cleared the rights to this retrospective CD-ROM on Clint Eastwood's
5145 It was one year later
—"and even then we weren't sure whether we
5146 were totally in the clear."
5148 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5150 Alben is proud of his work. The project was the first of its kind and
5151 the only time he knew of that a team had undertaken such a massive
5152 project for the purpose of releasing a retrospective.
5156 Everyone thought it would be too hard. Everyone just threw up their
5157 hands and said, "Oh, my gosh, a film, it's so many copyrights, there's
5158 the music, there's the screenplay, there's the director, there's the
5159 actors." But we just broke it down. We just put it into its
5160 constituent parts and said, "Okay, there's this many actors, this many
5161 directors, . . . this many musicians," and we just went at it very
5162 systematically and cleared the rights.
5167 <!-- PAGE BREAK 114 -->
5168 And no doubt, the product itself was exceptionally good. Eastwood
5169 loved it, and it sold very well.
5171 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5173 But I pressed Alben about how weird it seems that it would have to
5174 take a year's work simply to clear rights. No doubt Alben had done
5175 this efficiently, but as Peter Drucker has famously quipped, "There is
5176 nothing so useless as doing efficiently that which should not be done
5177 at all."
<footnote><para>
5179 U.S. Department of Commerce Office of Acquisition Management, Seven
5180 Steps to Performance-Based Services Acquisition, available at
5181 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
22</ulink>.
5183 Did it make sense, I asked Alben, that this is the way a new work
5187 For, as he acknowledged, "very few . . . have the time and resources,
5188 and the will to do this," and thus, very few such works would ever be
5189 made. Does it make sense, I asked him, from the standpoint of what
5190 anybody really thought they were ever giving rights for originally, that
5191 you would have to go clear rights for these kinds of clips?
5195 I don't think so. When an actor renders a performance in a movie,
5196 he or she gets paid very well. . . . And then when
30 seconds of
5197 that performance is used in a new product that is a retrospective
5198 of somebody's career, I don't think that that person . . . should be
5199 compensated for that.
5203 Or at least, is this how the artist should be compensated? Would it
5204 make sense, I asked, for there to be some kind of statutory license that
5205 someone could pay and be free to make derivative use of clips like this?
5206 Did it really make sense that a follow-on creator would have to track
5207 down every artist, actor, director, musician, and get explicit permission
5208 from each? Wouldn't a lot more be created if the legal part of the
5210 process could be made to be more clean?
5214 Absolutely. I think that if there were some fair-licensing
5215 mechanism
—where
5216 you weren't subject to hold-ups and you weren't
5217 subject to estranged former spouses
—you'd see a lot more of this
5218 work, because it wouldn't be so daunting to try to put together a
5219 <!-- PAGE BREAK 115 -->
5220 retrospective of someone's career and meaningfully illustrate it
5221 with lots of media from that person's career. You'd build in a cost
5222 as the producer of one of these things. You'd build in a cost of
5224 X dollars to the talent that performed. But it would be a
5225 known cost. That's the thing that trips everybody up and makes
5226 this kind of product hard to get off the ground. If you knew I have
5227 a hundred minutes of film in this product and it's going to cost me
5228 X, then you build your budget around it, and you can get
5230 and everything else that you need to produce it. But if you
5231 say, "Oh, I want a hundred minutes of something and I have no
5232 idea what it's going to cost me, and a certain number of people are
5233 going to hold me up for money," then it becomes difficult to put
5234 one of these things together.
5237 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5239 Alben worked for a big company. His company was backed by some of the
5240 richest investors in the world. He therefore had authority and access
5241 that the average Web designer would not have. So if it took him a
5242 year, how long would it take someone else? And how much creativity is
5243 never made just because the costs of clearing the rights are so high?
5244 These costs are the burdens of a kind of regulation. Put on a
5245 Republican hat for a moment, and get angry for a bit. The government
5246 defines the scope of these rights, and the scope defined determines
5247 how much it's going to cost to negotiate them. (Remember the idea that
5248 land runs to the heavens, and imagine the pilot purchasing flythrough
5249 rights as he negotiates to fly from Los Angeles to San Francisco.)
5250 These rights might well have once made sense; but as circumstances
5251 change, they make no sense at all. Or at least, a well-trained,
5252 regulationminimizing Republican should look at the rights and ask,
5253 "Does this still make sense?"
5256 I've seen the flash of recognition when people get this point, but only
5257 a few times. The first was at a conference of federal judges in California.
5258 The judges were gathered to discuss the emerging topic of cyber-law. I
5259 was asked to be on the panel. Harvey Saferstein, a well-respected lawyer
5261 <!-- PAGE BREAK 116 -->
5262 from an L.A. firm, introduced the panel with a video that he and a
5263 friend, Robert Fairbank, had produced.
5266 The video was a brilliant collage of film from every period in the
5267 twentieth century, all framed around the idea of a
60 Minutes episode.
5268 The execution was perfect, down to the sixty-minute stopwatch. The
5269 judges loved every minute of it.
5271 <indexterm><primary>Nimmer, David
</primary></indexterm>
5273 When the lights came up, I looked over to my copanelist, David
5274 Nimmer, perhaps the leading copyright scholar and practitioner in the
5275 nation. He had an astonished look on his face, as he peered across the
5276 room of over
250 well-entertained judges. Taking an ominous tone, he
5277 began his talk with a question: "Do you know how many federal laws
5278 were just violated in this room?"
5280 <indexterm><primary>Boies, David
</primary></indexterm>
5282 For of course, the two brilliantly talented creators who made this
5283 film hadn't done what Alben did. They hadn't spent a year clearing the
5284 rights to these clips; technically, what they had done violated the
5285 law. Of course, it wasn't as if they or anyone were going to be
5286 prosecuted for this violation (the presence of
250 judges and a gaggle
5287 of federal marshals notwithstanding). But Nimmer was making an
5288 important point: A year before anyone would have heard of the word
5289 Napster, and two years before another member of our panel, David
5290 Boies, would defend Napster before the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals,
5291 Nimmer was trying to get the judges to see that the law would not be
5292 friendly to the capacities that this technology would
5293 enable. Technology means you can now do amazing things easily; but you
5294 couldn't easily do them legally.
5297 We live in a "cut and paste" culture enabled by technology. Anyone
5298 building a presentation knows the extraordinary freedom that the cut
5299 and paste architecture of the Internet created
—in a second you can
5300 find just about any image you want; in another second, you can have it
5301 planted in your presentation.
5304 But presentations are just a tiny beginning. Using the Internet and
5305 <!-- PAGE BREAK 117 -->
5306 its archives, musicians are able to string together mixes of sound
5307 never before imagined; filmmakers are able to build movies out of
5308 clips on computers around the world. An extraordinary site in Sweden
5309 takes images of politicians and blends them with music to create
5310 biting political commentary. A site called Camp Chaos has produced
5311 some of the most biting criticism of the record industry that there is
5312 through the mixing of Flash! and music.
5315 All of these creations are technically illegal. Even if the creators
5316 wanted to be "legal," the cost of complying with the law is impossibly
5317 high. Therefore, for the law-abiding sorts, a wealth of creativity is
5318 never made. And for that part that is made, if it doesn't follow the
5319 clearance rules, it doesn't get released.
5322 To some, these stories suggest a solution: Let's alter the mix of
5323 rights so that people are free to build upon our culture. Free to add
5324 or mix as they see fit. We could even make this change without
5325 necessarily requiring that the "free" use be free as in "free beer."
5326 Instead, the system could simply make it easy for follow-on creators
5327 to compensate artists without requiring an army of lawyers to come
5328 along: a rule, for example, that says "the royalty owed the copyright
5329 owner of an unregistered work for the derivative reuse of his work
5330 will be a flat
1 percent of net revenues, to be held in escrow for the
5331 copyright owner." Under this rule, the copyright owner could benefit
5332 from some royalty, but he would not have the benefit of a full
5333 property right (meaning the right to name his own price) unless he
5337 Who could possibly object to this? And what reason would there be
5338 for objecting? We're talking about work that is not now being made;
5339 which if made, under this plan, would produce new income for artists.
5340 What reason would anyone have to oppose it?
5343 In February
2003, DreamWorks studios announced an agreement with Mike
5344 Myers, the comic genius of Saturday Night Live and
5345 <!-- PAGE BREAK 118 -->
5346 Austin Powers. According to the announcement, Myers and Dream-Works
5347 would work together to form a "unique filmmaking pact." Under the
5348 agreement, DreamWorks "will acquire the rights to existing motion
5349 picture hits and classics, write new storylines and
—with the use
5350 of stateof-the-art digital technology
—insert Myers and other
5351 actors into the film, thereby creating an entirely new piece of
5355 The announcement called this "film sampling." As Myers explained,
5356 "Film Sampling is an exciting way to put an original spin on existing
5357 films and allow audiences to see old movies in a new light. Rap
5358 artists have been doing this for years with music and now we are able
5359 to take that same concept and apply it to film." Steven Spielberg is
5360 quoted as saying, "If anyone can create a way to bring old films to
5361 new audiences, it is Mike."
5364 Spielberg is right. Film sampling by Myers will be brilliant. But if
5365 you don't think about it, you might miss the truly astonishing point
5366 about this announcement. As the vast majority of our film heritage
5367 remains under copyright, the real meaning of the DreamWorks
5368 announcement is just this: It is Mike Myers and only Mike Myers who is
5369 free to sample. Any general freedom to build upon the film archive of
5370 our culture, a freedom in other contexts presumed for us all, is now a
5371 privilege reserved for the funny and famous
—and presumably rich.
5374 This privilege becomes reserved for two sorts of reasons. The first
5375 continues the story of the last chapter: the vagueness of "fair use."
5376 Much of "sampling" should be considered "fair use." But few would
5377 rely upon so weak a doctrine to create. That leads to the second reason
5378 that the privilege is reserved for the few: The costs of negotiating the
5379 legal rights for the creative reuse of content are astronomically high.
5380 These costs mirror the costs with fair use: You either pay a lawyer to
5381 defend your fair use rights or pay a lawyer to track down permissions
5382 so you don't have to rely upon fair use rights. Either way, the creative
5383 process is a process of paying lawyers
—again a privilege, or perhaps a
5384 curse, reserved for the few.
5386 <!-- PAGE BREAK 119 -->
5388 <sect1 id=
"collectors">
5389 <title>CHAPTER NINE: Collectors
</title>
5391 In April
1996, millions of "bots"
—computer codes designed to
5392 "spider," or automatically search the Internet and copy content
—began
5393 running across the Net. Page by page, these bots copied Internet-based
5394 information onto a small set of computers located in a basement in San
5395 Francisco's Presidio. Once the bots finished the whole of the Internet,
5396 they started again. Over and over again, once every two months, these
5397 bits of code took copies of the Internet and stored them.
5400 By October
2001, the bots had collected more than five years of
5401 copies. And at a small announcement in Berkeley, California, the archive
5402 that these copies created, the Internet Archive, was opened to the
5403 world. Using a technology called "the Way Back Machine," you could
5404 enter a Web page, and see all of its copies going back to
1996, as well
5405 as when those pages changed.
5408 This is the thing about the Internet that Orwell would have
5410 In the dystopia described in
1984, old newspapers were
5412 updated to assure that the current view of the world, approved
5413 of by the government, was not contradicted by previous news reports.
5416 <!-- PAGE BREAK 120 -->
5417 Thousands of workers constantly reedited the past, meaning there was
5418 no way ever to know whether the story you were reading today was the
5419 story that was printed on the date published on the paper.
5422 It's the same with the Internet. If you go to a Web page today,
5423 there's no way for you to know whether the content you are reading is
5424 the same as the content you read before. The page may seem the same,
5425 but the content could easily be different. The Internet is Orwell's
5426 library
—constantly
5427 updated, without any reliable memory.
5430 Until the Way Back Machine, at least. With the Way Back
5432 and the Internet Archive underlying it, you can see what the
5433 Internet was. You have the power to see what you remember. More
5434 importantly, perhaps, you also have the power to find what you don't
5435 remember and what others might prefer you forget.
<footnote><para>
5437 The temptations remain, however. Brewster Kahle reports that the White
5438 House changes its own press releases without notice. A May
13,
2003, press
5439 release stated, "Combat Operations in Iraq Have Ended." That was later
5440 changed, without notice, to "Major Combat Operations in Iraq Have Ended."
5441 E-mail from Brewster Kahle,
1 December
2003.
5445 We take it for granted that we can go back to see what we
5447 reading. Think about newspapers. If you wanted to study the
5449 of your hometown newspaper to the race riots in Watts in
1965,
5450 or to Bull Connor's water cannon in
1963, you could go to your public
5451 library and look at the newspapers. Those papers probably exist on
5452 microfiche. If you're lucky, they exist in paper, too. Either way, you
5453 are free, using a library, to go back and remember
—not just what it is
5454 convenient to remember, but remember something close to the truth.
5457 It is said that those who fail to remember history are doomed to
5459 it. That's not quite correct. We all forget history. The key is whether
5460 we have a way to go back to rediscover what we forget. More directly, the
5461 key is whether an objective past can keep us honest. Libraries help do
5462 that, by collecting content and keeping it, for schoolchildren, for
5464 for grandma. A free society presumes this knowedge.
5467 The Internet was an exception to this presumption. Until the
5469 Archive, there was no way to go back. The Internet was the
5470 quintessentially transitory medium. And yet, as it becomes more
5472 in forming and reforming society, it becomes more and more
5473 <!-- PAGE BREAK 121 -->
5475 to maintain in some historical form. It's just bizarre to think that
5476 we have scads of archives of newspapers from tiny towns around the
5477 world, yet there is but one copy of the Internet
—the one kept by the
5482 Brewster Kahle is the founder of the Internet Archive. He was a very
5483 successful Internet entrepreneur after he was a successful computer
5485 In the
1990s, Kahle decided he had had enough business
5487 It was time to become a different kind of success. So he launched
5488 a series of projects designed to archive human knowledge. The
5490 Archive was just the first of the projects of this Andrew Carnegie
5491 of the Internet. By December of
2002, the archive had over
10 billion
5492 pages, and it was growing at about a billion pages a month.
5495 The Way Back Machine is the largest archive of human knowledge
5496 in human history. At the end of
2002, it held "two hundred and thirty
5497 terabytes of material"
—and was "ten times larger than the Library of
5498 Congress." And this was just the first of the archives that Kahle set
5499 out to build. In addition to the Internet Archive, Kahle has been
5501 the Television Archive. Television, it turns out, is even more
5502 ephemeral than the Internet. While much of twentieth-century culture
5503 was constructed through television, only a tiny proportion of that
5505 is available for anyone to see today. Three hours of news are
5507 each evening by Vanderbilt University
—thanks to a specific
5508 exemption in the copyright law. That content is indexed, and is available
5509 to scholars for a very low fee. "But other than that, [television] is almost
5510 unavailable," Kahle told me. "If you were Barbara Walters you could get
5511 access to [the archives], but if you are just a graduate student?" As Kahle
5516 Do you remember when Dan Quayle was interacting with
5518 Brown? Remember that back and forth surreal experience of
5519 a politician interacting with a fictional television character? If you
5520 were a graduate student wanting to study that, and you wanted to
5521 get those original back and forth exchanges between the two, the
5523 <!-- PAGE BREAK 122 -->
5524 60 Minutes episode that came out after it . . . it would be almost
5525 impossible. . . . Those materials are almost unfindable. . . .
5529 Why is that? Why is it that the part of our culture that is recorded
5530 in newspapers remains perpetually accessible, while the part that is
5531 recorded on videotape is not? How is it that we've created a world
5532 where researchers trying to understand the effect of media on
5534 America will have an easier time than researchers trying to
5536 the effect of media on twentieth-century America?
5539 In part, this is because of the law. Early in American copyright law,
5540 copyright owners were required to deposit copies of their work in
5542 These copies were intended both to facilitate the spread of
5543 knowledge and to assure that a copy of the work would be around once
5544 the copyright expired, so that others might access and copy the work.
5547 These rules applied to film as well. But in
1915, the Library of
5549 made an exception for film. Film could be copyrighted so long
5550 as such deposits were made. But the filmmaker was then allowed to
5551 borrow back the deposits
—for an unlimited time at no cost. In
1915
5552 alone, there were more than
5,
475 films deposited and "borrowed back."
5553 Thus, when the copyrights to films expire, there is no copy held by any
5554 library. The copy exists
—if it exists at all
—in the library archive of the
5555 film company.
<footnote><para>
5557 Doug Herrick, "Toward a National Film Collection: Motion Pictures at the
5558 Library of Congress," Film Library Quarterly
13 nos.
2–3 (
1980):
5;
5560 Slide, Nitrate Won't Wait: A History of Film Preservation in the United
5561 States ( Jefferson, N.C.: McFarland
& Co.,
1992),
36.
5565 The same is generally true about television. Television broadcasts
5566 were originally not copyrighted
—there was no way to capture the
5567 broadcasts, so there was no fear of "theft." But as technology enabled
5568 capturing, broadcasters relied increasingly upon the law. The law
5570 they make a copy of each broadcast for the work to be
5572 But those copies were simply kept by the broadcasters. No
5573 library had any right to them; the government didn't demand them.
5574 The content of this part of American culture is practically invisible to
5575 anyone who would look.
5578 Kahle was eager to correct this. Before September
11,
2001, he and
5579 <!-- PAGE BREAK 123 -->
5580 his allies had started capturing television. They selected twenty
5582 from around the world and hit the Record button. After
5584 11, Kahle, working with dozens of others, selected twenty stations
5585 from around the world and, beginning October
11,
2001, made their
5586 coverage during the week of September
11 available free on-line.
5588 could see how news reports from around the world covered the
5592 Kahle had the same idea with film. Working with Rick Prelinger,
5593 whose archive of film includes close to
45,
000 "ephemeral films"
5594 (meaning films other than Hollywood movies, films that were never
5595 copyrighted), Kahle established the Movie Archive. Prelinger let Kahle
5596 digitize
1,
300 films in this archive and post those films on the Internet
5597 to be downloaded for free. Prelinger's is a for-profit company. It sells
5598 copies of these films as stock footage. What he has discovered is that
5599 after he made a significant chunk available for free, his stock footage
5600 sales went up dramatically. People could easily find the material they
5601 wanted to use. Some downloaded that material and made films on
5602 their own. Others purchased copies to enable other films to be made.
5603 Either way, the archive enabled access to this important part of our
5605 Want to see a copy of the "Duck and Cover" film that instructed
5606 children how to save themselves in the middle of nuclear attack? Go to
5607 archive.org, and you can download the film in a few minutes
—for free.
5610 Here again, Kahle is providing access to a part of our culture that
5611 we otherwise could not get easily, if at all. It is yet another part of what
5612 defines the twentieth century that we have lost to history. The law
5613 doesn't require these copies to be kept by anyone, or to be deposited in
5614 an archive by anyone. Therefore, there is no simple way to find them.
5617 The key here is access, not price. Kahle wants to enable free access to
5618 this content, but he also wants to enable others to sell access to it. His
5619 aim is to ensure competition in access to this important part of our
5621 Not during the commercial life of a bit of creative property, but
5623 a second life that all creative property has
—a noncommercial life.
5626 For here is an idea that we should more clearly recognize. Every bit
5627 of creative property goes through different "lives." In its first life, if the
5629 <!-- PAGE BREAK 124 -->
5630 creator is lucky, the content is sold. In such cases the commercial
5632 is successful for the creator. The vast majority of creative property
5633 doesn't enjoy such success, but some clearly does. For that content,
5634 commercial life is extremely important. Without this commercial
5636 there would be, many argue, much less creativity.
5639 After the commercial life of creative property has ended, our
5641 has always supported a second life as well. A newspaper delivers
5642 the news every day to the doorsteps of America. The very next day, it is
5643 used to wrap fish or to fill boxes with fragile gifts or to build an archive
5644 of knowledge about our history. In this second life, the content can
5645 continue to inform even if that information is no longer sold.
5648 The same has always been true about books. A book goes out of
5649 print very quickly (the average today is after about a year
<footnote><para>
5651 Dave Barns, "Fledgling Career in Antique Books: Woodstock Landlord,
5652 Bar Owner Starts a New Chapter by Adopting Business," Chicago Tribune,
5653 5 September
1997, at Metro Lake
1L. Of books published between
1927
5654 and
1946, only
2.2 percent were in print in
2002. R. Anthony Reese, "The
5655 First Sale Doctrine in the Era of Digital Networks," Boston College Law
5657 44 (
2003):
593 n.
51.
5658 </para></footnote>). After it is
5659 out of print, it can be sold in used book stores without the copyright
5660 owner getting anything and stored in libraries, where many get to read
5661 the book, also for free. Used book stores and libraries are thus the
5663 life of a book. That second life is extremely important to the
5664 spread and stability of culture.
5667 Yet increasingly, any assumption about a stable second life for
5669 property does not hold true with the most important components
5670 of popular culture in the twentieth and twenty-first centuries. For
5671 these
—television, movies, music, radio, the Internet
—there is no
5673 of a second life. For these sorts of culture, it is as if we've replaced
5674 libraries with Barnes
& Noble superstores. With this culture, what's
5675 accessible is nothing but what a certain limited market demands.
5677 that, culture disappears.
5680 For most of the twentieth century, it was economics that made this
5681 so. It would have been insanely expensive to collect and make
5683 all television and film and music: The cost of analog copies is
5685 high. So even though the law in principle would have
5686 restricted the ability of a Brewster Kahle to copy culture generally, the
5687 <!-- PAGE BREAK 125 -->
5688 real restriction was economics. The market made it impossibly difficult
5689 to do anything about this ephemeral culture; the law had little
5694 Perhaps the single most important feature of the digital revolution
5695 is that for the first time since the Library of Alexandria, it is feasible to
5696 imagine constructing archives that hold all culture produced or
5698 publicly. Technology makes it possible to imagine an archive of all
5699 books published, and increasingly makes it possible to imagine an
5700 archive of all moving images and sound.
5703 The scale of this potential archive is something we've never
5705 before. The Brewster Kahles of our history have dreamed about it;
5706 but we are for the first time at a point where that dream is possible. As
5711 It looks like there's about two to three million recordings of
5713 Ever. There are about a hundred thousand theatrical releases
5714 of movies, . . . and about one to two million movies [distributed]
5715 during the twentieth century. There are about twenty-six million
5716 different titles of books. All of these would fit on computers that
5717 would fit in this room and be able to be afforded by a small
5719 So we're at a turning point in our history. Universal access is
5720 the goal. And the opportunity of leading a different life, based on
5721 this, is . . . thrilling. It could be one of the things humankind
5722 would be most proud of. Up there with the Library of Alexandria,
5723 putting a man on the moon, and the invention of the printing
5728 Kahle is not the only librarian. The Internet Archive is not the only
5729 archive. But Kahle and the Internet Archive suggest what the future of
5730 libraries or archives could be. When the commercial life of creative
5731 property ends, I don't know. But it does. And whenever it does, Kahle
5732 and his archive hint at a world where this knowledge, and culture,
5734 perpetually available. Some will draw upon it to understand it;
5735 <!-- PAGE BREAK 126 -->
5736 some to criticize it. Some will use it, as Walt Disney did, to re-create
5737 the past for the future. These technologies promise something that had
5738 become unimaginable for much of our past
—a future for our past. The
5739 technology of digital arts could make the dream of the Library of
5740 Alexandria real again.
5743 Technologists have thus removed the economic costs of building
5744 such an archive. But lawyers' costs remain. For as much as we might
5745 like to call these "archives," as warm as the idea of a "library" might
5746 seem, the "content" that is collected in these digital spaces is also
5748 "property." And the law of property restricts the freedoms that
5749 Kahle and others would exercise.
5751 <!-- PAGE BREAK 127 -->
5753 <sect1 id=
"property-i">
5754 <title>CHAPTER TEN: "Property"
</title>
5756 Jack Valenti has been the president of the Motion Picture
5758 of America since
1966. He first came to Washington, D.C.,
5759 with Lyndon Johnson's administration
—literally. The famous picture
5760 of Johnson's swearing-in on Air Force One after the assassination of
5761 President Kennedy has Valenti in the background. In his almost forty
5762 years of running the MPAA, Valenti has established himself as perhaps
5763 the most prominent and effective lobbyist in Washington.
5766 The MPAA is the American branch of the international Motion
5767 Picture Association. It was formed in
1922 as a trade association whose
5768 goal was to defend American movies against increasing domestic
5770 The organization now represents not only filmmakers but
5772 and distributors of entertainment for television, video, and
5773 cable. Its board is made up of the chairmen and presidents of the seven
5774 major producers and distributors of motion picture and television
5776 in the United States: Walt Disney, Sony Pictures
5778 MGM, Paramount Pictures, Twentieth Century Fox, Universal
5779 Studios, and Warner Brothers.
5782 <!-- PAGE BREAK 128 -->
5783 Valenti is only the third president of the MPAA. No president
5784 before him has had as much influence over that organization, or over
5785 Washington. As a Texan, Valenti has mastered the single most
5787 political skill of a Southerner
—the ability to appear simple and
5788 slow while hiding a lightning-fast intellect. To this day, Valenti plays
5789 the simple, humble man. But this Harvard MBA, and author of four
5790 books, who finished high school at the age of fifteen and flew more
5791 than fifty combat missions in World War II, is no Mr. Smith. When
5792 Valenti went to Washington, he mastered the city in a quintessentially
5796 In defending artistic liberty and the freedom of speech that our
5798 depends upon, the MPAA has done important good. In crafting
5799 the MPAA rating system, it has probably avoided a great deal of
5800 speech-regulating harm. But there is an aspect to the organization's
5801 mission that is both the most radical and the most important. This is
5802 the organization's effort, epitomized in Valenti's every act, to redefine
5803 the meaning of "creative property."
5806 In
1982, Valenti's testimony to Congress captured the strategy
5811 No matter the lengthy arguments made, no matter the charges
5812 and the counter-charges, no matter the tumult and the shouting,
5813 reasonable men and women will keep returning to the
5815 issue, the central theme which animates this entire debate:
5817 property owners must be accorded the same rights and protection
5818 resident in all other property owners in the nation. That is the issue.
5819 That is the question. And that is the rostrum on which this entire
5820 hearing and the debates to follow must rest.
<footnote><para>
5822 Home Recording of Copyrighted Works: Hearings on H.R.
4783, H.R.
5823 4794, H.R.
4808, H.R.
5250, H.R.
5488, and H.R.
5705 Before the
5825 on Courts, Civil Liberties, and the Administration of Justice of
5826 the Committee on the Judiciary of the House of Representatives,
97th
5827 Cong.,
2nd sess. (
1982):
65 (testimony of Jack Valenti).
5832 The strategy of this rhetoric, like the strategy of most of Valenti's
5833 rhetoric, is brilliant and simple and brilliant because simple. The
5835 theme" to which "reasonable men and women" will return is this:
5836 <!-- PAGE BREAK 129 -->
5837 "Creative property owners must be accorded the same rights and
5839 resident in all other property owners in the nation." There are
5840 no second-class citizens, Valenti might have continued. There should
5841 be no second-class property owners.
5844 This claim has an obvious and powerful intuitive pull. It is stated
5845 with such clarity as to make the idea as obvious as the notion that we
5846 use elections to pick presidents. But in fact, there is no more extreme a
5847 claim made by anyone who is serious in this debate than this claim of
5848 Valenti's. Jack Valenti, however sweet and however brilliant, is perhaps
5849 the nation's foremost extremist when it comes to the nature and scope
5850 of "creative property." His views have no reasonable connection to our
5851 actual legal tradition, even if the subtle pull of his Texan charm has
5852 slowly redefined that tradition, at least in Washington.
5855 While "creative property" is certainly "property" in a nerdy and
5857 sense that lawyers are trained to understand,
<footnote><para>
5859 Lawyers speak of "property" not as an absolute thing, but as a bundle of
5860 rights that are sometimes associated with a particular object. Thus, my
5861 "property right" to my car gives me the right to exclusive use, but not the
5862 right to drive at
150 miles an hour. For the best effort to connect the
5864 meaning of "property" to "lawyer talk," see Bruce Ackerman, Private
5865 Property and the Constitution (New Haven: Yale University Press,
1977),
5867 </para></footnote> it has never been the
5868 case, nor should it be, that "creative property owners" have been
5870 the same rights and protection resident in all other property
5871 owners." Indeed, if creative property owners were given the same rights
5872 as all other property owners, that would effect a radical, and radically
5873 undesirable, change in our tradition.
5876 Valenti knows this. But he speaks for an industry that cares squat
5877 for our tradition and the values it represents. He speaks for an industry
5878 that is instead fighting to restore the tradition that the British
5880 in
1710. In the world that Valenti's changes would create, a
5881 powerful few would exercise powerful control over how our creative
5882 culture would develop.
5885 I have two purposes in this chapter. The first is to convince you
5886 that, historically, Valenti's claim is absolutely wrong. The second is to
5887 convince you that it would be terribly wrong for us to reject our
5889 We have always treated rights in creative property differently
5890 from the rights resident in all other property owners. They have never
5891 been the same. And they should never be the same, because, however
5892 counterintuitive this may seem, to make them the same would be to
5894 <!-- PAGE BREAK 130 -->
5895 fundamentally weaken the opportunity for new creators to create.
5897 depends upon the owners of creativity having less than perfect
5901 Organizations such as the MPAA, whose board includes the most
5902 powerful of the old guard, have little interest, their rhetoric
5904 in assuring that the new can displace them. No organization
5905 does. No person does. (Ask me about tenure, for example.) But what's
5906 good for the MPAA is not necessarily good for America. A society that
5907 defends the ideals of free culture must preserve precisely the
5909 for new creativity to threaten the old.
5910 To get just a hint that there is something fundamentally wrong in
5911 Valenti's argument, we need look no further than the United States
5912 Constitution itself.
5915 The framers of our Constitution loved "property." Indeed, so
5916 strongly did they love property that they built into the Constitution an
5917 important requirement. If the government takes your property
—if it
5918 condemns your house, or acquires a slice of land from your farm
—it is
5919 required, under the Fifth Amendment's "Takings Clause," to pay you
5920 "just compensation" for that taking. The Constitution thus guarantees
5921 that property is, in a certain sense, sacred. It cannot ever be taken from
5922 the property owner unless the government pays for the privilege.
5925 Yet the very same Constitution speaks very differently about what
5926 Valenti calls "creative property." In the clause granting Congress the
5927 power to create "creative property," the Constitution requires that after
5928 a "limited time," Congress take back the rights that it has granted and
5929 set the "creative property" free to the public domain. Yet when
5931 does this, when the expiration of a copyright term "takes" your
5932 copyright and turns it over to the public domain, Congress does not
5933 have any obligation to pay "just compensation" for this "taking."
5935 the same Constitution that requires compensation for your land
5936 <!-- PAGE BREAK 131 -->
5937 requires that you lose your "creative property" right without any
5942 The Constitution thus on its face states that these two forms of
5943 property are not to be accorded the same rights. They are plainly to be
5944 treated differently. Valenti is therefore not just asking for a change in
5945 our tradition when he argues that creative-property owners should be
5946 accorded the same rights as every other property-right owner. He is
5948 arguing for a change in our Constitution itself.
5951 Arguing for a change in our Constitution is not necessarily wrong.
5952 There was much in our original Constitution that was plainly wrong.
5953 The Constitution of
1789 entrenched slavery; it left senators to be
5955 rather than elected; it made it possible for the electoral college
5956 to produce a tie between the president and his own vice president (as it
5957 did in
1800). The framers were no doubt extraordinary, but I would be
5958 the first to admit that they made big mistakes. We have since rejected
5959 some of those mistakes; no doubt there could be others that we should
5960 reject as well. So my argument is not simply that because Jefferson did
5964 Instead, my argument is that because Jefferson did it, we should at
5965 least try to understand why. Why did the framers, fanatical property
5966 types that they were, reject the claim that creative property be given the
5967 same rights as all other property? Why did they require that for
5969 property there must be a public domain?
5972 To answer this question, we need to get some perspective on the
5974 of these "creative property" rights, and the control that they
5976 Once we see clearly how differently these rights have been
5977 defined, we will be in a better position to ask the question that should
5978 be at the core of this war: Not whether creative property should be
5980 but how. Not whether we will enforce the rights the law gives to
5981 creative-property owners, but what the particular mix of rights ought to
5982 be. Not whether artists should be paid, but whether institutions designed
5983 to assure that artists get paid need also control how culture develops.
5987 <!-- PAGE BREAK 132 -->
5988 To answer these questions, we need a more general way to talk about
5989 how property is protected. More precisely, we need a more general way
5990 than the narrow language of the law allows. In Code and Other Laws of
5991 Cyberspace, I used a simple model to capture this more general
5992 perspective. For any particular right or regulation, this model asks
5993 how four different modalities of regulation interact to support or
5994 weaken the right or regulation. I represented it with this diagram:
5996 <figure id=
"fig-1331">
5997 <title>How four different modalities of regulation interact to support or weaken the right or regulation.
</title>
5998 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6001 At the center of this picture is a regulated dot: the individual or
6002 group that is the target of regulation, or the holder of a right. (In each
6003 case throughout, we can describe this either as regulation or as a right.
6004 For simplicity's sake, I will speak only of regulations.) The ovals
6006 four ways in which the individual or group might be regulated
—
6007 either constrained or, alternatively, enabled. Law is the most obvious
6008 constraint (to lawyers, at least). It constrains by threatening
6010 after the fact if the rules set in advance are violated. So if, for
6012 you willfully infringe Madonna's copyright by copying a song
6013 from her latest CD and posting it on the Web, you can be punished
6014 <!-- PAGE BREAK 133 -->
6015 with a $
150,
000 fine. The fine is an ex post punishment for violating
6016 an ex ante rule. It is imposed by the state.
6019 Norms are a different kind of constraint. They, too, punish an
6020 individual for violating a rule. But the punishment of a norm is
6021 imposed by a community, not (or not only) by the state. There may be
6022 no law against spitting, but that doesn't mean you won't be punished
6023 if you spit on the ground while standing in line at a movie. The
6024 punishment might not be harsh, though depending upon the community, it
6025 could easily be more harsh than many of the punishments imposed by the
6026 state. The mark of the difference is not the severity of the rule, but
6027 the source of the enforcement.
6030 The market is a third type of constraint. Its constraint is effected
6031 through conditions: You can do X if you pay Y; you'll be paid M if you
6032 do N. These constraints are obviously not independent of law or
6033 norms
—it is property law that defines what must be bought if it is to
6034 be taken legally; it is norms that say what is appropriately sold. But
6035 given a set of norms, and a background of property and contract law,
6036 the market imposes a simultaneous constraint upon how an individual or
6040 Finally, and for the moment, perhaps, most mysteriously,
6041 "architecture"
—the physical world as one finds it
—is a constraint on
6042 behavior. A fallen bridge might constrain your ability to get across
6043 a river. Railroad tracks might constrain the ability of a community to
6044 integrate its social life. As with the market, architecture does not
6045 effect its constraint through ex post punishments. Instead, also as
6046 with the market, architecture effects its constraint through
6047 simultaneous conditions. These conditions are imposed not by courts
6048 enforcing contracts, or by police punishing theft, but by nature, by
6049 "architecture." If a
500-pound boulder blocks your way, it is the law
6050 of gravity that enforces this constraint. If a $
500 airplane ticket
6051 stands between you and a flight to New York, it is the market that
6052 enforces this constraint.
6056 <!-- PAGE BREAK 134 -->
6057 So the first point about these four modalities of regulation is
6059 They interact. Restrictions imposed by one might be reinforced
6060 by another. Or restrictions imposed by one might be undermined by
6064 The second point follows directly: If we want to understand the
6065 effective freedom that anyone has at a given moment to do any
6067 thing, we have to consider how these four modalities interact.
6068 Whether or not there are other constraints (there may well be; my
6069 claim is not about comprehensiveness), these four are among the most
6070 significant, and any regulator (whether controlling or freeing) must
6071 consider how these four in particular interact.
6074 So, for example, consider the "freedom" to drive a car at a high
6075 speed. That freedom is in part restricted by laws: speed limits that say
6076 how fast you can drive in particular places at particular times. It is in
6077 part restricted by architecture: speed bumps, for example, slow most
6079 drivers; governors in buses, as another example, set the
6081 rate at which the driver can drive. The freedom is in part restricted
6082 by the market: Fuel efficiency drops as speed increases, thus the price of
6083 gasoline indirectly constrains speed. And finally, the norms of a
6085 may or may not constrain the freedom to speed. Drive at
50
6086 mph by a school in your own neighborhood and you're likely to be
6087 punished by the neighbors. The same norm wouldn't be as effective in
6088 a different town, or at night.
6091 The final point about this simple model should also be fairly clear:
6092 While these four modalities are analytically independent, law has a
6093 special role in affecting the three.
<footnote><para>
6095 By describing the way law affects the other three modalities, I don't mean
6096 to suggest that the other three don't affect law. Obviously, they do. Law's
6097 only distinction is that it alone speaks as if it has a right self-consciously to
6098 change the other three. The right of the other three is more timidly
6100 See Lawrence Lessig, Code: And Other Laws of Cyberspace (New
6101 York: Basic Books,
1999):
90–95; Lawrence Lessig, "The New Chicago
6102 School," Journal of Legal Studies, June
1998.
6104 The law, in other words, sometimes
6105 operates to increase or decrease the constraint of a particular modality.
6106 Thus, the law might be used to increase taxes on gasoline, so as to
6108 the incentives to drive more slowly. The law might be used to
6109 mandate more speed bumps, so as to increase the difficulty of driving
6110 rapidly. The law might be used to fund ads that stigmatize reckless
6111 driving. Or the law might be used to require that other laws be more
6112 <!-- PAGE BREAK 135 -->
6113 strict
—a federal requirement that states decrease the speed limit, for
6114 example
—so as to decrease the attractiveness of fast driving.
6116 <figure id=
"fig-1361">
6117 <title>Law has a special role in affecting the three.
</title>
6118 <graphic fileref=
"images/1361.png"></graphic>
6121 These constraints can thus change, and they can be changed. To
6122 understand the effective protection of liberty or protection of
6123 property at any particular moment, we must track these changes over
6124 time. A restriction imposed by one modality might be erased by
6125 another. A freedom enabled by one modality might be displaced by
6127 <indexterm><primary>Commons, John R.
</primary></indexterm>
6130 Some people object to this way of talking about "liberty." They object
6131 because their focus when considering the constraints that exist at any
6132 particular moment are constraints imposed exclusively by the
6133 government. For instance, if a storm destroys a bridge, these people
6134 think it is meaningless to say that one's liberty has been
6135 restrained. A bridge has washed out, and it's harder to get from one
6136 place to another. To talk about this as a loss of freedom, they say,
6137 is to confuse the stuff of politics with the vagaries of ordinary
6138 life. I don't mean to deny the value in this narrower view, which
6139 depends upon the context of the inquiry. I do, however, mean to argue
6140 against any insistence that this narrower view is the only proper view
6141 of liberty. As I argued in Code, we come from a long tradition of
6142 political thought with a broader focus than the narrow question of
6143 what the government did when. John Stuart Mill defended freedom of
6144 speech, for example, from the tyranny of narrow minds, not from the
6145 fear of government prosecution; John Stuart Mill, On Liberty (Indiana:
6146 Hackett Publishing Co.,
1978),
19. John R. Commons famously defended
6147 the economic freedom of labor from constraints imposed by the market;
6148 John R. Commons, "The Right to Work," in Malcom Rutherford and Warren
6149 J. Samuels, eds., John R. Commons: Selected Essays (London:
6150 Routledge:
1997),
62. The Americans with Disabilities Act increases
6151 the liberty of people with physical disabilities by changing the
6152 architecture of certain public places, thereby making access to those
6153 places easier;
42 United States Code, section
12101 (
2000). Each of
6154 these interventions to change existing conditions changes the liberty
6155 of a particular group. The effect of those interventions should be
6156 accounted for in order to understand the effective liberty that each
6157 of these groups might face.
</para></footnote>
6159 <sect2 id=
"hollywood">
6160 <title>Why Hollywood Is Right
</title>
6162 The most obvious point that this model reveals is just why, or just
6163 how, Hollywood is right. The copyright warriors have rallied Congress
6164 and the courts to defend copyright. This model helps us see why that
6165 rallying makes sense.
6168 Let's say this is the picture of copyright's regulation before the
6171 <figure id=
"fig-1371">
6172 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.
</title>
6173 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6176 <!-- PAGE BREAK 136 -->
6177 There is balance between law, norms, market, and architecture. The law
6178 limits the ability to copy and share content, by imposing penalties on
6179 those who copy and share content. Those penalties are reinforced by
6180 technologies that make it hard to copy and share content
6181 (architecture) and expensive to copy and share content
6182 (market). Finally, those penalties are mitigated by norms we all
6183 recognize
—kids, for example, taping other kids' records. These
6184 uses of copyrighted material may well be infringement, but the norms
6185 of our society (before the Internet, at least) had no problem with
6186 this form of infringement.
6189 Enter the Internet, or, more precisely, technologies such as MP3s and
6190 p2p sharing. Now the constraint of architecture changes dramatically,
6191 as does the constraint of the market. And as both the market and
6192 architecture relax the regulation of copyright, norms pile on. The
6193 happy balance (for the warriors, at least) of life before the Internet
6194 becomes an effective state of anarchy after the Internet.
6197 Thus the sense of, and justification for, the warriors' response.
6198 Technology has changed, the warriors say, and the effect of this
6199 change, when ramified through the market and norms, is that a balance
6200 of protection for the copyright owners' rights has been lost. This is
6202 <!-- PAGE BREAK 137 -->
6203 after the fall of Saddam, but this time no government is justifying the
6204 looting that results.
6206 <figure id=
"fig-1381">
6207 <title>effective state of anarchy after the Internet.
</title>
6208 <graphic fileref=
"images/1381.png"></graphic>
6211 Neither this analysis nor the conclusions that follow are new to the
6212 warriors. Indeed, in a "White Paper" prepared by the Commerce
6213 Department (one heavily influenced by the copyright warriors) in
1995,
6214 this mix of regulatory modalities had already been identified and the
6215 strategy to respond already mapped. In response to the changes the
6216 Internet had effected, the White Paper argued (
1) Congress should
6217 strengthen intellectual property law, (
2) businesses should adopt
6218 innovative marketing techniques, (
3) technologists should push to
6219 develop code to protect copyrighted material, and (
4) educators should
6220 educate kids to better protect copyright.
6223 This mixed strategy is just what copyright needed
—if it was to
6224 preserve the particular balance that existed before the change induced
6225 by the Internet. And it's just what we should expect the content
6226 industry to push for. It is as American as apple pie to consider the
6227 happy life you have as an entitlement, and to look to the law to
6228 protect it if something comes along to change that happy
6229 life. Homeowners living in a
6231 <!-- PAGE BREAK 138 -->
6232 flood plain have no hesitation appealing to the government to rebuild
6233 (and rebuild again) when a flood (architecture) wipes away their
6234 property (law). Farmers have no hesitation appealing to the government
6235 to bail them out when a virus (architecture) devastates their
6236 crop. Unions have no hesitation appealing to the government to bail
6237 them out when imports (market) wipe out the U.S. steel industry.
6240 Thus, there's nothing wrong or surprising in the content industry's
6241 campaign to protect itself from the harmful consequences of a
6242 technological innovation. And I would be the last person to argue that
6243 the changing technology of the Internet has not had a profound effect
6244 on the content industry's way of doing business, or as John Seely
6245 Brown describes it, its "architecture of revenue."
6248 But just because a particular interest asks for government support, it
6249 doesn't follow that support should be granted. And just because
6250 technology has weakened a particular way of doing business, it doesn't
6251 follow that the government should intervene to support that old way of
6252 doing business. Kodak, for example, has lost perhaps as much as
20
6253 percent of their traditional film market to the emerging technologies
6254 of digital cameras.
<footnote><para>
6256 See Geoffrey Smith, "Film vs. Digital: Can Kodak Build a Bridge?"
6257 BusinessWeek online,
2 August
1999, available at
6258 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
23</ulink>. For a more
6259 recent analysis of Kodak's place in the market, see Chana
6260 R. Schoenberger, "Can Kodak Make Up for Lost Moments?" Forbes.com,
6
6261 October
2003, available at
6262 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
24</ulink>.
6265 Does anyone believe the government should ban digital cameras just to
6266 support Kodak? Highways have weakened the freight business for
6267 railroads. Does anyone think we should ban trucks from roads for the
6268 purpose of protecting the railroads? Closer to the subject of this
6269 book, remote channel changers have weakened the "stickiness" of
6270 television advertising (if a boring commercial comes on the TV, the
6271 remote makes it easy to surf ), and it may well be that this change
6272 has weakened the television advertising market. But does anyone
6273 believe we should regulate remotes to reinforce commercial television?
6274 (Maybe by limiting them to function only once a second, or to switch
6275 to only ten channels within an hour?)
6278 The obvious answer to these obviously rhetorical questions is no.
6279 In a free society, with a free market, supported by free enterprise and
6280 free trade, the government's role is not to support one way of doing
6281 <!-- PAGE BREAK 139 -->
6282 business against others. Its role is not to pick winners and protect
6283 them against loss. If the government did this generally, then we would
6284 never have any progress. As Microsoft chairman Bill Gates wrote in
6285 1991, in a memo criticizing software patents, "established companies
6286 have an interest in excluding future competitors."
<footnote><para>
6288 Fred Warshofsky, The Patent Wars (New York: Wiley,
1994),
170–71.
6291 startup, established companies also have the means. (Think RCA and
6292 FM radio.) A world in which competitors with new ideas must fight
6293 not only the market but also the government is a world in which
6294 competitors with new ideas will not succeed. It is a world of stasis and
6295 increasingly concentrated stagnation. It is the Soviet Union under
6299 Thus, while it is understandable for industries threatened with new
6300 technologies that change the way they do business to look to the
6301 government for protection, it is the special duty of policy makers to
6302 guarantee that that protection not become a deterrent to progress. It
6303 is the duty of policy makers, in other words, to assure that the
6304 changes they create, in response to the request of those hurt by
6305 changing technology, are changes that preserve the incentives and
6306 opportunities for innovation and change.
6309 In the context of laws regulating speech
—which include,
6310 obviously, copyright law
—that duty is even stronger. When the
6311 industry complaining about changing technologies is asking Congress to
6312 respond in a way that burdens speech and creativity, policy makers
6313 should be especially wary of the request. It is always a bad deal for
6314 the government to get into the business of regulating speech
6315 markets. The risks and dangers of that game are precisely why our
6316 framers created the First Amendment to our Constitution: "Congress
6317 shall make no law . . . abridging the freedom of speech." So when
6318 Congress is being asked to pass laws that would "abridge" the freedom
6319 of speech, it should ask
— carefully
—whether such
6320 regulation is justified.
6323 My argument just now, however, has nothing to do with whether
6324 <!-- PAGE BREAK 140 -->
6325 the changes that are being pushed by the copyright warriors are
6326 "justified." My argument is about their effect. For before we get to
6327 the question of justification, a hard question that depends a great
6328 deal upon your values, we should first ask whether we understand the
6329 effect of the changes the content industry wants.
6332 Here's the metaphor that will capture the argument to follow.
6335 In
1873, the chemical DDT was first synthesized. In
1948, Swiss
6336 chemist Paul Hermann Müller won the Nobel Prize for his work
6337 demonstrating the insecticidal properties of DDT. By the
1950s, the
6338 insecticide was widely used around the world to kill disease-carrying
6339 pests. It was also used to increase farm production.
6342 No one doubts that killing disease-carrying pests or increasing crop
6343 production is a good thing. No one doubts that the work of Müller was
6344 important and valuable and probably saved lives, possibly millions.
6346 <indexterm><primary>Carson, Rachel
</primary></indexterm>
6348 But in
1962, Rachel Carson published Silent Spring, which argued that
6349 DDT, whatever its primary benefits, was also having unintended
6350 environmental consequences. Birds were losing the ability to
6351 reproduce. Whole chains of the ecology were being destroyed.
6354 No one set out to destroy the environment. Paul Müller certainly did
6355 not aim to harm any birds. But the effort to solve one set of problems
6356 produced another set which, in the view of some, was far worse than
6357 the problems that were originally attacked. Or more accurately, the
6358 problems DDT caused were worse than the problems it solved, at least
6359 when considering the other, more environmentally friendly ways to
6360 solve the problems that DDT was meant to solve.
6363 It is to this image precisely that Duke University law professor James
6364 Boyle appeals when he argues that we need an "environmentalism" for
6365 culture.
<footnote><para>
6367 See, for example, James Boyle, "A Politics of Intellectual Property:
6368 Environmentalism for the Net?" Duke Law Journal
47 (
1997):
87.
6370 His point, and the point I want to develop in the balance of this
6371 chapter, is not that the aims of copyright are flawed. Or that authors
6372 should not be paid for their work. Or that music should be given away
6373 "for free." The point is that some of the ways in which we might
6374 protect authors will have unintended consequences for the cultural
6375 environment, much like DDT had for the natural environment. And just
6376 <!-- PAGE BREAK 141 -->
6377 as criticism of DDT is not an endorsement of malaria or an attack on
6378 farmers, so, too, is criticism of one particular set of regulations
6379 protecting copyright not an endorsement of anarchy or an attack on
6380 authors. It is an environment of creativity that we seek, and we
6381 should be aware of our actions' effects on the environment.
6384 My argument, in the balance of this chapter, tries to map exactly
6385 this effect. No doubt the technology of the Internet has had a dramatic
6386 effect on the ability of copyright owners to protect their content. But
6387 there should also be little doubt that when you add together the
6388 changes in copyright law over time, plus the change in technology that
6389 the Internet is undergoing just now, the net effect of these changes will
6390 not be only that copyrighted work is effectively protected. Also, and
6391 generally missed, the net effect of this massive increase in protection
6392 will be devastating to the environment for creativity.
6395 In a line: To kill a gnat, we are spraying DDT with consequences
6396 for free culture that will be far more devastating than that this gnat will
6400 <sect2 id=
"beginnings">
6401 <title>Beginnings
</title>
6403 America copied English copyright law. Actually, we copied and improved
6404 English copyright law. Our Constitution makes the purpose of "creative
6405 property" rights clear; its express limitations reinforce the English
6406 aim to avoid overly powerful publishers.
6409 The power to establish "creative property" rights is granted to
6410 Congress in a way that, for our Constitution, at least, is very
6411 odd. Article I, section
8, clause
8 of our Constitution states that:
6414 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science and
6415 useful Arts, by securing for limited Times to Authors and Inventors
6416 the exclusive Right to their respective Writings and Discoveries.
6418 <!-- PAGE BREAK 142 -->
6419 We can call this the "Progress Clause," for notice what this clause
6420 does not say. It does not say Congress has the power to grant
6421 "creative property rights." It says that Congress has the power to
6422 promote progress. The grant of power is its purpose, and its purpose
6423 is a public one, not the purpose of enriching publishers, nor even
6424 primarily the purpose of rewarding authors.
6427 The Progress Clause expressly limits the term of copyrights. As we saw
6428 in chapter
6, the English limited the term of copyright so as to
6429 assure that a few would not exercise disproportionate control over
6430 culture by exercising disproportionate control over publishing. We can
6431 assume the framers followed the English for a similar purpose. Indeed,
6432 unlike the English, the framers reinforced that objective, by
6433 requiring that copyrights extend "to Authors" only.
6436 The design of the Progress Clause reflects something about the
6437 Constitution's design in general. To avoid a problem, the framers
6438 built structure. To prevent the concentrated power of publishers, they
6439 built a structure that kept copyrights away from publishers and kept
6440 them short. To prevent the concentrated power of a church, they banned
6441 the federal government from establishing a church. To prevent
6442 concentrating power in the federal government, they built structures
6443 to reinforce the power of the states
—including the Senate, whose
6444 members were at the time selected by the states, and an electoral
6445 college, also selected by the states, to select the president. In each
6446 case, a structure built checks and balances into the constitutional
6447 frame, structured to prevent otherwise inevitable concentrations of
6451 I doubt the framers would recognize the regulation we call "copyright"
6452 today. The scope of that regulation is far beyond anything they ever
6453 considered. To begin to understand what they did, we need to put our
6454 "copyright" in context: We need to see how it has changed in the
210
6455 years since they first struck its design.
6458 Some of these changes come from the law: some in light of changes
6459 in technology, and some in light of changes in technology given a
6460 <!-- PAGE BREAK 143 -->
6461 particular concentration of market power. In terms of our model, we
6464 <figure id=
"fig-1441">
6465 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.
</title>
6466 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6471 <figure id=
"fig-1442">
6472 <title>"Copyright
" today.
</title>
6473 <graphic fileref=
"images/1442.png"></graphic>
6477 <!-- PAGE BREAK 144 -->
6480 <sect2 id=
"lawduration">
6481 <title>Law: Duration
</title>
6483 When the first Congress enacted laws to protect creative property, it
6484 faced the same uncertainty about the status of creative property that
6485 the English had confronted in
1774. Many states had passed laws
6486 protecting creative property, and some believed that these laws simply
6487 supplemented common law rights that already protected creative
6488 authorship.
<footnote>
6489 <indexterm><primary>Crosskey, William W.
</primary></indexterm>
6492 William W. Crosskey, Politics and the Constitution in the History of
6493 the United States (London: Cambridge University Press,
1953), vol.
1,
6494 485–86: "extinguish[ing], by plain implication of `the supreme
6495 Law of the Land,' the perpetual rights which authors had, or were
6496 supposed by some to have, under the Common Law" (emphasis added).
6498 This meant that there was no guaranteed public domain in the United
6499 States in
1790. If copyrights were protected by the common law, then
6500 there was no simple way to know whether a work published in the United
6501 States was controlled or free. Just as in England, this lingering
6502 uncertainty would make it hard for publishers to rely upon a public
6503 domain to reprint and distribute works.
6506 That uncertainty ended after Congress passed legislation granting
6507 copyrights. Because federal law overrides any contrary state law,
6508 federal protections for copyrighted works displaced any state law
6509 protections. Just as in England the Statute of Anne eventually meant
6510 that the copyrights for all English works expired, a federal statute
6511 meant that any state copyrights expired as well.
6514 In
1790, Congress enacted the first copyright law. It created a
6515 federal copyright and secured that copyright for fourteen years. If
6516 the author was alive at the end of that fourteen years, then he could
6517 opt to renew the copyright for another fourteen years. If he did not
6518 renew the copyright, his work passed into the public domain.
6521 While there were many works created in the United States in the first
6522 ten years of the Republic, only
5 percent of the works were actually
6523 registered under the federal copyright regime. Of all the work created
6524 in the United States both before
1790 and from
1790 through
1800,
95
6525 percent immediately passed into the public domain; the balance would
6526 pass into the pubic domain within twenty-eight years at most, and more
6527 likely within fourteen years.
<footnote><para>
6529 Although
13,
000 titles were published in the United States from
1790
6530 to
1799, only
556 copyright registrations were filed; John Tebbel, A
6531 History of Book Publishing in the United States, vol.
1, The Creation
6532 of an Industry,
1630–1865 (New York: Bowker,
1972),
141. Of the
21,
000
6533 imprints recorded before
1790, only twelve were copyrighted under the
6534 1790 act; William J. Maher, Copyright Term, Retrospective Extension
6535 and the Copyright Law of
1790 in Historical Context,
7–10 (
2002),
6536 available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
6537 #
25</ulink>. Thus, the overwhelming majority of works fell
6538 immediately into the public domain. Even those works that were
6539 copyrighted fell into the public domain quickly, because the term of
6540 copyright was short. The initial term of copyright was fourteen years,
6541 with the option of renewal for an additional fourteen years. Copyright
6542 Act of May
31,
1790, §
1,
1 stat.
124.
</para></footnote>
6545 This system of renewal was a crucial part of the American system
6546 of copyright. It assured that the maximum terms of copyright would be
6547 <!-- PAGE BREAK 145 -->
6548 granted only for works where they were wanted. After the initial term
6549 of fourteen years, if it wasn't worth it to an author to renew his
6550 copyright, then it wasn't worth it to society to insist on the
6554 Fourteen years may not seem long to us, but for the vast majority of
6555 copyright owners at that time, it was long enough: Only a small
6556 minority of them renewed their copyright after fourteen years; the
6557 balance allowed their work to pass into the public
6558 domain.
<footnote><para>
6560 Few copyright holders ever chose to renew their copyrights. For
6561 instance, of the
25,
006 copyrights registered in
1883, only
894 were
6562 renewed in
1910. For a year-by-year analysis of copyright renewal
6563 rates, see Barbara A. Ringer, "Study No.
31: Renewal of Copyright,"
6564 Studies on Copyright, vol.
1 (New York: Practicing Law Institute,
6565 1963),
618. For a more recent and comprehensive analysis, see William
6566 M. Landes and Richard A. Posner, "Indefinitely Renewable Copyright,"
6567 University of Chicago Law Review
70 (
2003):
471,
498–501, and
6568 accompanying figures.
</para></footnote>
6571 Even today, this structure would make sense. Most creative work
6572 has an actual commercial life of just a couple of years. Most books fall
6573 out of print after one year.
<footnote><para>
6575 See Ringer, ch.
9, n.
2.
</para></footnote> When that happens, the
6576 used books are traded free of copyright regulation. Thus the books are
6577 no longer effectively controlled by copyright. The only practical
6578 commercial use of the books at that time is to sell the books as used
6579 books; that use
—because it does not involve publication
—is
6583 In the first hundred years of the Republic, the term of copyright was
6584 changed once. In
1831, the term was increased from a maximum of
28
6585 years to a maximum of
42 by increasing the initial term of copyright
6586 from
14 years to
28 years. In the next fifty years of the Republic,
6587 the term increased once again. In
1909, Congress extended the renewal
6588 term of
14 years to
28 years, setting a maximum term of
56 years.
6591 Then, beginning in
1962, Congress started a practice that has defined
6592 copyright law since. Eleven times in the last forty years, Congress
6593 has extended the terms of existing copyrights; twice in those forty
6594 years, Congress extended the term of future copyrights. Initially, the
6595 extensions of existing copyrights were short, a mere one to two years.
6596 In
1976, Congress extended all existing copyrights by nineteen years.
6597 And in
1998, in the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, Congress
6598 extended the term of existing and future copyrights by twenty years.
6601 The effect of these extensions is simply to toll, or delay, the passing
6602 of works into the public domain. This latest extension means that the
6603 public domain will have been tolled for thirty-nine out of fifty-five
6604 years, or
70 percent of the time since
1962. Thus, in the twenty years
6606 <!-- PAGE BREAK 146 -->
6607 after the Sonny Bono Act, while one million patents will pass into the
6608 public domain, zero copyrights will pass into the public domain by virtue
6609 of the expiration of a copyright term.
6612 The effect of these extensions has been exacerbated by another,
6613 little-noticed change in the copyright law. Remember I said that the
6614 framers established a two-part copyright regime, requiring a copyright
6615 owner to renew his copyright after an initial term. The requirement of
6616 renewal meant that works that no longer needed copyright protection
6617 would pass more quickly into the public domain. The works remaining
6618 under protection would be those that had some continuing commercial
6622 The United States abandoned this sensible system in
1976. For
6623 all works created after
1978, there was only one copyright term
—the
6624 maximum term. For "natural" authors, that term was life plus fifty
6625 years. For corporations, the term was seventy-five years. Then, in
1992,
6626 Congress abandoned the renewal requirement for all works created
6627 before
1978. All works still under copyright would be accorded the
6628 maximum term then available. After the Sonny Bono Act, that term
6629 was ninety-five years.
6632 This change meant that American law no longer had an automatic way to
6633 assure that works that were no longer exploited passed into the public
6634 domain. And indeed, after these changes, it is unclear whether it is
6635 even possible to put works into the public domain. The public domain
6636 is orphaned by these changes in copyright law. Despite the requirement
6637 that terms be "limited," we have no evidence that anything will limit
6641 The effect of these changes on the average duration of copyright is
6642 dramatic. In
1973, more than
85 percent of copyright owners failed to
6643 renew their copyright. That meant that the average term of copyright
6644 in
1973 was just
32.2 years. Because of the elimination of the renewal
6645 requirement, the average term of copyright is now the maximum term.
6646 In thirty years, then, the average term has tripled, from
32.2 years to
95
6647 years.
<footnote><para>
6649 These statistics are understated. Between the years
1910 and
1962 (the
6650 first year the renewal term was extended), the average term was never
6651 more than thirty-two years, and averaged thirty years. See Landes and
6652 Posner, "Indefinitely Renewable Copyright," loc. cit.
6655 <!-- PAGE BREAK 147 -->
6657 <sect2 id=
"lawscope">
6658 <title>Law: Scope
</title>
6660 The "scope" of a copyright is the range of rights granted by the law.
6661 The scope of American copyright has changed dramatically. Those
6662 changes are not necessarily bad. But we should understand the extent
6663 of the changes if we're to keep this debate in context.
6666 In
1790, that scope was very narrow. Copyright covered only "maps,
6667 charts, and books." That means it didn't cover, for example, music or
6668 architecture. More significantly, the right granted by a copyright gave
6669 the author the exclusive right to "publish" copyrighted works. That
6670 means someone else violated the copyright only if he republished the
6671 work without the copyright owner's permission. Finally, the right granted
6672 by a copyright was an exclusive right to that particular book. The right
6673 did not extend to what lawyers call "derivative works." It would not,
6674 therefore, interfere with the right of someone other than the author to
6675 translate a copyrighted book, or to adapt the story to a different form
6676 (such as a drama based on a published book).
6679 This, too, has changed dramatically. While the contours of copyright
6680 today are extremely hard to describe simply, in general terms, the
6681 right covers practically any creative work that is reduced to a
6682 tangible form. It covers music as well as architecture, drama as well
6683 as computer programs. It gives the copyright owner of that creative
6684 work not only the exclusive right to "publish" the work, but also the
6685 exclusive right of control over any "copies" of that work. And most
6686 significant for our purposes here, the right gives the copyright owner
6687 control over not only his or her particular work, but also any
6688 "derivative work" that might grow out of the original work. In this
6689 way, the right covers more creative work, protects the creative work
6690 more broadly, and protects works that are based in a significant way
6691 on the initial creative work.
6694 At the same time that the scope of copyright has expanded, procedural
6695 limitations on the right have been relaxed. I've already described the
6696 complete removal of the renewal requirement in
1992. In addition
6697 <!-- PAGE BREAK 148 -->
6698 to the renewal requirement, for most of the history of American
6699 copyright law, there was a requirement that a work be registered
6700 before it could receive the protection of a copyright. There was also
6701 a requirement that any copyrighted work be marked either with that
6702 famous
© or the word copyright. And for most of the history of
6703 American copyright law, there was a requirement that works be
6704 deposited with the government before a copyright could be secured.
6707 The reason for the registration requirement was the sensible
6708 understanding that for most works, no copyright was required. Again,
6709 in the first ten years of the Republic,
95 percent of works eligible
6710 for copyright were never copyrighted. Thus, the rule reflected the
6711 norm: Most works apparently didn't need copyright, so registration
6712 narrowed the regulation of the law to the few that did. The same
6713 reasoning justified the requirement that a work be marked as
6714 copyrighted
—that way it was easy to know whether a copyright was
6715 being claimed. The requirement that works be deposited was to assure
6716 that after the copyright expired, there would be a copy of the work
6717 somewhere so that it could be copied by others without locating the
6721 All of these "formalities" were abolished in the American system when
6722 we decided to follow European copyright law. There is no requirement
6723 that you register a work to get a copyright; the copyright now is
6724 automatic; the copyright exists whether or not you mark your work with
6725 a
©; and the copyright exists whether or not you actually make a
6726 copy available for others to copy.
6729 Consider a practical example to understand the scope of these
6733 If, in
1790, you wrote a book and you were one of the
5 percent who
6734 actually copyrighted that book, then the copyright law protected you
6735 against another publisher's taking your book and republishing it
6736 without your permission. The aim of the act was to regulate publishers
6737 so as to prevent that kind of unfair competition. In
1790, there were
6738 174 publishers in the United States.
<footnote><para>
6740 See Thomas Bender and David Sampliner, "Poets, Pirates, and the
6742 of American Literature,"
29 New York University Journal of
6744 Law and Politics
255 (
1997), and James Gilraeth, ed., Federal
6745 Copyright Records,
1790–1800 (U.S. G.P.O.,
1987).
6747 The Copyright Act was thus a tiny
6748 regulation of a tiny proportion of a tiny part of the creative market in
6749 the United States
—publishers.
6752 <!-- PAGE BREAK 149 -->
6753 The act left other creators totally unregulated. If I copied your
6754 poem by hand, over and over again, as a way to learn it by heart, my
6755 act was totally unregulated by the
1790 act. If I took your novel and
6756 made a play based upon it, or if I translated it or abridged it, none of
6757 those activities were regulated by the original copyright act. These
6759 activities remained free, while the activities of publishers were
6763 Today the story is very different: If you write a book, your book is
6764 automatically protected. Indeed, not just your book. Every e-mail,
6765 every note to your spouse, every doodle, every creative act that's
6767 to a tangible form
—all of this is automatically copyrighted.
6768 There is no need to register or mark your work. The protection follows
6769 the creation, not the steps you take to protect it.
6772 That protection gives you the right (subject to a narrow range of
6773 fair use exceptions) to control how others copy the work, whether they
6774 copy it to republish it or to share an excerpt.
6777 That much is the obvious part. Any system of copyright would
6779 competing publishing. But there's a second part to the copyright of
6780 today that is not at all obvious. This is the protection of "derivative
6781 rights." If you write a book, no one can make a movie out of your
6782 book without permission. No one can translate it without permission.
6783 CliffsNotes can't make an abridgment unless permission is granted. All
6784 of these derivative uses of your original work are controlled by the
6785 copyright holder. The copyright, in other words, is now not just an
6787 right to your writings, but an exclusive right to your writings
6788 and a large proportion of the writings inspired by them.
6791 It is this derivative right that would seem most bizarre to our
6792 framers, though it has become second nature to us. Initially, this
6794 was created to deal with obvious evasions of a narrower
6796 If I write a book, can you change one word and then claim a
6797 copyright in a new and different book? Obviously that would make a
6798 joke of the copyright, so the law was properly expanded to include
6799 those slight modifications as well as the verbatim original work.
6803 <!-- PAGE BREAK 150 -->
6804 In preventing that joke, the law created an astonishing power within
6805 a free culture
—at least, it's astonishing when you understand that the
6806 law applies not just to the commercial publisher but to anyone with a
6807 computer. I understand the wrong in duplicating and selling someone
6808 else's work. But whatever that wrong is, transforming someone else's
6809 work is a different wrong. Some view transformation as no wrong at
6810 all
—they believe that our law, as the framers penned it, should not
6812 derivative rights at all.
<footnote><para>
6814 Jonathan Zittrain, "The Copyright Cage," Legal Affairs, July/August
6816 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
26</ulink>.
6818 Whether or not you go that far, it seems
6819 plain that whatever wrong is involved is fundamentally different from
6820 the wrong of direct piracy.
6823 Yet copyright law treats these two different wrongs in the same
6824 way. I can go to court and get an injunction against your pirating my
6825 book. I can go to court and get an injunction against your
6827 use of my book.
<footnote><para>
6829 Professor Rubenfeld has presented a powerful constitutional argument
6830 about the difference that copyright law should draw (from the perspective
6831 of the First Amendment) between mere "copies" and derivative works. See
6832 Jed Rubenfeld, "The Freedom of Imagination: Copyright's
6834 Yale Law Journal
112 (
2002):
1–60 (see especially pp.
53–59).
6836 These two different uses of my creative work are
6840 This again may seem right to you. If I wrote a book, then why
6841 should you be able to write a movie that takes my story and makes
6842 money from it without paying me or crediting me? Or if Disney
6844 a creature called "Mickey Mouse," why should you be able to make
6845 Mickey Mouse toys and be the one to trade on the value that Disney
6849 These are good arguments, and, in general, my point is not that the
6850 derivative right is unjustified. My aim just now is much narrower:
6852 to make clear that this expansion is a significant change from the
6853 rights originally granted.
6856 <sect2 id=
"lawreach">
6857 <title>Law and Architecture: Reach
</title>
6859 Whereas originally the law regulated only publishers, the change in
6860 copyright's scope means that the law today regulates publishers, users,
6861 and authors. It regulates them because all three are capable of making
6862 copies, and the core of the regulation of copyright law is copies.
<footnote><para>
6864 This is a simplification of the law, but not much of one. The law certainly
6865 regulates more than "copies"
—a public performance of a copyrighted
6866 song, for example, is regulated even though performance per se doesn't
6867 make a copy;
17 United States Code, section
106(
4). And it certainly
6869 doesn't regulate a "copy";
17 United States Code, section
112(a). But
6870 the presumption under the existing law (which regulates "copies;"
17
6871 United States Code, section
102) is that if there is a copy, there is a right.
6875 <!-- PAGE BREAK 151 -->
6876 "Copies." That certainly sounds like the obvious thing for copyright
6877 law to regulate. But as with Jack Valenti's argument at the start of this
6878 chapter, that "creative property" deserves the "same rights" as all other
6879 property, it is the obvious that we need to be most careful about. For
6880 while it may be obvious that in the world before the Internet, copies
6881 were the obvious trigger for copyright law, upon reflection, it should be
6882 obvious that in the world with the Internet, copies should not be the
6883 trigger for copyright law. More precisely, they should not always be the
6884 trigger for copyright law.
6887 This is perhaps the central claim of this book, so let me take this
6888 very slowly so that the point is not easily missed. My claim is that the
6889 Internet should at least force us to rethink the conditions under which
6890 the law of copyright automatically applies,
<footnote><para>
6892 Thus, my argument is not that in each place that copyright law extends,
6893 we should repeal it. It is instead that we should have a good argument for
6894 its extending where it does, and should not determine its reach on the
6896 of arbitrary and automatic changes caused by technology.
6898 because it is clear that the
6899 current reach of copyright was never contemplated, much less chosen,
6900 by the legislators who enacted copyright law.
6903 We can see this point abstractly by beginning with this largely
6906 <figure id=
"fig-1521">
6907 <title>All potential uses of a book.
</title>
6908 <graphic fileref=
"images/1521.png"></graphic>
6911 <!-- PAGE BREAK 152 -->
6912 Think about a book in real space, and imagine this circle to represent
6913 all its potential uses. Most of these uses are unregulated by
6914 copyright law, because the uses don't create a copy. If you read a
6915 book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If you give someone
6916 the book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If you resell a
6917 book, that act is not regulated (copyright law expressly states that
6918 after the first sale of a book, the copyright owner can impose no
6919 further conditions on the disposition of the book). If you sleep on
6920 the book or use it to hold up a lamp or let your puppy chew it up,
6921 those acts are not regulated by copyright law, because those acts do
6924 <figure id=
"fig-1531">
6925 <title>Examples of unregulated uses of a book.
</title>
6926 <graphic fileref=
"images/1531.png"></graphic>
6929 Obviously, however, some uses of a copyrighted book are regulated
6930 by copyright law. Republishing the book, for example, makes a copy. It
6931 is therefore regulated by copyright law. Indeed, this particular use stands
6932 at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work. It is the
6933 paradigmatic use properly regulated by copyright regulation (see first
6934 diagram on next page).
6937 Finally, there is a tiny sliver of otherwise regulated copying uses
6938 that remain unregulated because the law considers these "fair uses."
6940 <!-- PAGE BREAK 153 -->
6941 <figure id=
"fig-1541">
6942 <title>Republishing stands at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work.
</title>
6943 <graphic fileref=
"images/1541.png"></graphic>
6946 These are uses that themselves involve copying, but which the law treats
6947 as unregulated because public policy demands that they remain
6949 You are free to quote from this book, even in a review that
6950 is quite negative, without my permission, even though that quoting
6951 makes a copy. That copy would ordinarily give the copyright owner the
6952 exclusive right to say whether the copy is allowed or not, but the law
6953 denies the owner any exclusive right over such "fair uses" for public
6954 policy (and possibly First Amendment) reasons.
6956 <figure id=
"fig-1542">
6957 <title>Unregulated copying considered
"fair uses.
"</title>
6958 <graphic fileref=
"images/1542.png"></graphic>
6961 <figure id=
"fig-1551">
6962 <title>Uses that before were presumptively unregulated are now presumptively regulated.
</title>
6963 <graphic fileref=
"images/1551.png"></graphic>
6966 <!-- PAGE BREAK 154 -->
6967 In real space, then, the possible uses of a book are divided into three
6968 sorts: (
1) unregulated uses, (
2) regulated uses, and (
3) regulated uses that
6969 are nonetheless deemed "fair" regardless of the copyright owner's views.
6972 Enter the Internet
—a distributed, digital network where every use
6973 of a copyrighted work produces a copy.
<footnote><para>
6975 I don't mean "nature" in the sense that it couldn't be different, but rather that
6976 its present instantiation entails a copy. Optical networks need not make
6977 copies of content they transmit, and a digital network could be designed to
6978 delete anything it copies so that the same number of copies remain.
6980 And because of this single,
6981 arbitrary feature of the design of a digital network, the scope of
6983 1 changes dramatically. Uses that before were presumptively
6985 are now presumptively regulated. No longer is there a set of
6986 presumptively unregulated uses that define a freedom associated with a
6987 copyrighted work. Instead, each use is now subject to the copyright,
6988 because each use also makes a copy
—category
1 gets sucked into
6990 2. And those who would defend the unregulated uses of
6992 work must look exclusively to category
3, fair uses, to bear the
6993 burden of this shift.
6996 So let's be very specific to make this general point clear. Before the
6997 Internet, if you purchased a book and read it ten times, there would be
6998 no plausible copyright-related argument that the copyright owner could
6999 make to control that use of her book. Copyright law would have
7001 to say about whether you read the book once, ten times, or every
7002 <!-- PAGE BREAK 155 -->
7003 night before you went to bed. None of those instances of use
—reading
—
7004 could be regulated by copyright law because none of those uses
7009 But the same book as an e-book is effectively governed by a
7011 set of rules. Now if the copyright owner says you may read the book
7012 only once or only once a month, then copyright law would aid the
7014 owner in exercising this degree of control, because of the
7016 feature of copyright law that triggers its application upon there
7017 being a copy. Now if you read the book ten times and the license says
7018 you may read it only five times, then whenever you read the book (or
7019 any portion of it) beyond the fifth time, you are making a copy of the
7020 book contrary to the copyright owner's wish.
7023 There are some people who think this makes perfect sense. My aim
7024 just now is not to argue about whether it makes sense or not. My aim
7025 is only to make clear the change. Once you see this point, a few other
7026 points also become clear:
7029 First, making category
1 disappear is not anything any policy maker
7030 ever intended. Congress did not think through the collapse of the
7032 unregulated uses of copyrighted works. There is no
7034 at all that policy makers had this idea in mind when they allowed
7035 our policy here to shift. Unregulated uses were an important part of
7036 free culture before the Internet.
7039 Second, this shift is especially troubling in the context of
7041 uses of creative content. Again, we can all understand the wrong
7042 in commercial piracy. But the law now purports to regulate any
7044 you make of creative work using a machine. "Copy and paste"
7045 and "cut and paste" become crimes. Tinkering with a story and
7047 it to others exposes the tinkerer to at least a requirement of
7049 However troubling the expansion with respect to copying a
7050 particular work, it is extraordinarily troubling with respect to
7052 uses of creative work.
7055 Third, this shift from category
1 to category
2 puts an extraordinary
7057 <!-- PAGE BREAK 156 -->
7058 burden on category
3 ("fair use") that fair use never before had to bear.
7059 If a copyright owner now tried to control how many times I could read
7060 a book on-line, the natural response would be to argue that this is a
7061 violation of my fair use rights. But there has never been any litigation
7062 about whether I have a fair use right to read, because before the
7064 reading did not trigger the application of copyright law and hence
7065 the need for a fair use defense. The right to read was effectively
7067 before because reading was not regulated.
7070 This point about fair use is totally ignored, even by advocates for
7071 free culture. We have been cornered into arguing that our rights
7073 upon fair use
—never even addressing the earlier question about
7074 the expansion in effective regulation. A thin protection grounded in
7075 fair use makes sense when the vast majority of uses are unregulated. But
7076 when everything becomes presumptively regulated, then the
7078 of fair use are not enough.
7081 The case of Video Pipeline is a good example. Video Pipeline was
7082 in the business of making "trailer" advertisements for movies available
7083 to video stores. The video stores displayed the trailers as a way to sell
7084 videos. Video Pipeline got the trailers from the film distributors, put
7085 the trailers on tape, and sold the tapes to the retail stores.
7088 The company did this for about fifteen years. Then, in
1997, it
7090 to think about the Internet as another way to distribute these
7092 The idea was to expand their "selling by sampling" technique by
7093 giving on-line stores the same ability to enable "browsing." Just as in a
7094 bookstore you can read a few pages of a book before you buy the book,
7095 so, too, you would be able to sample a bit from the movie on-line
7100 In
1998, Video Pipeline informed Disney and other film
7102 that it intended to distribute the trailers through the Internet
7103 (rather than sending the tapes) to distributors of their videos. Two
7104 years later, Disney told Video Pipeline to stop. The owner of Video
7105 <!-- PAGE BREAK 157 -->
7106 Pipeline asked Disney to talk about the matter
—he had built a
7108 on distributing this content as a way to help sell Disney films; he
7109 had customers who depended upon his delivering this content. Disney
7110 would agree to talk only if Video Pipeline stopped the distribution
7112 Video Pipeline thought it was within their "fair use" rights
7113 to distribute the clips as they had. So they filed a lawsuit to ask the
7114 court to declare that these rights were in fact their rights.
7117 Disney countersued
—for $
100 million in damages. Those damages
7118 were predicated upon a claim that Video Pipeline had "willfully
7120 on Disney's copyright. When a court makes a finding of
7122 infringement, it can award damages not on the basis of the actual
7123 harm to the copyright owner, but on the basis of an amount set in the
7124 statute. Because Video Pipeline had distributed seven hundred clips of
7125 Disney movies to enable video stores to sell copies of those movies,
7126 Disney was now suing Video Pipeline for $
100 million.
7129 Disney has the right to control its property, of course. But the video
7130 stores that were selling Disney's films also had some sort of right to be
7131 able to sell the films that they had bought from Disney. Disney's claim
7132 in court was that the stores were allowed to sell the films and they were
7133 permitted to list the titles of the films they were selling, but they were
7134 not allowed to show clips of the films as a way of selling them without
7135 Disney's permission.
7138 Now, you might think this is a close case, and I think the courts would
7139 consider it a close case. My point here is to map the change that gives
7140 Disney this power. Before the Internet, Disney couldn't really control
7141 how people got access to their content. Once a video was in the
7143 the "first-sale doctrine" would free the seller to use the video as he
7144 wished, including showing portions of it in order to engender sales of the
7145 entire movie video. But with the Internet, it becomes possible for Disney
7146 to centralize control over access to this content. Because each use of the
7147 Internet produces a copy, use on the Internet becomes subject to the
7148 copyright owner's control. The technology expands the scope of effective
7149 control, because the technology builds a copy into every transaction.
7152 <!-- PAGE BREAK 158 -->
7153 No doubt, a potential is not yet an abuse, and so the potential for
7155 is not yet the abuse of control. Barnes
& Noble has the right to say
7156 you can't touch a book in their store; property law gives them that right.
7157 But the market effectively protects against that abuse. If Barnes
&
7159 banned browsing, then consumers would choose other bookstores.
7160 Competition protects against the extremes. And it may well be (my
7162 so far does not even question this) that competition would prevent
7163 any similar danger when it comes to copyright. Sure, publishers
7165 the rights that authors have assigned to them might try to regulate
7166 how many times you read a book, or try to stop you from sharing the book
7167 with anyone. But in a competitive market such as the book market, the
7168 dangers of this happening are quite slight.
7171 Again, my aim so far is simply to map the changes that this changed
7172 architecture enables. Enabling technology to enforce the control of
7173 copyright means that the control of copyright is no longer defined by
7174 balanced policy. The control of copyright is simply what private
7176 choose. In some contexts, at least, that fact is harmless. But in some
7177 contexts it is a recipe for disaster.
7180 <sect2 id=
"lawforce">
7181 <title>Architecture and Law: Force
</title>
7183 The disappearance of unregulated uses would be change enough, but a
7184 second important change brought about by the Internet magnifies its
7185 significance. This second change does not affect the reach of copyright
7186 regulation; it affects how such regulation is enforced.
7189 In the world before digital technology, it was generally the law that
7190 controlled whether and how someone was regulated by copyright law.
7191 The law, meaning a court, meaning a judge: In the end, it was a human,
7192 trained in the tradition of the law and cognizant of the balances that
7193 tradition embraced, who said whether and how the law would restrict
7196 <indexterm><primary>Casablanca
</primary></indexterm>
7198 There's a famous story about a battle between the Marx Brothers
7199 and Warner Brothers. The Marxes intended to make a parody of
7200 <!-- PAGE BREAK 159 -->
7201 Casablanca. Warner Brothers objected. They wrote a nasty letter to the
7202 Marxes, warning them that there would be serious legal consequences
7203 if they went forward with their plan.
<footnote><para>
7205 See David Lange, "Recognizing the Public Domain," Law and
7207 Problems
44 (
1981):
172–73.
7211 This led the Marx Brothers to respond in kind. They warned
7212 Warner Brothers that the Marx Brothers "were brothers long before
7213 you were."
<footnote><para>
7215 Ibid. See also Vaidhyanathan, Copyrights and Copywrongs,
1–3.
7217 The Marx Brothers therefore owned the word brothers,
7218 and if Warner Brothers insisted on trying to control Casablanca, then
7219 the Marx Brothers would insist on control over brothers.
7222 An absurd and hollow threat, of course, because Warner Brothers,
7223 like the Marx Brothers, knew that no court would ever enforce such a
7224 silly claim. This extremism was irrelevant to the real freedoms anyone
7225 (including Warner Brothers) enjoyed.
7228 On the Internet, however, there is no check on silly rules, because
7229 on the Internet, increasingly, rules are enforced not by a human but by
7230 a machine: Increasingly, the rules of copyright law, as interpreted by
7231 the copyright owner, get built into the technology that delivers
7233 content. It is code, rather than law, that rules. And the problem
7234 with code regulations is that, unlike law, code has no shame. Code
7235 would not get the humor of the Marx Brothers. The consequence of
7236 that is not at all funny.
7239 Consider the life of my Adobe eBook Reader.
7242 An e-book is a book delivered in electronic form. An Adobe eBook
7243 is not a book that Adobe has published; Adobe simply produces the
7244 software that publishers use to deliver e-books. It provides the
7246 and the publisher delivers the content by using the technology.
7249 On the next page is a picture of an old version of my Adobe eBook
7253 As you can see, I have a small collection of e-books within this
7254 e-book library. Some of these books reproduce content that is in the
7255 public domain: Middlemarch, for example, is in the public domain.
7256 Some of them reproduce content that is not in the public domain: My
7257 own book The Future of Ideas is not yet within the public domain.
7258 Consider Middlemarch first. If you click on my e-book copy of
7259 <!-- PAGE BREAK 160 -->
7260 Middlemarch, you'll see a fancy cover, and then a button at the bottom
7263 <figure id=
"fig-1611">
7264 <title>Picture of an old version of Adobe eBook Reader
</title>
7265 <graphic fileref=
"images/1611.png"></graphic>
7268 If you click on the Permissions button, you'll see a list of the
7269 permissions that the publisher purports to grant with this book.
7271 <figure id=
"fig-1612">
7272 <title>List of the permissions that the publisher purports to grant.
</title>
7273 <graphic fileref=
"images/1612.png"></graphic>
7276 <!-- PAGE BREAK 161 -->
7277 According to my eBook
7278 Reader, I have the permission
7279 to copy to the clipboard of the
7280 computer ten text selections
7281 every ten days. (So far, I've
7282 copied no text to the clipboard.)
7283 I also have the permission to
7284 print ten pages from the book
7285 every ten days. Lastly, I have
7286 the permission to use the Read
7287 Aloud button to hear
7289 read aloud through the
7293 Here's the e-book for another work in the public domain (including the
7294 translation): Aristotle's Politics.
7296 <figure id=
"fig-1621">
7297 <title>E-book of Aristotle;s
"Politics
"</title>
7298 <graphic fileref=
"images/1621.png"></graphic>
7301 According to its permissions, no printing or copying is permitted
7302 at all. But fortunately, you can use the Read Aloud button to hear
7305 <figure id=
"fig-1622">
7306 <title>List of the permissions for Aristotle;s
"Politics
".
</title>
7307 <graphic fileref=
"images/1622.png"></graphic>
7310 Finally (and most embarrassingly), here are the permissions for the
7311 original e-book version of my last book, The Future of Ideas:
7313 <!-- PAGE BREAK 162 -->
7314 <figure id=
"fig-1631">
7315 <title>List of the permissions for
"The Future of Ideas
".
</title>
7316 <graphic fileref=
"images/1631.png"></graphic>
7319 No copying, no printing, and don't you dare try to listen to this book!
7322 Now, the Adobe eBook Reader calls these controls "permissions"
—
7323 as if the publisher has the power to control how you use these works.
7324 For works under copyright, the copyright owner certainly does have
7325 the power
—up to the limits of the copyright law. But for work not
7327 copyright, there is no such copyright power.
<footnote><para>
7329 In principle, a contract might impose a requirement on me. I might, for
7330 example, buy a book from you that includes a contract that says I will read
7331 it only three times, or that I promise to read it three times. But that
7333 (and the limits for creating that obligation) would come from the
7334 contract, not from copyright law, and the obligations of contract would
7335 not necessarily pass to anyone who subsequently acquired the book.
7338 Middlemarch says I have the permission to copy only ten text selections
7339 into the memory every ten days, what that really means is that the
7340 eBook Reader has enabled the publisher to control how I use the book
7341 on my computer, far beyond the control that the law would enable.
7344 The control comes instead from the code
—from the technology
7345 within which the e-book "lives." Though the e-book says that these are
7346 permissions, they are not the sort of "permissions" that most of us deal
7347 with. When a teenager gets "permission" to stay out till midnight, she
7348 knows (unless she's Cinderella) that she can stay out till
2 A.M., but
7349 will suffer a punishment if she's caught. But when the Adobe eBook
7350 Reader says I have the permission to make ten copies of the text into
7351 the computer's memory, that means that after I've made ten copies, the
7352 computer will not make any more. The same with the printing
7354 After ten pages, the eBook Reader will not print any more pages.
7355 It's the same with the silly restriction that says that you can't use the
7356 Read Aloud button to read my book aloud
—it's not that the company
7357 will sue you if you do; instead, if you push the Read Aloud button with
7358 my book, the machine simply won't read aloud.
7361 <!-- PAGE BREAK 163 -->
7362 These are controls, not permissions. Imagine a world where the
7363 Marx Brothers sold word processing software that, when you tried to
7364 type "Warner Brothers," erased "Brothers" from the sentence.
7367 This is the future of copyright law: not so much copyright law as
7368 copyright code. The controls over access to content will not be controls
7369 that are ratified by courts; the controls over access to content will be
7370 controls that are coded by programmers. And whereas the controls that
7371 are built into the law are always to be checked by a judge, the controls
7372 that are built into the technology have no similar built-in check.
7375 How significant is this? Isn't it always possible to get around the
7376 controls built into the technology? Software used to be sold with
7378 that limited the ability of users to copy the software, but those
7379 were trivial protections to defeat. Why won't it be trivial to defeat these
7380 protections as well?
7383 We've only scratched the surface of this story. Return to the Adobe
7387 Early in the life of the Adobe eBook Reader, Adobe suffered a
7389 relations nightmare. Among the books that you could download for
7390 free on the Adobe site was a copy of Alice's Adventures in Wonderland.
7391 This wonderful book is in the public domain. Yet when you clicked on
7392 Permissions for that book, you got the following report:
7394 <figure id=
"fig-1641">
7395 <title>List of the permissions for
"Alice's Adventures in
7396 Wonderland
".
</title>
7397 <graphic fileref=
"images/1641.png"></graphic>
7400 <!-- PAGE BREAK 164 -->
7401 Here was a public domain children's book that you were not
7403 to copy, not allowed to lend, not allowed to give, and, as the
7405 indicated, not allowed to "read aloud"!
7408 The public relations nightmare attached to that final permission.
7409 For the text did not say that you were not permitted to use the Read
7410 Aloud button; it said you did not have the permission to read the book
7411 aloud. That led some people to think that Adobe was restricting the
7412 right of parents, for example, to read the book to their children, which
7413 seemed, to say the least, absurd.
7416 Adobe responded quickly that it was absurd to think that it was trying
7417 to restrict the right to read a book aloud. Obviously it was only
7418 restricting the ability to use the Read Aloud button to have the book
7419 read aloud. But the question Adobe never did answer is this: Would
7420 Adobe thus agree that a consumer was free to use software to hack
7421 around the restrictions built into the eBook Reader? If some company
7422 (call it Elcomsoft) developed a program to disable the technological
7423 protection built into an Adobe eBook so that a blind person, say,
7424 could use a computer to read the book aloud, would Adobe agree that
7425 such a use of an eBook Reader was fair? Adobe didn't answer because
7426 the answer, however absurd it might seem, is no.
7429 The point is not to blame Adobe. Indeed, Adobe is among the most
7430 innovative companies developing strategies to balance open access to
7431 content with incentives for companies to innovate. But Adobe's
7432 technology enables control, and Adobe has an incentive to defend this
7433 control. That incentive is understandable, yet what it creates is
7437 To see the point in a particularly absurd context, consider a favorite
7438 story of mine that makes the same point.
7440 <indexterm><primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7442 Consider the robotic dog made by Sony named "Aibo." The Aibo
7443 learns tricks, cuddles, and follows you around. It eats only electricity
7444 and that doesn't leave that much of a mess (at least in your house).
7447 The Aibo is expensive and popular. Fans from around the world
7448 have set up clubs to trade stories. One fan in particular set up a Web
7449 site to enable information about the Aibo dog to be shared. This fan set
7450 <!-- PAGE BREAK 165 -->
7451 up aibopet.com (and aibohack.com, but that resolves to the same site),
7452 and on that site he provided information about how to teach an Aibo
7453 to do tricks in addition to the ones Sony had taught it.
7456 "Teach" here has a special meaning. Aibos are just cute computers.
7457 You teach a computer how to do something by programming it
7458 differently. So to say that aibopet.com was giving information about
7459 how to teach the dog to do new tricks is just to say that aibopet.com
7460 was giving information to users of the Aibo pet about how to hack
7461 their computer "dog" to make it do new tricks (thus, aibohack.com).
7464 If you're not a programmer or don't know many programmers, the
7465 word hack has a particularly unfriendly connotation. Nonprogrammers
7466 hack bushes or weeds. Nonprogrammers in horror movies do even
7467 worse. But to programmers, or coders, as I call them, hack is a much
7468 more positive term. Hack just means code that enables the program to
7469 do something it wasn't originally intended or enabled to do. If you buy
7470 a new printer for an old computer, you might find the old computer
7471 doesn't run, or "drive," the printer. If you discovered that, you'd later be
7472 happy to discover a hack on the Net by someone who has written a
7473 driver to enable the computer to drive the printer you just bought.
7476 Some hacks are easy. Some are unbelievably hard. Hackers as a
7477 community like to challenge themselves and others with increasingly
7478 difficult tasks. There's a certain respect that goes with the talent to hack
7479 well. There's a well-deserved respect that goes with the talent to hack
7482 <indexterm><primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary></indexterm>
7484 The Aibo fan was displaying a bit of both when he hacked the program
7485 and offered to the world a bit of code that would enable the Aibo to
7486 dance jazz. The dog wasn't programmed to dance jazz. It was a clever
7487 bit of tinkering that turned the dog into a more talented creature
7488 than Sony had built.
7491 I've told this story in many contexts, both inside and outside the
7492 United States. Once I was asked by a puzzled member of the audience,
7493 is it permissible for a dog to dance jazz in the United States? We
7494 forget that stories about the backcountry still flow across much of
7497 <!-- PAGE BREAK 166 -->
7498 world. So let's just be clear before we continue: It's not a crime
7499 anywhere (anymore) to dance jazz. Nor is it a crime to teach your dog
7500 to dance jazz. Nor should it be a crime (though we don't have a lot to
7501 go on here) to teach your robot dog to dance jazz. Dancing jazz is a
7502 completely legal activity. One imagines that the owner of aibopet.com
7503 thought, What possible problem could there be with teaching a robot
7507 Let's put the dog to sleep for a minute, and turn to a pony show
—
7508 not literally a pony show, but rather a paper that a Princeton academic
7509 named Ed Felten prepared for a conference. This Princeton academic
7510 is well known and respected. He was hired by the government in the
7511 Microsoft case to test Microsoft's claims about what could and could
7512 not be done with its own code. In that trial, he demonstrated both his
7513 brilliance and his coolness. Under heavy badgering by Microsoft
7514 lawyers, Ed Felten stood his ground. He was not about to be bullied
7515 into being silent about something he knew very well.
7518 But Felten's bravery was really tested in April
2001.
<footnote><para>
7520 See Pamela Samuelson, "Anticircumvention Rules: Threat to Science,"
7521 Science
293 (
2001):
2028; Brendan I. Koerner, "Play Dead: Sony Muzzles
7522 the Techies Who Teach a Robot Dog New Tricks," American Prospect,
7523 January
2002; "Court Dismisses Computer Scientists' Challenge to
7524 DMCA," Intellectual Property Litigation Reporter,
11 December
2001; Bill
7525 Holland, "Copyright Act Raising Free-Speech Concerns," Billboard,
7526 May
2001; Janelle Brown, "Is the RIAA Running Scared?" Salon.com,
7527 April
2001; Electronic Frontier Foundation, "Frequently Asked
7529 about Felten and USENIX v. RIAA Legal Case," available at
7530 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
27</ulink>.
7532 He and a group of colleagues were working on a paper to be submitted
7533 at conference. The paper was intended to describe the weakness in an
7534 encryption system being developed by the Secure Digital Music
7535 Initiative as a technique to control the distribution of music.
7538 The SDMI coalition had as its goal a technology to enable content
7539 owners to exercise much better control over their content than the
7540 Internet, as it originally stood, granted them. Using encryption, SDMI
7541 hoped to develop a standard that would allow the content owner to say
7542 "this music cannot be copied," and have a computer respect that
7543 command. The technology was to be part of a "trusted system" of
7544 control that would get content owners to trust the system of the
7548 When SDMI thought it was close to a standard, it set up a competition.
7549 In exchange for providing contestants with the code to an
7550 SDMI-encrypted bit of content, contestants were to try to crack it
7551 and, if they did, report the problems to the consortium.
7554 <!-- PAGE BREAK 167 -->
7555 Felten and his team figured out the encryption system quickly. He and
7556 the team saw the weakness of this system as a type: Many encryption
7557 systems would suffer the same weakness, and Felten and his team
7558 thought it worthwhile to point this out to those who study encryption.
7561 Let's review just what Felten was doing. Again, this is the United
7562 States. We have a principle of free speech. We have this principle not
7563 just because it is the law, but also because it is a really great
7564 idea. A strongly protected tradition of free speech is likely to
7565 encourage a wide range of criticism. That criticism is likely, in
7566 turn, to improve the systems or people or ideas criticized.
7569 What Felten and his colleagues were doing was publishing a paper
7570 describing the weakness in a technology. They were not spreading free
7571 music, or building and deploying this technology. The paper was an
7572 academic essay, unintelligible to most people. But it clearly showed the
7573 weakness in the SDMI system, and why SDMI would not, as presently
7574 constituted, succeed.
7577 What links these two, aibopet.com and Felten, is the letters they
7578 then received. Aibopet.com received a letter from Sony about the
7579 aibopet.com hack. Though a jazz-dancing dog is perfectly legal, Sony
7584 Your site contains information providing the means to circumvent
7585 AIBO-ware's copy protection protocol constituting a violation of the
7586 anti-circumvention provisions of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act.
7590 And though an academic paper describing the weakness in a system
7591 of encryption should also be perfectly legal, Felten received a letter
7592 from an RIAA lawyer that read:
7596 Any disclosure of information gained from participating in the
7597 <!-- PAGE BREAK 168 -->
7598 Public Challenge would be outside the scope of activities permitted by
7599 the Agreement and could subject you and your research team to actions
7600 under the Digital Millennium Copyright Act ("DMCA").
7604 In both cases, this weirdly Orwellian law was invoked to control the
7605 spread of information. The Digital Millennium Copyright Act made
7606 spreading such information an offense.
7609 The DMCA was enacted as a response to copyright owners' first fear
7610 about cyberspace. The fear was that copyright control was effectively
7611 dead; the response was to find technologies that might compensate.
7612 These new technologies would be copyright protection technologies
—
7613 technologies to control the replication and distribution of copyrighted
7614 material. They were designed as code to modify the original code of the
7615 Internet, to reestablish some protection for copyright owners.
7618 The DMCA was a bit of law intended to back up the protection of this
7619 code designed to protect copyrighted material. It was, we could say,
7620 legal code intended to buttress software code which itself was
7621 intended to support the legal code of copyright.
7624 But the DMCA was not designed merely to protect copyrighted works to
7625 the extent copyright law protected them. Its protection, that is, did
7626 not end at the line that copyright law drew. The DMCA regulated
7627 devices that were designed to circumvent copyright protection
7628 measures. It was designed to ban those devices, whether or not the use
7629 of the copyrighted material made possible by that circumvention would
7630 have been a copyright violation.
7633 Aibopet.com and Felten make the point. The Aibo hack circumvented a
7634 copyright protection system for the purpose of enabling the dog to
7635 dance jazz. That enablement no doubt involved the use of copyrighted
7636 material. But as aibopet.com's site was noncommercial, and the use did
7637 not enable subsequent copyright infringements, there's no doubt that
7638 aibopet.com's hack was fair use of Sony's copyrighted material. Yet
7639 fair use is not a defense to the DMCA. The question is not whether the
7640 <!-- PAGE BREAK 169 -->
7641 use of the copyrighted material was a copyright violation. The question
7642 is whether a copyright protection system was circumvented.
7645 The threat against Felten was more attenuated, but it followed the
7646 same line of reasoning. By publishing a paper describing how a
7647 copyright protection system could be circumvented, the RIAA lawyer
7648 suggested, Felten himself was distributing a circumvention technology.
7649 Thus, even though he was not himself infringing anyone's copyright,
7650 his academic paper was enabling others to infringe others' copyright.
7653 The bizarreness of these arguments is captured in a cartoon drawn in
7654 1981 by Paul Conrad. At that time, a court in California had held that
7655 the VCR could be banned because it was a copyright-infringing
7656 technology: It enabled consumers to copy films without the permission
7657 of the copyright owner. No doubt there were uses of the technology
7658 that were legal: Fred Rogers, aka "Mr. Rogers," for example, had
7659 testified in that case that he wanted people to feel free to tape
7660 Mr. Rogers' Neighborhood.
7664 Some public stations, as well as commercial stations, program the
7665 "Neighborhood" at hours when some children cannot use it. I think that
7666 it's a real service to families to be able to record such programs and
7667 show them at appropriate times. I have always felt that with the
7668 advent of all of this new technology that allows people to tape the
7669 "Neighborhood" off-the-air, and I'm speaking for the "Neighborhood"
7670 because that's what I produce, that they then become much more active
7671 in the programming of their family's television life. Very frankly, I
7672 am opposed to people being programmed by others. My whole approach in
7673 broadcasting has always been "You are an important person just the way
7674 you are. You can make healthy decisions." Maybe I'm going on too long,
7675 but I just feel that anything that allows a person to be more active
7676 in the control of his or her life, in a healthy way, is
7677 important.
<footnote><para>
7679 Sony Corporation of America v. Universal City Studios, Inc.,
464 U.S.
417,
7680 455 fn.
27 (
1984). Rogers never changed his view about the VCR. See
7681 James Lardner, Fast Forward: Hollywood, the Japanese, and the Onslaught of
7682 the VCR (New York: W. W. Norton,
1987),
270–71.
7687 <!-- PAGE BREAK 170 -->
7688 Even though there were uses that were legal, because there were
7689 some uses that were illegal, the court held the companies producing
7690 the VCR responsible.
7693 This led Conrad to draw the cartoon below, which we can adopt to
7697 No argument I have can top this picture, but let me try to get close.
7700 The anticircumvention provisions of the DMCA target copyright
7701 circumvention technologies. Circumvention technologies can be used for
7702 different ends. They can be used, for example, to enable massive
7703 pirating of copyrighted material
—a bad end. Or they can be used
7704 to enable the use of particular copyrighted materials in ways that
7705 would be considered fair use
—a good end.
7708 A handgun can be used to shoot a police officer or a child. Most
7709 <!-- PAGE BREAK 171 -->
7710 would agree such a use is bad. Or a handgun can be used for target
7711 practice or to protect against an intruder. At least some would say that
7712 such a use would be good. It, too, is a technology that has both good
7715 <figure id=
"fig-1711">
7716 <title>VCR/handgun cartoon.
</title>
7717 <graphic fileref=
"images/1711.png"></graphic>
7720 The obvious point of Conrad's cartoon is the weirdness of a world
7721 where guns are legal, despite the harm they can do, while VCRs (and
7722 circumvention technologies) are illegal. Flash: No one ever died from
7723 copyright circumvention. Yet the law bans circumvention technologies
7724 absolutely, despite the potential that they might do some good, but
7725 permits guns, despite the obvious and tragic harm they do.
7728 The Aibo and RIAA examples demonstrate how copyright owners are
7729 changing the balance that copyright law grants. Using code, copyright
7730 owners restrict fair use; using the DMCA, they punish those who would
7731 attempt to evade the restrictions on fair use that they impose through
7732 code. Technology becomes a means by which fair use can be erased; the
7733 law of the DMCA backs up that erasing.
7736 This is how code becomes law. The controls built into the technology
7737 of copy and access protection become rules the violation of which is also
7738 a violation of the law. In this way, the code extends the law
—increasing its
7739 regulation, even if the subject it regulates (activities that would otherwise
7740 plainly constitute fair use) is beyond the reach of the law. Code becomes
7741 law; code extends the law; code thus extends the control that copyright
7742 owners effect
—at least for those copyright holders with the lawyers
7743 who can write the nasty letters that Felten and aibopet.com received.
7746 There is one final aspect of the interaction between architecture and
7747 law that contributes to the force of copyright's regulation. This is
7748 the ease with which infringements of the law can be detected. For
7749 contrary to the rhetoric common at the birth of cyberspace that on the
7750 Internet, no one knows you're a dog, increasingly, given changing
7751 technologies deployed on the Internet, it is easy to find the dog who
7752 committed a legal wrong. The technologies of the Internet are open to
7753 snoops as well as sharers, and the snoops are increasingly good at
7754 tracking down the identity of those who violate the rules.
7758 <!-- PAGE BREAK 172 -->
7759 For example, imagine you were part of a Star Trek fan club. You
7760 gathered every month to share trivia, and maybe to enact a kind of fan
7761 fiction about the show. One person would play Spock, another, Captain
7762 Kirk. The characters would begin with a plot from a real story, then
7763 simply continue it.
<footnote><para>
7765 For an early and prescient analysis, see Rebecca Tushnet, "Legal Fictions,
7766 Copyright, Fan Fiction, and a New Common Law," Loyola of Los Angeles
7767 Entertainment Law Journal
17 (
1997):
651.
7771 Before the Internet, this was, in effect, a totally unregulated
7772 activity. No matter what happened inside your club room, you would
7773 never be interfered with by the copyright police. You were free in
7774 that space to do as you wished with this part of our culture. You were
7775 allowed to build on it as you wished without fear of legal control.
7778 But if you moved your club onto the Internet, and made it generally
7779 available for others to join, the story would be very different. Bots
7780 scouring the Net for trademark and copyright infringement would
7781 quickly find your site. Your posting of fan fiction, depending upon
7782 the ownership of the series that you're depicting, could well inspire
7783 a lawyer's threat. And ignoring the lawyer's threat would be extremely
7784 costly indeed. The law of copyright is extremely efficient. The
7785 penalties are severe, and the process is quick.
7788 This change in the effective force of the law is caused by a change
7789 in the ease with which the law can be enforced. That change too shifts
7790 the law's balance radically. It is as if your car transmitted the speed at
7791 which you traveled at every moment that you drove; that would be just
7792 one step before the state started issuing tickets based upon the data you
7793 transmitted. That is, in effect, what is happening here.
7796 <sect2 id=
"marketconcentration">
7797 <title>Market: Concentration
</title>
7799 So copyright's duration has increased dramatically
—tripled in
7800 the past thirty years. And copyright's scope has increased as
7801 well
—from regulating only publishers to now regulating just
7802 about everyone. And copyright's reach has changed, as every action
7803 becomes a copy and hence presumptively regulated. And as technologists
7805 <!-- PAGE BREAK 173 -->
7806 to control the use of content, and as copyright is increasingly
7807 enforced through technology, copyright's force changes, too. Misuse is
7808 easier to find and easier to control. This regulation of the creative
7809 process, which began as a tiny regulation governing a tiny part of the
7810 market for creative work, has become the single most important
7811 regulator of creativity there is. It is a massive expansion in the
7812 scope of the government's control over innovation and creativity; it
7813 would be totally unrecognizable to those who gave birth to copyright's
7817 Still, in my view, all of these changes would not matter much if it
7818 weren't for one more change that we must also consider. This is a
7819 change that is in some sense the most familiar, though its significance
7820 and scope are not well understood. It is the one that creates precisely the
7821 reason to be concerned about all the other changes I have described.
7824 This is the change in the concentration and integration of the media.
7825 In the past twenty years, the nature of media ownership has undergone
7826 a radical alteration, caused by changes in legal rules governing the
7827 media. Before this change happened, the different forms of media were
7828 owned by separate media companies. Now, the media is increasingly
7829 owned by only a few companies. Indeed, after the changes that the FCC
7830 announced in June
2003, most expect that within a few years, we will
7831 live in a world where just three companies control more than percent
7835 These changes are of two sorts: the scope of concentration, and its
7838 <indexterm><primary>BMG
</primary></indexterm>
7840 Changes in scope are the easier ones to describe. As Senator John
7841 McCain summarized the data produced in the FCC's review of media
7842 ownership, "five companies control
85 percent of our media sources."
<footnote><para>
7844 FCC Oversight: Hearing Before the Senate Commerce, Science and
7845 Transportation Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st sess. (
22 May
2003)
7846 (statement of Senator John McCain).
</para></footnote>
7847 The five recording labels of Universal Music Group, BMG, Sony Music
7848 Entertainment, Warner Music Group, and EMI control
84.8 percent of the
7849 U.S. music market.
<footnote><para>
7851 Lynette Holloway, "Despite a Marketing Blitz, CD Sales Continue to
7852 Slide," New York Times,
23 December
2002.
7854 The "five largest cable companies pipe
7855 programming to
74 percent of the cable subscribers nationwide."
<footnote><para>
7857 Molly Ivins, "Media Consolidation Must Be Stopped," Charleston Gazette,
7862 The story with radio is even more dramatic. Before deregulation,
7863 the nation's largest radio broadcasting conglomerate owned fewer than
7864 <!-- PAGE BREAK 174 -->
7865 seventy-five stations. Today one company owns more than
1,
200
7866 stations. During that period of consolidation, the total number of
7867 radio owners dropped by
34 percent. Today, in most markets, the two
7868 largest broadcasters control
74 percent of that market's
7869 revenues. Overall, just four companies control
90 percent of the
7870 nation's radio advertising revenues.
7873 Newspaper ownership is becoming more concentrated as well. Today,
7874 there are six hundred fewer daily newspapers in the United States than
7875 there were eighty years ago, and ten companies control half of the
7876 nation's circulation. There are twenty major newspaper publishers in
7877 the United States. The top ten film studios receive
99 percent of all
7878 film revenue. The ten largest cable companies account for
85 percent
7879 of all cable revenue. This is a market far from the free press the
7880 framers sought to protect. Indeed, it is a market that is quite well
7881 protected
— by the market.
7884 Concentration in size alone is one thing. The more invidious
7885 change is in the nature of that concentration. As author James Fallows
7886 put it in a recent article about Rupert Murdoch,
7890 Murdoch's companies now constitute a production system
7891 unmatched in its integration. They supply content
—Fox movies
7892 . . . Fox TV shows . . . Fox-controlled sports broadcasts, plus
7893 newspapers and books. They sell the content to the public and to
7894 advertisers
—in newspapers, on the broadcast network, on the
7895 cable channels. And they operate the physical distribution system
7896 through which the content reaches the customers. Murdoch's satellite
7897 systems now distribute News Corp. content in Europe and Asia; if
7898 Murdoch becomes DirecTV's largest single owner, that system will serve
7899 the same function in the United States.
<footnote><para>
7901 James Fallows, "The Age of Murdoch," Atlantic Monthly (September
7907 The pattern with Murdoch is the pattern of modern media. Not
7908 just large companies owning many radio stations, but a few companies
7909 owning as many outlets of media as possible. A picture describes this
7910 pattern better than a thousand words could do:
7912 <figure id=
"fig-1761">
7913 <title>Pattern of modern media ownership.
</title>
7914 <graphic fileref=
"images/1761.png"></graphic>
7917 <!-- PAGE BREAK 175 -->
7918 Does this concentration matter? Will it affect what is made, or
7919 what is distributed? Or is it merely a more efficient way to produce and
7923 My view was that concentration wouldn't matter. I thought it was
7924 nothing more than a more efficient financial structure. But now, after
7925 reading and listening to a barrage of creators try to convince me to the
7926 contrary, I am beginning to change my mind.
7929 Here's a representative story that begins to suggest how this
7930 integration may matter.
7932 <indexterm><primary>Lear, Norman
</primary></indexterm>
7933 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
7934 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family
</primary></indexterm>
7936 In
1969, Norman Lear created a pilot for All in the Family. He took
7937 the pilot to ABC. The network didn't like it. It was too edgy, they told
7938 Lear. Make it again. Lear made a second pilot, more edgy than the
7939 first. ABC was exasperated. You're missing the point, they told Lear.
7940 We wanted less edgy, not more.
7943 Rather than comply, Lear simply took the show elsewhere. CBS
7944 was happy to have the series; ABC could not stop Lear from walking.
7945 The copyrights that Lear held assured an independence from network
7946 control.
<footnote><para>
7948 Leonard Hill, "The Axis of Access," remarks before Weidenbaum Center
7949 Forum, "Entertainment Economics: The Movie Industry," St. Louis,
7951 3 April
2003 (transcript of prepared remarks available at
7952 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
28</ulink>;
7953 for the Lear story, not included in the prepared remarks, see
7954 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
29</ulink>).
7959 <!-- PAGE BREAK 176 -->
7960 The network did not control those copyrights because the law
7962 the networks from controlling the content they syndicated. The
7963 law required a separation between the networks and the content
7965 that separation would guarantee Lear freedom. And as late as
7966 1992, because of these rules, the vast majority of prime time
7968 percent of it
—was "independent" of the networks.
7971 In
1994, the FCC abandoned the rules that required this
7973 After that change, the networks quickly changed the balance.
7974 In
1985, there were twenty-five independent television production
7976 in
2002, only five independent television studios remained. "In
7977 1992, only
15 percent of new series were produced for a network by a
7978 company it controlled. Last year, the percentage of shows produced by
7979 controlled companies more than quintupled to
77 percent." "In
1992,
7980 16 new series were produced independently of conglomerate control,
7981 last year there was one."
<footnote><para>
7983 NewsCorp./DirecTV Merger and Media Consolidation: Hearings on
7984 Media Ownership Before the Senate Commerce Committee,
108th
7985 Cong.,
1st sess. (
2003) (testimony of Gene Kimmelman on behalf of
7987 Union and the Consumer Federation of America), available at
7988 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
30</ulink>. Kimmelman quotes Victoria Riskin, president of Writers Guild of
7989 America, West, in her Remarks at FCC En Banc Hearing, Richmond,
7990 Virginia,
27 February
2003.
7992 In
2002,
75 percent of prime time television
7993 was owned by the networks that ran it. "In the ten-year period between
7994 1992 and
2002, the number of prime time television hours per week
7995 produced by network studios increased over
200%, whereas the
7997 of prime time television hours per week produced by independent
7998 studios decreased
63%."
<footnote><para>
8003 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family
</primary></indexterm>
8005 Today, another Norman Lear with another All in the Family would
8006 find that he had the choice either to make the show less edgy or to be
8007 fired: The content of any show developed for a network is increasingly
8008 owned by the network.
8011 While the number of channels has increased dramatically, the
8013 of those channels has narrowed to an ever smaller and smaller
8014 few. As Barry Diller said to Bill Moyers,
8018 Well, if you have companies that produce, that finance, that air on
8019 their channel and then distribute worldwide everything that goes
8020 through their controlled distribution system, then what you get is
8021 fewer and fewer actual voices participating in the process. [We
8022 <!-- PAGE BREAK 177 -->
8023 u]sed to have dozens and dozens of thriving independent
8025 companies producing television programs. Now you have less
8026 than a handful.
<footnote><para>
8028 "Barry Diller Takes on Media Deregulation," Now with Bill Moyers, Bill
8029 Moyers,
25 April
2003, edited transcript available at
8030 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
31</ulink>.
8035 This narrowing has an effect on what is produced. The product of
8036 such large and concentrated networks is increasingly homogenous.
8038 safe. Increasingly sterile. The product of news shows from
8039 networks like this is increasingly tailored to the message the network
8040 wants to convey. This is not the communist party, though from the
8042 it must feel a bit like the communist party. No one can question
8043 without risk of consequence
—not necessarily banishment to Siberia,
8044 but punishment nonetheless. Independent, critical, different views are
8045 quashed. This is not the environment for a democracy.
8047 <indexterm><primary>Clark, Kim B.
</primary></indexterm>
8049 Economics itself offers a parallel that explains why this integration
8050 affects creativity. Clay Christensen has written about the "Innovator's
8051 Dilemma": the fact that large traditional firms find it rational to ignore
8052 new, breakthrough technologies that compete with their core business.
8053 The same analysis could help explain why large, traditional media
8054 companies would find it rational to ignore new cultural trends.
<footnote><para>
8056 Clayton M. Christensen, The Innovator's Dilemma: The Revolutionary
8058 Bestseller that Changed the Way We Do Business (Cambridge: Harvard
8059 Business School Press,
1997). Christensen acknowledges that the idea was
8060 first suggested by Dean Kim Clark. See Kim B. Clark, "The Interaction of
8061 Design Hierarchies and Market Concepts in Technological Evolution,"
8062 Research Policy
14 (
1985):
235–51. For a more recent study, see Richard
8063 Foster and Sarah Kaplan, Creative Destruction: Why Companies That Are
8064 Built to Last Underperform the Market
—and How to Successfully Transform
8065 Them (New York: Currency/Doubleday,
2001).
8068 Lumbering giants not only don't, but should not, sprint. Yet if the
8069 field is only open to the giants, there will be far too little
8073 I don't think we know enough about the economics of the media
8074 market to say with certainty what concentration and integration will
8075 do. The efficiencies are important, and the effect on culture is hard to
8079 But there is a quintessentially obvious example that does strongly
8080 suggest the concern.
8083 In addition to the copyright wars, we're in the middle of the drug
8084 wars. Government policy is strongly directed against the drug cartels;
8085 criminal and civil courts are filled with the consequences of this battle.
8088 Let me hereby disqualify myself from any possible appointment to
8089 any position in government by saying I believe this war is a profound
8090 mistake. I am not pro drugs. Indeed, I come from a family once
8092 <!-- PAGE BREAK 178 -->
8093 wrecked by drugs
—though the drugs that wrecked my family were
8094 all quite legal. I believe this war is a profound mistake because the
8095 collateral damage from it is so great as to make waging the war
8096 insane. When you add together the burdens on the criminal justice
8097 system, the desperation of generations of kids whose only real
8098 economic opportunities are as drug warriors, the queering of
8099 constitutional protections because of the constant surveillance this
8100 war requires, and, most profoundly, the total destruction of the legal
8101 systems of many South American nations because of the power of the
8102 local drug cartels, I find it impossible to believe that the marginal
8103 benefit in reduced drug consumption by Americans could possibly
8104 outweigh these costs.
8107 You may not be convinced. That's fine. We live in a democracy, and it
8108 is through votes that we are to choose policy. But to do that, we
8109 depend fundamentally upon the press to help inform Americans about
8113 Beginning in
1998, the Office of National Drug Control Policy launched
8114 a media campaign as part of the "war on drugs." The campaign produced
8115 scores of short film clips about issues related to illegal drugs. In
8116 one series (the Nick and Norm series) two men are in a bar, discussing
8117 the idea of legalizing drugs as a way to avoid some of the collateral
8118 damage from the war. One advances an argument in favor of drug
8119 legalization. The other responds in a powerful and effective way
8120 against the argument of the first. In the end, the first guy changes
8121 his mind (hey, it's television). The plug at the end is a damning
8122 attack on the pro-legalization campaign.
8125 Fair enough. It's a good ad. Not terribly misleading. It delivers its
8126 message well. It's a fair and reasonable message.
8129 But let's say you think it is a wrong message, and you'd like to run a
8130 countercommercial. Say you want to run a series of ads that try to
8131 demonstrate the extraordinary collateral harm that comes from the drug
8135 Well, obviously, these ads cost lots of money. Assume you raise the
8136 <!-- PAGE BREAK 179 -->
8137 money. Assume a group of concerned citizens donates all the money in
8138 the world to help you get your message out. Can you be sure your
8139 message will be heard then?
8142 No. You cannot. Television stations have a general policy of avoiding
8143 "controversial" ads. Ads sponsored by the government are deemed
8144 uncontroversial; ads disagreeing with the government are
8145 controversial. This selectivity might be thought inconsistent with
8146 the First Amendment, but the Supreme Court has held that stations have
8147 the right to choose what they run. Thus, the major channels of
8148 commercial media will refuse one side of a crucial debate the
8149 opportunity to present its case. And the courts will defend the
8150 rights of the stations to be this biased.
<footnote><para>
8152 The Marijuana Policy Project, in February
2003, sought to place ads
8153 that directly responded to the Nick and Norm series on stations within
8154 the Washington, D.C., area. Comcast rejected the ads as "against
8155 [their] policy." The local NBC affiliate, WRC, rejected the ads
8156 without reviewing them. The local ABC affiliate, WJOA, originally
8157 agreed to run the ads and accepted payment to do so, but later decided
8158 not to run the ads and returned the collected fees. Interview with
8159 Neal Levine,
15 October
2003. These restrictions are, of course, not
8160 limited to drug policy. See, for example, Nat Ives, "On the Issue of
8161 an Iraq War, Advocacy Ads Meet with Rejection from TV Networks," New
8162 York Times,
13 March
2003, C4. Outside of election-related air time
8163 there is very little that the FCC or the courts are willing to do to
8164 even the playing field. For a general overview, see Rhonda Brown, "Ad
8165 Hoc Access: The Regulation of Editorial Advertising on Television and
8166 Radio," Yale Law and Policy Review
6 (
1988):
449–79, and for a
8167 more recent summary of the stance of the FCC and the courts, see
8168 Radio-Television News Directors Association v. FCC,
184 F.
3d
872
8169 (D.C. Cir.
1999). Municipal authorities exercise the same authority as
8170 the networks. In a recent example from San Francisco, the San
8171 Francisco transit authority rejected an ad that criticized its Muni
8172 diesel buses. Phillip Matier and Andrew Ross, "Antidiesel Group Fuming
8173 After Muni Rejects Ad," SFGate.com,
16 June
2003, available at
8174 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
32</ulink>. The ground
8175 was that the criticism was "too controversial."
8179 I'd be happy to defend the networks' rights, as well
—if we lived
8180 in a media market that was truly diverse. But concentration in the
8181 media throws that condition into doubt. If a handful of companies
8182 control access to the media, and that handful of companies gets to
8183 decide which political positions it will allow to be promoted on its
8184 channels, then in an obvious and important way, concentration
8185 matters. You might like the positions the handful of companies
8186 selects. But you should not like a world in which a mere few get to
8187 decide which issues the rest of us get to know about.
8190 <sect2 id=
"together">
8191 <title>Together
</title>
8193 There is something innocent and obvious about the claim of the
8194 copyright warriors that the government should "protect my property."
8195 In the abstract, it is obviously true and, ordinarily, totally
8196 harmless. No sane sort who is not an anarchist could disagree.
8199 But when we see how dramatically this "property" has changed
—
8200 when we recognize how it might now interact with both technology and
8201 markets to mean that the effective constraint on the liberty to
8202 cultivate our culture is dramatically different
—the claim begins
8205 <!-- PAGE BREAK 180 -->
8206 less innocent and obvious. Given (
1) the power of technology to
8207 supplement the law's control, and (
2) the power of concentrated
8208 markets to weaken the opportunity for dissent, if strictly enforcing
8209 the massively expanded "property" rights granted by copyright
8210 fundamentally changes the freedom within this culture to cultivate and
8211 build upon our past, then we have to ask whether this property should
8215 Not starkly. Or absolutely. My point is not that we should abolish
8216 copyright or go back to the eighteenth century. That would be a total
8217 mistake, disastrous for the most important creative enterprises within
8221 But there is a space between zero and one, Internet culture
8222 notwithstanding. And these massive shifts in the effective power of
8223 copyright regulation, tied to increased concentration of the content
8224 industry and resting in the hands of technology that will increasingly
8225 enable control over the use of culture, should drive us to consider
8226 whether another adjustment is called for. Not an adjustment that
8227 increases copyright's power. Not an adjustment that increases its
8228 term. Rather, an adjustment to restore the balance that has
8229 traditionally defined copyright's regulation
—a weakening of that
8230 regulation, to strengthen creativity.
8233 Copyright law has not been a rock of Gibraltar. It's not a set of
8234 constant commitments that, for some mysterious reason, teenagers and
8235 geeks now flout. Instead, copyright power has grown dramatically in a
8236 short period of time, as the technologies of distribution and creation
8237 have changed and as lobbyists have pushed for more control by
8238 copyright holders. Changes in the past in response to changes in
8239 technology suggest that we may well need similar changes in the
8240 future. And these changes have to be reductions in the scope of
8241 copyright, in response to the extraordinary increase in control that
8242 technology and the market enable.
8245 For the single point that is lost in this war on pirates is a point that
8246 we see only after surveying the range of these changes. When you add
8247 <!-- PAGE BREAK 181 -->
8248 together the effect of changing law, concentrated markets, and
8249 changing technology, together they produce an astonishing conclusion:
8250 Never in our history have fewer had a legal right to control more of
8251 the development of our culture than now.
8253 <para> Not when copyrights were perpetual, for when copyrights were
8254 perpetual, they affected only that precise creative work. Not when
8255 only publishers had the tools to publish, for the market then was much
8256 more diverse. Not when there were only three television networks, for
8257 even then, newspapers, film studios, radio stations, and publishers
8258 were independent of the networks. Never has copyright protected such a
8259 wide range of rights, against as broad a range of actors, for a term
8260 that was remotely as long. This form of regulation
—a tiny
8261 regulation of a tiny part of the creative energy of a nation at the
8262 founding
—is now a massive regulation of the overall creative
8263 process. Law plus technology plus the market now interact to turn this
8264 historically benign regulation into the most significant regulation of
8265 culture that our free society has known.
<footnote><para>
8267 Siva Vaidhyanathan captures a similar point in his "four surrenders" of
8268 copyright law in the digital age. See Vaidhyanathan,
159–60.
8272 This has been a long chapter. Its point can now be briefly stated.
8275 At the start of this book, I distinguished between commercial and
8276 noncommercial culture. In the course of this chapter, I have
8277 distinguished between copying a work and transforming it. We can now
8278 combine these two distinctions and draw a clear map of the changes
8279 that copyright law has undergone. In
1790, the law looked like this:
8284 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8288 <entry>PUBLISH
</entry>
8289 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8294 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8295 <entry>©</entry>
8299 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8308 The act of publishing a map, chart, and book was regulated by
8309 copyright law. Nothing else was. Transformations were free. And as
8310 copyright attached only with registration, and only those who intended
8312 <!-- PAGE BREAK 182 -->
8313 to benefit commercially would register, copying through publishing of
8314 noncommercial work was also free.
8317 By the end of the nineteenth century, the law had changed to this:
8322 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8326 <entry>PUBLISH
</entry>
8327 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8332 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8333 <entry>©</entry>
8334 <entry>©</entry>
8337 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8346 Derivative works were now regulated by copyright law
—if
8347 published, which again, given the economics of publishing at the time,
8348 means if offered commercially. But noncommercial publishing and
8349 transformation were still essentially free.
8352 In
1909 the law changed to regulate copies, not publishing, and after
8353 this change, the scope of the law was tied to technology. As the
8354 technology of copying became more prevalent, the reach of the law
8355 expanded. Thus by
1975, as photocopying machines became more common,
8356 we could say the law began to look like this:
8361 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8366 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8371 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8372 <entry>©</entry>
8373 <entry>©</entry>
8376 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8377 <entry>©/Free
</entry>
8385 The law was interpreted to reach noncommercial copying through,
8386 say, copy machines, but still much of copying outside of the
8388 market remained free. But the consequence of the emergence of
8389 digital technologies, especially in the context of a digital network,
8390 means that the law now looks like this:
8395 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8400 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8405 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8406 <entry>©</entry>
8407 <entry>©</entry>
8410 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8411 <entry>©</entry>
8412 <entry>©</entry>
8419 Every realm is governed by copyright law, whereas before most
8420 creativity was not. The law now regulates the full range of
8422 <!-- PAGE BREAK 183 -->
8423 commercial or not, transformative or not
—with the same rules
8424 designed to regulate commercial publishers.
8427 Obviously, copyright law is not the enemy. The enemy is regulation
8428 that does no good. So the question that we should be asking just now
8429 is whether extending the regulations of copyright law into each of
8430 these domains actually does any good.
8433 I have no doubt that it does good in regulating commercial copying.
8434 But I also have no doubt that it does more harm than good when
8435 regulating (as it regulates just now) noncommercial copying and,
8436 especially, noncommercial transformation. And increasingly, for the
8437 reasons sketched especially in chapters
7 and
8, one might well wonder
8438 whether it does more harm than good for commercial transformation.
8439 More commercial transformative work would be created if derivative
8440 rights were more sharply restricted.
8443 The issue is therefore not simply whether copyright is property. Of
8444 course copyright is a kind of "property," and of course, as with any
8445 property, the state ought to protect it. But first impressions
8446 notwithstanding, historically, this property right (as with all
8447 property rights
<footnote><para>
8449 It was the single most important contribution of the legal realist
8450 movement to demonstrate that all property rights are always crafted to
8451 balance public and private interests. See Thomas C. Grey, "The
8452 Disintegration of Property," in Nomos XXII: Property, J. Roland
8453 Pennock and John W. Chapman, eds. (New York: New York University
8456 has been crafted to balance the important need to give authors and
8457 artists incentives with the equally important need to assure access to
8458 creative work. This balance has always been struck in light of new
8459 technologies. And for almost half of our tradition, the "copyright"
8460 did not control at all the freedom of others to build upon or
8461 transform a creative work. American culture was born free, and for
8462 almost
180 years our country consistently protected a vibrant and rich
8466 We achieved that free culture because our law respected important
8467 limits on the scope of the interests protected by "property." The very
8468 birth of "copyright" as a statutory right recognized those limits, by
8469 granting copyright owners protection for a limited time only (the
8470 story of chapter
6). The tradition of "fair use" is animated by a
8471 similar concern that is increasingly under strain as the costs of
8472 exercising any fair use right become unavoidably high (the story of
8474 <!-- PAGE BREAK 184 -->
8475 statutory rights where markets might stifle innovation is another
8476 familiar limit on the property right that copyright is (chapter
8477 8). And granting archives and libraries a broad freedom to collect,
8478 claims of property notwithstanding, is a crucial part of guaranteeing
8479 the soul of a culture (chapter
9). Free cultures, like free markets,
8480 are built with property. But the nature of the property that builds a
8481 free culture is very different from the extremist vision that
8482 dominates the debate today.
8485 Free culture is increasingly the casualty in this war on piracy. In
8486 response to a real, if not yet quantified, threat that the
8487 technologies of the Internet present to twentieth-century business
8488 models for producing and distributing culture, the law and technology
8489 are being transformed in a way that will undermine our tradition of
8490 free culture. The property right that is copyright is no longer the
8491 balanced right that it was, or was intended to be. The property right
8492 that is copyright has become unbalanced, tilted toward an extreme. The
8493 opportunity to create and transform becomes weakened in a world in
8494 which creation requires permission and creativity must check with a
8497 <!-- PAGE BREAK 185 -->
8501 <chapter id=
"c-puzzles">
8502 <title>PUZZLES
</title>
8504 <!-- PAGE BREAK 186 -->
8505 <sect1 id=
"chimera">
8506 <title>CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera
</title>
8507 <indexterm id=
"idxchimera" class='startofrange'
>
8508 <primary>chimeras
</primary>
8510 <indexterm id=
"idxwells" class='startofrange'
>
8511 <primary>Wells, H. G.
</primary>
8513 <indexterm id=
"idxtcotb" class='startofrange'
>
8514 <primary>"Country of the Blind, The
" (Wells)
</primary>
8518 In a well-known short story by H. G. Wells, a mountain climber
8519 named Nunez trips (literally, down an ice slope) into an unknown and
8520 isolated valley in the Peruvian Andes.
<footnote><para>
8522 H. G. Wells, "The Country of the Blind" (
1904,
1911). See H. G. Wells,
8523 The Country of the Blind and Other Stories, Michael Sherborne, ed. (New
8524 York: Oxford University Press,
1996).
8526 The valley is extraordinarily beautiful, with "sweet water, pasture,
8527 an even climate, slopes of rich brown soil with tangles of a shrub
8528 that bore an excellent fruit." But the villagers are all blind. Nunez
8529 takes this as an opportunity. "In the Country of the Blind," he tells
8530 himself, "the One-Eyed Man is King." So he resolves to live with the
8531 villagers to explore life as a king.
8534 Things don't go quite as he planned. He tries to explain the idea of
8535 sight to the villagers. They don't understand. He tells them they are
8536 "blind." They don't have the word blind. They think he's just thick.
8537 Indeed, as they increasingly notice the things he can't do (hear the
8538 sound of grass being stepped on, for example), they increasingly try
8539 to control him. He, in turn, becomes increasingly frustrated. "`You
8540 don't understand,' he cried, in a voice that was meant to be great and
8541 resolute, and which broke. `You are blind and I can see. Leave me
8545 <!-- PAGE BREAK 187 -->
8546 The villagers don't leave him alone. Nor do they see (so to speak) the
8547 virtue of his special power. Not even the ultimate target of his
8548 affection, a young woman who to him seems "the most beautiful thing in
8549 the whole of creation," understands the beauty of sight. Nunez's
8550 description of what he sees "seemed to her the most poetical of
8551 fancies, and she listened to his description of the stars and the
8552 mountains and her own sweet white-lit beauty as though it was a guilty
8553 indulgence." "She did not believe," Wells tells us, and "she could
8554 only half understand, but she was mysteriously delighted."
8557 When Nunez announces his desire to marry his "mysteriously delighted"
8558 love, the father and the village object. "You see, my dear," her
8559 father instructs, "he's an idiot. He has delusions. He can't do
8560 anything right." They take Nunez to the village doctor.
8563 After a careful examination, the doctor gives his opinion. "His brain
8564 is affected," he reports.
8567 "What affects it?" the father asks. "Those queer things that are
8568 called the eyes . . . are diseased . . . in such a way as to affect
8572 The doctor continues: "I think I may say with reasonable certainty
8573 that in order to cure him completely, all that we need to do is a
8574 simple and easy surgical operation
—namely, to remove these
8575 irritant bodies [the eyes]."
8578 "Thank Heaven for science!" says the father to the doctor. They inform
8579 Nunez of this condition necessary for him to be allowed his bride.
8580 (You'll have to read the original to learn what happens in the end. I
8581 believe in free culture, but never in giving away the end of a story.)
8582 It sometimes happens that the eggs of twins fuse in the mother's
8583 womb. That fusion produces a "chimera." A chimera is a single creature
8584 with two sets of DNA. The DNA in the blood, for example, might be
8585 different from the DNA of the skin. This possibility is an underused
8587 <!-- PAGE BREAK 188 -->
8588 plot for murder mysteries. "But the DNA shows with
100 percent
8589 certainty that she was not the person whose blood was at the
8592 <indexterm startref=
"idxtcotb" class='endofrange'
/>
8593 <indexterm startref=
"idxwells" class=
"endofrange"/>
8595 Before I had read about chimeras, I would have said they were
8596 impossible. A single person can't have two sets of DNA. The very idea
8597 of DNA is that it is the code of an individual. Yet in fact, not only
8598 can two individuals have the same set of DNA (identical twins), but
8599 one person can have two different sets of DNA (a chimera). Our
8600 understanding of a "person" should reflect this reality.
8603 The more I work to understand the current struggle over copyright and
8604 culture, which I've sometimes called unfairly, and sometimes not
8605 unfairly enough, "the copyright wars," the more I think we're dealing
8606 with a chimera. For example, in the battle over the question "What is
8607 p2p file sharing?" both sides have it right, and both sides have it
8608 wrong. One side says, "File sharing is just like two kids taping each
8609 others' records
—the sort of thing we've been doing for the last
8610 thirty years without any question at all." That's true, at least in
8611 part. When I tell my best friend to try out a new CD that I've bought,
8612 but rather than just send the CD, I point him to my p2p server, that
8613 is, in all relevant respects, just like what every executive in every
8614 recording company no doubt did as a kid: sharing music.
8617 But the description is also false in part. For when my p2p server is
8618 on a p2p network through which anyone can get access to my music, then
8619 sure, my friends can get access, but it stretches the meaning of
8620 "friends" beyond recognition to say "my ten thousand best friends" can
8621 get access. Whether or not sharing my music with my best friend is
8622 what "we have always been allowed to do," we have not always been
8623 allowed to share music with "our ten thousand best friends."
8626 Likewise, when the other side says, "File sharing is just like walking
8627 into a Tower Records and taking a CD off the shelf and walking out
8628 with it," that's true, at least in part. If, after Lyle Lovett
8629 (finally) releases a new album, rather than buying it, I go to Kazaa
8630 and find a free copy to take, that is very much like stealing a copy
8635 <!-- PAGE BREAK 189 -->
8636 But it is not quite stealing from Tower. After all, when I take a CD
8637 from Tower Records, Tower has one less CD to sell. And when I take a
8638 CD from Tower Records, I get a bit of plastic and a cover, and
8639 something to show on my shelves. (And, while we're at it, we could
8640 also note that when I take a CD from Tower Records, the maximum fine
8641 that might be imposed on me, under California law, at least, is
8642 $
1,
000. According to the RIAA, by contrast, if I download a ten-song
8643 CD, I'm liable for $
1,
500,
000 in damages.)
8646 The point is not that it is as neither side describes. The point is
8647 that it is both
—both as the RIAA describes it and as Kazaa
8648 describes it. It is a chimera. And rather than simply denying what the
8649 other side asserts, we need to begin to think about how we should
8650 respond to this chimera. What rules should govern it?
8653 We could respond by simply pretending that it is not a chimera. We
8654 could, with the RIAA, decide that every act of file sharing should be
8655 a felony. We could prosecute families for millions of dollars in
8656 damages just because file sharing occurred on a family computer. And
8657 we can get universities to monitor all computer traffic to make sure
8658 that no computer is used to commit this crime. These responses might
8659 be extreme, but each of them has either been proposed or actually
8660 implemented.
<footnote><para>
8661 <!-- f2. --> For an excellent summary, see the report prepared by GartnerG2 and the
8662 Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School,
8664 and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World,"
27 June
2003, available
8666 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
33</ulink>. Reps. John Conyers Jr. (D-Mich.) and Howard L. Berman
8667 (D-Calif.) have introduced a bill that would treat unauthorized on-line
8668 copying as a felony offense with punishments ranging as high as five years
8669 imprisonment; see Jon Healey, "House Bill Aims to Up Stakes on Piracy,"
8670 Los Angeles Times,
17 July
2003, available at
8671 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
34</ulink>. Civil penalties are
8672 currently set at $
150,
000 per copied song. For a recent (and unsuccessful)
8673 legal challenge to the RIAA's demand that an ISP reveal the identity of a
8674 user accused of sharing more than
600 songs through a family computer,
8675 see RIAA v. Verizon Internet Services (In re. Verizon Internet Services),
240 F.
8676 Supp.
2d
24 (D.D.C.
2003). Such a user could face liability ranging as
8677 high as $
90 million. Such astronomical figures furnish the RIAA with a
8678 powerful arsenal in its prosecution of file sharers. Settlements ranging
8679 from $
12,
000 to $
17,
500 for four students accused of heavy file sharing on
8680 university networks must have seemed a mere pittance next to the $
98
8682 the RIAA could seek should the matter proceed to court. See
8684 Young, "Downloading Could Lead to Fines," redandblack.com,
8685 August
2003, available at
8686 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
35</ulink>. For an example of the RIAA's
8688 of student file sharing, and of the subpoenas issued to universities to
8689 reveal student file-sharer identities, see James Collins, "RIAA Steps Up
8690 Bid to Force BC, MIT to Name Students," Boston Globe,
8 August
2003,
8692 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
36</ulink>.
8696 <indexterm startref=
"idxchimera" class='endofrange'
/>
8698 Alternatively, we could respond to file sharing the way many kids act
8699 as though we've responded. We could totally legalize it. Let there be
8700 no copyright liability, either civil or criminal, for making
8701 copyrighted content available on the Net. Make file sharing like
8702 gossip: regulated, if at all, by social norms but not by law.
8705 Either response is possible. I think either would be a mistake.
8706 Rather than embrace one of these two extremes, we should embrace
8707 something that recognizes the truth in both. And while I end this book
8708 with a sketch of a system that does just that, my aim in the next chapter
8709 is to show just how awful it would be for us to adopt the zero-tolerance
8710 extreme. I believe either extreme would be worse than a reasonable
8712 But I believe the zero-tolerance solution would be the worse
8713 of the two extremes.
8717 <!-- PAGE BREAK 190 -->
8718 Yet zero tolerance is increasingly our government's policy. In the
8719 middle of the chaos that the Internet has created, an extraordinary land
8720 grab is occurring. The law and technology are being shifted to give
8722 holders a kind of control over our culture that they have never had
8723 before. And in this extremism, many an opportunity for new
8725 and new creativity will be lost.
8728 I'm not talking about the opportunities for kids to "steal" music. My
8729 focus instead is the commercial and cultural innovation that this war
8730 will also kill. We have never seen the power to innovate spread so
8731 broadly among our citizens, and we have just begun to see the
8733 that this power will unleash. Yet the Internet has already seen the
8734 passing of one cycle of innovation around technologies to distribute
8735 content. The law is responsible for this passing. As the vice president
8736 for global public policy at one of these new innovators, eMusic.com,
8737 put it when criticizing the DMCA's added protection for copyrighted
8742 eMusic opposes music piracy. We are a distributor of copyrighted
8743 material, and we want to protect those rights.
8746 But building a technology fortress that locks in the clout of
8747 the major labels is by no means the only way to protect copyright
8748 interests, nor is it necessarily the best. It is simply too early to
8750 that question. Market forces operating naturally may very
8751 well produce a totally different industry model.
8754 This is a critical point. The choices that industry sectors make
8755 with respect to these systems will in many ways directly shape the
8756 market for digital media and the manner in which digital media
8757 are distributed. This in turn will directly influence the options
8758 that are available to consumers, both in terms of the ease with
8759 which they will be able to access digital media and the equipment
8760 that they will require to do so. Poor choices made this early in the
8761 game will retard the growth of this market, hurting everyone's
8762 interests.
<footnote><para>
8763 <!-- f3. --> WIPO and the DMCA One Year Later: Assessing Consumer Access to
8764 Digital Entertainment on the Internet and Other Media: Hearing Before
8765 the Subcommittee on Telecommunications, Trade, and Consumer
8767 House Committee on Commerce,
106th Cong.
29 (
1999) (statement
8768 of Peter Harter, vice president, Global Public Policy and Standards,
8770 available in LEXIS, Federal Document Clearing House
8776 <!-- PAGE BREAK 191 -->
8778 In April
2001, eMusic.com was purchased by Vivendi Universal,
8779 one of "the major labels." Its position on these matters has now
8783 Reversing our tradition of tolerance now will not merely quash
8784 piracy. It will sacrifice values that are important to this culture, and will
8785 kill opportunities that could be extraordinarily valuable.
8788 <!-- PAGE BREAK 192 -->
8791 <title>CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms
</title>
8794 To fight "piracy," to protect "property," the content industry has
8795 launched a war. Lobbying and lots of campaign contributions have
8796 now brought the government into this war. As with any war, this one
8797 will have both direct and collateral damage. As with any war of
8799 these damages will be suffered most by our own people.
8802 My aim so far has been to describe the consequences of this war, in
8803 particular, the consequences for "free culture." But my aim now is to
8805 this description of consequences into an argument. Is this war
8809 In my view, it is not. There is no good reason why this time, for the
8810 first time, the law should defend the old against the new, just when the
8811 power of the property called "intellectual property" is at its greatest in
8814 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
8815 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
8817 Yet "common sense" does not see it this way. Common sense is still on
8818 the side of the Causbys and the content industry. The extreme claims
8819 of control in the name of property still resonate; the uncritical
8820 rejection of "piracy" still has play.
8823 <!-- PAGE BREAK 193 -->
8824 There will be many consequences of continuing this war. I want to
8825 describe just three. All three might be said to be unintended. I am quite
8826 confident the third is unintended. I'm less sure about the first two. The
8827 first two protect modern RCAs, but there is no Howard Armstrong in
8828 the wings to fight today's monopolists of culture.
8830 <sect2 id=
"constrain">
8831 <title>Constraining Creators
</title>
8833 In the next ten years we will see an explosion of digital
8834 technologies. These technologies will enable almost anyone to capture
8835 and share content. Capturing and sharing content, of course, is what
8836 humans have done since the dawn of man. It is how we learn and
8837 communicate. But capturing and sharing through digital technology is
8838 different. The fidelity and power are different. You could send an
8839 e-mail telling someone about a joke you saw on Comedy Central, or you
8840 could send the clip. You could write an essay about the
8841 inconsistencies in the arguments of the politician you most love to
8842 hate, or you could make a short film that puts statement against
8843 statement. You could write a poem to express your love, or you could
8844 weave together a string
—a mash-up
— of songs from your
8845 favorite artists in a collage and make it available on the Net.
8848 This digital "capturing and sharing" is in part an extension of the
8849 capturing and sharing that has always been integral to our culture,
8850 and in part it is something new. It is continuous with the Kodak, but
8851 it explodes the boundaries of Kodak-like technologies. The technology
8852 of digital "capturing and sharing" promises a world of extraordinarily
8853 diverse creativity that can be easily and broadly shared. And as that
8854 creativity is applied to democracy, it will enable a broad range of
8855 citizens to use technology to express and criticize and contribute to
8856 the culture all around.
8859 Technology has thus given us an opportunity to do something with
8860 culture that has only ever been possible for individuals in small groups,
8862 <!-- PAGE BREAK 194 -->
8864 isolated from others. Think about an old man telling a story to a
8865 collection of neighbors in a small town. Now imagine that same
8866 storytelling extended across the globe.
8869 Yet all this is possible only if the activity is presumptively legal. In
8870 the current regime of legal regulation, it is not. Forget file sharing for
8871 a moment. Think about your favorite amazing sites on the Net. Web
8872 sites that offer plot summaries from forgotten television shows; sites
8873 that catalog cartoons from the
1960s; sites that mix images and sound
8874 to criticize politicians or businesses; sites that gather newspaper articles
8875 on remote topics of science or culture. There is a vast amount of creative
8876 work spread across the Internet. But as the law is currently crafted, this
8877 work is presumptively illegal.
8880 That presumption will increasingly chill creativity, as the
8881 examples of extreme penalties for vague infringements continue to
8882 proliferate. It is impossible to get a clear sense of what's allowed
8883 and what's not, and at the same time, the penalties for crossing the
8884 line are astonishingly harsh. The four students who were threatened
8885 by the RIAA ( Jesse Jordan of chapter
3 was just one) were threatened
8886 with a $
98 billion lawsuit for building search engines that permitted
8887 songs to be copied. Yet World-Com
—which defrauded investors of
8888 $
11 billion, resulting in a loss to investors in market capitalization
8889 of over $
200 billion
—received a fine of a mere $
750
8890 million.
<footnote><para>
8892 See Lynne W. Jeter, Disconnected: Deceit and Betrayal at WorldCom
8893 (Hoboken, N.J.: John Wiley
& Sons,
2003),
176,
204; for details of
8894 the settlement, see MCI press release, "MCI Wins U.S. District Court
8895 Approval for SEC Settlement" (
7 July
2003), available at
8896 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
37</ulink>.
8898 And under legislation being pushed in Congress right now, a doctor who
8899 negligently removes the wrong leg in an operation would be liable for
8900 no more than $
250,
000 in damages for pain and
8901 suffering.
<footnote>
8902 <indexterm><primary>Bush, George W.
</primary></indexterm>
8904 <!-- f2. --> The bill, modeled after California's tort reform model, was passed in the
8905 House of Representatives but defeated in a Senate vote in July
2003. For
8906 an overview, see Tanya Albert, "Measure Stalls in Senate: `We'll Be Back,'
8907 Say Tort Reformers," amednews.com,
28 July
2003, available at
8908 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
38</ulink>,
8909 and "Senate Turns Back Malpractice Caps," CBSNews.com,
9 July
2003,
8911 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
39</ulink>. President Bush has continued to urge tort reform in
8914 Can common sense recognize the absurdity in a world where
8915 the maximum fine for downloading two songs off the Internet is more
8916 than the fine for a doctor's negligently butchering a patient?
8919 The consequence of this legal uncertainty, tied to these extremely
8920 high penalties, is that an extraordinary amount of creativity will either
8921 never be exercised, or never be exercised in the open. We drive this
8923 process underground by branding the modern-day Walt Disneys
8924 "pirates." We make it impossible for businesses to rely upon a public
8925 domain, because the boundaries of the public domain are designed to
8927 <!-- PAGE BREAK 195 -->
8928 be unclear. It never pays to do anything except pay for the right to
8930 and hence only those who can pay are allowed to create. As was the
8931 case in the Soviet Union, though for very different reasons, we will
8933 to see a world of underground art
—not because the message is
8935 political, or because the subject is controversial, but because the
8936 very act of creating the art is legally fraught. Already, exhibits of
8938 art" tour the United States.
<footnote><para>
8939 <!-- f3. --> See Danit Lidor, "Artists Just Wanna Be Free," Wired,
7 July
2003,
8942 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
40</ulink>. For an overview of the exhibition, see
8943 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
41</ulink>.
8945 In what does their "illegality" consist?
8946 In the act of mixing the culture around us with an expression that is
8947 critical or reflective.
8950 Part of the reason for this fear of illegality has to do with the
8951 changing law. I described that change in detail in chapter
10. But an
8952 even bigger part has to do with the increasing ease with which
8953 infractions can be tracked. As users of file-sharing systems
8954 discovered in
2002, it is a trivial matter for copyright owners to get
8955 courts to order Internet service providers to reveal who has what
8956 content. It is as if your cassette tape player transmitted a list of
8957 the songs that you played in the privacy of your own home that anyone
8958 could tune into for whatever reason they chose.
8961 Never in our history has a painter had to worry about whether
8962 his painting infringed on someone else's work; but the modern-day
8963 painter, using the tools of Photoshop, sharing content on the Web,
8964 must worry all the time. Images are all around, but the only safe images
8965 to use in the act of creation are those purchased from Corbis or another
8966 image farm. And in purchasing, censoring happens. There is a free
8967 market in pencils; we needn't worry about its effect on creativity. But
8968 there is a highly regulated, monopolized market in cultural icons; the
8969 right to cultivate and transform them is not similarly free.
8972 Lawyers rarely see this because lawyers are rarely empirical. As I
8973 described in chapter
7, in response to the story about documentary
8974 filmmaker Jon Else, I have been lectured again and again by lawyers
8975 who insist Else's use was fair use, and hence I am wrong to say that the
8976 law regulates such a use.
8980 <!-- PAGE BREAK 196 -->
8981 But fair use in America simply means the right to hire a lawyer to
8982 defend your right to create. And as lawyers love to forget, our system
8983 for defending rights such as fair use is astonishingly bad
—in
8984 practically every context, but especially here. It costs too much, it
8985 delivers too slowly, and what it delivers often has little connection
8986 to the justice underlying the claim. The legal system may be tolerable
8987 for the very rich. For everyone else, it is an embarrassment to a
8988 tradition that prides itself on the rule of law.
8991 Judges and lawyers can tell themselves that fair use provides adequate
8992 "breathing room" between regulation by the law and the access the law
8993 should allow. But it is a measure of how out of touch our legal system
8994 has become that anyone actually believes this. The rules that
8995 publishers impose upon writers, the rules that film distributors
8996 impose upon filmmakers, the rules that newspapers impose upon
8997 journalists
— these are the real laws governing creativity. And
8998 these rules have little relationship to the "law" with which judges
9002 For in a world that threatens $
150,
000 for a single willful
9003 infringement of a copyright, and which demands tens of thousands of
9004 dollars to even defend against a copyright infringement claim, and
9005 which would never return to the wrongfully accused defendant anything
9006 of the costs she suffered to defend her right to speak
—in that
9007 world, the astonishingly broad regulations that pass under the name
9008 "copyright" silence speech and creativity. And in that world, it takes
9009 a studied blindness for people to continue to believe they live in a
9010 culture that is free.
9013 As Jed Horovitz, the businessman behind Video Pipeline, said to me,
9017 We're losing [creative] opportunities right and left. Creative people
9018 are being forced not to express themselves. Thoughts are not being
9019 expressed. And while a lot of stuff may [still] be created, it still
9020 won't get distributed. Even if the stuff gets made . . . you're not
9021 going to get it distributed in the mainstream media unless
9022 <!-- PAGE BREAK 197 -->
9023 you've got a little note from a lawyer saying, "This has been
9024 cleared." You're not even going to get it on PBS without that kind of
9025 permission. That's the point at which they control it.
9029 <sect2 id=
"innovators">
9030 <title>Constraining Innovators
</title>
9032 The story of the last section was a crunchy-lefty
9033 story
—creativity quashed, artists who can't speak, yada yada
9034 yada. Maybe that doesn't get you going. Maybe you think there's enough
9035 weird art out there, and enough expression that is critical of what
9036 seems to be just about everything. And if you think that, you might
9037 think there's little in this story to worry you.
9040 But there's an aspect of this story that is not lefty in any sense.
9041 Indeed, it is an aspect that could be written by the most extreme
9042 promarket ideologue. And if you're one of these sorts (and a special
9043 one at that,
188 pages into a book like this), then you can see this
9044 other aspect by substituting "free market" every place I've spoken of
9045 "free culture." The point is the same, even if the interests
9046 affecting culture are more fundamental.
9049 The charge I've been making about the regulation of culture is the
9050 same charge free marketers make about regulating markets. Everyone, of
9051 course, concedes that some regulation of markets is necessary
—at
9052 a minimum, we need rules of property and contract, and courts to
9053 enforce both. Likewise, in this culture debate, everyone concedes that
9054 at least some framework of copyright is also required. But both
9055 perspectives vehemently insist that just because some regulation is
9056 good, it doesn't follow that more regulation is better. And both
9057 perspectives are constantly attuned to the ways in which regulation
9058 simply enables the powerful industries of today to protect themselves
9059 against the competitors of tomorrow.
9061 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank
</primary></indexterm>
9063 This is the single most dramatic effect of the shift in regulatory
9064 <!-- PAGE BREAK 198 -->
9065 strategy that I described in chapter
10. The consequence of this
9066 massive threat of liability tied to the murky boundaries of copyright
9067 law is that innovators who want to innovate in this space can safely
9068 innovate only if they have the sign-off from last generation's
9069 dominant industries. That lesson has been taught through a series of
9070 cases that were designed and executed to teach venture capitalists a
9071 lesson. That lesson
—what former Napster CEO Hank Barry calls a
9072 "nuclear pall" that has fallen over the Valley
—has been learned.
9075 Consider one example to make the point, a story whose beginning
9076 I told in The Future of Ideas and which has progressed in a way that
9077 even I (pessimist extraordinaire) would never have predicted.
9080 In
1997, Michael Roberts launched a company called MP3.com. MP3.com
9081 was keen to remake the music business. Their goal was not just to
9082 facilitate new ways to get access to content. Their goal was also to
9083 facilitate new ways to create content. Unlike the major labels,
9084 MP3.com offered creators a venue to distribute their creativity,
9085 without demanding an exclusive engagement from the creators.
9088 To make this system work, however, MP3.com needed a reliable way to
9089 recommend music to its users. The idea behind this alternative was to
9090 leverage the revealed preferences of music listeners to recommend new
9091 artists. If you like Lyle Lovett, you're likely to enjoy Bonnie
9095 This idea required a simple way to gather data about user preferences.
9096 MP3.com came up with an extraordinarily clever way to gather this
9097 preference data. In January
2000, the company launched a service
9098 called my.mp3.com. Using software provided by MP3.com, a user would
9099 sign into an account and then insert into her computer a CD. The
9100 software would identify the CD, and then give the user access to that
9101 content. So, for example, if you inserted a CD by Jill Sobule, then
9102 wherever you were
—at work or at home
—you could get access
9103 to that music once you signed into your account. The system was
9104 therefore a kind of music-lockbox.
9107 No doubt some could use this system to illegally copy content. But
9108 that opportunity existed with or without MP3.com. The aim of the
9110 <!-- PAGE BREAK 199 -->
9111 my.mp3.com service was to give users access to their own content, and
9112 as a by-product, by seeing the content they already owned, to discover
9113 the kind of content the users liked.
9116 To make this system function, however, MP3.com needed to copy
50,
000
9117 CDs to a server. (In principle, it could have been the user who
9118 uploaded the music, but that would have taken a great deal of time,
9119 and would have produced a product of questionable quality.) It
9120 therefore purchased
50,
000 CDs from a store, and started the process
9121 of making copies of those CDs. Again, it would not serve the content
9122 from those copies to anyone except those who authenticated that they
9123 had a copy of the CD they wanted to access. So while this was
50,
000
9124 copies, it was
50,
000 copies directed at giving customers something
9125 they had already bought.
9128 Nine days after MP3.com launched its service, the five major labels,
9129 headed by the RIAA, brought a lawsuit against MP3.com. MP3.com settled
9130 with four of the five. Nine months later, a federal judge found
9131 MP3.com to have been guilty of willful infringement with respect to
9132 the fifth. Applying the law as it is, the judge imposed a fine against
9133 MP3.com of $
118 million. MP3.com then settled with the remaining
9134 plaintiff, Vivendi Universal, paying over $
54 million. Vivendi
9135 purchased MP3.com just about a year later.
9138 That part of the story I have told before. Now consider its conclusion.
9141 After Vivendi purchased MP3.com, Vivendi turned around and filed a
9142 malpractice lawsuit against the lawyers who had advised it that they
9143 had a good faith claim that the service they wanted to offer would be
9144 considered legal under copyright law. This lawsuit alleged that it
9145 should have been obvious that the courts would find this behavior
9146 illegal; therefore, this lawsuit sought to punish any lawyer who had
9147 dared to suggest that the law was less restrictive than the labels
9151 The clear purpose of this lawsuit (which was settled for an
9152 unspecified amount shortly after the story was no longer covered in
9153 the press) was to send an unequivocal message to lawyers advising
9155 <!-- PAGE BREAK 200 -->
9156 space: It is not just your clients who might suffer if the content
9157 industry directs its guns against them. It is also you. So those of
9158 you who believe the law should be less restrictive should realize that
9159 such a view of the law will cost you and your firm dearly.
9161 <indexterm><primary>Hummer, John
</primary></indexterm>
9162 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank
</primary></indexterm>
9164 This strategy is not just limited to the lawyers. In April
2003,
9165 Universal and EMI brought a lawsuit against Hummer Winblad, the
9166 venture capital firm (VC) that had funded Napster at a certain stage of
9167 its development, its cofounder ( John Hummer), and general partner
9168 (Hank Barry).
<footnote><para>
9169 <!-- f4. --> See Joseph Menn, "Universal, EMI Sue Napster Investor," Los Angeles
9170 Times,
23 April
2003. For a parallel argument about the effects on
9172 in the distribution of music, see Janelle Brown, "The Music
9174 Will Not Be Digitized," Salon.com,
1 June
2001, available at
9175 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
42</ulink>.
9176 See also Jon Healey, "Online Music Services Besieged," Los Angeles
9179 The claim here, as well, was that the VC should have
9180 recognized the right of the content industry to control how the
9182 should develop. They should be held personally liable for funding a
9183 company whose business turned out to be beyond the law. Here again,
9184 the aim of the lawsuit is transparent: Any VC now recognizes that if
9185 you fund a company whose business is not approved of by the dinosaurs,
9186 you are at risk not just in the marketplace, but in the courtroom as well.
9187 Your investment buys you not only a company, it also buys you a lawsuit.
9188 So extreme has the environment become that even car manufacturers
9189 are afraid of technologies that touch content. In an article in Business
9190 2.0, Rafe Needleman describes a discussion with BMW:
9193 <indexterm><primary>BMW
</primary></indexterm>
9195 I asked why, with all the storage capacity and computer power in
9196 the car, there was no way to play MP3 files. I was told that BMW
9197 engineers in Germany had rigged a new vehicle to play MP3s via
9198 the car's built-in sound system, but that the company's marketing
9199 and legal departments weren't comfortable with pushing this
9200 forward for release stateside. Even today, no new cars are sold in the
9201 United States with bona fide MP3 players. . . .
<footnote>
9202 <indexterm><primary>Needleman, Rafe
</primary></indexterm>
9205 Rafe Needleman, "Driving in Cars with MP3s," Business
2.0,
16 June
9207 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
43</ulink>. I am grateful
9208 to Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli for this example.
9213 This is the world of the mafia
—filled with "your money or your
9214 life" offers, governed in the end not by courts but by the threats
9215 that the law empowers copyright holders to exercise. It is a system
9216 that will obviously and necessarily stifle new innovation. It is hard
9217 enough to start a company. It is impossibly hard if that company is
9218 constantly threatened by litigation.
9222 <!-- PAGE BREAK 201 -->
9223 The point is not that businesses should have a right to start illegal
9224 enterprises. The point is the definition of "illegal." The law is a mess of
9225 uncertainty. We have no good way to know how it should apply to new
9226 technologies. Yet by reversing our tradition of judicial deference, and
9227 by embracing the astonishingly high penalties that copyright law
9229 that uncertainty now yields a reality which is far more
9231 than is right. If the law imposed the death penalty for parking
9232 tickets, we'd not only have fewer parking tickets, we'd also have much
9233 less driving. The same principle applies to innovation. If innovation is
9234 constantly checked by this uncertain and unlimited liability, we will
9235 have much less vibrant innovation and much less creativity.
9238 The point is directly parallel to the crunchy-lefty point about fair
9239 use. Whatever the "real" law is, realism about the effect of law in both
9240 contexts is the same. This wildly punitive system of regulation will
9242 stifle creativity and innovation. It will protect some
9244 and some creators, but it will harm industry and creativity
9245 generally. Free market and free culture depend upon vibrant
9247 Yet the effect of the law today is to stifle just this kind of
9249 The effect is to produce an overregulated culture, just as the effect
9250 of too much control in the market is to produce an
9251 overregulatedregulated
9255 The building of a permission culture, rather than a free culture, is
9256 the first important way in which the changes I have described will
9258 innovation. A permission culture means a lawyer's culture
—a
9260 in which the ability to create requires a call to your lawyer. Again,
9261 I am not antilawyer, at least when they're kept in their proper place. I
9262 am certainly not antilaw. But our profession has lost the sense of its
9263 limits. And leaders in our profession have lost an appreciation of the
9264 high costs that our profession imposes upon others. The inefficiency of
9265 the law is an embarrassment to our tradition. And while I believe our
9266 profession should therefore do everything it can to make the law more
9267 efficient, it should at least do everything it can to limit the reach of the
9268 <!-- PAGE BREAK 202 -->
9269 law where the law is not doing any good. The transaction costs buried
9270 within a permission culture are enough to bury a wide range of
9272 Someone needs to do a lot of justifying to justify that result.
9273 The uncertainty of the law is one burden on innovation. There is
9274 a second burden that operates more directly. This is the effort by many
9275 in the content industry to use the law to directly regulate the
9277 of the Internet so that it better protects their content.
9280 The motivation for this response is obvious. The Internet enables
9281 the efficient spread of content. That efficiency is a feature of the
9283 design. But from the perspective of the content industry, this
9285 is a "bug." The efficient spread of content means that content
9286 distributors have a harder time controlling the distribution of content.
9287 One obvious response to this efficiency is thus to make the Internet
9288 less efficient. If the Internet enables "piracy," then, this response says,
9289 we should break the kneecaps of the Internet.
9292 The examples of this form of legislation are many. At the urging of
9293 the content industry, some in Congress have threatened legislation that
9294 would require computers to determine whether the content they access
9295 is protected or not, and to disable the spread of protected content.
<footnote><para>
9296 <!-- f6. --> "Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World," GartnerG2 and
9297 the Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School
9298 (
2003),
33–35, available at
9299 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
44</ulink>.
9303 has already launched proceedings to explore a mandatory
9305 flag" that would be required on any device capable of transmitting
9306 digital video (i.e., a computer), and that would disable the copying of
9307 any content that is marked with a broadcast flag. Other members of
9308 Congress have proposed immunizing content providers from liability
9309 for technology they might deploy that would hunt down copyright
9311 and disable their machines.
<footnote><para>
9312 <!-- f7. --> GartnerG2,
26–27.
9317 In one sense, these solutions seem sensible. If the problem is the
9318 code, why not regulate the code to remove the problem. But any
9320 of technical infrastructure will always be tuned to the particular
9321 technology of the day. It will impose significant burdens and costs on
9323 <!-- PAGE BREAK 203 -->
9324 the technology, but will likely be eclipsed by advances around exactly
9328 In March
2002, a broad coalition of technology companies, led by
9329 Intel, tried to get Congress to see the harm that such legislation would
9330 impose.
<footnote><para>
9331 <!-- f8. --> See David McGuire, "Tech Execs Square Off Over Piracy," Newsbytes,
9332 February
2002 (Entertainment).
9334 Their argument was obviously not that copyright should not
9335 be protected. Instead, they argued, any protection should not do more
9339 There is one more obvious way in which this war has harmed
9340 innovation
—again,
9341 a story that will be quite familiar to the free market
9345 Copyright may be property, but like all property, it is also a form
9346 of regulation. It is a regulation that benefits some and harms others.
9347 When done right, it benefits creators and harms leeches. When done
9348 wrong, it is regulation the powerful use to defeat competitors.
9351 As I described in chapter
10, despite this feature of copyright as
9352 regulation, and subject to important qualifications outlined by Jessica
9353 Litman in her book Digital Copyright,
<footnote><para>
9354 <!-- f9. --> Jessica Litman, Digital Copyright (Amherst, N.Y.: Prometheus Books,
9357 overall this history of copyright
9358 is not bad. As chapter
10 details, when new technologies have come
9359 along, Congress has struck a balance to assure that the new is protected
9360 from the old. Compulsory, or statutory, licenses have been one part of
9361 that strategy. Free use (as in the case of the VCR) has been another.
9364 But that pattern of deference to new technologies has now changed
9365 with the rise of the Internet. Rather than striking a balance between
9366 the claims of a new technology and the legitimate rights of content
9367 creators, both the courts and Congress have imposed legal restrictions
9368 that will have the effect of smothering the new to benefit the old.
9371 The response by the courts has been fairly universal.
<footnote><para>
9372 <!-- f10. --> The only circuit court exception is found in Recording Industry Association
9373 of America (RIAA) v. Diamond Multimedia Systems,
180 F.
3d
1072 (
9th
9374 Cir.
1999). There the court of appeals for the Ninth Circuit reasoned that
9375 makers of a portable MP3 player were not liable for contributory
9377 infringement for a device that is unable to record or redistribute
9379 (a device whose only copying function is to render portable a music file
9380 already stored on a user's hard drive).
9381 At the district court level, the only exception is found in
9383 Studios, Inc. v. Grokster, Ltd.,
259 F. Supp.
2d
1029 (C.D.
9384 Cal.,
2003), where the court found the link between the distributor and
9385 any given user's conduct too attenuated to make the distributor liable for
9386 contributory or vicarious infringement liability.
9389 mirrored in the responses threatened and actually implemented by
9390 Congress. I won't catalog all of those responses here.
<footnote><para>
9391 <!-- f11. --> For example, in July
2002, Representative Howard Berman introduced the
9392 Peer-to-Peer Piracy Prevention Act (H.R.
5211), which would immunize
9393 copyright holders from liability for damage done to computers when the
9394 copyright holders use technology to stop copyright infringement. In
9396 2002, Representative Billy Tauzin introduced a bill to mandate that
9397 technologies capable of rebroadcasting digital copies of films broadcast on
9398 TV (i.e., computers) respect a "broadcast flag" that would disable copying
9399 of that content. And in March of the same year, Senator Fritz Hollings
9400 introduced the Consumer Broadband and Digital Television Promotion
9401 Act, which mandated copyright protection technology in all digital media
9402 devices. See GartnerG2, "Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster
9403 World,"
27 June
2003,
33–34, available at
9404 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
44</ulink>.
9407 example that captures the flavor of them all. This is the story of the
9413 <!-- PAGE BREAK 204 -->
9414 As I described in chapter
4, when a radio station plays a song, the
9415 recording artist doesn't get paid for that "radio performance" unless he
9416 or she is also the composer. So, for example if Marilyn Monroe had
9417 recorded a version of "Happy Birthday"
—to memorialize her famous
9418 performance before President Kennedy at Madison Square Garden
—
9419 then whenever that recording was played on the radio, the current
9421 owners of "Happy Birthday" would get some money, whereas
9422 Marilyn Monroe would not.
9425 The reasoning behind this balance struck by Congress makes some
9426 sense. The justification was that radio was a kind of advertising. The
9427 recording artist thus benefited because by playing her music, the radio
9428 station was making it more likely that her records would be purchased.
9429 Thus, the recording artist got something, even if only indirectly.
9431 this reasoning had less to do with the result than with the power
9432 of radio stations: Their lobbyists were quite good at stopping any
9434 to get Congress to require compensation to the recording artists.
9437 Enter Internet radio. Like regular radio, Internet radio is a
9439 to stream content from a broadcaster to a listener. The broadcast
9440 travels across the Internet, not across the ether of radio spectrum.
9441 Thus, I can "tune in" to an Internet radio station in Berlin while sitting
9442 in San Francisco, even though there's no way for me to tune in to a
9444 radio station much beyond the San Francisco metropolitan area.
9447 This feature of the architecture of Internet radio means that there
9448 are potentially an unlimited number of radio stations that a user could
9449 tune in to using her computer, whereas under the existing architecture
9450 for broadcast radio, there is an obvious limit to the number of
9452 and clear broadcast frequencies. Internet radio could therefore
9453 be more competitive than regular radio; it could provide a wider range
9454 of selections. And because the potential audience for Internet radio is
9455 the whole world, niche stations could easily develop and market their
9456 content to a relatively large number of users worldwide. According to
9457 some estimates, more than eighty million users worldwide have tuned
9458 in to this new form of radio.
9462 <!-- PAGE BREAK 205 -->
9463 Internet radio is thus to radio what FM was to AM. It is an
9465 potentially vastly more significant than the FM
9467 over AM, since not only is the technology better, so, too, is the
9468 competition. Indeed, there is a direct parallel between the fight to
9470 FM radio and the fight to protect Internet radio. As one author
9471 describes Howard Armstrong's struggle to enable FM radio,
9475 An almost unlimited number of FM stations was possible in the
9476 shortwaves, thus ending the unnatural restrictions imposed on
9478 in the crowded longwaves. If FM were freely developed, the
9479 number of stations would be limited only by economics and
9481 rather than by technical restrictions. . . . Armstrong
9482 likened the situation that had grown up in radio to that following
9483 the invention of the printing press, when governments and ruling
9484 interests attempted to control this new instrument of mass
9486 by imposing restrictive licenses on it. This tyranny
9487 was broken only when it became possible for men freely to
9489 printing presses and freely to run them. FM in this sense
9490 was as great an invention as the printing presses, for it gave radio
9491 the opportunity to strike off its shackles.
<footnote><para>
9492 <!-- f12. --> Lessing,
239.
9497 This potential for FM radio was never realized
—not because
9499 was wrong about the technology, but because he underestimated
9500 the power of "vested interests, habits, customs and legislation"
<footnote><para>
9501 <!-- f13. --> Ibid.,
229.
9505 the growth of this competing technology.
9508 Now the very same claim could be made about Internet radio. For
9509 again, there is no technical limitation that could restrict the number of
9510 Internet radio stations. The only restrictions on Internet radio are
9511 those imposed by the law. Copyright law is one such law. So the first
9512 question we should ask is, what copyright rules would govern Internet
9516 But here the power of the lobbyists is reversed. Internet radio is a
9517 new industry. The recording artists, on the other hand, have a very
9519 <!-- PAGE BREAK 206 -->
9520 powerful lobby, the RIAA. Thus when Congress considered the
9522 of Internet radio in
1995, the lobbyists had primed Congress
9523 to adopt a different rule for Internet radio than the rule that applies to
9524 terrestrial radio. While terrestrial radio does not have to pay our
9526 Marilyn Monroe when it plays her hypothetical recording of
9527 "Happy Birthday" on the air, Internet radio does. Not only is the law not
9528 neutral toward Internet radio
—the law actually burdens Internet radio
9529 more than it burdens terrestrial radio.
9532 This financial burden is not slight. As Harvard law professor
9533 William Fisher estimates, if an Internet radio station distributed adfree
9534 popular music to (on average) ten thousand listeners, twenty-four
9535 hours a day, the total artist fees that radio station would owe would be
9536 over $
1 million a year.
<footnote>
9537 <indexterm><primary>CARP (Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panel)
</primary></indexterm>
9540 This example was derived from fees set by the original Copyright
9541 Arbitration Royalty Panel (CARP) proceedings, and is drawn from an
9542 example offered by Professor William Fisher. Conference Proceedings,
9543 iLaw (Stanford),
3 July
2003, on file with author. Professors Fisher
9544 and Zittrain submitted testimony in the CARP proceeding that was
9545 ultimately rejected. See Jonathan Zittrain, Digital Performance Right
9546 in Sound Recordings and Ephemeral Recordings, Docket No.
2000-
9, CARP
9547 DTRA
1 and
2, available at
9548 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
45</ulink>.
9549 For an excellent analysis making a similar point, see Randal
9550 C. Picker, "Copyright as Entry Policy: The Case of Digital
9551 Distribution," Antitrust Bulletin (Summer/Fall
2002):
461: "This was
9552 not confusion, these are just old-fashioned entry barriers. Analog
9553 radio stations are protected from digital entrants, reducing entry in
9554 radio and diversity. Yes, this is done in the name of getting
9555 royalties to copyright holders, but, absent the play of powerful
9556 interests, that could have been done in a media-neutral way."
9558 A regular radio station broadcasting the same content would pay no
9562 The burden is not financial only. Under the original rules that were
9563 proposed, an Internet radio station (but not a terrestrial radio station)
9564 would have to collect the following data from every listening transaction:
9566 <!-- PAGE BREAK 207 -->
9567 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
9569 name of the service;
9572 channel of the program (AM/FM stations use station ID);
9575 type of program (archived/looped/live);
9578 date of transmission;
9581 time of transmission;
9584 time zone of origination of transmission;
9587 numeric designation of the place of the sound recording within the program;
9590 duration of transmission (to nearest second);
9593 sound recording title;
9596 ISRC code of the recording;
9599 release year of the album per copyright notice and in the case of compilation albums, the release year of the album and copy- right date of the track;
9602 featured recording artist;
9611 UPC code of the retail album;
9617 copyright owner information;
9620 musical genre of the channel or program (station format);
9623 name of the service or entity;
9629 date and time that the user logged in (in the user's time zone);
9632 date and time that the user logged out (in the user's time zone);
9635 time zone where the signal was received (user);
9638 Unique User identifier;
9641 the country in which the user received the transmissions.
9646 The Librarian of Congress eventually suspended these reporting
9647 requirements, pending further study. And he also changed the original
9648 rates set by the arbitration panel charged with setting rates. But the
9649 basic difference between Internet radio and terrestrial radio remains:
9650 Internet radio has to pay a type of copyright fee that terrestrial radio
9654 Why? What justifies this difference? Was there any study of the
9655 economic consequences from Internet radio that would justify these
9656 differences? Was the motive to protect artists against piracy?
9658 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
9660 In a rare bit of candor, one RIAA expert admitted what seemed obvious
9661 to everyone at the time. As Alex Alben, vice president for Public
9662 Policy at Real Networks, told me,
9666 The RIAA, which was representing the record labels, presented
9667 some testimony about what they thought a willing buyer would
9668 pay to a willing seller, and it was much higher. It was ten times
9669 higher than what radio stations pay to perform the same songs for
9670 the same period of time. And so the attorneys representing the
9671 webcasters asked the RIAA, . . . "How do you come up with a
9673 <!-- PAGE BREAK 208 -->
9674 rate that's so much higher? Why is it worth more than radio?
9676 here we have hundreds of thousands of webcasters who
9677 want to pay, and that should establish the market rate, and if you
9678 set the rate so high, you're going to drive the small webcasters out
9682 And the RIAA experts said, "Well, we don't really model this
9683 as an industry with thousands of webcasters, we think it should be
9684 an industry with, you know, five or seven big players who can pay a
9685 high rate and it's a stable, predictable market." (Emphasis added.)
9689 Translation: The aim is to use the law to eliminate competition, so
9690 that this platform of potentially immense competition, which would
9691 cause the diversity and range of content available to explode, would not
9692 cause pain to the dinosaurs of old. There is no one, on either the right
9693 or the left, who should endorse this use of the law. And yet there is
9694 practically no one, on either the right or the left, who is doing anything
9695 effective to prevent it.
9698 <sect2 id=
"corruptingcitizens">
9699 <title>Corrupting Citizens
</title>
9701 Overregulation stifles creativity. It smothers innovation. It gives
9703 a veto over the future. It wastes the extraordinary opportunity
9704 for a democratic creativity that digital technology enables.
9707 In addition to these important harms, there is one more that was
9708 important to our forebears, but seems forgotten today. Overregulation
9709 corrupts citizens and weakens the rule of law.
9712 The war that is being waged today is a war of prohibition. As with
9713 every war of prohibition, it is targeted against the behavior of a very
9714 large number of citizens. According to The New York Times,
43 million
9715 Americans downloaded music in May
2002.
<footnote><para>
9716 <!-- f15. --> Mike Graziano and Lee Rainie, "The Music Downloading Deluge," Pew
9717 Internet and American Life Project (
24 April
2001), available at
9718 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
46</ulink>.
9719 The Pew Internet and American Life Project reported that
37 million
9720 Americans had downloaded music files from the Internet by early
2001.
9722 According to the RIAA,
9723 the behavior of those
43 million Americans is a felony. We thus have a
9724 set of rules that transform
20 percent of America into criminals. As the
9726 <!-- PAGE BREAK 209 -->
9727 RIAA launches lawsuits against not only the Napsters and Kazaas of
9728 the world, but against students building search engines, and
9730 against ordinary users downloading content, the technologies for
9731 sharing will advance to further protect and hide illegal use. It is an arms
9732 race or a civil war, with the extremes of one side inviting a more
9734 response by the other.
9737 The content industry's tactics exploit the failings of the American
9738 legal system. When the RIAA brought suit against Jesse Jordan, it
9739 knew that in Jordan it had found a scapegoat, not a defendant. The
9740 threat of having to pay either all the money in the world in damages
9741 ($
15,
000,
000) or almost all the money in the world to defend against
9742 paying all the money in the world in damages ($
250,
000 in legal fees)
9743 led Jordan to choose to pay all the money he had in the world
9744 ($
12,
000) to make the suit go away. The same strategy animates the
9745 RIAA's suits against individual users. In September
2003, the RIAA
9746 sued
261 individuals
—including a twelve-year-old girl living in public
9747 housing and a seventy-year-old man who had no idea what file sharing
9748 was.
<footnote><para>
9750 Alex Pham, "The Labels Strike Back: N.Y. Girl Settles RIAA Case," Los
9751 Angeles Times,
10 September
2003, Business.
9753 As these scapegoats discovered, it will always cost more to defend
9754 against these suits than it would cost to simply settle. (The twelve
9755 year old, for example, like Jesse Jordan, paid her life savings of $
2,
000
9756 to settle the case.) Our law is an awful system for defending rights. It
9757 is an embarrassment to our tradition. And the consequence of our law
9758 as it is, is that those with the power can use the law to quash any rights
9762 Wars of prohibition are nothing new in America. This one is just
9763 something more extreme than anything we've seen before. We
9764 experimented with alcohol prohibition, at a time when the per capita
9765 consumption of alcohol was
1.5 gallons per capita per year. The war
9766 against drinking initially reduced that consumption to just
30 percent
9767 of its preprohibition levels, but by the end of prohibition,
9768 consumption was up to
70 percent of the preprohibition
9769 level. Americans were drinking just about as much, but now, a vast
9770 number were criminals.
<footnote><para>
9772 Jeffrey A. Miron and Jeffrey Zwiebel, "Alcohol Consumption During
9773 Prohibition," American Economic Review
81, no.
2 (
1991):
242.
9776 <!-- PAGE BREAK 210 -->
9777 launched a war on drugs aimed at reducing the consumption of regulated
9778 narcotics that
7 percent (or
16 million) Americans now use.
<footnote><para>
9780 National Drug Control Policy: Hearing Before the House Government
9781 Reform Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st sess. (
5 March
2003) (statement of
9782 John P. Walters, director of National Drug Control Policy).
9784 That is a drop from the high (so to speak) in
1979 of
14 percent of
9785 the population. We regulate automobiles to the point where the vast
9786 majority of Americans violate the law every day. We run such a complex
9787 tax system that a majority of cash businesses regularly
9788 cheat.
<footnote><para>
9790 See James Andreoni, Brian Erard, and Jonathon Feinstein, "Tax
9791 Compliance," Journal of Economic Literature
36 (
1998):
818 (survey of
9792 compliance literature).
9794 We pride ourselves on our "free society," but an endless array of
9795 ordinary behavior is regulated within our society. And as a result, a
9796 huge proportion of Americans regularly violate at least some law.
9799 This state of affairs is not without consequence. It is a particularly
9800 salient issue for teachers like me, whose job it is to teach law
9801 students about the importance of "ethics." As my colleague Charlie
9802 Nesson told a class at Stanford, each year law schools admit thousands
9803 of students who have illegally downloaded music, illegally consumed
9804 alcohol and sometimes drugs, illegally worked without paying taxes,
9805 illegally driven cars. These are kids for whom behaving illegally is
9806 increasingly the norm. And then we, as law professors, are supposed to
9807 teach them how to behave ethically
—how to say no to bribes, or
9808 keep client funds separate, or honor a demand to disclose a document
9809 that will mean that your case is over. Generations of
9810 Americans
—more significantly in some parts of America than in
9811 others, but still, everywhere in America today
—can't live their
9812 lives both normally and legally, since "normally" entails a certain
9813 degree of illegality.
9816 The response to this general illegality is either to enforce the law
9817 more severely or to change the law. We, as a society, have to learn
9818 how to make that choice more rationally. Whether a law makes sense
9819 depends, in part, at least, upon whether the costs of the law, both
9820 intended and collateral, outweigh the benefits. If the costs, intended
9821 and collateral, do outweigh the benefits, then the law ought to be
9822 changed. Alternatively, if the costs of the existing system are much
9823 greater than the costs of an alternative, then we have a good reason
9824 to consider the alternative.
9828 <!-- PAGE BREAK 211 -->
9829 My point is not the idiotic one: Just because people violate a law, we
9830 should therefore repeal it. Obviously, we could reduce murder statistics
9831 dramatically by legalizing murder on Wednesdays and Fridays. But
9832 that wouldn't make any sense, since murder is wrong every day of the
9833 week. A society is right to ban murder always and everywhere.
9836 My point is instead one that democracies understood for generations,
9837 but that we recently have learned to forget. The rule of law depends
9838 upon people obeying the law. The more often, and more repeatedly, we
9839 as citizens experience violating the law, the less we respect the
9840 law. Obviously, in most cases, the important issue is the law, not
9841 respect for the law. I don't care whether the rapist respects the law
9842 or not; I want to catch and incarcerate the rapist. But I do care
9843 whether my students respect the law. And I do care if the rules of law
9844 sow increasing disrespect because of the extreme of regulation they
9845 impose. Twenty million Americans have come of age since the Internet
9846 introduced this different idea of "sharing." We need to be able to
9847 call these twenty million Americans "citizens," not "felons."
9850 When at least forty-three million citizens download content from the
9851 Internet, and when they use tools to combine that content in ways
9852 unauthorized by copyright holders, the first question we should be
9853 asking is not how best to involve the FBI. The first question should
9854 be whether this particular prohibition is really necessary in order to
9855 achieve the proper ends that copyright law serves. Is there another
9856 way to assure that artists get paid without transforming forty-three
9857 million Americans into felons? Does it make sense if there are other
9858 ways to assure that artists get paid without transforming America into
9862 This abstract point can be made more clear with a particular example.
9865 We all own CDs. Many of us still own phonograph records. These pieces
9866 of plastic encode music that in a certain sense we have bought. The
9867 law protects our right to buy and sell that plastic: It is not a
9868 copyright infringement for me to sell all my classical records at a
9871 <!-- PAGE BREAK 212 -->
9872 record store and buy jazz records to replace them. That "use" of the
9876 But as the MP3 craze has demonstrated, there is another use of
9877 phonograph records that is effectively free. Because these recordings
9878 were made without copy-protection technologies, I am "free" to copy,
9879 or "rip," music from my records onto a computer hard disk. Indeed,
9880 Apple Corporation went so far as to suggest that "freedom" was a
9881 right: In a series of commercials, Apple endorsed the "Rip, Mix, Burn"
9882 capacities of digital technologies.
9884 <indexterm><primary>Adromeda
</primary></indexterm>
9886 This "use" of my records is certainly valuable. I have begun a large
9887 process at home of ripping all of my and my wife's CDs, and storing
9888 them in one archive. Then, using Apple's iTunes, or a wonderful
9889 program called Andromeda, we can build different play lists of our
9890 music: Bach, Baroque, Love Songs, Love Songs of Significant
9891 Others
—the potential is endless. And by reducing the costs of
9892 mixing play lists, these technologies help build a creativity with
9893 play lists that is itself independently valuable. Compilations of
9894 songs are creative and meaningful in their own right.
9897 This use is enabled by unprotected media
—either CDs or records.
9898 But unprotected media also enable file sharing. File sharing threatens
9899 (or so the content industry believes) the ability of creators to earn
9900 a fair return from their creativity. And thus, many are beginning to
9901 experiment with technologies to eliminate unprotected media. These
9902 technologies, for example, would enable CDs that could not be
9903 ripped. Or they might enable spy programs to identify ripped content
9904 on people's machines.
9907 If these technologies took off, then the building of large archives of
9908 your own music would become quite difficult. You might hang in hacker
9909 circles, and get technology to disable the technologies that protect
9910 the content. Trading in those technologies is illegal, but maybe that
9911 doesn't bother you much. In any case, for the vast majority of people,
9912 these protection technologies would effectively destroy the archiving
9914 <!-- PAGE BREAK 213 -->
9915 use of CDs. The technology, in other words, would force us all back to
9916 the world where we either listened to music by manipulating pieces of
9917 plastic or were part of a massively complex "digital rights
9921 If the only way to assure that artists get paid were the elimination
9922 of the ability to freely move content, then these technologies to
9923 interfere with the freedom to move content would be justifiable. But
9924 what if there were another way to assure that artists are paid,
9925 without locking down any content? What if, in other words, a different
9926 system could assure compensation to artists while also preserving the
9927 freedom to move content easily?
9930 My point just now is not to prove that there is such a system. I offer
9931 a version of such a system in the last chapter of this book. For now,
9932 the only point is the relatively uncontroversial one: If a different
9933 system achieved the same legitimate objectives that the existing
9934 copyright system achieved, but left consumers and creators much more
9935 free, then we'd have a very good reason to pursue this
9936 alternative
—namely, freedom. The choice, in other words, would
9937 not be between property and piracy; the choice would be between
9938 different property systems and the freedoms each allowed.
9941 I believe there is a way to assure that artists are paid without
9942 turning forty-three million Americans into felons. But the salient
9943 feature of this alternative is that it would lead to a very different
9944 market for producing and distributing creativity. The dominant few,
9945 who today control the vast majority of the distribution of content in
9946 the world, would no longer exercise this extreme of control. Rather,
9947 they would go the way of the horse-drawn buggy.
9950 Except that this generation's buggy manufacturers have already saddled
9951 Congress, and are riding the law to protect themselves against this
9952 new form of competition. For them the choice is between fortythree
9953 million Americans as criminals and their own survival.
9956 It is understandable why they choose as they do. It is not
9957 understandable why we as a democracy continue to choose as we do. Jack
9959 <!-- PAGE BREAK 214 -->
9961 Valenti is charming; but not so charming as to justify giving up a
9962 tradition as deep and important as our tradition of free culture.
9963 There's one more aspect to this corruption that is particularly
9964 important to civil liberties, and follows directly from any war of
9965 prohibition. As Electronic Frontier Foundation attorney Fred von
9966 Lohmann describes, this is the "collateral damage" that "arises
9967 whenever you turn a very large percentage of the population into
9968 criminals." This is the collateral damage to civil liberties
9972 "If you can treat someone as a putative lawbreaker," von Lohmann
9977 then all of a sudden a lot of basic civil liberty protections
9978 evaporate to one degree or another. . . . If you're a copyright
9979 infringer, how can you hope to have any privacy rights? If you're a
9980 copyright infringer, how can you hope to be secure against seizures of
9981 your computer? How can you hope to continue to receive Internet
9982 access? . . . Our sensibilities change as soon as we think, "Oh, well,
9983 but that person's a criminal, a lawbreaker." Well, what this campaign
9984 against file sharing has done is turn a remarkable percentage of the
9985 American Internet-using population into "lawbreakers."
9989 And the consequence of this transformation of the American public
9990 into criminals is that it becomes trivial, as a matter of due process, to
9991 effectively erase much of the privacy most would presume.
9994 Users of the Internet began to see this generally in
2003 as the RIAA
9995 launched its campaign to force Internet service providers to turn over
9996 the names of customers who the RIAA believed were violating copyright
9997 law. Verizon fought that demand and lost. With a simple request to a
9998 judge, and without any notice to the customer at all, the identity of
9999 an Internet user is revealed.
10002 <!-- PAGE BREAK 215 -->
10003 The RIAA then expanded this campaign, by announcing a general strategy
10004 to sue individual users of the Internet who are alleged to have
10005 downloaded copyrighted music from file-sharing systems. But as we've
10006 seen, the potential damages from these suits are astronomical: If a
10007 family's computer is used to download a single CD's worth of music,
10008 the family could be liable for $
2 million in damages. That didn't stop
10009 the RIAA from suing a number of these families, just as they had sued
10010 Jesse Jordan.
<footnote><para>
10012 See Frank Ahrens, "RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised Targets; Single
10013 Mother in Calif.,
12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among Defendants,"
10014 Washington Post,
10 September
2003, E1; Chris Cobbs, "Worried Parents
10015 Pull Plug on File `Stealing'; With the Music Industry Cracking Down on
10016 File Swapping, Parents are Yanking Software from Home PCs to Avoid
10017 Being Sued," Orlando Sentinel Tribune,
30 August
2003, C1; Jefferson
10018 Graham, "Recording Industry Sues Parents," USA Today,
15 September
10019 2003,
4D; John Schwartz, "She Says She's No Music Pirate. No Snoop
10020 Fan, Either," New York Times,
25 September
2003, C1; Margo Varadi, "Is
10021 Brianna a Criminal?" Toronto Star,
18 September
2003, P7.
10026 Even this understates the espionage that is being waged by the
10027 RIAA. A report from CNN late last summer described a strategy the
10028 RIAA had adopted to track Napster users.
<footnote><para>
10030 See "Revealed: How RIAA Tracks Downloaders: Music Industry Discloses
10031 Some Methods Used," CNN.com, available at
10032 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
47</ulink>.
10034 Using a sophisticated hashing algorithm, the RIAA took what is in
10035 effect a fingerprint of every song in the Napster catalog. Any copy of
10036 one of those MP3s will have the same "fingerprint."
10039 So imagine the following not-implausible scenario: Imagine a
10040 friend gives a CD to your daughter
—a collection of songs just
10041 like the cassettes you used to make as a kid. You don't know, and
10042 neither does your daughter, where these songs came from. But she
10043 copies these songs onto her computer. She then takes her computer to
10044 college and connects it to a college network, and if the college
10045 network is "cooperating" with the RIAA's espionage, and she hasn't
10046 properly protected her content from the network (do you know how to do
10047 that yourself ?), then the RIAA will be able to identify your daughter
10048 as a "criminal." And under the rules that universities are beginning
10049 to deploy,
<footnote><para>
10051 See Jeff Adler, "Cambridge: On Campus, Pirates Are Not Penitent,"
10052 Boston Globe,
18 May
2003, City Weekly,
1; Frank Ahrens, "Four
10053 Students Sued over Music Sites; Industry Group Targets File Sharing at
10054 Colleges," Washington Post,
4 April
2003, E1; Elizabeth Armstrong,
10055 "Students `Rip, Mix, Burn' at Their Own Risk," Christian Science
10056 Monitor,
2 September
2003,
20; Robert Becker and Angela Rozas, "Music
10057 Pirate Hunt Turns to Loyola; Two Students Names Are Handed Over;
10058 Lawsuit Possible," Chicago Tribune,
16 July
2003,
1C; Beth Cox, "RIAA
10059 Trains Antipiracy Guns on Universities," Internet News,
30 January
10060 2003, available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
10061 #
48</ulink>; Benny Evangelista, "Download Warning
101: Freshman
10062 Orientation This Fall to Include Record Industry Warnings Against File
10063 Sharing," San Francisco Chronicle,
11 August
2003, E11; "Raid, Letters
10064 Are Weapons at Universities," USA Today,
26 September
2000,
3D.
10066 your daughter can lose the right to use the university's computer
10067 network. She can, in some cases, be expelled.
10070 Now, of course, she'll have the right to defend herself. You can hire
10071 a lawyer for her (at $
300 per hour, if you're lucky), and she can
10072 plead that she didn't know anything about the source of the songs or
10073 that they came from Napster. And it may well be that the university
10074 believes her. But the university might not believe her. It might treat
10075 this "contraband" as presumptive of guilt. And as any number of
10078 <!-- PAGE BREAK 216 -->
10079 have already learned, our presumptions about innocence disappear in
10080 the middle of wars of prohibition. This war is no different.
10085 So when we're talking about numbers like forty to sixty million
10086 Americans that are essentially copyright infringers, you create a
10087 situation where the civil liberties of those people are very much in
10088 peril in a general matter. [I don't] think [there is any] analog where
10089 you could randomly choose any person off the street and be confident
10090 that they were committing an unlawful act that could put them on the
10091 hook for potential felony liability or hundreds of millions of dollars
10092 of civil liability. Certainly we all speed, but speeding isn't the
10093 kind of an act for which we routinely forfeit civil liberties. Some
10094 people use drugs, and I think that's the closest analog, [but] many
10095 have noted that the war against drugs has eroded all of our civil
10096 liberties because it's treated so many Americans as criminals. Well, I
10097 think it's fair to say that file sharing is an order of magnitude
10098 larger number of Americans than drug use. . . . If forty to sixty
10099 million Americans have become lawbreakers, then we're really on a
10100 slippery slope to lose a lot of civil liberties for all forty to sixty
10105 When forty to sixty million Americans are considered "criminals" under
10106 the law, and when the law could achieve the same objective
—
10107 securing rights to authors
—without these millions being
10108 considered "criminals," who is the villain? Americans or the law?
10109 Which is American, a constant war on our own people or a concerted
10110 effort through our democracy to change our law?
10113 <!-- PAGE BREAK 217 -->
10117 <chapter id=
"c-balances">
10118 <title>BALANCES
</title>
10120 <!-- PAGE BREAK 218 -->
10122 So here's the picture: You're standing at the side of the road. Your
10123 car is on fire. You are angry and upset because in part you helped start
10124 the fire. Now you don't know how to put it out. Next to you is a bucket,
10125 filled with gasoline. Obviously, gasoline won't put the fire out.
10128 As you ponder the mess, someone else comes along. In a panic, she
10129 grabs the bucket. Before you have a chance to tell her to
10130 stop
—or before she understands just why she should
10131 stop
—the bucket is in the air. The gasoline is about to hit the
10132 blazing car. And the fire that gasoline will ignite is about to ignite
10136 A war about copyright rages all around
—and we're all focusing on
10137 the wrong thing. No doubt, current technologies threaten existing
10138 businesses. No doubt they may threaten artists. But technologies
10139 change. The industry and technologists have plenty of ways to use
10140 technology to protect themselves against the current threats of the
10141 Internet. This is a fire that if let alone would burn itself out.
10144 <!-- PAGE BREAK 219 -->
10145 Yet policy makers are not willing to leave this fire to itself. Primed
10146 with plenty of lobbyists' money, they are keen to intervene to
10147 eliminate the problem they perceive. But the problem they perceive is
10148 not the real threat this culture faces. For while we watch this small
10149 fire in the corner, there is a massive change in the way culture is
10150 made that is happening all around.
10153 Somehow we have to find a way to turn attention to this more important
10154 and fundamental issue. Somehow we have to find a way to avoid pouring
10155 gasoline onto this fire.
10158 We have not found that way yet. Instead, we seem trapped in a simpler,
10159 binary view. However much many people push to frame this debate more
10160 broadly, it is the simple, binary view that remains. We rubberneck to
10161 look at the fire when we should be keeping our eyes on the road.
10164 This challenge has been my life these last few years. It has also been
10165 my failure. In the two chapters that follow, I describe one small
10166 brace of efforts, so far failed, to find a way to refocus this
10167 debate. We must understand these failures if we're to understand what
10168 success will require.
10171 <!-- PAGE BREAK 220 -->
10172 <sect1 id=
"eldred">
10173 <title>CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred
</title>
10175 In
1995, a father was frustrated that his daughters didn't seem to
10176 like Hawthorne. No doubt there was more than one such father, but at
10177 least one did something about it. Eric Eldred, a retired computer
10178 programmer living in New Hampshire, decided to put Hawthorne on the
10179 Web. An electronic version, Eldred thought, with links to pictures and
10180 explanatory text, would make this nineteenth-century author's work
10184 It didn't work
—at least for his daughters. They didn't find
10185 Hawthorne any more interesting than before. But Eldred's experiment
10186 gave birth to a hobby, and his hobby begat a cause: Eldred would build
10187 a library of public domain works by scanning these works and making
10188 them available for free.
10191 Eldred's library was not simply a copy of certain public domain
10192 works, though even a copy would have been of great value to people
10193 across the world who can't get access to printed versions of these
10194 works. Instead, Eldred was producing derivative works from these
10195 public domain works. Just as Disney turned Grimm into stories more
10196 <!-- PAGE BREAK 221 -->
10197 accessible to the twentieth century, Eldred transformed Hawthorne, and
10198 many others, into a form more accessible
—technically
10199 accessible
—today.
10202 Eldred's freedom to do this with Hawthorne's work grew from the same
10203 source as Disney's. Hawthorne's Scarlet Letter had passed into the
10204 public domain in
1907. It was free for anyone to take without the
10205 permission of the Hawthorne estate or anyone else. Some, such as Dover
10206 Press and Penguin Classics, take works from the public domain and
10207 produce printed editions, which they sell in bookstores across the
10208 country. Others, such as Disney, take these stories and turn them into
10209 animated cartoons, sometimes successfully (Cinderella), sometimes not
10210 (The Hunchback of Notre Dame, Treasure Planet). These are all
10211 commercial publications of public domain works.
10214 The Internet created the possibility of noncommercial publications of
10215 public domain works. Eldred's is just one example. There are literally
10216 thousands of others. Hundreds of thousands from across the world have
10217 discovered this platform of expression and now use it to share works
10218 that are, by law, free for the taking. This has produced what we might
10219 call the "noncommercial publishing industry," which before the
10220 Internet was limited to people with large egos or with political or
10221 social causes. But with the Internet, it includes a wide range of
10222 individuals and groups dedicated to spreading culture
10223 generally.
<footnote><para>
10225 There's a parallel here with pornography that is a bit hard to
10226 describe, but it's a strong one. One phenomenon that the Internet
10227 created was a world of noncommercial pornographers
—people who
10228 were distributing porn but were not making money directly or
10229 indirectly from that distribution. Such a class didn't exist before
10230 the Internet came into being because the costs of distributing porn
10231 were so high. Yet this new class of distributors got special attention
10232 in the Supreme Court, when the Court struck down the Communications
10233 Decency Act of
1996. It was partly because of the burden on
10234 noncommercial speakers that the statute was found to exceed Congress's
10235 power. The same point could have been made about noncommercial
10236 publishers after the advent of the Internet. The Eric Eldreds of the
10237 world before the Internet were extremely few. Yet one would think it
10238 at least as important to protect the Eldreds of the world as to
10239 protect noncommercial pornographers.
</para></footnote>
10242 As I said, Eldred lives in New Hampshire. In
1998, Robert Frost's
10243 collection of poems New Hampshire was slated to pass into the public
10244 domain. Eldred wanted to post that collection in his free public
10245 library. But Congress got in the way. As I described in chapter
10,
10246 in
1998, for the eleventh time in forty years, Congress extended the
10247 terms of existing copyrights
—this time by twenty years. Eldred
10248 would not be free to add any works more recent than
1923 to his
10249 collection until
2019. Indeed, no copyrighted work would pass into
10250 the public domain until that year (and not even then, if Congress
10251 extends the term again). By contrast, in the same period, more than
1
10252 million patents will pass into the public domain.
10256 <!-- PAGE BREAK 222 -->
10257 This was the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act
10258 (CTEA), enacted in memory of the congressman and former musician
10259 Sonny Bono, who, his widow, Mary Bono, says, believed that
10260 "copyrights should be forever."
<footnote><para>
10262 The full text is: "Sonny [Bono] wanted the term of copyright
10263 protection to last forever. I am informed by staff that such a change
10264 would violate the Constitution. I invite all of you to work with me to
10265 strengthen our copyright laws in all of the ways available to us. As
10266 you know, there is also Jack Valenti's proposal for a term to last
10267 forever less one day. Perhaps the Committee may look at that next
10268 Congress,"
144 Cong. Rec. H9946,
9951-
2 (October
7,
1998).
10273 Eldred decided to fight this law. He first resolved to fight it through
10274 civil disobedience. In a series of interviews, Eldred announced that he
10275 would publish as planned, CTEA notwithstanding. But because of a
10276 second law passed in
1998, the NET (No Electronic Theft) Act, his act
10277 of publishing would make Eldred a felon
—whether or not anyone
10278 complained. This was a dangerous strategy for a disabled programmer
10282 It was here that I became involved in Eldred's battle. I was a
10284 scholar whose first passion was constitutional
10286 And though constitutional law courses never focus upon the
10287 Progress Clause of the Constitution, it had always struck me as
10289 different. As you know, the Constitution says,
10293 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science . . .
10294 by securing for limited Times to Authors . . . exclusive Right to
10295 their . . . Writings. . . .
10299 As I've described, this clause is unique within the power-granting
10300 clause of Article I, section
8 of our Constitution. Every other clause
10301 granting power to Congress simply says Congress has the power to do
10302 something
—for example, to regulate "commerce among the several
10303 states" or "declare War." But here, the "something" is something quite
10305 "promote . . . Progress"
—through means that are also specific
—
10306 by "securing" "exclusive Rights" (i.e., copyrights) "for limited Times."
10309 In the past forty years, Congress has gotten into the practice of
10311 existing terms of copyright protection. What puzzled me
10312 about this was, if Congress has the power to extend existing terms,
10313 then the Constitution's requirement that terms be "limited" will have
10314 <!-- PAGE BREAK 223 -->
10315 no practical effect. If every time a copyright is about to expire,
10317 has the power to extend its term, then Congress can achieve what
10318 the Constitution plainly forbids
—perpetual terms "on the installment
10319 plan," as Professor Peter Jaszi so nicely put it.
10322 As an academic, my first response was to hit the books. I remember
10323 sitting late at the office, scouring on-line databases for any serious
10325 of the question. No one had ever challenged Congress's
10326 practice of extending existing terms. That failure may in part be why
10327 Congress seemed so untroubled in its habit. That, and the fact that the
10328 practice had become so lucrative for Congress. Congress knows that
10329 copyright owners will be willing to pay a great deal of money to see
10330 their copyright terms extended. And so Congress is quite happy to
10331 keep this gravy train going.
10334 For this is the core of the corruption in our present system of
10335 government. "Corruption" not in the sense that representatives are bribed.
10336 Rather, "corruption" in the sense that the system induces the
10338 of Congress's acts to raise and give money to Congress to induce
10339 it to act. There's only so much time; there's only so much Congress can
10340 do. Why not limit its actions to those things it must do
—and those
10341 things that pay? Extending copyright terms pays.
10344 If that's not obvious to you, consider the following: Say you're one
10345 of the very few lucky copyright owners whose copyright continues to
10346 make money one hundred years after it was created. The Estate of
10347 Robert Frost is a good example. Frost died in
1963. His poetry
10349 to be extraordinarily valuable. Thus the Robert Frost estate
10351 greatly from any extension of copyright, since no publisher would
10352 pay the estate any money if the poems Frost wrote could be published
10353 by anyone for free.
10356 So imagine the Robert Frost estate is earning $
100,
000 a year from
10357 three of Frost's poems. And imagine the copyright for those poems
10358 is about to expire. You sit on the board of the Robert Frost estate.
10359 Your financial adviser comes to your board meeting with a very grim
10363 "Next year," the adviser announces, "our copyrights in works A, B,
10365 <!-- PAGE BREAK 224 -->
10366 and C will expire. That means that after next year, we will no longer be
10367 receiving the annual royalty check of $
100,
000 from the publishers of
10371 "There's a proposal in Congress, however," she continues, "that
10372 could change this. A few congressmen are floating a bill to extend the
10373 terms of copyright by twenty years. That bill would be extraordinarily
10374 valuable to us. So we should hope this bill passes."
10377 "Hope?" a fellow board member says. "Can't we be doing something
10381 "Well, obviously, yes," the adviser responds. "We could contribute
10382 to the campaigns of a number of representatives to try to assure that
10383 they support the bill."
10386 You hate politics. You hate contributing to campaigns. So you want
10387 to know whether this disgusting practice is worth it. "How much
10388 would we get if this extension were passed?" you ask the adviser. "How
10392 "Well," the adviser says, "if you're confident that you will continue
10393 to get at least $
100,
000 a year from these copyrights, and you use the
10394 `discount rate' that we use to evaluate estate investments (
6 percent),
10395 then this law would be worth $
1,
146,
000 to the estate."
10398 You're a bit shocked by the number, but you quickly come to the
10399 correct conclusion:
10402 "So you're saying it would be worth it for us to pay more than
10403 $
1,
000,
000 in campaign contributions if we were confident those
10405 would assure that the bill was passed?"
10408 "Absolutely," the adviser responds. "It is worth it to you to
10410 up to the `present value' of the income you expect from these
10411 copyrights. Which for us means over $
1,
000,
000."
10414 You quickly get the point
—you as the member of the board and, I
10415 trust, you the reader. Each time copyrights are about to expire, every
10416 beneficiary in the position of the Robert Frost estate faces the same
10417 choice: If they can contribute to get a law passed to extend copyrights,
10418 <!-- PAGE BREAK 225 -->
10419 they will benefit greatly from that extension. And so each time
10421 are about to expire, there is a massive amount of lobbying to get
10422 the copyright term extended.
10425 Thus a congressional perpetual motion machine: So long as
10427 can be bought (albeit indirectly), there will be all the incentive in
10428 the world to buy further extensions of copyright.
10431 In the lobbying that led to the passage of the Sonny Bono
10433 Term Extension Act, this "theory" about incentives was proved
10434 real. Ten of the thirteen original sponsors of the act in the House
10435 received the maximum contribution from Disney's political action
10436 committee; in the Senate, eight of the twelve sponsors received
10437 contributions.
<footnote><para>
10438 <!-- f3. --> Associated Press, "Disney Lobbying for Copyright Extension No Mickey
10439 Mouse Effort; Congress OKs Bill Granting Creators
20 More Years,"
10440 Chicago Tribune,
17 October
1998,
22.
10442 The RIAA and the MPAA are estimated to have spent over
10443 $
1.5 million lobbying in the
1998 election cycle. They paid out more
10444 than $
200,
000 in campaign contributions.
<footnote><para>
10445 <!-- f4. --> See Nick Brown, "Fair Use No More?: Copyright in the Information
10447 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
49</ulink>.
10449 Disney is estimated to have
10450 contributed more than $
800,
000 to reelection campaigns in the
10451 cycle.
<footnote><para>
10452 <!-- f5. --> Alan K. Ota, "Disney in Washington: The Mouse That Roars,"
10454 Quarterly This Week,
8 August
1990, available at
10455 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
50</ulink>.
10460 Constitutional law is not oblivious to the obvious. Or at least,
10461 it need not be. So when I was considering Eldred's complaint, this
10463 about the never-ending incentives to increase the copyright term
10464 was central to my thinking. In my view, a pragmatic court committed
10465 to interpreting and applying the Constitution of our framers would see
10466 that if Congress has the power to extend existing terms, then there
10467 would be no effective constitutional requirement that terms be
10469 If they could extend it once, they would extend it again and again
10473 It was also my judgment that this Supreme Court would not allow
10474 Congress to extend existing terms. As anyone close to the Supreme
10475 Court's work knows, this Court has increasingly restricted the power
10476 of Congress when it has viewed Congress's actions as exceeding the
10477 power granted to it by the Constitution. Among constitutional
10479 the most famous example of this trend was the Supreme Court's
10481 <!-- PAGE BREAK 226 -->
10482 decision in
1995 to strike down a law that banned the possession of
10486 Since
1937, the Supreme Court had interpreted Congress's granted
10487 powers very broadly; so, while the Constitution grants Congress the
10488 power to regulate only "commerce among the several states" (aka
10490 commerce"), the Supreme Court had interpreted that power to
10491 include the power to regulate any activity that merely affected
10496 As the economy grew, this standard increasingly meant that there
10497 was no limit to Congress's power to regulate, since just about every
10499 when considered on a national scale, affects interstate commerce.
10500 A Constitution designed to limit Congress's power was instead
10502 to impose no limit.
10505 The Supreme Court, under Chief Justice Rehnquist's command,
10506 changed that in United States v. Lopez. The government had argued
10507 that possessing guns near schools affected interstate commerce. Guns
10508 near schools increase crime, crime lowers property values, and so on. In
10509 the oral argument, the Chief Justice asked the government whether
10510 there was any activity that would not affect interstate commerce under
10511 the reasoning the government advanced. The government said there
10512 was not; if Congress says an activity affects interstate commerce, then
10513 that activity affects interstate commerce. The Supreme Court, the
10515 said, was not in the position to second-guess Congress.
10518 "We pause to consider the implications of the government's
10520 the Chief Justice wrote.
<footnote><para>
10521 <!-- f6. --> United States v. Lopez,
514 U.S.
549,
564 (
1995).
10523 If anything Congress says is interstate
10524 commerce must therefore be considered interstate commerce, then
10525 there would be no limit to Congress's power. The decision in Lopez was
10526 reaffirmed five years later in United States v. Morrison.
<footnote><para>
10527 <!-- f7. --> United States v. Morrison,
529 U.S.
598 (
2000).
10532 If a principle were at work here, then it should apply to the Progress
10533 Clause as much as the Commerce Clause.
<footnote><para>
10534 <!-- f8. --> If it is a principle about enumerated powers, then the principle carries
10535 from one enumerated power to another. The animating point in the
10537 of the Commerce Clause was that the interpretation offered by the
10538 government would allow the government unending power to regulate
10539 commerce
—the limitation to interstate commerce notwithstanding. The
10540 same point is true in the context of the Copyright Clause. Here, too, the
10541 government's interpretation would allow the government unending power
10542 to regulate copyrights
—the limitation to "limited times" notwithstanding.
10544 And if it is applied to the
10545 Progress Clause, the principle should yield the conclusion that
10547 <!-- PAGE BREAK 227 -->
10548 can't extend an existing term. If Congress could extend an
10550 term, then there would be no "stopping point" to Congress's power
10551 over terms, though the Constitution expressly states that there is such
10552 a limit. Thus, the same principle applied to the power to grant
10554 should entail that Congress is not allowed to extend the term of
10555 existing copyrights.
10558 If, that is, the principle announced in Lopez stood for a principle.
10559 Many believed the decision in Lopez stood for politics
—a conservative
10560 Supreme Court, which believed in states' rights, using its power over
10561 Congress to advance its own personal political preferences. But I
10563 that view of the Supreme Court's decision. Indeed, shortly after
10564 the decision, I wrote an article demonstrating the "fidelity" in such an
10565 interpretation of the Constitution. The idea that the Supreme Court
10566 decides cases based upon its politics struck me as extraordinarily
10568 I was not going to devote my life to teaching constitutional law if
10569 these nine Justices were going to be petty politicians.
10572 Now let's pause for a moment to make sure we understand what
10573 the argument in Eldred was not about. By insisting on the
10575 limits to copyright, obviously Eldred was not endorsing piracy.
10576 Indeed, in an obvious sense, he was fighting a kind of piracy
—piracy of
10577 the public domain. When Robert Frost wrote his work and when Walt
10578 Disney created Mickey Mouse, the maximum copyright term was just
10579 fifty-six years. Because of interim changes, Frost and Disney had
10581 enjoyed a seventy-five-year monopoly for their work. They had
10582 gotten the benefit of the bargain that the Constitution envisions: In
10583 exchange for a monopoly protected for fifty-six years, they created new
10584 work. But now these entities were using their power
—expressed
10585 through the power of lobbyists' money
—to get another twenty-year
10586 dollop of monopoly. That twenty-year dollop would be taken from the
10587 public domain. Eric Eldred was fighting a piracy that affects us all.
10590 Some people view the public domain with contempt. In their brief
10592 <!-- PAGE BREAK 228 -->
10593 before the Supreme Court, the Nashville Songwriters Association
10594 wrote that the public domain is nothing more than "legal piracy."
<footnote><para>
10595 <!-- f9. --> Brief of the Nashville Songwriters Association, Eldred v. Ashcroft,
537 U.S.
10596 186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618), n
.10, available at
10597 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
51</ulink>.
10600 it is not piracy when the law allows it; and in our constitutional system,
10601 our law requires it. Some may not like the Constitution's requirements,
10602 but that doesn't make the Constitution a pirate's charter.
10605 As we've seen, our constitutional system requires limits on
10607 as a way to assure that copyright holders do not too heavily
10609 the development and distribution of our culture. Yet, as Eric
10610 Eldred discovered, we have set up a system that assures that copyright
10611 terms will be repeatedly extended, and extended, and extended. We
10612 have created the perfect storm for the public domain. Copyrights have
10613 not expired, and will not expire, so long as Congress is free to be
10614 bought to extend them again.
10617 It is valuable copyrights that are responsible for terms being
10619 Mickey Mouse and "Rhapsody in Blue." These works are too
10620 valuable for copyright owners to ignore. But the real harm to our
10622 from copyright extensions is not that Mickey Mouse remains
10624 Forget Mickey Mouse. Forget Robert Frost. Forget all the works
10625 from the
1920s and
1930s that have continuing commercial value. The
10626 real harm of term extension comes not from these famous works. The
10627 real harm is to the works that are not famous, not commercially
10629 and no longer available as a result.
10632 If you look at the work created in the first twenty years (
1923 to
10633 1942) affected by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act,
10634 2 percent of that work has any continuing commercial value. It was the
10635 copyright holders for that
2 percent who pushed the CTEA through.
10636 But the law and its effect were not limited to that
2 percent. The law
10637 extended the terms of copyright generally.
<footnote><para>
10638 <!-- f10. --> The figure of
2 percent is an extrapolation from the study by the
10640 Research Service, in light of the estimated renewal ranges. See Brief
10641 of Petitioners, Eldred v. Ashcroft,
7, available at
10642 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
52</ulink>.
10647 Think practically about the consequence of this
10648 extension
—practically,
10649 as a businessperson, and not as a lawyer eager for more legal
10651 <!-- PAGE BREAK 229 -->
10652 work. In
1930,
10,
047 books were published. In
2000,
174 of those
10653 books were still in print. Let's say you were Brewster Kahle, and you
10654 wanted to make available to the world in your iArchive project the
10656 9,
873. What would you have to do?
10659 Well, first, you'd have to determine which of the
9,
873 books were
10660 still under copyright. That requires going to a library (these data are
10661 not on-line) and paging through tomes of books, cross-checking the
10662 titles and authors of the
9,
873 books with the copyright registration
10663 and renewal records for works published in
1930. That will produce a
10664 list of books still under copyright.
10667 Then for the books still under copyright, you would need to locate
10668 the current copyright owners. How would you do that?
10671 Most people think that there must be a list of these copyright
10673 somewhere. Practical people think this way. How could there be
10674 thousands and thousands of government monopolies without there
10675 being at least a list?
10678 But there is no list. There may be a name from
1930, and then in
10679 1959, of the person who registered the copyright. But just think
10681 about how impossibly difficult it would be to track down
10683 of such records
—especially since the person who registered is
10684 not necessarily the current owner. And we're just talking about
1930!
10687 "But there isn't a list of who owns property generally," the
10689 for the system respond. "Why should there be a list of copyright
10693 Well, actually, if you think about it, there are plenty of lists of who
10694 owns what property. Think about deeds on houses, or titles to cars.
10695 And where there isn't a list, the code of real space is pretty good at
10697 who the owner of a bit of property is. (A swing set in your
10698 backyard is probably yours.) So formally or informally, we have a pretty
10699 good way to know who owns what tangible property.
10702 So: You walk down a street and see a house. You can know who
10703 owns the house by looking it up in the courthouse registry. If you see
10704 a car, there is ordinarily a license plate that will link the owner to the
10706 <!-- PAGE BREAK 230 -->
10707 car. If you see a bunch of children's toys sitting on the front lawn of a
10708 house, it's fairly easy to determine who owns the toys. And if you
10710 to see a baseball lying in a gutter on the side of the road, look
10711 around for a second for some kids playing ball. If you don't see any
10712 kids, then okay: Here's a bit of property whose owner we can't easily
10713 determine. It is the exception that proves the rule: that we ordinarily
10714 know quite well who owns what property.
10717 Compare this story to intangible property. You go into a library.
10718 The library owns the books. But who owns the copyrights? As I've
10720 described, there's no list of copyright owners. There are authors'
10721 names, of course, but their copyrights could have been assigned, or
10722 passed down in an estate like Grandma's old jewelry. To know who
10723 owns what, you would have to hire a private detective. The bottom
10724 line: The owner cannot easily be located. And in a regime like ours, in
10725 which it is a felony to use such property without the property owner's
10726 permission, the property isn't going to be used.
10729 The consequence with respect to old books is that they won't be
10730 digitized, and hence will simply rot away on shelves. But the
10732 for other creative works is much more dire.
10734 <indexterm><primary>Agee, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
10736 Consider the story of Michael Agee, chairman of Hal Roach Studios,
10737 which owns the copyrights for the Laurel and Hardy films. Agee is a
10738 direct beneficiary of the Bono Act. The Laurel and Hardy films were
10739 made between
1921 and
1951. Only one of these films, The Lucky Dog, is
10740 currently out of copyright. But for the CTEA, films made after
1923
10741 would have begun entering the public domain. Because Agee controls the
10742 exclusive rights for these popular films, he makes a great deal of
10743 money. According to one estimate, "Roach has sold about
60,
000
10744 videocassettes and
50,
000 DVDs of the duo's silent
10745 films."
<footnote><para>
10747 See David G. Savage, "High Court Scene of Showdown on Copyright Law,"
10748 Los Angeles Times,
6 October
2002; David Streitfeld, "Classic Movies,
10749 Songs, Books at Stake; Supreme Court Hears Arguments Today on Striking
10750 Down Copyright Extension," Orlando Sentinel Tribune,
9 October
2002.
10755 Yet Agee opposed the CTEA. His reasons demonstrate a rare virtue in
10756 this culture: selflessness. He argued in a brief before the Supreme
10757 Court that the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act will, if left
10758 standing, destroy a whole generation of American film.
10761 His argument is straightforward. A tiny fraction of this work has
10763 <!-- PAGE BREAK 231 -->
10764 any continuing commercial value. The rest
—to the extent it
10765 survives at all
—sits in vaults gathering dust. It may be that
10766 some of this work not now commercially valuable will be deemed to be
10767 valuable by the owners of the vaults. For this to occur, however, the
10768 commercial benefit from the work must exceed the costs of making the
10769 work available for distribution.
10772 We can't know the benefits, but we do know a lot about the costs.
10773 For most of the history of film, the costs of restoring film were very
10774 high; digital technology has lowered these costs substantially. While
10775 it cost more than $
10,
000 to restore a ninety-minute black-and-white
10776 film in
1993, it can now cost as little as $
100 to digitize one hour of
10777 mm film.
<footnote><para>
10778 <!-- f12. --> Brief of Hal Roach Studios and Michael Agee as Amicus Curiae
10780 the Petitoners, Eldred v. Ashcroft,
537 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
10781 618),
12. See also Brief of Amicus Curiae filed on behalf of Petitioners by
10782 the Internet Archive, Eldred v. Ashcroft, available at
10783 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
53</ulink>.
10788 Restoration technology is not the only cost, nor the most
10790 Lawyers, too, are a cost, and increasingly, a very important one. In
10791 addition to preserving the film, a distributor needs to secure the rights.
10792 And to secure the rights for a film that is under copyright, you need to
10793 locate the copyright owner.
10796 Or more accurately, owners. As we've seen, there isn't only a single
10797 copyright associated with a film; there are many. There isn't a single
10798 person whom you can contact about those copyrights; there are as
10799 many as can hold the rights, which turns out to be an extremely large
10800 number. Thus the costs of clearing the rights to these films is
10805 "But can't you just restore the film, distribute it, and then pay the
10806 copyright owner when she shows up?" Sure, if you want to commit a
10807 felony. And even if you're not worried about committing a felony, when
10808 she does show up, she'll have the right to sue you for all the profits you
10809 have made. So, if you're successful, you can be fairly confident you'll be
10810 getting a call from someone's lawyer. And if you're not successful, you
10811 won't make enough to cover the costs of your own lawyer. Either way,
10812 you have to talk to a lawyer. And as is too often the case, saying you have
10813 to talk to a lawyer is the same as saying you won't make any money.
10816 For some films, the benefit of releasing the film may well exceed
10818 <!-- PAGE BREAK 232 -->
10819 these costs. But for the vast majority of them, there is no way the
10821 would outweigh the legal costs. Thus, for the vast majority of old
10822 films, Agee argued, the film will not be restored and distributed until
10823 the copyright expires.
10826 But by the time the copyright for these films expires, the film will
10827 have expired. These films were produced on nitrate-based stock, and
10828 nitrate stock dissolves over time. They will be gone, and the metal
10830 in which they are now stored will be filled with nothing more
10834 Of all the creative work produced by humans anywhere, a tiny
10835 fraction has continuing commercial value. For that tiny fraction, the
10836 copyright is a crucially important legal device. For that tiny fraction,
10837 the copyright creates incentives to produce and distribute the
10839 work. For that tiny fraction, the copyright acts as an "engine of
10843 But even for that tiny fraction, the actual time during which the
10844 creative work has a commercial life is extremely short. As I've
10846 most books go out of print within one year. The same is true of
10847 music and film. Commercial culture is sharklike. It must keep moving.
10848 And when a creative work falls out of favor with the commercial
10850 the commercial life ends.
10853 Yet that doesn't mean the life of the creative work ends. We don't
10854 keep libraries of books in order to compete with Barnes
& Noble, and
10855 we don't have archives of films because we expect people to choose
10857 spending Friday night watching new movies and spending
10859 night watching a
1930 news documentary. The noncommercial life
10860 of culture is important and valuable
—for entertainment but also, and
10861 more importantly, for knowledge. To understand who we are, and
10862 where we came from, and how we have made the mistakes that we
10863 have, we need to have access to this history.
10866 Copyrights in this context do not drive an engine of free expression.
10868 <!-- PAGE BREAK 233 -->
10869 In this context, there is no need for an exclusive right. Copyrights in
10870 this context do no good.
10873 Yet, for most of our history, they also did little harm. For most of
10874 our history, when a work ended its commercial life, there was no
10875 copyright-related use that would be inhibited by an exclusive right.
10876 When a book went out of print, you could not buy it from a publisher.
10877 But you could still buy it from a used book store, and when a used
10878 book store sells it, in America, at least, there is no need to pay the
10879 copyright owner anything. Thus, the ordinary use of a book after its
10880 commercial life ended was a use that was independent of copyright law.
10883 The same was effectively true of film. Because the costs of restoring
10884 a film
—the real economic costs, not the lawyer costs
—were
10885 so high, it was never at all feasible to preserve or restore
10886 film. Like the remains of a great dinner, when it's over, it's
10887 over. Once a film passed out of its commercial life, it may have been
10888 archived for a bit, but that was the end of its life so long as the
10889 market didn't have more to offer.
10892 In other words, though copyright has been relatively short for most
10893 of our history, long copyrights wouldn't have mattered for the works
10894 that lost their commercial value. Long copyrights for these works
10895 would not have interfered with anything.
10898 But this situation has now changed.
10901 One crucially important consequence of the emergence of digital
10902 technologies is to enable the archive that Brewster Kahle dreams of.
10903 Digital technologies now make it possible to preserve and give access
10904 to all sorts of knowledge. Once a book goes out of print, we can now
10905 imagine digitizing it and making it available to everyone,
10906 forever. Once a film goes out of distribution, we could digitize it
10907 and make it available to everyone, forever. Digital technologies give
10908 new life to copyrighted material after it passes out of its commercial
10909 life. It is now possible to preserve and assure universal access to
10910 this knowledge and culture, whereas before it was not.
10913 <!-- PAGE BREAK 234 -->
10914 And now copyright law does get in the way. Every step of producing
10915 this digital archive of our culture infringes on the exclusive right
10916 of copyright. To digitize a book is to copy it. To do that requires
10917 permission of the copyright owner. The same with music, film, or any
10918 other aspect of our culture protected by copyright. The effort to make
10919 these things available to history, or to researchers, or to those who
10920 just want to explore, is now inhibited by a set of rules that were
10921 written for a radically different context.
10924 Here is the core of the harm that comes from extending terms: Now that
10925 technology enables us to rebuild the library of Alexandria, the law
10926 gets in the way. And it doesn't get in the way for any useful
10927 copyright purpose, for the purpose of copyright is to enable the
10928 commercial market that spreads culture. No, we are talking about
10929 culture after it has lived its commercial life. In this context,
10930 copyright is serving no purpose at all related to the spread of
10931 knowledge. In this context, copyright is not an engine of free
10932 expression. Copyright is a brake.
10935 You may well ask, "But if digital technologies lower the costs for
10936 Brewster Kahle, then they will lower the costs for Random House, too.
10937 So won't Random House do as well as Brewster Kahle in spreading
10941 Maybe. Someday. But there is absolutely no evidence to suggest that
10942 publishers would be as complete as libraries. If Barnes
& Noble
10943 offered to lend books from its stores for a low price, would that
10944 eliminate the need for libraries? Only if you think that the only role
10945 of a library is to serve what "the market" would demand. But if you
10946 think the role of a library is bigger than this
—if you think its
10947 role is to archive culture, whether there's a demand for any
10948 particular bit of that culture or not
—then we can't count on the
10949 commercial market to do our library work for us.
10952 I would be the first to agree that it should do as much as it can: We
10953 should rely upon the market as much as possible to spread and enable
10954 culture. My message is absolutely not antimarket. But where we see the
10955 market is not doing the job, then we should allow nonmarket forces the
10957 <!-- PAGE BREAK 235 -->
10958 freedom to fill the gaps. As one researcher calculated for American
10959 culture,
94 percent of the films, books, and music produced between
10960 and
1946 is not commercially available. However much you love the
10961 commercial market, if access is a value, then
6 percent is a failure
10962 to provide that value.
<footnote><para>
10964 Jason Schultz, "The Myth of the
1976 Copyright `Chaos' Theory,"
20
10965 December
2002, available at
10966 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
54</ulink>.
10971 In January
1999, we filed a lawsuit on Eric Eldred's behalf in federal
10972 district court in Washington, D.C., asking the court to declare the
10973 Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act unconstitutional. The two
10974 central claims that we made were (
1) that extending existing terms
10975 violated the Constitution's "limited Times" requirement, and (
2) that
10976 extending terms by another twenty years violated the First Amendment.
10979 The district court dismissed our claims without even hearing an
10980 argument. A panel of the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit also
10981 dismissed our claims, though after hearing an extensive argument. But
10982 that decision at least had a dissent, by one of the most conservative
10983 judges on that court. That dissent gave our claims life.
10986 Judge David Sentelle said the CTEA violated the requirement that
10987 copyrights be for "limited Times" only. His argument was as elegant as
10988 it was simple: If Congress can extend existing terms, then there is no
10989 "stopping point" to Congress's power under the Copyright Clause. The
10990 power to extend existing terms means Congress is not required to grant
10991 terms that are "limited." Thus, Judge Sentelle argued, the court had
10992 to interpret the term "limited Times" to give it meaning. And the best
10993 interpretation, Judge Sentelle argued, would be to deny Congress the
10994 power to extend existing terms.
10997 We asked the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit as a whole to
10998 hear the case. Cases are ordinarily heard in panels of three, except for
10999 important cases or cases that raise issues specific to the circuit as a
11000 whole, where the court will sit "en banc" to hear the case.
11003 The Court of Appeals rejected our request to hear the case en banc.
11004 This time, Judge Sentelle was joined by the most liberal member of the
11006 <!-- PAGE BREAK 236 -->
11007 D.C. Circuit, Judge David Tatel. Both the most conservative and the
11008 most liberal judges in the D.C. Circuit believed Congress had
11009 overstepped its bounds.
11012 It was here that most expected Eldred v. Ashcroft would die, for the
11013 Supreme Court rarely reviews any decision by a court of appeals. (It
11014 hears about one hundred cases a year, out of more than five thousand
11015 appeals.) And it practically never reviews a decision that upholds a
11016 statute when no other court has yet reviewed the statute.
11019 But in February
2002, the Supreme Court surprised the world by
11020 granting our petition to review the D.C. Circuit opinion. Argument
11021 was set for October of
2002. The summer would be spent writing
11022 briefs and preparing for argument.
11025 It is over a year later as I write these words. It is still
11026 astonishingly hard. If you know anything at all about this story, you
11027 know that we lost the appeal. And if you know something more than just
11028 the minimum, you probably think there was no way this case could have
11029 been won. After our defeat, I received literally thousands of missives
11030 by well-wishers and supporters, thanking me for my work on behalf of
11031 this noble but doomed cause. And none from this pile was more
11032 significant to me than the e-mail from my client, Eric Eldred.
11035 But my client and these friends were wrong. This case could have
11036 been won. It should have been won. And no matter how hard I try to
11037 retell this story to myself, I can never escape believing that my own
11040 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey
</primary></indexterm>
11042 The mistake was made early, though it became obvious only at the very
11043 end. Our case had been supported from the very beginning by an
11044 extraordinary lawyer, Geoffrey Stewart, and by the law firm he had
11045 moved to, Jones, Day, Reavis and Pogue. Jones Day took a great deal of
11047 <!-- PAGE BREAK 237 -->
11048 from its copyright-protectionist clients for supporting us. They
11049 ignored this pressure (something that few law firms today would ever
11050 do), and throughout the case, they gave it everything they could.
11052 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11053 <indexterm><primary>Bromberg, Dan
</primary></indexterm>
11054 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey
</primary></indexterm>
11056 There were three key lawyers on the case from Jones Day. Geoff
11057 Stewart was the first, but then Dan Bromberg and Don Ayer became
11058 quite involved. Bromberg and Ayer in particular had a common view
11059 about how this case would be won: We would only win, they repeatedly
11060 told me, if we could make the issue seem "important" to the Supreme
11061 Court. It had to seem as if dramatic harm were being done to free
11062 speech and free culture; otherwise, they would never vote against "the
11063 most powerful media companies in the world."
11066 I hate this view of the law. Of course I thought the Sonny Bono Act
11067 was a dramatic harm to free speech and free culture. Of course I still
11068 think it is. But the idea that the Supreme Court decides the law based
11069 on how important they believe the issues are is just wrong. It might be
11070 "right" as in "true," I thought, but it is "wrong" as in "it just shouldn't be
11071 that way." As I believed that any faithful interpretation of what the
11072 framers of our Constitution did would yield the conclusion that the
11073 CTEA was unconstitutional, and as I believed that any faithful
11075 of what the First Amendment means would yield the
11076 conclusion that the power to extend existing copyright terms is
11078 I was not persuaded that we had to sell our case like soap.
11079 Just as a law that bans the swastika is unconstitutional not because the
11080 Court likes Nazis but because such a law would violate the
11082 so too, in my view, would the Court decide whether Congress's
11083 law was constitutional based on the Constitution, not based on whether
11084 they liked the values that the framers put in the Constitution.
11087 In any case, I thought, the Court must already see the danger and
11088 the harm caused by this sort of law. Why else would they grant review?
11089 There was no reason to hear the case in the Supreme Court if they
11090 weren't convinced that this regulation was harmful. So in my view, we
11091 didn't need to persuade them that this law was bad, we needed to show
11092 why it was unconstitutional.
11095 There was one way, however, in which I felt politics would matter
11097 <!-- PAGE BREAK 238 -->
11098 and in which I thought a response was appropriate. I was convinced
11099 that the Court would not hear our arguments if it thought these were
11100 just the arguments of a group of lefty loons. This Supreme Court was
11101 not about to launch into a new field of judicial review if it seemed that
11102 this field of review was simply the preference of a small political
11104 Although my focus in the case was not to demonstrate how bad the
11105 Sonny Bono Act was but to demonstrate that it was unconstitutional,
11106 my hope was to make this argument against a background of briefs that
11107 covered the full range of political views. To show that this claim against
11108 the CTEA was grounded in law and not politics, then, we tried to
11109 gather the widest range of credible critics
—credible not because they
11110 were rich and famous, but because they, in the aggregate, demonstrated
11111 that this law was unconstitutional regardless of one's politics.
11114 The first step happened all by itself. Phyllis Schlafly's organization,
11115 Eagle Forum, had been an opponent of the CTEA from the very
11117 Mrs. Schlafly viewed the CTEA as a sellout by Congress. In
11118 November
1998, she wrote a stinging editorial attacking the
11120 Congress for allowing the law to pass. As she wrote, "Do you
11121 sometimes wonder why bills that create a financial windfall to narrow
11122 special interests slide easily through the intricate legislative process,
11123 while bills that benefit the general public seem to get bogged down?"
11124 The answer, as the editorial documented, was the power of money.
11125 Schlafly enumerated Disney's contributions to the key players on the
11126 committees. It was money, not justice, that gave Mickey Mouse twenty
11127 more years in Disney's control, Schlafly argued.
11130 In the Court of Appeals, Eagle Forum was eager to file a brief
11132 our position. Their brief made the argument that became the
11133 core claim in the Supreme Court: If Congress can extend the term of
11134 existing copyrights, there is no limit to Congress's power to set terms.
11135 That strong conservative argument persuaded a strong conservative
11136 judge, Judge Sentelle.
11139 In the Supreme Court, the briefs on our side were about as diverse as
11140 it gets. They included an extraordinary historical brief by the Free
11142 <!-- PAGE BREAK 239 -->
11143 Software Foundation (home of the GNU project that made GNU/ Linux
11144 possible). They included a powerful brief about the costs of
11145 uncertainty by Intel. There were two law professors' briefs, one by
11146 copyright scholars and one by First Amendment scholars. There was an
11147 exhaustive and uncontroverted brief by the world's experts in the
11148 history of the Progress Clause. And of course, there was a new brief
11149 by Eagle Forum, repeating and strengthening its arguments.
11152 Those briefs framed a legal argument. Then to support the legal
11153 argument, there were a number of powerful briefs by libraries and
11154 archives, including the Internet Archive, the American Association of
11155 Law Libraries, and the National Writers Union.
11158 But two briefs captured the policy argument best. One made the
11159 argument I've already described: A brief by Hal Roach Studios argued
11160 that unless the law was struck, a whole generation of American film
11161 would disappear. The other made the economic argument absolutely
11164 <indexterm><primary>Akerlof, George
</primary></indexterm>
11165 <indexterm><primary>Arrow, Kenneth
</primary></indexterm>
11166 <indexterm><primary>Buchanan, James
</primary></indexterm>
11167 <indexterm><primary>Coase, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
11168 <indexterm><primary>Friedman, Milton
</primary></indexterm>
11170 This economists' brief was signed by seventeen economists, including
11171 five Nobel Prize winners, including Ronald Coase, James Buchanan,
11172 Milton Friedman, Kenneth Arrow, and George Akerlof. The economists, as
11173 the list of Nobel winners demonstrates, spanned the political
11174 spectrum. Their conclusions were powerful: There was no plausible
11175 claim that extending the terms of existing copyrights would do
11176 anything to increase incentives to create. Such extensions were
11177 nothing more than "rent-seeking"
—the fancy term economists use
11178 to describe special-interest legislation gone wild.
11181 The same effort at balance was reflected in the legal team we gathered
11182 to write our briefs in the case. The Jones Day lawyers had been with
11183 us from the start. But when the case got to the Supreme Court, we
11184 added three lawyers to help us frame this argument to this Court: Alan
11185 Morrison, a lawyer from Public Citizen, a Washington group that had
11186 made constitutional history with a series of seminal victories in the
11187 Supreme Court defending individual rights; my colleague and dean,
11188 Kathleen Sullivan, who had argued many cases in the Court, and
11190 <!-- PAGE BREAK 240 -->
11191 who had advised us early on about a First Amendment strategy; and
11192 finally, former solicitor general Charles Fried.
11195 Fried was a special victory for our side. Every other former solicitor
11196 general was hired by the other side to defend Congress's power to give
11197 media companies the special favor of extended copyright terms. Fried
11198 was the only one who turned down that lucrative assignment to stand up
11199 for something he believed in. He had been Ronald Reagan's chief lawyer
11200 in the Supreme Court. He had helped craft the line of cases that
11201 limited Congress's power in the context of the Commerce Clause. And
11202 while he had argued many positions in the Supreme Court that I
11203 personally disagreed with, his joining the cause was a vote of
11204 confidence in our argument.
11207 The government, in defending the statute, had its collection of
11208 friends, as well. Significantly, however, none of these "friends" included
11209 historians or economists. The briefs on the other side of the case were
11210 written exclusively by major media companies, congressmen, and
11214 The media companies were not surprising. They had the most to gain
11215 from the law. The congressmen were not surprising either
—they
11216 were defending their power and, indirectly, the gravy train of
11217 contributions such power induced. And of course it was not surprising
11218 that the copyright holders would defend the idea that they should
11219 continue to have the right to control who did what with content they
11223 Dr. Seuss's representatives, for example, argued that it was
11224 better for the Dr. Seuss estate to control what happened to
11225 Dr. Seuss's work
— better than allowing it to fall into the
11226 public domain
—because if this creativity were in the public
11227 domain, then people could use it to "glorify drugs or to create
11228 pornography."
<footnote><para>
11230 Brief of Amici Dr. Seuss Enterprise et al., Eldred v. Ashcroft,
537
11231 U.S. (
2003) (No.
01-
618),
19.
11233 That was also the motive of
11234 the Gershwin estate, which defended its "protection" of the work of
11235 George Gershwin. They refuse, for example, to license Porgy and Bess
11236 to anyone who refuses to use African Americans in the cast.
<footnote><para>
11238 Dinitia Smith, "Immortal Words, Immortal Royalties? Even Mickey
11239 Mouse Joins the Fray," New York Times,
28 March
1998, B7.
11243 <!-- PAGE BREAK 241 -->
11244 their view of how this part of American culture should be controlled,
11245 and they wanted this law to help them effect that control.
11248 This argument made clear a theme that is rarely noticed in this
11249 debate. When Congress decides to extend the term of existing
11250 copyrights, Congress is making a choice about which speakers it will
11251 favor. Famous and beloved copyright owners, such as the Gershwin
11252 estate and Dr. Seuss, come to Congress and say, "Give us twenty years
11253 to control the speech about these icons of American culture. We'll do
11254 better with them than anyone else." Congress of course likes to reward
11255 the popular and famous by giving them what they want. But when
11256 Congress gives people an exclusive right to speak in a certain way,
11257 that's just what the First Amendment is traditionally meant to block.
11260 We argued as much in a final brief. Not only would upholding the CTEA
11261 mean that there was no limit to the power of Congress to extend
11262 copyrights
—extensions that would further concentrate the market;
11263 it would also mean that there was no limit to Congress's power to play
11264 favorites, through copyright, with who has the right to speak.
11265 Between February and October, there was little I did beyond preparing
11266 for this case. Early on, as I said, I set the strategy.
11269 The Supreme Court was divided into two important camps. One
11270 camp we called "the Conservatives." The other we called "the Rest."
11271 The Conservatives included Chief Justice Rehnquist, Justice O'Connor,
11272 Justice Scalia, Justice Kennedy, and Justice Thomas. These five had
11273 been the most consistent in limiting Congress's power. They were the
11274 five who had supported the Lopez/Morrison line of cases that said that
11275 an enumerated power had to be interpreted to assure that Congress's
11278 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11280 The Rest were the four Justices who had strongly opposed limits on
11281 Congress's power. These four
—Justice Stevens, Justice Souter,
11282 Justice Ginsburg, and Justice Breyer
—had repeatedly argued that
11284 <!-- PAGE BREAK 242 -->
11285 gives Congress broad discretion to decide how best to implement its
11286 powers. In case after case, these justices had argued that the Court's
11287 role should be one of deference. Though the votes of these four
11288 justices were the votes that I personally had most consistently agreed
11289 with, they were also the votes that we were least likely to get.
11292 In particular, the least likely was Justice Ginsburg's. In addition to
11293 her general view about deference to Congress (except where issues of
11294 gender are involved), she had been particularly deferential in the
11295 context of intellectual property protections. She and her daughter (an
11296 excellent and well-known intellectual property scholar) were cut from
11297 the same intellectual property cloth. We expected she would agree with
11298 the writings of her daughter: that Congress had the power in this
11299 context to do as it wished, even if what Congress wished made little
11302 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11304 Close behind Justice Ginsburg were two justices whom we also viewed as
11305 unlikely allies, though possible surprises. Justice Souter strongly
11306 favored deference to Congress, as did Justice Breyer. But both were
11307 also very sensitive to free speech concerns. And as we strongly
11308 believed, there was a very important free speech argument against
11309 these retrospective extensions.
11312 The only vote we could be confident about was that of Justice
11313 Stevens. History will record Justice Stevens as one of the greatest
11314 judges on this Court. His votes are consistently eclectic, which just
11315 means that no simple ideology explains where he will stand. But he
11316 had consistently argued for limits in the context of intellectual property
11317 generally. We were fairly confident he would recognize limits here.
11320 This analysis of "the Rest" showed most clearly where our focus
11321 had to be: on the Conservatives. To win this case, we had to crack open
11322 these five and get at least a majority to go our way. Thus, the single
11324 argument that animated our claim rested on the Conservatives'
11325 most important jurisprudential innovation
—the argument that Judge
11326 Sentelle had relied upon in the Court of Appeals, that Congress's power
11327 must be interpreted so that its enumerated powers have limits.
11330 This then was the core of our strategy
—a strategy for which I am
11331 responsible. We would get the Court to see that just as with the Lopez
11333 <!-- PAGE BREAK 243 -->
11334 case, under the government's argument here, Congress would always
11335 have unlimited power to extend existing terms. If anything was plain
11336 about Congress's power under the Progress Clause, it was that this
11337 power was supposed to be "limited." Our aim would be to get the
11338 Court to reconcile Eldred with Lopez: If Congress's power to regulate
11339 commerce was limited, then so, too, must Congress's power to regulate
11340 copyright be limited.
11343 The argument on the government's side came down to this:
11345 has done it before. It should be allowed to do it again. The
11347 claimed that from the very beginning, Congress has been
11348 extending the term of existing copyrights. So, the government argued,
11349 the Court should not now say that practice is unconstitutional.
11352 There was some truth to the government's claim, but not much. We
11353 certainly agreed that Congress had extended existing terms in
11354 and in
1909. And of course, in
1962, Congress began extending
11356 terms regularly
—eleven times in forty years.
11359 But this "consistency" should be kept in perspective. Congress
11361 existing terms once in the first hundred years of the Republic.
11362 It then extended existing terms once again in the next fifty. Those rare
11363 extensions are in contrast to the now regular practice of extending
11365 terms. Whatever restraint Congress had had in the past, that
11367 was now gone. Congress was now in a cycle of extensions; there
11368 was no reason to expect that cycle would end. This Court had not
11370 to intervene where Congress was in a similar cycle of extension.
11371 There was no reason it couldn't intervene here.
11372 Oral argument was scheduled for the first week in October. I
11374 in D.C. two weeks before the argument. During those two
11375 weeks, I was repeatedly "mooted" by lawyers who had volunteered to
11377 <!-- PAGE BREAK 244 -->
11378 help in the case. Such "moots" are basically practice rounds, where
11379 wannabe justices fire questions at wannabe winners.
11382 I was convinced that to win, I had to keep the Court focused on a
11383 single point: that if this extension is permitted, then there is no limit to
11384 the power to set terms. Going with the government would mean that
11385 terms would be effectively unlimited; going with us would give
11387 a clear line to follow: Don't extend existing terms. The moots
11388 were an effective practice; I found ways to take every question back to
11391 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11393 One moot was before the lawyers at Jones Day. Don Ayer was the
11394 skeptic. He had served in the Reagan Justice Department with Solicitor
11395 General Charles Fried. He had argued many cases before the Supreme
11396 Court. And in his review of the moot, he let his concern speak:
11399 "I'm just afraid that unless they really see the harm, they won't be
11400 willing to upset this practice that the government says has been a
11401 consistent practice for two hundred years. You have to make them see
11402 the harm
—passionately get them to see the harm. For if they
11403 don't see that, then we haven't any chance of winning."
11405 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11407 He may have argued many cases before this Court, I thought, but
11408 he didn't understand its soul. As a clerk, I had seen the Justices do the
11409 right thing
—not because of politics but because it was right. As a law
11410 professor, I had spent my life teaching my students that this Court
11411 does the right thing
—not because of politics but because it is right. As
11412 I listened to Ayer's plea for passion in pressing politics, I understood
11413 his point, and I rejected it. Our argument was right. That was enough.
11414 Let the politicians learn to see that it was also good.
11415 The night before the argument, a line of people began to form
11416 in front of the Supreme Court. The case had become a focus of the
11417 press and of the movement to free culture. Hundreds stood in line
11419 <!-- PAGE BREAK 245 -->
11420 for the chance to see the proceedings. Scores spent the night on the
11421 Supreme Court steps so that they would be assured a seat.
11424 Not everyone has to wait in line. People who know the Justices can
11425 ask for seats they control. (I asked Justice Scalia's chambers for seats for
11426 my parents, for example.) Members of the Supreme Court bar can get
11427 a seat in a special section reserved for them. And senators and
11429 have a special place where they get to sit, too. And finally, of
11430 course, the press has a gallery, as do clerks working for the Justices on
11431 the Court. As we entered that morning, there was no place that was
11432 not taken. This was an argument about intellectual property law, yet
11433 the halls were filled. As I walked in to take my seat at the front of the
11434 Court, I saw my parents sitting on the left. As I sat down at the table,
11435 I saw Jack Valenti sitting in the special section ordinarily reserved for
11436 family of the Justices.
11439 When the Chief Justice called me to begin my argument, I began
11440 where I intended to stay: on the question of the limits on Congress's
11441 power. This was a case about enumerated powers, I said, and whether
11442 those enumerated powers had any limit.
11445 Justice O'Connor stopped me within one minute of my opening.
11446 The history was bothering her.
11450 justice o'connor: Congress has extended the term so often
11451 through the years, and if you are right, don't we run the risk of
11452 upsetting previous extensions of time? I mean, this seems to be a
11453 practice that began with the very first act.
11457 She was quite willing to concede "that this flies directly in the face
11458 of what the framers had in mind." But my response again and again
11459 was to emphasize limits on Congress's power.
11463 mr. lessig: Well, if it flies in the face of what the framers had in
11464 mind, then the question is, is there a way of interpreting their
11465 <!-- PAGE BREAK 246 -->
11466 words that gives effect to what they had in mind, and the answer
11471 There were two points in this argument when I should have seen
11472 where the Court was going. The first was a question by Justice
11473 Kennedy, who observed,
11477 justice kennedy: Well, I suppose implicit in the argument that
11478 the '
76 act, too, should have been declared void, and that we
11479 might leave it alone because of the disruption, is that for all these
11480 years the act has impeded progress in science and the useful arts.
11481 I just don't see any empirical evidence for that.
11485 Here follows my clear mistake. Like a professor correcting a
11491 mr. lessig: Justice, we are not making an empirical claim at all.
11492 Nothing in our Copyright Clause claim hangs upon the empirical
11493 assertion about impeding progress. Our only argument is this is a
11494 structural limit necessary to assure that what would be an
11496 perpetual term not be permitted under the copyright laws.
11499 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11501 That was a correct answer, but it wasn't the right answer. The right
11502 answer was instead that there was an obvious and profound harm. Any
11503 number of briefs had been written about it. He wanted to hear it. And
11504 here was the place Don Ayer's advice should have mattered. This was a
11505 softball; my answer was a swing and a miss.
11508 The second came from the Chief, for whom the whole case had
11509 been crafted. For the Chief Justice had crafted the Lopez ruling, and we
11510 hoped that he would see this case as its second cousin.
11513 It was clear a second into his question that he wasn't at all
11515 To him, we were a bunch of anarchists. As he asked:
11517 <!-- PAGE BREAK 247 -->
11521 chief justice: Well, but you want more than that. You want the
11522 right to copy verbatim other people's books, don't you?
11525 mr. lessig: We want the right to copy verbatim works that
11526 should be in the public domain and would be in the public
11528 but for a statute that cannot be justified under ordinary First
11529 Amendment analysis or under a proper reading of the limits built
11530 into the Copyright Clause.
11534 Things went better for us when the government gave its argument;
11535 for now the Court picked up on the core of our claim. As Justice Scalia
11536 asked Solicitor General Olson,
11540 justice scalia: You say that the functional equivalent of an
11542 time would be a violation [of the Constitution], but that's
11543 precisely the argument that's being made by petitioners here, that
11544 a limited time which is extendable is the functional equivalent of
11549 When Olson was finished, it was my turn to give a closing rebuttal.
11550 Olson's flailing had revived my anger. But my anger still was directed
11551 to the academic, not the practical. The government was arguing as if
11552 this were the first case ever to consider limits on Congress's Copyright
11553 and Patent Clause power. Ever the professor and not the advocate, I
11554 closed by pointing out the long history of the Court imposing limits on
11555 Congress's power in the name of the Copyright and Patent Clause
—
11556 indeed, the very first case striking a law of Congress as exceeding a
11558 enumerated power was based upon the Copyright and Patent
11559 Clause. All true. But it wasn't going to move the Court to my side.
11562 As I left the court that day, I knew there were a hundred points I
11563 wished I could remake. There were a hundred questions I wished I had
11565 <!-- PAGE BREAK 248 -->
11566 answered differently. But one way of thinking about this case left me
11570 The government had been asked over and over again, what is the
11571 limit? Over and over again, it had answered there is no limit. This
11572 was precisely the answer I wanted the Court to hear. For I could not
11573 imagine how the Court could understand that the government
11575 Congress's power was unlimited under the terms of the
11577 Clause, and sustain the government's argument. The solicitor
11578 general had made my argument for me. No matter how often I tried,
11579 I could not understand how the Court could find that Congress's
11580 power under the Commerce Clause was limited, but under the
11582 Clause, unlimited. In those rare moments when I let myself
11584 that we may have prevailed, it was because I felt this Court
—in
11585 particular, the Conservatives
—would feel itself constrained by the rule
11586 of law that it had established elsewhere.
11589 The morning of January
15,
2003, I was five minutes late to the office
11590 and missed the
7:
00 A.M. call from the Supreme Court clerk. Listening to
11591 the message, I could tell in an instant that she had bad news to report.The
11592 Supreme Court had affirmed the decision of the Court of Appeals. Seven
11593 justices had voted in the majority. There were two dissents.
11596 A few seconds later, the opinions arrived by e-mail. I took the
11597 phone off the hook, posted an announcement to our blog, and sat
11598 down to see where I had been wrong in my reasoning.
11601 My reasoning. Here was a case that pitted all the money in the
11602 world against reasoning. And here was the last naïve law professor,
11603 scouring the pages, looking for reasoning.
11606 I first scoured the opinion, looking for how the Court would
11608 the principle in this case from the principle in Lopez. The
11610 was nowhere to be found. The case was not even cited. The
11611 argument that was the core argument of our case did not even appear
11612 in the Court's opinion.
11616 <!-- PAGE BREAK 249 -->
11617 Justice Ginsburg simply ignored the enumerated powers argument.
11618 Consistent with her view that Congress's power was not limited
11620 she had found Congress's power not limited here.
11623 Her opinion was perfectly reasonable
—for her, and for Justice
11624 Souter. Neither believes in Lopez. It would be too much to expect them
11625 to write an opinion that recognized, much less explained, the doctrine
11626 they had worked so hard to defeat.
11629 But as I realized what had happened, I couldn't quite believe what I
11630 was reading. I had said there was no way this Court could reconcile
11631 limited powers with the Commerce Clause and unlimited powers with
11632 the Progress Clause. It had never even occurred to me that they could
11633 reconcile the two simply by not addressing the argument. There was no
11634 inconsistency because they would not talk about the two together.
11635 There was therefore no principle that followed from the Lopez case: In
11636 that context, Congress's power would be limited, but in this context it
11640 Yet by what right did they get to choose which of the framers' values
11641 they would respect? By what right did they
—the silent
11642 five
—get to select the part of the Constitution they would
11643 enforce based on the values they thought important? We were right back
11644 to the argument that I said I hated at the start: I had failed to
11645 convince them that the issue here was important, and I had failed to
11646 recognize that however much I might hate a system in which the Court
11647 gets to pick the constitutional values that it will respect, that is
11648 the system we have.
11650 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11652 Justices Breyer and Stevens wrote very strong dissents. Stevens's
11653 opinion was crafted internal to the law: He argued that the tradition
11654 of intellectual property law should not support this unjustified
11655 extension of terms. He based his argument on a parallel analysis that
11656 had governed in the context of patents (so had we). But the rest of
11657 the Court discounted the parallel
—without explaining how the
11658 very same words in the Progress Clause could come to mean totally
11659 different things depending upon whether the words were about patents
11660 or copyrights. The Court let Justice Stevens's charge go unanswered.
11662 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11664 <!-- PAGE BREAK 250 -->
11665 Justice Breyer's opinion, perhaps the best opinion he has ever
11666 written, was external to the Constitution. He argued that the term of
11667 copyrights has become so long as to be effectively unlimited. We had
11668 said that under the current term, a copyright gave an author
99.8
11669 percent of the value of a perpetual term. Breyer said we were wrong,
11670 that the actual number was
99.9997 percent of a perpetual term. Either
11671 way, the point was clear: If the Constitution said a term had to be
11672 "limited," and the existing term was so long as to be effectively
11673 unlimited, then it was unconstitutional.
11676 These two justices understood all the arguments we had made. But
11677 because neither believed in the Lopez case, neither was willing to push
11678 it as a reason to reject this extension. The case was decided without
11679 anyone having addressed the argument that we had carried from Judge
11680 Sentelle. It was Hamlet without the Prince.
11683 Defeat brings depression. They say it is a sign of health when
11684 depression gives way to anger. My anger came quickly, but it didn't cure
11685 the depression. This anger was of two sorts.
11688 It was first anger with the five "Conservatives." It would have been
11689 one thing for them to have explained why the principle of Lopez didn't
11690 apply in this case. That wouldn't have been a very convincing
11691 argument, I don't believe, having read it made by others, and having
11692 tried to make it myself. But it at least would have been an act of
11693 integrity. These justices in particular have repeatedly said that the
11694 proper mode of interpreting the Constitution is "originalism"
—to
11695 first understand the framers' text, interpreted in their context, in
11696 light of the structure of the Constitution. That method had produced
11697 Lopez and many other "originalist" rulings. Where was their
11701 Here, they had joined an opinion that never once tried to explain
11702 what the framers had meant by crafting the Progress Clause as they
11703 did; they joined an opinion that never once tried to explain how the
11704 structure of that clause would affect the interpretation of Congress's
11706 <!-- PAGE BREAK 251 -->
11707 power. And they joined an opinion that didn't even try to explain why
11708 this grant of power could be unlimited, whereas the Commerce Clause
11709 would be limited. In short, they had joined an opinion that did not
11710 apply to, and was inconsistent with, their own method for interpreting
11711 the Constitution. This opinion may well have yielded a result that
11712 they liked. It did not produce a reason that was consistent with their
11716 My anger with the Conservatives quickly yielded to anger with
11718 For I had let a view of the law that I liked interfere with a view of
11721 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11723 Most lawyers, and most law professors, have little patience for
11724 idealism about courts in general and this Supreme Court in particular.
11725 Most have a much more pragmatic view. When Don Ayer said that this
11726 case would be won based on whether I could convince the Justices that
11727 the framers' values were important, I fought the idea, because I
11728 didn't want to believe that that is how this Court decides. I insisted
11729 on arguing this case as if it were a simple application of a set of
11730 principles. I had an argument that followed in logic. I didn't need
11731 to waste my time showing it should also follow in popularity.
11734 As I read back over the transcript from that argument in October, I
11735 can see a hundred places where the answers could have taken the
11736 conversation in different directions, where the truth about the harm
11737 that this unchecked power will cause could have been made clear to
11738 this Court. Justice Kennedy in good faith wanted to be shown. I,
11739 idiotically, corrected his question. Justice Souter in good faith
11740 wanted to be shown the First Amendment harms. I, like a math teacher,
11741 reframed the question to make the logical point. I had shown them how
11742 they could strike this law of Congress if they wanted to. There were a
11743 hundred places where I could have helped them want to, yet my
11744 stubbornness, my refusal to give in, stopped me. I have stood before
11745 hundreds of audiences trying to persuade; I have used passion in that
11746 effort to persuade; but I
11747 <!-- PAGE BREAK 252 -->
11748 refused to stand before this audience and try to persuade with the
11749 passion I had used elsewhere. It was not the basis on which a court
11750 should decide the issue.
11752 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11754 Would it have been different if I had argued it differently? Would it
11755 have been different if Don Ayer had argued it? Or Charles Fried? Or
11759 My friends huddled around me to insist it would not. The Court
11760 was not ready, my friends insisted. This was a loss that was destined. It
11761 would take a great deal more to show our society why our framers were
11762 right. And when we do that, we will be able to show that Court.
11765 Maybe, but I doubt it. These Justices have no financial interest in
11766 doing anything except the right thing. They are not lobbied. They have
11767 little reason to resist doing right. I can't help but think that if I had
11768 stepped down from this pretty picture of dispassionate justice, I could
11772 And even if I couldn't, then that doesn't excuse what happened in
11773 January. For at the start of this case, one of America's leading
11774 intellectual property professors stated publicly that my bringing this
11775 case was a mistake. "The Court is not ready," Peter Jaszi said; this
11776 issue should not be raised until it is.
11779 After the argument and after the decision, Peter said to me, and
11780 publicly, that he was wrong. But if indeed that Court could not have
11781 been persuaded, then that is all the evidence that's needed to know that
11782 here again Peter was right. Either I was not ready to argue this case in
11783 a way that would do some good or they were not ready to hear this case
11784 in a way that would do some good. Either way, the decision to bring
11785 this case
—a decision I had made four years before
—was wrong.
11786 While the reaction to the Sonny Bono Act itself was almost
11787 unanimously negative, the reaction to the Court's decision was mixed.
11788 No one, at least in the press, tried to say that extending the term of
11789 copyright was a good idea. We had won that battle over ideas. Where
11791 <!-- PAGE BREAK 253 -->
11792 the decision was praised, it was praised by papers that had been
11793 skeptical of the Court's activism in other cases. Deference was a good
11794 thing, even if it left standing a silly law. But where the decision
11795 was attacked, it was attacked because it left standing a silly and
11796 harmful law. The New York Times wrote in its editorial,
11800 In effect, the Supreme Court's decision makes it likely that we are
11801 seeing the beginning of the end of public domain and the birth of
11802 copyright perpetuity. The public domain has been a grand experiment,
11803 one that should not be allowed to die. The ability to draw freely on
11804 the entire creative output of humanity is one of the reasons we live
11805 in a time of such fruitful creative ferment.
11809 The best responses were in the cartoons. There was a gaggle of
11810 hilarious images
—of Mickey in jail and the like. The best, from
11811 my view of the case, was Ruben Bolling's, reproduced on the next
11812 page. The "powerful and wealthy" line is a bit unfair. But the punch
11813 in the face felt exactly like that.
11816 The image that will always stick in my head is that evoked by the
11817 quote from The New York Times. That "grand experiment" we call the
11818 "public domain" is over? When I can make light of it, I think, "Honey,
11819 I shrunk the Constitution." But I can rarely make light of it. We had
11820 in our Constitution a commitment to free culture. In the case that I
11821 fathered, the Supreme Court effectively renounced that commitment. A
11822 better lawyer would have made them see differently.
11824 <!-- PAGE BREAK 254 -->
11826 <sect1 id=
"eldred-ii">
11827 <title>CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II
</title>
11829 The day Eldred was decided, fate would have it that I was to travel to
11830 Washington, D.C. (The day the rehearing petition in Eldred was
11831 denied
—meaning the case was really finally over
—fate would
11832 have it that I was giving a speech to technologists at Disney World.)
11833 This was a particularly long flight to my least favorite city. The
11834 drive into the city from Dulles was delayed because of traffic, so I
11835 opened up my computer and wrote an op-ed piece.
11837 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11839 It was an act of contrition. During the whole of the flight from San
11840 Francisco to Washington, I had heard over and over again in my head
11841 the same advice from Don Ayer: You need to make them see why it is
11842 important. And alternating with that command was the question of
11843 Justice Kennedy: "For all these years the act has impeded progress in
11844 science and the useful arts. I just don't see any empirical evidence for
11845 that." And so, having failed in the argument of constitutional principle,
11846 finally, I turned to an argument of politics.
11849 The New York Times published the piece. In it, I proposed a simple
11850 fix: Fifty years after a work has been published, the copyright owner
11851 <!-- PAGE BREAK 256 -->
11852 would be required to register the work and pay a small fee. If he paid
11853 the fee, he got the benefit of the full term of copyright. If he did not,
11854 the work passed into the public domain.
11857 We called this the Eldred Act, but that was just to give it a name.
11858 Eric Eldred was kind enough to let his name be used once again, but as
11859 he said early on, it won't get passed unless it has another name.
11862 Or another two names. For depending upon your perspective, this
11863 is either the "Public Domain Enhancement Act" or the "Copyright
11864 Term Deregulation Act." Either way, the essence of the idea is clear
11865 and obvious: Remove copyright where it is doing nothing except
11866 blocking access and the spread of knowledge. Leave it for as long as
11867 Congress allows for those works where its worth is at least $
1. But for
11868 everything else, let the content go.
11870 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
11872 The reaction to this idea was amazingly strong. Steve Forbes endorsed
11873 it in an editorial. I received an avalanche of e-mail and letters
11874 expressing support. When you focus the issue on lost creativity,
11875 people can see the copyright system makes no sense. As a good
11876 Republican might say, here government regulation is simply getting in
11877 the way of innovation and creativity. And as a good Democrat might
11878 say, here the government is blocking access and the spread of
11879 knowledge for no good reason. Indeed, there is no real difference
11880 between Democrats and Republicans on this issue. Anyone can recognize
11881 the stupid harm of the present system.
11884 Indeed, many recognized the obvious benefit of the registration
11885 requirement. For one of the hardest things about the current system
11886 for people who want to license content is that there is no obvious
11887 place to look for the current copyright owners. Since registration is
11888 not required, since marking content is not required, since no
11889 formality at all is required, it is often impossibly hard to locate
11890 copyright owners to ask permission to use or license their work. This
11891 system would lower these costs, by establishing at least one registry
11892 where copyright owners could be identified.
11894 <indexterm><primary>Berlin Act (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
11895 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
11897 <!-- PAGE BREAK 257 -->
11898 As I described in chapter
10, formalities in copyright law were
11899 removed in
1976, when Congress followed the Europeans by abandoning
11900 any formal requirement before a copyright is granted.
<footnote><para>
11902 Until the
1908 Berlin Act of the Berne Convention, national copyright
11903 legislation sometimes made protection depend upon compliance with
11904 formalities such as registration, deposit, and affixation of notice of
11905 the author's claim of copyright. However, starting with the
1908 act,
11906 every text of the Convention has provided that "the enjoyment and the
11907 exercise" of rights guaranteed by the Convention "shall not be subject
11908 to any formality." The prohibition against formalities is presently
11909 embodied in Article
5(
2) of the Paris Text of the Berne
11910 Convention. Many countries continue to impose some form of deposit or
11911 registration requirement, albeit not as a condition of
11912 copyright. French law, for example, requires the deposit of copies of
11913 works in national repositories, principally the National Museum.
11914 Copies of books published in the United Kingdom must be deposited in
11915 the British Library. The German Copyright Act provides for a Registrar
11916 of Authors where the author's true name can be filed in the case of
11917 anonymous or pseudonymous works. Paul Goldstein, International
11918 Intellectual Property Law, Cases and Materials (New York: Foundation
11919 Press,
2001),
153–54.
</para></footnote>
11920 The Europeans are said to view copyright as a "natural right." Natural
11921 rights don't need forms to exist. Traditions, like the Anglo-American
11922 tradition that required copyright owners to follow form if their
11923 rights were to be protected, did not, the Europeans thought, properly
11924 respect the dignity of the author. My right as a creator turns on my
11925 creativity, not upon the special favor of the government.
11928 That's great rhetoric. It sounds wonderfully romantic. But it is
11929 absurd copyright policy. It is absurd especially for authors, because
11930 a world without formalities harms the creator. The ability to spread
11931 "Walt Disney creativity" is destroyed when there is no simple way to
11932 know what's protected and what's not.
11934 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
11936 The fight against formalities achieved its first real victory in
11937 Berlin in
1908. International copyright lawyers amended the Berne
11938 Convention in
1908, to require copyright terms of life plus fifty
11939 years, as well as the abolition of copyright formalities. The
11940 formalities were hated because the stories of inadvertent loss were
11941 increasingly common. It was as if a Charles Dickens character ran all
11942 copyright offices, and the failure to dot an i or cross a t resulted
11943 in the loss of widows' only income.
11946 These complaints were real and sensible. And the strictness of the
11947 formalities, especially in the United States, was absurd. The law
11948 should always have ways of forgiving innocent mistakes. There is no
11949 reason copyright law couldn't, as well. Rather than abandoning
11950 formalities totally, the response in Berlin should have been to
11951 embrace a more equitable system of registration.
11954 Even that would have been resisted, however, because registration
11955 in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries was still expensive. It was
11956 also a hassle. The abolishment of formalities promised not only to save
11957 the starving widows, but also to lighten an unnecessary regulatory
11959 imposed upon creators.
11962 In addition to the practical complaint of authors in
1908, there was
11963 a moral claim as well. There was no reason that creative property
11965 <!-- PAGE BREAK 258 -->
11966 should be a second-class form of property. If a carpenter builds a
11967 table, his rights over the table don't depend upon filing a form with
11968 the government. He has a property right over the table "naturally,"
11969 and he can assert that right against anyone who would steal the table,
11970 whether or not he has informed the government of his ownership of the
11974 This argument is correct, but its implications are misleading. For the
11975 argument in favor of formalities does not depend upon creative
11976 property being second-class property. The argument in favor of
11977 formalities turns upon the special problems that creative property
11978 presents. The law of formalities responds to the special physics of
11979 creative property, to assure that it can be efficiently and fairly
11983 No one thinks, for example, that land is second-class property just
11984 because you have to register a deed with a court if your sale of land
11985 is to be effective. And few would think a car is second-class property
11986 just because you must register the car with the state and tag it with
11987 a license. In both of those cases, everyone sees that there is an
11988 important reason to secure registration
—both because it makes
11989 the markets more efficient and because it better secures the rights of
11990 the owner. Without a registration system for land, landowners would
11991 perpetually have to guard their property. With registration, they can
11992 simply point the police to a deed. Without a registration system for
11993 cars, auto theft would be much easier. With a registration system, the
11994 thief has a high burden to sell a stolen car. A slight burden is
11995 placed on the property owner, but those burdens produce a much better
11996 system of protection for property generally.
11999 It is similarly special physics that makes formalities important in
12000 copyright law. Unlike a carpenter's table, there's nothing in nature that
12001 makes it relatively obvious who might own a particular bit of creative
12002 property. A recording of Lyle Lovett's latest album can exist in a billion
12003 places without anything necessarily linking it back to a particular
12004 owner. And like a car, there's no way to buy and sell creative property
12005 with confidence unless there is some simple way to authenticate who is
12006 the author and what rights he has. Simple transactions are destroyed in
12008 <!-- PAGE BREAK 259 -->
12009 a world without formalities. Complex, expensive, lawyer transactions
12013 This was the understanding of the problem with the Sonny Bono
12014 Act that we tried to demonstrate to the Court. This was the part it
12015 didn't "get." Because we live in a system without formalities, there is no
12016 way easily to build upon or use culture from our past. If copyright
12017 terms were, as Justice Story said they would be, "short," then this
12018 wouldn't matter much. For fourteen years, under the framers' system, a
12019 work would be presumptively controlled. After fourteen years, it would
12020 be presumptively uncontrolled.
12023 But now that copyrights can be just about a century long, the
12024 inability to know what is protected and what is not protected becomes
12025 a huge and obvious burden on the creative process. If the only way a
12026 library can offer an Internet exhibit about the New Deal is to hire a
12027 lawyer to clear the rights to every image and sound, then the
12028 copyright system is burdening creativity in a way that has never been
12029 seen before because there are no formalities.
12032 The Eldred Act was designed to respond to exactly this problem. If
12033 it is worth $
1 to you, then register your work and you can get the
12034 longer term. Others will know how to contact you and, therefore, how
12035 to get your permission if they want to use your work. And you will get
12036 the benefit of an extended copyright term.
12039 If it isn't worth it to you to register to get the benefit of an extended
12040 term, then it shouldn't be worth it for the government to defend your
12041 monopoly over that work either. The work should pass into the public
12042 domain where anyone can copy it, or build archives with it, or create a
12043 movie based on it. It should become free if it is not worth $
1 to you.
12046 Some worry about the burden on authors. Won't the burden of
12047 registering the work mean that the $
1 is really misleading? Isn't the
12048 hassle worth more than $
1? Isn't that the real problem with
12052 It is. The hassle is terrible. The system that exists now is awful. I
12053 completely agree that the Copyright Office has done a terrible job (no
12054 doubt because they are terribly funded) in enabling simple and cheap
12056 <!-- PAGE BREAK 260 -->
12057 registrations. Any real solution to the problem of formalities must
12058 address the real problem of governments standing at the core of any
12059 system of formalities. In this book, I offer such a solution. That
12060 solution essentially remakes the Copyright Office. For now, assume it
12061 was Amazon that ran the registration system. Assume it was one-click
12062 registration. The Eldred Act would propose a simple, one-click
12063 registration fifty years after a work was published. Based upon
12064 historical data, that system would move up to
98 percent of commercial
12065 work, commercial work that no longer had a commercial life, into the
12066 public domain within fifty years. What do you think?
12068 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
12070 When Steve Forbes endorsed the idea, some in Washington began to pay
12071 attention. Many people contacted me pointing to representatives who
12072 might be willing to introduce the Eldred Act. And I had a few who
12073 directly suggested that they might be willing to take the first step.
12076 One representative, Zoe Lofgren of California, went so far as to get
12077 the bill drafted. The draft solved any problem with international
12078 law. It imposed the simplest requirement upon copyright owners
12079 possible. In May
2003, it looked as if the bill would be
12080 introduced. On May
16, I posted on the Eldred Act blog, "we are
12081 close." There was a general reaction in the blog community that
12082 something good might happen here.
12085 But at this stage, the lobbyists began to intervene. Jack Valenti and
12086 the MPAA general counsel came to the congresswoman's office to give
12087 the view of the MPAA. Aided by his lawyer, as Valenti told me, Valenti
12088 informed the congresswoman that the MPAA would oppose the Eldred
12089 Act. The reasons are embarrassingly thin. More importantly, their
12090 thinness shows something clear about what this debate is really about.
12093 The MPAA argued first that Congress had "firmly rejected the central
12094 concept in the proposed bill"
—that copyrights be renewed. That
12095 was true, but irrelevant, as Congress's "firm rejection" had occurred
12096 <!-- PAGE BREAK 261 -->
12097 long before the Internet made subsequent uses much more likely.
12098 Second, they argued that the proposal would harm poor copyright
12099 owners
—apparently those who could not afford the $
1 fee. Third,
12100 they argued that Congress had determined that extending a copyright
12101 term would encourage restoration work. Maybe in the case of the small
12102 percentage of work covered by copyright law that is still commercially
12103 valuable, but again this was irrelevant, as the proposal would not cut
12104 off the extended term unless the $
1 fee was not paid. Fourth, the MPAA
12105 argued that the bill would impose "enormous" costs, since a
12106 registration system is not free. True enough, but those costs are
12107 certainly less than the costs of clearing the rights for a copyright
12108 whose owner is not known. Fifth, they worried about the risks if the
12109 copyright to a story underlying a film were to pass into the public
12110 domain. But what risk is that? If it is in the public domain, then the
12111 film is a valid derivative use.
12114 Finally, the MPAA argued that existing law enabled copyright owners to
12115 do this if they wanted. But the whole point is that there are
12116 thousands of copyright owners who don't even know they have a
12117 copyright to give. Whether they are free to give away their copyright
12118 or not
—a controversial claim in any case
—unless they know
12119 about a copyright, they're not likely to.
12122 At the beginning of this book, I told two stories about the law
12123 reacting to changes in technology. In the one, common sense prevailed.
12124 In the other, common sense was delayed. The difference between the two
12125 stories was the power of the opposition
—the power of the side
12126 that fought to defend the status quo. In both cases, a new technology
12127 threatened old interests. But in only one case did those interest's
12128 have the power to protect themselves against this new competitive
12132 I used these two cases as a way to frame the war that this book has
12133 been about. For here, too, a new technology is forcing the law to react.
12134 And here, too, we should ask, is the law following or resisting common
12135 sense? If common sense supports the law, what explains this common
12140 <!-- PAGE BREAK 262 -->
12141 When the issue is piracy, it is right for the law to back the
12142 copyright owners. The commercial piracy that I described is wrong and
12143 harmful, and the law should work to eliminate it. When the issue is
12144 p2p sharing, it is easy to understand why the law backs the owners
12145 still: Much of this sharing is wrong, even if much is harmless. When
12146 the issue is copyright terms for the Mickey Mouses of the world, it is
12147 possible still to understand why the law favors Hollywood: Most people
12148 don't recognize the reasons for limiting copyright terms; it is thus
12149 still possible to see good faith within the resistance.
12152 But when the copyright owners oppose a proposal such as the Eldred
12153 Act, then, finally, there is an example that lays bare the naked
12154 selfinterest driving this war. This act would free an extraordinary
12155 range of content that is otherwise unused. It wouldn't interfere with
12156 any copyright owner's desire to exercise continued control over his
12157 content. It would simply liberate what Kevin Kelly calls the "Dark
12158 Content" that fills archives around the world. So when the warriors
12159 oppose a change like this, we should ask one simple question:
12162 What does this industry really want?
12165 With very little effort, the warriors could protect their content. So
12166 the effort to block something like the Eldred Act is not really about
12167 protecting their content. The effort to block the Eldred Act is an effort
12168 to assure that nothing more passes into the public domain. It is another
12169 step to assure that the public domain will never compete, that there
12170 will be no use of content that is not commercially controlled, and that
12171 there will be no commercial use of content that doesn't require their
12175 The opposition to the Eldred Act reveals how extreme the other side
12176 is. The most powerful and sexy and well loved of lobbies really has as
12177 its aim not the protection of "property" but the rejection of a
12178 tradition. Their aim is not simply to protect what is theirs. Their
12179 aim is to assure that all there is is what is theirs.
12182 It is not hard to understand why the warriors take this view. It is not
12183 hard to see why it would benefit them if the competition of the public
12185 <!-- PAGE BREAK 263 -->
12186 domain tied to the Internet could somehow be quashed. Just as RCA
12187 feared the competition of FM, they fear the competition of a public
12188 domain connected to a public that now has the means to create with it
12189 and to share its own creation.
12191 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
12192 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
12194 What is hard to understand is why the public takes this view. It is
12195 as if the law made airplanes trespassers. The MPAA stands with the
12196 Causbys and demands that their remote and useless property rights be
12197 respected, so that these remote and forgotten copyright holders might
12198 block the progress of others.
12201 All this seems to follow easily from this untroubled acceptance of the
12202 "property" in intellectual property. Common sense supports it, and so
12203 long as it does, the assaults will rain down upon the technologies of
12204 the Internet. The consequence will be an increasing "permission
12205 society." The past can be cultivated only if you can identify the
12206 owner and gain permission to build upon his work. The future will be
12207 controlled by this dead (and often unfindable) hand of the past.
12209 <!-- PAGE BREAK 264 -->
12212 <chapter id=
"c-conclusion">
12213 <title>CONCLUSION
</title>
12215 There are more than
35 million people with the AIDS virus
12216 worldwide. Twenty-five million of them live in sub-Saharan Africa.
12217 Seventeen million have already died. Seventeen million Africans
12218 is proportional percentage-wise to seven million Americans. More
12219 importantly, it is seventeen million Africans.
12222 There is no cure for AIDS, but there are drugs to slow its
12223 progression. These antiretroviral therapies are still experimental,
12224 but they have already had a dramatic effect. In the United States,
12225 AIDS patients who regularly take a cocktail of these drugs increase
12226 their life expectancy by ten to twenty years. For some, the drugs make
12227 the disease almost invisible.
12230 These drugs are expensive. When they were first introduced in the
12231 United States, they cost between $
10,
000 and $
15,
000 per person per
12232 year. Today, some cost $
25,
000 per year. At these prices, of course, no
12233 African nation can afford the drugs for the vast majority of its
12235 $
15,
000 is thirty times the per capita gross national product of
12236 Zimbabwe. At these prices, the drugs are totally unavailable.
<footnote><para>
12237 <!-- f1. --> Commission on Intellectual Property Rights, "Final Report: Integrating
12238 Intellectual Property Rights and Development Policy" (London,
2002),
12240 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
55</ulink>. According to a World Health Organization press
12242 issued
9 July
2002, only
230,
000 of the
6 million who need drugs in
12243 the developing world receive them
—and half of them are in Brazil.
12247 <!-- PAGE BREAK 265 -->
12248 These prices are not high because the ingredients of the drugs are
12249 expensive. These prices are high because the drugs are protected by
12250 patents. The drug companies that produced these life-saving mixes
12251 enjoy at least a twenty-year monopoly for their inventions. They use
12252 that monopoly power to extract the most they can from the market. That
12253 power is in turn used to keep the prices high.
12256 There are many who are skeptical of patents, especially drug
12257 patents. I am not. Indeed, of all the areas of research that might be
12258 supported by patents, drug research is, in my view, the clearest case
12259 where patents are needed. The patent gives the drug company some
12260 assurance that if it is successful in inventing a new drug to treat a
12261 disease, it will be able to earn back its investment and more. This is
12262 socially an extremely valuable incentive. I am the last person who
12263 would argue that the law should abolish it, at least without other
12267 But it is one thing to support patents, even drug patents. It is
12268 another thing to determine how best to deal with a crisis. And as
12269 African leaders began to recognize the devastation that AIDS was
12270 bringing, they started looking for ways to import HIV treatments at
12271 costs significantly below the market price.
12274 In
1997, South Africa tried one tack. It passed a law to allow the
12275 importation of patented medicines that had been produced or sold in
12276 another nation's market with the consent of the patent owner. For
12277 example, if the drug was sold in India, it could be imported into
12278 Africa from India. This is called "parallel importation," and it is
12279 generally permitted under international trade law and is specifically
12280 permitted within the European Union.
<footnote>
12281 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John
</primary></indexterm>
12284 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite, Information Feudalism: Who
12285 Owns the Knowledge Economy? (New York: The New Press,
2003),
37.
12289 However, the United States government opposed the bill. Indeed,
12290 more than opposed. As the International Intellectual Property
12292 characterized it, "The U.S. government pressured South Africa . . .
12293 not to permit compulsory licensing or parallel imports."
<footnote><para>
12294 <!-- f3. --> International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI), Patent Protection and
12295 Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan Africa, a Report
12297 for the World Intellectual Property Organization (Washington, D.C.,
12298 2000),
14, available at
12299 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
56</ulink>. For a firsthand account of the struggle over
12300 South Africa, see Hearing Before the Subcommittee on Criminal Justice,
12301 Drug Policy, and Human Resources, House Committee on Government
12302 Reform, H. Rep.,
1st sess., Ser. No.
106-
126 (
22 July
1999),
150–57
12303 (statement of James Love).
12306 Office of the United States Trade Representative, the government
12307 asked South Africa to change the law
—and to add pressure to that
12309 in
1998, the USTR listed South Africa for possible trade sanctions.
12310 <!-- PAGE BREAK 266 -->
12311 That same year, more than forty pharmaceutical companies
12313 proceedings in the South African courts to challenge the
12315 actions. The United States was then joined by other governments
12316 from the EU. Their claim, and the claim of the pharmaceutical
12318 was that South Africa was violating its obligations under
12320 law by discriminating against a particular kind of patent
—
12321 pharmaceutical patents. The demand of these governments, with the
12322 United States in the lead, was that South Africa respect these patents
12323 as it respects any other patent, regardless of any effect on the treatment
12324 of AIDS within South Africa.
<footnote><para>
12325 <!-- f4. --> International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI), Patent Protection and
12326 Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan Africa, a Report
12328 for the World Intellectual Property Organization (Washington, D.C.,
12333 We should place the intervention by the United States in context.
12334 No doubt patents are not the most important reason that Africans
12335 don't have access to drugs. Poverty and the total absence of an effective
12336 health care infrastructure matter more. But whether patents are the
12337 most important reason or not, the price of drugs has an effect on their
12338 demand, and patents affect price. And so, whether massive or
12340 there was an effect from our government's intervention to stop
12341 the flow of medications into Africa.
12344 By stopping the flow of HIV treatment into Africa, the United
12345 States government was not saving drugs for United States citizens.
12346 This is not like wheat (if they eat it, we can't); instead, the flow that the
12347 United States intervened to stop was, in effect, a flow of knowledge:
12348 information about how to take chemicals that exist within Africa, and
12349 turn those chemicals into drugs that would save
15 to
30 million lives.
12352 Nor was the intervention by the United States going to protect the
12353 profits of United States drug companies
—at least, not substantially. It
12354 was not as if these countries were in the position to buy the drugs for
12355 the prices the drug companies were charging. Again, the Africans are
12356 wildly too poor to afford these drugs at the offered prices. Stopping the
12357 parallel import of these drugs would not substantially increase the sales
12361 Instead, the argument in favor of restricting this flow of
12363 which was needed to save the lives of millions, was an argument
12364 <!-- PAGE BREAK 267 -->
12365 about the sanctity of property.
<footnote><para>
12366 <!-- f5. --> See Sabin Russell, "New Crusade to Lower AIDS Drug Costs: Africa's
12367 Needs at Odds with Firms' Profit Motive," San Francisco Chronicle,
24
12368 May
1999, A1, available at
12369 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
57</ulink> ("compulsory licenses and gray
12371 pose a threat to the entire system of intellectual property protection");
12372 Robert Weissman, "AIDS and Developing Countries: Democratizing
12374 to Essential Medicines," Foreign Policy in Focus
4:
23 (August
1999),
12376 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
58</ulink> (describing U.S. policy); John A. Harrelson, "TRIPS,
12377 Pharmaceutical Patents, and the HIV/AIDS Crisis: Finding the Proper
12378 Balance Between Intellectual Property Rights and Compassion, a
12380 Widener Law Symposium Journal (Spring
2001):
175.
12381 <!-- PAGE BREAK 333 -->
12383 It was because "intellectual property"
12384 would be violated that these drugs should not flow into Africa. It was
12385 a principle about the importance of "intellectual property" that led
12386 these government actors to intervene against the South African
12391 Now just step back for a moment. There will be a time thirty years
12392 from now when our children look back at us and ask, how could we have
12393 let this happen? How could we allow a policy to be pursued whose
12395 cost would be to speed the death of
15 to
30 million Africans, and
12396 whose only real benefit would be to uphold the "sanctity" of an idea?
12397 What possible justification could there ever be for a policy that results
12398 in so many deaths? What exactly is the insanity that would allow so
12399 many to die for such an abstraction?
12402 Some blame the drug companies. I don't. They are corporations.
12403 Their managers are ordered by law to make money for the corporation.
12404 They push a certain patent policy not because of ideals, but because it is
12405 the policy that makes them the most money. And it only makes them the
12406 most money because of a certain corruption within our political system
—
12407 a corruption the drug companies are certainly not responsible for.
12410 The corruption is our own politicians' failure of integrity. For the
12411 drug companies would love
—they say, and I believe them
—to sell their
12412 drugs as cheaply as they can to countries in Africa and elsewhere.
12413 There are issues they'd have to resolve to make sure the drugs didn't get
12414 back into the United States, but those are mere problems of
12416 They could be overcome.
12419 A different problem, however, could not be overcome. This is the
12420 fear of the grandstanding politician who would call the presidents of
12421 the drug companies before a Senate or House hearing, and ask, "How
12422 is it you can sell this HIV drug in Africa for only $
1 a pill, but the same
12423 drug would cost an American $
1,
500?" Because there is no "sound
12424 bite" answer to that question, its effect would be to induce regulation
12425 of prices in America. The drug companies thus avoid this spiral by
12426 avoiding the first step. They reinforce the idea that property should be
12427 <!-- PAGE BREAK 268 -->
12428 sacred. They adopt a rational strategy in an irrational context, with the
12429 unintended consequence that perhaps millions die. And that rational
12430 strategy thus becomes framed in terms of this ideal
—the sanctity of an
12431 idea called "intellectual property."
12434 So when the common sense of your child confronts you, what will
12435 you say? When the common sense of a generation finally revolts
12436 against what we have done, how will we justify what we have done?
12437 What is the argument?
12440 A sensible patent policy could endorse and strongly support the
12441 patent system without having to reach everyone everywhere in exactly
12442 the same way. Just as a sensible copyright policy could endorse and
12443 strongly support a copyright system without having to regulate the
12444 spread of culture perfectly and forever, a sensible patent policy could
12445 endorse and strongly support a patent system without having to block
12446 the spread of drugs to a country not rich enough to afford market
12447 prices in any case. A sensible policy, in other words, could be a balanced
12448 policy. For most of our history, both copyright and patent policies were
12449 balanced in just this sense.
12452 But we as a culture have lost this sense of balance. We have lost the
12453 critical eye that helps us see the difference between truth and
12455 A certain property fundamentalism, having no connection to our
12456 tradition, now reigns in this culture
—bizarrely, and with consequences
12457 more grave to the spread of ideas and culture than almost any other
12458 single policy decision that we as a democracy will make.
12459 A simple idea blinds us, and under the cover of darkness, much
12460 happens that most of us would reject if any of us looked. So uncritically
12461 do we accept the idea of property in ideas that we don't even notice
12462 how monstrous it is to deny ideas to a people who are dying without
12463 them. So uncritically do we accept the idea of property in culture that
12464 we don't even question when the control of that property removes our
12465 <!-- PAGE BREAK 269 -->
12466 ability, as a people, to develop our culture democratically. Blindness
12467 becomes our common sense. And the challenge for anyone who would
12468 reclaim the right to cultivate our culture is to find a way to make
12469 this common sense open its eyes.
12472 So far, common sense sleeps. There is no revolt. Common sense
12473 does not yet see what there could be to revolt about. The extremism
12474 that now dominates this debate fits with ideas that seem natural, and
12475 that fit is reinforced by the RCAs of our day. They wage a frantic war
12476 to fight "piracy," and devastate a culture for creativity. They defend
12477 the idea of "creative property," while transforming real creators into
12478 modern-day sharecroppers. They are insulted by the idea that rights
12479 should be balanced, even though each of the major players in this
12480 content war was itself a beneficiary of a more balanced ideal. The
12481 hypocrisy reeks. Yet in a city like Washington, hypocrisy is not even
12482 noticed. Powerful lobbies, complex issues, and MTV attention spans
12483 produce the "perfect storm" for free culture.
12486 In August
2003, a fight broke out in the United States about a
12487 decision by the World Intellectual Property Organization to cancel a
12488 meeting.
<footnote><para>
12489 <!-- f6. --> Jonathan Krim, "The Quiet War over Open-Source," Washington Post,
12490 August
2003, E1, available at
12491 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
59</ulink>; William New, "Global Group's
12492 Shift on `Open Source' Meeting Spurs Stir," National Journal's Technology
12493 Daily,
19 August
2003, available at
12494 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
60</ulink>; William New, "U.S. Official
12495 Opposes `Open Source' Talks at WIPO," National Journal's Technology
12496 Daily,
19 August
2003, available at
12497 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
61</ulink>.
12499 At the request of a wide range of interests, WIPO had
12501 to hold a meeting to discuss "open and collaborative projects to
12502 create public goods." These are projects that have been successful in
12503 producing public goods without relying exclusively upon a proprietary
12504 use of intellectual property. Examples include the Internet and the
12505 World Wide Web, both of which were developed on the basis of
12507 in the public domain. It included an emerging trend to support
12508 open academic journals, including the Public Library of Science
12510 that I describe in the Afterword. It included a project to develop
12511 single nucleotide polymorphisms (SNPs), which are thought to have
12512 great significance in biomedical research. (That nonprofit project
12514 a consortium of the Wellcome Trust and pharmaceutical and
12515 technological companies, including Amersham Biosciences, AstraZeneca,
12516 <!-- PAGE BREAK 270 -->
12517 Aventis, Bayer, Bristol-Myers Squibb, Hoffmann-La Roche,
12519 IBM, Motorola, Novartis, Pfizer, and Searle.) It included
12520 the Global Positioning System, which Ronald Reagan set free in the
12521 early
1980s. And it included "open source and free software."
12524 The aim of the meeting was to consider this wide range of projects
12525 from one common perspective: that none of these projects relied upon
12526 intellectual property extremism. Instead, in all of them, intellectual
12527 property was balanced by agreements to keep access open or to impose
12528 limitations on the way in which proprietary claims might be used.
12531 From the perspective of this book, then, the conference was ideal.
<footnote><para>
12532 <!-- f7. --> I should disclose that I was one of the people who asked WIPO for the
12535 The projects within its scope included both commercial and
12537 work. They primarily involved science, but from many
12539 And WIPO was an ideal venue for this discussion, since
12540 WIPO is the preeminent international body dealing with intellectual
12544 Indeed, I was once publicly scolded for not recognizing this fact
12545 about WIPO. In February
2003, I delivered a keynote address to a
12546 preparatory conference for the World Summit on the Information
12548 (WSIS). At a press conference before the address, I was asked
12549 what I would say. I responded that I would be talking a little about the
12550 importance of balance in intellectual property for the development of
12551 an information society. The moderator for the event then promptly
12553 to inform me and the assembled reporters that no question
12554 about intellectual property would be discussed by WSIS, since those
12555 questions were the exclusive domain of WIPO. In the talk that I had
12556 prepared, I had actually made the issue of intellectual property
12558 minor. But after this astonishing statement, I made intellectual
12559 property the sole focus of my talk. There was no way to talk about an
12560 "Information Society" unless one also talked about the range of
12562 and culture that would be free. My talk did not make my
12564 moderator very happy. And she was no doubt correct that the
12565 scope of intellectual property protections was ordinarily the stuff of
12566 <!-- PAGE BREAK 271 -->
12567 WIPO. But in my view, there couldn't be too much of a conversation
12568 about how much intellectual property is needed, since in my view, the
12569 very idea of balance in intellectual property had been lost.
12572 So whether or not WSIS can discuss balance in intellectual
12574 I had thought it was taken for granted that WIPO could and
12575 should. And thus the meeting about "open and collaborative projects to
12576 create public goods" seemed perfectly appropriate within the WIPO
12580 But there is one project within that list that is highly controversial,
12581 at least among lobbyists. That project is "open source and free
12583 Microsoft in particular is wary of discussion of the subject. From
12584 its perspective, a conference to discuss open source and free software
12585 would be like a conference to discuss Apple's operating system. Both
12586 open source and free software compete with Microsoft's software. And
12587 internationally, many governments have begun to explore requirements
12588 that they use open source or free software, rather than "proprietary
12589 software," for their own internal uses.
12592 I don't mean to enter that debate here. It is important only to make
12593 clear that the distinction is not between commercial and
12595 software. There are many important companies that depend
12597 upon open source and free software, IBM being the most
12598 prominent. IBM is increasingly shifting its focus to the GNU/Linux
12599 operating system, the most famous bit of "free software"
—and IBM is
12600 emphatically a commercial entity. Thus, to support "open source and
12601 free software" is not to oppose commercial entities. It is, instead, to
12602 support a mode of software development that is different from
12603 Microsoft's.
<footnote><para>
12604 <!-- f8. --> Microsoft's position about free and open source software is more
12606 As it has repeatedly asserted, it has no problem with "open source"
12607 software or software in the public domain. Microsoft's principal
12609 is to "free software" licensed under a "copyleft" license, meaning a
12611 that requires the licensee to adopt the same terms on any derivative
12612 work. See Bradford L. Smith, "The Future of Software: Enabling the
12614 to Decide," Government Policy Toward Open Source Software
12615 (Washington, D.C.: AEI-Brookings Joint Center for Regulatory Studies,
12616 American Enterprise Institute for Public Policy Research,
2002),
69,
12618 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
62</ulink>. See also Craig Mundie, Microsoft senior vice
12620 The Commercial Software Model, discussion at New York University
12621 Stern School of Business (
3 May
2001), available at
12622 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
63</ulink>.
12626 More important for our purposes, to support "open source and free
12627 software" is not to oppose copyright. "Open source and free software"
12628 is not software in the public domain. Instead, like Microsoft's
12629 software, the copyright owners of free and open source software insist
12630 quite strongly that the terms of their software license be respected
12632 <!-- PAGE BREAK 272 -->
12633 adopters of free and open source software. The terms of that license
12634 are no doubt different from the terms of a proprietary software
12635 license. Free software licensed under the General Public License
12636 (GPL), for example, requires that the source code for the software be
12637 made available by anyone who modifies and redistributes the
12638 software. But that requirement is effective only if copyright governs
12639 software. If copyright did not govern software, then free software
12640 could not impose the same kind of requirements on its adopters. It
12641 thus depends upon copyright law just as Microsoft does.
12644 It is therefore understandable that as a proprietary software
12645 developer, Microsoft would oppose this WIPO meeting, and
12646 understandable that it would use its lobbyists to get the United
12647 States government to oppose it, as well. And indeed, that is just what
12648 was reported to have happened. According to Jonathan Krim of the
12649 Washington Post, Microsoft's lobbyists succeeded in getting the United
12650 States government to veto the meeting.
<footnote><para>
12652 Krim, "The Quiet War over Open-Source," available at
<ulink
12653 url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
64</ulink>.
12655 And without U.S. backing, the meeting was canceled.
12658 I don't blame Microsoft for doing what it can to advance its own
12659 interests, consistent with the law. And lobbying governments is
12660 plainly consistent with the law. There was nothing surprising about
12661 its lobbying here, and nothing terribly surprising about the most
12662 powerful software producer in the United States having succeeded in
12663 its lobbying efforts.
12666 What was surprising was the United States government's reason for
12667 opposing the meeting. Again, as reported by Krim, Lois Boland, acting
12668 director of international relations for the U.S. Patent and Trademark
12669 Office, explained that "open-source software runs counter to the
12670 mission of WIPO, which is to promote intellectual-property rights."
12671 She is quoted as saying, "To hold a meeting which has as its purpose
12672 to disclaim or waive such rights seems to us to be contrary to the
12676 These statements are astonishing on a number of levels.
12678 <!-- PAGE BREAK 273 -->
12680 First, they are just flat wrong. As I described, most open source and
12681 free software relies fundamentally upon the intellectual property
12682 right called "copyright". Without it, restrictions imposed by those
12683 licenses wouldn't work. Thus, to say it "runs counter" to the mission
12684 of promoting intellectual property rights reveals an extraordinary gap
12685 in understanding
—the sort of mistake that is excusable in a
12686 first-year law student, but an embarrassment from a high government
12687 official dealing with intellectual property issues.
12690 Second, who ever said that WIPO's exclusive aim was to "promote"
12691 intellectual property maximally? As I had been scolded at the
12692 preparatory conference of WSIS, WIPO is to consider not only how best
12693 to protect intellectual property, but also what the best balance of
12694 intellectual property is. As every economist and lawyer knows, the
12695 hard question in intellectual property law is to find that
12696 balance. But that there should be limits is, I had thought,
12697 uncontested. One wants to ask Ms. Boland, are generic drugs (drugs
12698 based on drugs whose patent has expired) contrary to the WIPO mission?
12699 Does the public domain weaken intellectual property? Would it have
12700 been better if the protocols of the Internet had been patented?
12703 Third, even if one believed that the purpose of WIPO was to maximize
12704 intellectual property rights, in our tradition, intellectual property
12705 rights are held by individuals and corporations. They get to decide
12706 what to do with those rights because, again, they are their rights. If
12707 they want to "waive" or "disclaim" their rights, that is, within our
12708 tradition, totally appropriate. When Bill Gates gives away more than
12709 $
20 billion to do good in the world, that is not inconsistent with the
12710 objectives of the property system. That is, on the contrary, just what
12711 a property system is supposed to be about: giving individuals the
12712 right to decide what to do with their property.
12715 When Ms. Boland says that there is something wrong with a meeting
12716 "which has as its purpose to disclaim or waive such rights," she's
12717 saying that WIPO has an interest in interfering with the choices of
12718 <!-- PAGE BREAK 274 -->
12719 the individuals who own intellectual property rights. That somehow,
12720 WIPO's objective should be to stop an individual from "waiving" or
12721 "disclaiming" an intellectual property right. That the interest of
12722 WIPO is not just that intellectual property rights be maximized, but
12723 that they also should be exercised in the most extreme and restrictive
12727 There is a history of just such a property system that is well known
12728 in the Anglo-American tradition. It is called "feudalism." Under
12729 feudalism, not only was property held by a relatively small number of
12730 individuals and entities. And not only were the rights that ran with
12731 that property powerful and extensive. But the feudal system had a
12732 strong interest in assuring that property holders within that system
12733 not weaken feudalism by liberating people or property within their
12734 control to the free market. Feudalism depended upon maximum control
12735 and concentration. It fought any freedom that might interfere with
12738 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
12739 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John
</primary></indexterm>
12741 As Peter Drahos and John Braithwaite relate, this is precisely the
12742 choice we are now making about intellectual property.
<footnote><para>
12744 See Drahos with Braithwaite, Information Feudalism,
210–20.
12746 We will have an information society. That much is certain. Our only
12747 choice now is whether that information society will be free or
12748 feudal. The trend is toward the feudal.
12751 When this battle broke, I blogged it. A spirited debate within the
12752 comment section ensued. Ms. Boland had a number of supporters who
12753 tried to show why her comments made sense. But there was one comment
12754 that was particularly depressing for me. An anonymous poster wrote,
12758 George, you misunderstand Lessig: He's only talking about the world as
12759 it should be ("the goal of WIPO, and the goal of any government,
12760 should be to promote the right balance of intellectualproperty rights,
12761 not simply to promote intellectual property rights"), not as it is. If
12762 we were talking about the world as it is, then of course Boland didn't
12763 say anything wrong. But in the world
12764 <!-- PAGE BREAK 275 -->
12765 as Lessig would have it, then of course she did. Always pay attention
12766 to the distinction between Lessig's world and ours.
12770 I missed the irony the first time I read it. I read it quickly and
12771 thought the poster was supporting the idea that seeking balance was
12772 what our government should be doing. (Of course, my criticism of Ms.
12773 Boland was not about whether she was seeking balance or not; my
12774 criticism was that her comments betrayed a first-year law student's
12775 mistake. I have no illusion about the extremism of our government,
12776 whether Republican or Democrat. My only illusion apparently is about
12777 whether our government should speak the truth or not.)
12780 Obviously, however, the poster was not supporting that idea. Instead,
12781 the poster was ridiculing the very idea that in the real world, the
12782 "goal" of a government should be "to promote the right balance" of
12783 intellectual property. That was obviously silly to him. And it
12784 obviously betrayed, he believed, my own silly utopianism. "Typical for
12785 an academic," the poster might well have continued.
12788 I understand criticism of academic utopianism. I think utopianism is
12789 silly, too, and I'd be the first to poke fun at the absurdly
12790 unrealistic ideals of academics throughout history (and not just in
12791 our own country's history).
12794 But when it has become silly to suppose that the role of our
12795 government should be to "seek balance," then count me with the silly,
12796 for that means that this has become quite serious indeed. If it should
12797 be obvious to everyone that the government does not seek balance, that
12798 the government is simply the tool of the most powerful lobbyists, that
12799 the idea of holding the government to a different standard is absurd,
12800 that the idea of demanding of the government that it speak truth and
12801 not lies is just na
ïve, then who have we, the most powerful
12802 democracy in the world, become?
12805 It might be crazy to expect a high government official to speak
12806 the truth. It might be crazy to believe that government policy will be
12807 something more than the handmaiden of the most powerful interests.
12808 <!-- PAGE BREAK 276 -->
12809 It might be crazy to argue that we should preserve a tradition that has
12810 been part of our tradition for most of our history
—free culture.
12812 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace
</primary></indexterm>
12814 If this is crazy, then let there be more crazies. Soon. There are
12815 moments of hope in this struggle. And moments that surprise. When the
12816 FCC was considering relaxing ownership rules, which would thereby
12817 further increase the concentration in media ownership, an
12818 extraordinary bipartisan coalition formed to fight this change. For
12819 perhaps the first time in history, interests as diverse as the NRA,
12820 the ACLU, Moveon.org, William Safire, Ted Turner, and CodePink Women
12821 for Peace organized to oppose this change in FCC policy. An
12822 astonishing
700,
000 letters were sent to the FCC, demanding more
12823 hearings and a different result.
12826 This activism did not stop the FCC, but soon after, a broad coalition
12827 in the Senate voted to reverse the FCC decision. The hostile hearings
12828 leading up to that vote revealed just how powerful this movement had
12829 become. There was no substantial support for the FCC's decision, and
12830 there was broad and sustained support for fighting further
12831 concentration in the media.
12834 But even this movement misses an important piece of the puzzle.
12835 Largeness as such is not bad. Freedom is not threatened just because
12836 some become very rich, or because there are only a handful of big
12837 players. The poor quality of Big Macs or Quarter Pounders does not
12838 mean that you can't get a good hamburger from somewhere else.
12841 The danger in media concentration comes not from the concentration,
12842 but instead from the feudalism that this concentration, tied to the
12843 change in copyright, produces. It is not just that there are a few
12844 powerful companies that control an ever expanding slice of the
12845 media. It is that this concentration can call upon an equally bloated
12846 range of rights
—property rights of a historically extreme
12847 form
—that makes their bigness bad.
12849 <!-- PAGE BREAK 277 -->
12851 It is therefore significant that so many would rally to demand
12852 competition and increased diversity. Still, if the rally is understood
12853 as being about bigness alone, it is not terribly surprising. We
12854 Americans have a long history of fighting "big," wisely or not. That
12855 we could be motivated to fight "big" again is not something new.
12858 It would be something new, and something very important, if an equal
12859 number could be rallied to fight the increasing extremism built within
12860 the idea of "intellectual property." Not because balance is alien to
12861 our tradition; indeed, as I've argued, balance is our tradition. But
12862 because the muscle to think critically about the scope of anything
12863 called "property" is not well exercised within this tradition anymore.
12866 If we were Achilles, this would be our heel. This would be the place
12870 As I write these final words, the news is filled with stories about
12871 the RIAA lawsuits against almost three hundred individuals.
<footnote><para>
12873 John Borland, "RIAA Sues
261 File Swappers," CNET News.com, September
12875 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
65</ulink>; Paul
12876 R. La Monica, "Music Industry Sues Swappers," CNN/Money,
8 September
12878 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
66</ulink>; Soni
12879 Sangha and Phyllis Furman with Robert Gearty, "Sued for a Song,
12880 N.Y.C.
12-Yr-Old Among
261 Cited as Sharers," New York Daily News,
9
12881 September
2003,
3; Frank Ahrens, "RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised
12882 Targets; Single Mother in Calif.,
12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among
12883 Defendants," Washington Post,
10 September
2003, E1; Katie Dean,
12884 "Schoolgirl Settles with RIAA," Wired News,
10 September
2003,
12886 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
67</ulink>.
12888 Eminem has just been sued for "sampling" someone else's
12889 music.
<footnote><para>
12891 Jon Wiederhorn, "Eminem Gets Sued . . . by a Little Old Lady,"
12892 mtv.com,
17 September
2003, available at
12893 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
68</ulink>.
12895 The story about Bob Dylan "stealing" from a Japanese author has just
12896 finished making the rounds.
<footnote><para>
12898 Kenji Hall, Associated Press, "Japanese Book May Be Inspiration for
12899 Dylan Songs," Kansascity.com,
9 July
2003, available at
12900 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
69</ulink>.
12901 <!-- PAGE BREAK 334 -->
12903 An insider from Hollywood
—who insists he must remain
12904 anonymous
—reports "an amazing conversation with these studio
12905 guys. They've got extraordinary [old] content that they'd love to use
12906 but can't because they can't begin to clear the rights. They've got
12907 scores of kids who could do amazing things with the content, but it
12908 would take scores of lawyers to clean it first." Congressmen are
12909 talking about deputizing computer viruses to bring down computers
12910 thought to violate the law. Universities are threatening expulsion for
12911 kids who use a computer to share content.
12913 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
12914 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
12915 <indexterm><primary>Creative Commons
</primary></indexterm>
12916 <indexterm><primary>Gil, Gilberto
</primary></indexterm>
12918 Yet on the other side of the Atlantic, the BBC has just announced
12919 that it will build a "Creative Archive," from which British citizens can
12920 download BBC content, and rip, mix, and burn it.
<footnote><para>
12921 <!-- f14. --> "BBC Plans to Open Up Its Archive to the Public," BBC press release,
12922 24 August
2003, available at
12923 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
70</ulink>.
12925 And in Brazil, the culture minister, Gilberto Gil, himself a folk hero
12926 of Brazilian music, has joined with Creative Commons to release
12927 content and free licenses in that Latin American
12928 country.
<footnote><para>
12930 "Creative Commons and Brazil," Creative Commons Weblog,
6 August
2003,
12932 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
71</ulink>.
12934 <!-- PAGE BREAK 278 -->
12935 I've told a dark story. The truth is more mixed. A technology has
12936 given us a new freedom. Slowly, some begin to understand that this
12937 freedom need not mean anarchy. We can carry a free culture into the
12938 twenty-first century, without artists losing and without the potential of
12939 digital technology being destroyed. It will take some thought, and
12940 more importantly, it will take some will to transform the RCAs of our
12941 day into the Causbys.
12944 Common sense must revolt. It must act to free culture. Soon, if this
12945 potential is ever to be realized.
12947 <!-- PAGE BREAK 279 -->
12951 <chapter id=
"c-afterword">
12952 <title>AFTERWORD
</title>
12955 <!-- PAGE BREAK 280 -->
12956 At least some who have read this far will agree with me that something
12957 must be done to change where we are heading. The balance of this book
12958 maps what might be done.
12961 I divide this map into two parts: that which anyone can do now,
12962 and that which requires the help of lawmakers. If there is one lesson
12963 that we can draw from the history of remaking common sense, it is that
12964 it requires remaking how many people think about the very same issue.
12967 That means this movement must begin in the streets. It must recruit a
12968 significant number of parents, teachers, librarians, creators,
12969 authors, musicians, filmmakers, scientists
—all to tell this
12970 story in their own words, and to tell their neighbors why this battle
12974 Once this movement has its effect in the streets, it has some hope of
12975 having an effect in Washington. We are still a democracy. What people
12976 think matters. Not as much as it should, at least when an RCA stands
12977 opposed, but still, it matters. And thus, in the second part below, I
12978 sketch changes that Congress could make to better secure a free culture.
12980 <!-- PAGE BREAK 281 -->
12983 <title>US, NOW
</title>
12985 Common sense is with the copyright warriors because the debate so far
12986 has been framed at the extremes
—as a grand either/or: either
12987 property or anarchy, either total control or artists won't be paid. If
12988 that really is the choice, then the warriors should win.
12991 The mistake here is the error of the excluded middle. There are
12992 extremes in this debate, but the extremes are not all that there
12993 is. There are those who believe in maximal copyright
—"All Rights
12994 Reserved"
— and those who reject copyright
—"No Rights
12995 Reserved." The "All Rights Reserved" sorts believe that you should ask
12996 permission before you "use" a copyrighted work in any way. The "No
12997 Rights Reserved" sorts believe you should be able to do with content
12998 as you wish, regardless of whether you have permission or not.
13001 When the Internet was first born, its initial architecture effectively
13002 tilted in the "no rights reserved" direction. Content could be copied
13003 perfectly and cheaply; rights could not easily be controlled. Thus,
13004 regardless of anyone's desire, the effective regime of copyright under
13007 <!-- PAGE BREAK 282 -->
13008 original design of the Internet was "no rights reserved." Content was
13009 "taken" regardless of the rights. Any rights were effectively
13013 This initial character produced a reaction (opposite, but not quite
13014 equal) by copyright owners. That reaction has been the topic of this
13015 book. Through legislation, litigation, and changes to the network's
13016 design, copyright holders have been able to change the essential
13017 character of the environment of the original Internet. If the original
13018 architecture made the effective default "no rights reserved," the
13019 future architecture will make the effective default "all rights
13020 reserved." The architecture and law that surround the Internet's
13021 design will increasingly produce an environment where all use of
13022 content requires permission. The "cut and paste" world that defines
13023 the Internet today will become a "get permission to cut and paste"
13024 world that is a creator's nightmare.
13027 What's needed is a way to say something in the middle
—neither "all
13028 rights reserved" nor "no rights reserved" but "some rights reserved"
—
13029 and thus a way to respect copyrights but enable creators to free content
13030 as they see fit. In other words, we need a way to restore a set of
13032 that we could just take for granted before.
13035 <sect2 id=
"examples">
13036 <title>Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples
</title>
13038 If you step back from the battle I've been describing here, you will
13039 recognize this problem from other contexts. Think about
13040 privacy. Before the Internet, most of us didn't have to worry much
13041 about data about our lives that we broadcast to the world. If you
13042 walked into a bookstore and browsed through some of the works of Karl
13043 Marx, you didn't need to worry about explaining your browsing habits
13044 to your neighbors or boss. The "privacy" of your browsing habits was
13048 What made it assured?
13050 <!-- PAGE BREAK 283 -->
13052 Well, if we think in terms of the modalities I described in chapter
13053 10, your privacy was assured because of an inefficient architecture
13054 for gathering data and hence a market constraint (cost) on anyone who
13055 wanted to gather that data. If you were a suspected spy for North
13056 Korea, working for the CIA, no doubt your privacy would not be
13057 assured. But that's because the CIA would (we hope) find it valuable
13058 enough to spend the thousands required to track you. But for most of
13059 us (again, we can hope), spying doesn't pay. The highly inefficient
13060 architecture of real space means we all enjoy a fairly robust amount
13061 of privacy. That privacy is guaranteed to us by friction. Not by law
13062 (there is no law protecting "privacy" in public places), and in many
13063 places, not by norms (snooping and gossip are just fun), but instead,
13064 by the costs that friction imposes on anyone who would want to spy.
13066 <indexterm><primary>Amazon
</primary></indexterm>
13068 Enter the Internet, where the cost of tracking browsing in particular
13069 has become quite tiny. If you're a customer at Amazon, then as you
13070 browse the pages, Amazon collects the data about what you've looked
13071 at. You know this because at the side of the page, there's a list of
13072 "recently viewed" pages. Now, because of the architecture of the Net
13073 and the function of cookies on the Net, it is easier to collect the
13074 data than not. The friction has disappeared, and hence any "privacy"
13075 protected by the friction disappears, too.
13078 Amazon, of course, is not the problem. But we might begin to worry
13079 about libraries. If you're one of those crazy lefties who thinks that
13080 people should have the "right" to browse in a library without the
13081 government knowing which books you look at (I'm one of those lefties,
13082 too), then this change in the technology of monitoring might concern
13083 you. If it becomes simple to gather and sort who does what in
13084 electronic spaces, then the friction-induced privacy of yesterday
13088 It is this reality that explains the push of many to define "privacy"
13089 on the Internet. It is the recognition that technology can remove what
13090 friction before gave us that leads many to push for laws to do what
13091 friction did.
<footnote><para>
13094 See, for example, Marc Rotenberg, "Fair Information Practices and the
13095 Architecture of Privacy (What Larry Doesn't Get)," Stanford Technology
13096 Law Review
1 (
2001): par.
6–18, available at
13098 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
72</ulink>
13099 (describing examples in which technology defines privacy policy). See
13100 also Jeffrey Rosen, The Naked Crowd: Reclaiming Security and Freedom
13101 in an Anxious Age (New York: Random House,
2004) (mapping tradeoffs
13102 between technology and privacy).
</para></footnote>
13103 And whether you're in favor of those laws or not, it is the pattern
13104 that is important here. We must take affirmative steps to secure a
13106 <!-- PAGE BREAK 284 -->
13107 kind of freedom that was passively provided before. A change in
13108 technology now forces those who believe in privacy to affirmatively
13109 act where, before, privacy was given by default.
13112 A similar story could be told about the birth of the free software
13113 movement. When computers with software were first made available
13114 commercially, the software
—both the source code and the
13115 binaries
— was free. You couldn't run a program written for a
13116 Data General machine on an IBM machine, so Data General and IBM didn't
13117 care much about controlling their software.
13119 <indexterm><primary>Stallman, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
13121 That was the world Richard Stallman was born into, and while he was a
13122 researcher at MIT, he grew to love the community that developed when
13123 one was free to explore and tinker with the software that ran on
13124 machines. Being a smart sort himself, and a talented programmer,
13125 Stallman grew to depend upon the freedom to add to or modify other
13129 In an academic setting, at least, that's not a terribly radical
13130 idea. In a math department, anyone would be free to tinker with a
13131 proof that someone offered. If you thought you had a better way to
13132 prove a theorem, you could take what someone else did and change
13133 it. In a classics department, if you believed a colleague's
13134 translation of a recently discovered text was flawed, you were free to
13135 improve it. Thus, to Stallman, it seemed obvious that you should be
13136 free to tinker with and improve the code that ran a machine. This,
13137 too, was knowledge. Why shouldn't it be open for criticism like
13141 No one answered that question. Instead, the architecture of revenue
13142 for computing changed. As it became possible to import programs from
13143 one system to another, it became economically attractive (at least in
13144 the view of some) to hide the code of your program. So, too, as
13145 companies started selling peripherals for mainframe systems. If I
13146 could just take your printer driver and copy it, then that would make
13147 it easier for me to sell a printer to the market than it was for you.
13150 Thus, the practice of proprietary code began to spread, and by the
13151 early
1980s, Stallman found himself surrounded by proprietary code.
13152 <!-- PAGE BREAK 285 -->
13153 The world of free software had been erased by a change in the
13154 economics of computing. And as he believed, if he did nothing about
13155 it, then the freedom to change and share software would be
13156 fundamentally weakened.
13159 Therefore, in
1984, Stallman began a project to build a free operating
13160 system, so that at least a strain of free software would survive. That
13161 was the birth of the GNU project, into which Linus Torvalds's "Linux"
13162 kernel was added to produce the GNU/Linux operating system.
13165 Stallman's technique was to use copyright law to build a world of
13166 software that must be kept free. Software licensed under the Free
13167 Software Foundation's GPL cannot be modified and distributed unless
13168 the source code for that software is made available as well. Thus,
13169 anyone building upon GPL'd software would have to make their buildings
13170 free as well. This would assure, Stallman believed, that an ecology of
13171 code would develop that remained free for others to build upon. His
13172 fundamental goal was freedom; innovative creative code was a
13176 Stallman was thus doing for software what privacy advocates now
13177 do for privacy. He was seeking a way to rebuild a kind of freedom that
13178 was taken for granted before. Through the affirmative use of licenses
13179 that bind copyrighted code, Stallman was affirmatively reclaiming a
13180 space where free software would survive. He was actively protecting
13181 what before had been passively guaranteed.
13184 Finally, consider a very recent example that more directly resonates
13185 with the story of this book. This is the shift in the way academic and
13186 scientific journals are produced.
13189 As digital technologies develop, it is becoming obvious to many
13190 that printing thousands of copies of journals every month and sending
13191 them to libraries is perhaps not the most efficient way to distribute
13192 knowledge. Instead, journals are increasingly becoming electronic, and
13193 libraries and their users are given access to these electronic journals
13194 through password-protected sites. Something similar to this has been
13195 happening in law for almost thirty years: Lexis and Westlaw have had
13196 electronic versions of case reports available to subscribers to their
13198 Although a Supreme Court opinion is not copyrighted, and
13200 is free to go to a library and read it, Lexis and Westlaw are also free
13201 <!-- PAGE BREAK 286 -->
13202 to charge users for the privilege of gaining access to that Supreme
13203 Court opinion through their respective services.
13206 There's nothing wrong in general with this, and indeed, the ability
13207 to charge for access to even public domain materials is a good incentive
13208 for people to develop new and innovative ways to spread knowledge.
13209 The law has agreed, which is why Lexis and Westlaw have been
13211 to flourish. And if there's nothing wrong with selling the public
13212 domain, then there could be nothing wrong, in principle, with selling
13213 access to material that is not in the public domain.
13216 But what if the only way to get access to social and scientific data
13217 was through proprietary services? What if no one had the ability to
13218 browse this data except by paying for a subscription?
13221 As many are beginning to notice, this is increasingly the reality with
13222 scientific journals. When these journals were distributed in paper form,
13223 libraries could make the journals available to anyone who had access to
13224 the library. Thus, patients with cancer could become cancer experts
13226 the library gave them access. Or patients trying to understand
13227 the risks of a certain treatment could research those risks by reading all
13228 available articles about that treatment. This freedom was therefore a
13229 function of the institution of libraries (norms) and the technology of
13230 paper journals (architecture)
—namely, that it was very hard to control
13231 access to a paper journal.
13234 As journals become electronic, however, the publishers are demanding
13235 that libraries not give the general public access to the
13236 journals. This means that the freedoms provided by print journals in
13237 public libraries begin to disappear. Thus, as with privacy and with
13238 software, a changing technology and market shrink a freedom taken for
13242 This shrinking freedom has led many to take affirmative steps to
13243 restore the freedom that has been lost. The Public Library of Science
13244 (PLoS), for example, is a nonprofit corporation dedicated to making
13245 scientific research available to anyone with a Web connection. Authors
13246 <!-- PAGE BREAK 287 -->
13247 of scientific work submit that work to the Public Library of Science.
13248 That work is then subject to peer review. If accepted, the work is
13249 then deposited in a public, electronic archive and made permanently
13250 available for free. PLoS also sells a print version of its work, but
13251 the copyright for the print journal does not inhibit the right of
13252 anyone to redistribute the work for free.
13255 This is one of many such efforts to restore a freedom taken for
13256 granted before, but now threatened by changing technology and markets.
13257 There's no doubt that this alternative competes with the traditional
13258 publishers and their efforts to make money from the exclusive
13259 distribution of content. But competition in our tradition is
13260 presumptively a good
—especially when it helps spread knowledge
13265 <sect2 id=
"oneidea">
13266 <title>Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea
</title>
13267 <indexterm id=
"idxcc" class='startofrange'
>
13268 <primary>Creative Commons
</primary>
13271 The same strategy could be applied to culture, as a response to the
13272 increasing control effected through law and technology.
13275 Enter the Creative Commons. The Creative Commons is a nonprofit
13276 corporation established in Massachusetts, but with its home at
13277 Stanford University. Its aim is to build a layer of reasonable
13278 copyright on top of the extremes that now reign. It does this by
13279 making it easy for people to build upon other people's work, by making
13280 it simple for creators to express the freedom for others to take and
13281 build upon their work. Simple tags, tied to human-readable
13282 descriptions, tied to bulletproof licenses, make this possible.
13285 Simple
—which means without a middleman, or without a lawyer. By
13286 developing a free set of licenses that people can attach to their
13287 content, Creative Commons aims to mark a range of content that can
13288 easily, and reliably, be built upon. These tags are then linked to
13289 machine-readable versions of the license that enable computers
13290 automatically to identify content that can easily be shared. These
13291 three expressions together
—a legal license, a human-readable
13293 <!-- PAGE BREAK 288 -->
13294 machine-readable tags
—constitute a Creative Commons license. A
13295 Creative Commons license constitutes a grant of freedom to anyone who
13296 accesses the license, and more importantly, an expression of the ideal
13297 that the person associated with the license believes in something
13298 different than the "All" or "No" extremes. Content is marked with the
13299 CC mark, which does not mean that copyright is waived, but that
13300 certain freedoms are given.
13303 These freedoms are beyond the freedoms promised by fair use. Their
13304 precise contours depend upon the choices the creator makes. The
13305 creator can choose a license that permits any use, so long as
13306 attribution is given. She can choose a license that permits only
13307 noncommercial use. She can choose a license that permits any use so
13308 long as the same freedoms are given to other uses ("share and share
13309 alike"). Or any use so long as no derivative use is made. Or any use
13310 at all within developing nations. Or any sampling use, so long as full
13311 copies are not made. Or lastly, any educational use.
13314 These choices thus establish a range of freedoms beyond the default of
13315 copyright law. They also enable freedoms that go beyond traditional
13316 fair use. And most importantly, they express these freedoms in a way
13317 that subsequent users can use and rely upon without the need to hire a
13318 lawyer. Creative Commons thus aims to build a layer of content,
13319 governed by a layer of reasonable copyright law, that others can build
13320 upon. Voluntary choice of individuals and creators will make this
13321 content available. And that content will in turn enable us to rebuild
13325 This is just one project among many within the Creative Commons. And
13326 of course, Creative Commons is not the only organization pursuing such
13327 freedoms. But the point that distinguishes the Creative Commons from
13328 many is that we are not interested only in talking about a public
13329 domain or in getting legislators to help build a public domain. Our
13330 aim is to build a movement of consumers and producers
13331 <!-- PAGE BREAK 289 -->
13332 of content ("content conducers," as attorney Mia Garlick calls them)
13333 who help build the public domain and, by their work, demonstrate the
13334 importance of the public domain to other creativity.
13337 The aim is not to fight the "All Rights Reserved" sorts. The aim is to
13338 complement them. The problems that the law creates for us as a culture
13339 are produced by insane and unintended consequences of laws written
13340 centuries ago, applied to a technology that only Jefferson could have
13341 imagined. The rules may well have made sense against a background of
13342 technologies from centuries ago, but they do not make sense against
13343 the background of digital technologies. New rules
—with different
13344 freedoms, expressed in ways so that humans without lawyers can use
13345 them
—are needed. Creative Commons gives people a way effectively
13346 to begin to build those rules.
13349 Why would creators participate in giving up total control? Some
13350 participate to better spread their content. Cory Doctorow, for
13351 example, is a science fiction author. His first novel, Down and Out in
13352 the Magic Kingdom, was released on-line and for free, under a Creative
13353 Commons license, on the same day that it went on sale in bookstores.
13356 Why would a publisher ever agree to this? I suspect his publisher
13357 reasoned like this: There are two groups of people out there: (
1)
13358 those who will buy Cory's book whether or not it's on the Internet,
13359 and (
2) those who may never hear of Cory's book, if it isn't made
13360 available for free on the Internet. Some part of (
1) will download
13361 Cory's book instead of buying it. Call them bad-(
1)s. Some part of (
2)
13362 will download Cory's book, like it, and then decide to buy it. Call
13363 them (
2)-goods. If there are more (
2)-goods than bad-(
1)s, the
13364 strategy of releasing Cory's book free on-line will probably increase
13365 sales of Cory's book.
13368 Indeed, the experience of his publisher clearly supports that
13369 conclusion. The book's first printing was exhausted months before the
13370 publisher had expected. This first novel of a science fiction author
13371 was a total success.
13374 The idea that free content might increase the value of nonfree content
13375 was confirmed by the experience of another author. Peter Wayner,
13376 <!-- PAGE BREAK 290 -->
13377 who wrote a book about the free software movement titled Free for All,
13378 made an electronic version of his book free on-line under a Creative
13379 Commons license after the book went out of print. He then monitored
13380 used book store prices for the book. As predicted, as the number of
13381 downloads increased, the used book price for his book increased, as
13385 These are examples of using the Commons to better spread
13386 proprietary content. I believe that is a wonderful and common use of
13387 the Commons. There are others who use Creative Commons licenses for
13388 other reasons. Many who use the "sampling license" do so because
13389 anything else would be hypocritical. The sampling license says that
13390 others are free, for commercial or noncommercial purposes, to sample
13391 content from the licensed work; they are just not free to make full
13392 copies of the licensed work available to others. This is consistent
13393 with their own art
—they, too, sample from others. Because the
13394 legal costs of sampling are so high (Walter Leaphart, manager of the
13395 rap group Public Enemy, which was born sampling the music of others,
13396 has stated that he does not "allow" Public Enemy to sample anymore,
13397 because the legal costs are so high
<footnote><para>
13400 Willful Infringement: A Report from the Front Lines of the Real
13401 Culture Wars (
2003), produced by Jed Horovitz, directed by Greg
13402 Hittelman, a Fiat Lucre production, available at
13403 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
72</ulink>.
13404 </para></footnote>),
13405 these artists release into the creative environment content
13406 that others can build upon, so that their form of creativity might grow.
13409 Finally, there are many who mark their content with a Creative Commons
13410 license just because they want to express to others the importance of
13411 balance in this debate. If you just go along with the system as it is,
13412 you are effectively saying you believe in the "All Rights Reserved"
13413 model. Good for you, but many do not. Many believe that however
13414 appropriate that rule is for Hollywood and freaks, it is not an
13415 appropriate description of how most creators view the rights
13416 associated with their content. The Creative Commons license expresses
13417 this notion of "Some Rights Reserved," and gives many the chance to
13421 In the first six months of the Creative Commons experiment, over
13422 1 million objects were licensed with these free-culture licenses. The next
13423 step is partnerships with middleware content providers to help them
13424 build into their technologies simple ways for users to mark their content
13426 <!-- PAGE BREAK 291 -->
13427 with Creative Commons freedoms. Then the next step is to watch and
13428 celebrate creators who build content based upon content set free.
13431 These are first steps to rebuilding a public domain. They are not
13432 mere arguments; they are action. Building a public domain is the first
13433 step to showing people how important that domain is to creativity and
13434 innovation. Creative Commons relies upon voluntary steps to achieve
13435 this rebuilding. They will lead to a world in which more than voluntary
13436 steps are possible.
13439 Creative Commons is just one example of voluntary efforts by
13440 individuals and creators to change the mix of rights that now govern
13441 the creative field. The project does not compete with copyright; it
13442 complements it. Its aim is not to defeat the rights of authors, but to
13443 make it easier for authors and creators to exercise their rights more
13444 flexibly and cheaply. That difference, we believe, will enable
13445 creativity to spread more easily.
13447 <indexterm startref=
"idxcc" class='endofrange'
/>
13449 <!-- PAGE BREAK 292 -->
13452 <sect1 id=
"themsoon">
13453 <title>THEM, SOON
</title>
13455 We will not reclaim a free culture by individual action alone. It will
13456 also take important reforms of laws. We have a long way to go before
13457 the politicians will listen to these ideas and implement these reforms.
13458 But that also means that we have time to build awareness around the
13459 changes that we need.
13462 In this chapter, I outline five kinds of changes: four that are general,
13463 and one that's specific to the most heated battle of the day, music. Each
13464 is a step, not an end. But any of these steps would carry us a long way
13468 <sect2 id=
"formalities">
13469 <title>1. More Formalities
</title>
13471 If you buy a house, you have to record the sale in a deed. If you buy land
13472 upon which to build a house, you have to record the purchase in a deed.
13473 If you buy a car, you get a bill of sale and register the car. If you buy an
13474 airplane ticket, it has your name on it.
13477 <!-- PAGE BREAK 293 -->
13478 These are all formalities associated with property. They are
13480 that we all must bear if we want our property to be protected.
13483 In contrast, under current copyright law, you automatically get a
13484 copyright, regardless of whether you comply with any formality. You
13485 don't have to register. You don't even have to mark your content. The
13486 default is control, and "formalities" are banished.
13492 As I suggested in chapter
10, the motivation to abolish formalities
13493 was a good one. In the world before digital technologies, formalities
13494 imposed a burden on copyright holders without much benefit. Thus, it
13495 was progress when the law relaxed the formal requirements that a
13496 copyright owner must bear to protect and secure his work. Those
13498 were getting in the way.
13501 But the Internet changes all this. Formalities today need not be a
13502 burden. Rather, the world without formalities is the world that
13504 creativity. Today, there is no simple way to know who owns what,
13505 or with whom one must deal in order to use or build upon the
13507 work of others. There are no records, there is no system to trace
—
13508 there is no simple way to know how to get permission. Yet given the
13509 massive increase in the scope of copyright's rule, getting permission is
13510 a necessary step for any work that builds upon our past. And thus, the
13511 lack of formalities forces many into silence where they otherwise could
13515 The law should therefore change this requirement
<footnote><para>
13516 <!-- f1. --> The proposal I am advancing here would apply to American works only.
13517 Obviously, I believe it would be beneficial for the same idea to be adopted
13518 by other countries as well.
13519 </para></footnote>—but it should
13520 not change it by going back to the old, broken system. We should
13522 formalities, but we should establish a system that will create the
13523 incentives to minimize the burden of these formalities.
13526 The important formalities are three: marking copyrighted work,
13528 copyrights, and renewing the claim to copyright. Traditionally,
13529 the first of these three was something the copyright owner did; the
13531 two were something the government did. But a revised system of
13532 formalities would banish the government from the process, except for
13533 the sole purpose of approving standards developed by others.
13536 <!-- PAGE BREAK 294 -->
13538 <sect3 id=
"registration">
13539 <title>REGISTRATION AND RENEWAL
</title>
13541 Under the old system, a copyright owner had to file a registration
13542 with the Copyright Office to register or renew a copyright. When
13543 filing that registration, the copyright owner paid a fee. As with most
13544 government agencies, the Copyright Office had little incentive to
13545 minimize the burden of registration; it also had little incentive to
13546 minimize the fee. And as the Copyright Office is not a main target of
13547 government policymaking, the office has historically been terribly
13548 underfunded. Thus, when people who know something about the process
13549 hear this idea about formalities, their first reaction is
13550 panic
—nothing could be worse than forcing people to deal with
13551 the mess that is the Copyright Office.
13554 Yet it is always astonishing to me that we, who come from a tradition
13555 of extraordinary innovation in governmental design, can no longer
13556 think innovatively about how governmental functions can be designed.
13557 Just because there is a public purpose to a government role, it
13558 doesn't follow that the government must actually administer the
13559 role. Instead, we should be creating incentives for private parties to
13560 serve the public, subject to standards that the government sets.
13563 In the context of registration, one obvious model is the Internet.
13564 There are at least
32 million Web sites registered around the world.
13565 Domain name owners for these Web sites have to pay a fee to keep their
13566 registration alive. In the main top-level domains (.com, .org, .net),
13567 there is a central registry. The actual registrations are, however,
13568 performed by many competing registrars. That competition drives the
13569 cost of registering down, and more importantly, it drives the ease
13570 with which registration occurs up.
13573 We should adopt a similar model for the registration and renewal of
13574 copyrights. The Copyright Office may well serve as the central
13575 registry, but it should not be in the registrar business. Instead, it
13576 should establish a database, and a set of standards for registrars. It
13577 should approve registrars that meet its standards. Those registrars
13578 would then compete with one another to deliver the cheapest and
13579 simplest systems for registering and renewing copyrights. That
13580 competition would substantially lower the burden of this
13581 formality
—while producing a database
13582 <!-- PAGE BREAK 295 -->
13583 of registrations that would facilitate the licensing of content.
13587 <sect3 id=
"marking">
13588 <title>MARKING
</title>
13590 It used to be that the failure to include a copyright notice on a
13591 creative work meant that the copyright was forfeited. That was a harsh
13592 punishment for failing to comply with a regulatory rule
—akin to
13593 imposing the death penalty for a parking ticket in the world of
13594 creative rights. Here again, there is no reason that a marking
13595 requirement needs to be enforced in this way. And more importantly,
13596 there is no reason a marking requirement needs to be enforced
13597 uniformly across all media.
13600 The aim of marking is to signal to the public that this work is
13601 copyrighted and that the author wants to enforce his rights. The mark
13602 also makes it easy to locate a copyright owner to secure permission to
13606 One of the problems the copyright system confronted early on was
13607 that different copyrighted works had to be differently marked. It wasn't
13608 clear how or where a statue was to be marked, or a record, or a film. A
13609 new marking requirement could solve these problems by recognizing
13610 the differences in media, and by allowing the system of marking to
13611 evolve as technologies enable it to. The system could enable a special
13612 signal from the failure to mark
—not the loss of the copyright, but the
13613 loss of the right to punish someone for failing to get permission first.
13616 Let's start with the last point. If a copyright owner allows his work
13617 to be published without a copyright notice, the consequence of that
13618 failure need not be that the copyright is lost. The consequence could
13619 instead be that anyone has the right to use this work, until the
13620 copyright owner complains and demonstrates that it is his work and he
13621 doesn't give permission.
<footnote><para>
13623 There would be a complication with derivative works that I have not
13624 solved here. In my view, the law of derivatives creates a more complicated
13625 system than is justified by the marginal incentive it creates.
13627 The meaning of an unmarked work would therefore be "use unless someone
13628 complains." If someone does complain, then the obligation would be to
13629 stop using the work in any new
13630 <!-- PAGE BREAK 296 -->
13631 work from then on though no penalty would attach for existing uses.
13632 This would create a strong incentive for copyright owners to mark
13636 That in turn raises the question about how work should best be
13637 marked. Here again, the system needs to adjust as the technologies
13638 evolve. The best way to ensure that the system evolves is to limit the
13639 Copyright Office's role to that of approving standards for marking
13640 content that have been crafted elsewhere.
13643 For example, if a recording industry association devises a method for
13644 marking CDs, it would propose that to the Copyright Office. The
13645 Copyright Office would hold a hearing, at which other proposals could
13646 be made. The Copyright Office would then select the proposal that it
13647 judged preferable, and it would base that choice solely upon the
13648 consideration of which method could best be integrated into the
13649 registration and renewal system. We would not count on the government
13650 to innovate; but we would count on the government to keep the product
13651 of innovation in line with its other important functions.
13654 Finally, marking content clearly would simplify registration
13655 requirements. If photographs were marked by author and year, there
13656 would be little reason not to allow a photographer to reregister, for
13657 example, all photographs taken in a particular year in one quick
13658 step. The aim of the formality is not to burden the creator; the
13659 system itself should be kept as simple as possible.
13662 The objective of formalities is to make things clear. The existing
13663 system does nothing to make things clear. Indeed, it seems designed to
13664 make things unclear.
13667 If formalities such as registration were reinstated, one of the most
13668 difficult aspects of relying upon the public domain would be removed.
13669 It would be simple to identify what content is presumptively free; it
13670 would be simple to identify who controls the rights for a particular
13671 kind of content; it would be simple to assert those rights, and to renew
13672 that assertion at the appropriate time.
13675 <!-- PAGE BREAK 297 -->
13678 <sect2 id=
"shortterms">
13679 <title>2. Shorter Terms
</title>
13681 The term of copyright has gone from fourteen years to ninety-five
13682 years for corporate authors, and life of the author plus seventy years for
13686 In The Future of Ideas, I proposed a seventy-five-year term, granted
13687 in five-year increments with a requirement of renewal every five
13688 years. That seemed radical enough at the time. But after we lost
13689 Eldred v. Ashcroft, the proposals became even more radical. The
13690 Economist endorsed a proposal for a fourteen-year copyright
13691 term.
<footnote><para>
13693 "A Radical Rethink," Economist,
366:
8308 (
25 January
2003):
15,
13695 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
74</ulink>.
13697 Others have proposed tying the term to the term for patents.
13700 I agree with those who believe that we need a radical change in
13701 copyright's term. But whether fourteen years or seventy-five, there
13702 are four principles that are important to keep in mind about copyright
13705 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
13708 Keep it short: The term should be as long as necessary to give
13709 incentives to create, but no longer. If it were tied to very strong
13710 protections for authors (so authors were able to reclaim rights from
13711 publishers), rights to the same work (not derivative works) might be
13712 extended further. The key is not to tie the work up with legal
13713 regulations when it no longer benefits an author.
</para></listitem>
13716 Keep it simple: The line between the public domain and protected
13717 content must be kept clear. Lawyers like the fuzziness of "fair use,"
13718 and the distinction between "ideas" and "expression." That kind of
13719 law gives them lots of work. But our framers had a simpler idea in
13720 mind: protected versus unprotected. The value of short terms is that
13721 there is little need to build exceptions into copyright when the term
13722 itself is kept short. A clear and active "lawyer-free zone" makes the
13723 complexities of "fair use" and "idea/expression" less necessary to
13725 <!-- PAGE BREAK 298 -->
13729 Keep it alive: Copyright should have to be renewed. Especially if the
13730 maximum term is long, the copyright owner should be required to signal
13731 periodically that he wants the protection continued. This need not be
13732 an onerous burden, but there is no reason this monopoly protection has
13733 to be granted for free. On average, it takes ninety minutes for a
13734 veteran to apply for a pension.
<footnote><para>
13736 Department of Veterans Affairs, Veteran's Application for Compensation
13737 and/or Pension, VA Form
21-
526 (OMB Approved No.
2900-
0001),
13739 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
75</ulink>.
13741 If we make veterans suffer that burden, I don't see why we couldn't
13742 require authors to spend ten minutes every fifty years to file a
13747 Keep it prospective: Whatever the term of copyright should be, the
13748 clearest lesson that economists teach is that a term once given should
13749 not be extended. It might have been a mistake in
1923 for the law to
13750 offer authors only a fifty-six-year term. I don't think so, but it's
13751 possible. If it was a mistake, then the consequence was that we got
13752 fewer authors to create in
1923 than we otherwise would have. But we
13753 can't correct that mistake today by increasing the term. No matter
13754 what we do today, we will not increase the number of authors who wrote
13755 in
1923. Of course, we can increase the reward that those who write
13756 now get (or alternatively, increase the copyright burden that smothers
13757 many works that are today invisible). But increasing their reward will
13758 not increase their creativity in
1923. What's not done is not done,
13759 and there's nothing we can do about that now.
</para></listitem>
13762 These changes together should produce an average copyright term
13763 that is much shorter than the current term. Until
1976, the average
13764 term was just
32.2 years. We should be aiming for the same.
13767 No doubt the extremists will call these ideas "radical." (After all, I
13768 call them "extremists.") But again, the term I recommended was longer
13769 than the term under Richard Nixon. How "radical" can it be to ask for
13770 a more generous copyright law than Richard Nixon presided over?
13773 <!-- PAGE BREAK 299 -->
13776 <sect2 id=
"freefairuse">
13777 <title>3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use
</title>
13779 As I observed at the beginning of this book, property law originally
13780 granted property owners the right to control their property from the
13781 ground to the heavens. The airplane came along. The scope of property
13782 rights quickly changed. There was no fuss, no constitutional
13783 challenge. It made no sense anymore to grant that much control, given
13784 the emergence of that new technology.
13787 Our Constitution gives Congress the power to give authors "exclusive
13788 right" to "their writings." Congress has given authors an exclusive
13789 right to "their writings" plus any derivative writings (made by
13790 others) that are sufficiently close to the author's original
13791 work. Thus, if I write a book, and you base a movie on that book, I
13792 have the power to deny you the right to release that movie, even
13793 though that movie is not "my writing."
13796 Congress granted the beginnings of this right in
1870, when it
13797 expanded the exclusive right of copyright to include a right to
13798 control translations and dramatizations of a work.
<footnote><para>
13800 Benjamin Kaplan, An Unhurried View of Copyright (New York: Columbia
13801 University Press,
1967),
32.
13803 The courts have expanded it slowly through judicial interpretation
13804 ever since. This expansion has been commented upon by one of the law's
13805 greatest judges, Judge Benjamin Kaplan.
13809 So inured have we become to the extension of the monopoly to a
13810 large range of so-called derivative works, that we no longer sense
13811 the oddity of accepting such an enlargement of copyright while
13812 yet intoning the abracadabra of idea and expression.
<footnote><para>
13813 <!-- f6. --> Ibid.,
56.
13818 I think it's time to recognize that there are airplanes in this field and
13819 the expansiveness of these rights of derivative use no longer make
13820 sense. More precisely, they don't make sense for the period of time that
13821 a copyright runs. And they don't make sense as an amorphous grant.
13822 Consider each limitation in turn.
13825 Term: If Congress wants to grant a derivative right, then that right
13826 should be for a much shorter term. It makes sense to protect John
13828 <!-- PAGE BREAK 300 -->
13829 Grisham's right to sell the movie rights to his latest novel (or at least
13830 I'm willing to assume it does); but it does not make sense for that right
13831 to run for the same term as the underlying copyright. The derivative
13832 right could be important in inducing creativity; it is not important long
13833 after the creative work is done.
13836 Scope: Likewise should the scope of derivative rights be narrowed.
13837 Again, there are some cases in which derivative rights are important.
13838 Those should be specified. But the law should draw clear lines around
13839 regulated and unregulated uses of copyrighted material. When all
13840 "reuse" of creative material was within the control of businesses,
13842 it made sense to require lawyers to negotiate the lines. It no longer
13843 makes sense for lawyers to negotiate the lines. Think about all the
13845 possibilities that digital technologies enable; now imagine
13847 molasses into the machines. That's what this general requirement
13848 of permission does to the creative process. Smothers it.
13851 This was the point that Alben made when describing the making of the
13852 Clint Eastwood CD. While it makes sense to require negotiation for
13853 foreseeable derivative rights
—turning a book into a movie, or a
13854 poem into a musical score
—it doesn't make sense to require
13855 negotiation for the unforeseeable. Here, a statutory right would make
13859 In each of these cases, the law should mark the uses that are
13860 protected, and the presumption should be that other uses are not
13861 protected. This is the reverse of the recommendation of my colleague
13862 Paul Goldstein.
<footnote>
13863 <indexterm><primary>Goldstein, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
13866 Paul Goldstein, Copyright's Highway: From Gutenberg to the Celestial
13867 Jukebox (Stanford: Stanford University Press,
2003),
187–216.
13869 His view is that the law should be written so that
13870 expanded protections follow expanded uses.
13873 Goldstein's analysis would make perfect sense if the cost of the legal
13874 system were small. But as we are currently seeing in the context of
13875 the Internet, the uncertainty about the scope of protection, and the
13876 incentives to protect existing architectures of revenue, combined with
13877 a strong copyright, weaken the process of innovation.
13880 The law could remedy this problem either by removing protection
13881 <!-- PAGE BREAK 301 -->
13882 beyond the part explicitly drawn or by granting reuse rights upon
13883 certain statutory conditions. Either way, the effect would be to free
13884 a great deal of culture to others to cultivate. And under a statutory
13885 rights regime, that reuse would earn artists more income.
13889 <sect2 id=
"liberatemusic">
13890 <title>4. Liberate the Music
—Again
</title>
13892 The battle that got this whole war going was about music, so it
13893 wouldn't be fair to end this book without addressing the issue that
13894 is, to most people, most pressing
—music. There is no other
13895 policy issue that better teaches the lessons of this book than the
13896 battles around the sharing of music.
13899 The appeal of file-sharing music was the crack cocaine of the
13900 Internet's growth. It drove demand for access to the Internet more
13901 powerfully than any other single application. It was the Internet's
13902 killer app
—possibly in two senses of that word. It no doubt was
13903 the application that drove demand for bandwidth. It may well be the
13904 application that drives demand for regulations that in the end kill
13905 innovation on the network.
13908 The aim of copyright, with respect to content in general and music in
13909 particular, is to create the incentives for music to be composed,
13910 performed, and, most importantly, spread. The law does this by giving
13911 an exclusive right to a composer to control public performances of his
13912 work, and to a performing artist to control copies of her performance.
13915 File-sharing networks complicate this model by enabling the
13916 spread of content for which the performer has not been paid. But of
13917 course, that's not all the file-sharing networks do. As I described in
13918 chapter
5, they enable four different kinds of sharing:
13920 <orderedlist numeration=
"upperalpha">
13923 There are some who are using sharing networks as substitutes
13924 for purchasing CDs.
13928 There are also some who are using sharing networks to sample,
13929 on the way to purchasing CDs.
13932 <!-- PAGE BREAK 302 -->
13934 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
13935 content that is no longer sold but is still under copyright or that
13936 would have been too cumbersome to buy off the Net.
13940 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
13941 content that is not copyrighted or to get access that the copyright
13942 owner plainly endorses.
13946 Any reform of the law needs to keep these different uses in focus. It
13947 must avoid burdening type D even if it aims to eliminate type A. The
13948 eagerness with which the law aims to eliminate type A, moreover,
13949 should depend upon the magnitude of type B. As with VCRs, if the net
13950 effect of sharing is actually not very harmful, the need for regulation is
13951 significantly weakened.
13954 As I said in chapter
5, the actual harm caused by sharing is
13955 controversial. For the purposes of this chapter, however, I assume
13956 the harm is real. I assume, in other words, that type A sharing is
13957 significantly greater than type B, and is the dominant use of sharing
13961 Nonetheless, there is a crucial fact about the current technological
13962 context that we must keep in mind if we are to understand how the law
13966 Today, file sharing is addictive. In ten years, it won't be. It is
13967 addictive today because it is the easiest way to gain access to a
13968 broad range of content. It won't be the easiest way to get access to
13969 a broad range of content in ten years. Today, access to the Internet
13970 is cumbersome and slow
—we in the United States are lucky to have
13971 broadband service at
1.5 MBs, and very rarely do we get service at
13972 that speed both up and down. Although wireless access is growing, most
13973 of us still get access across wires. Most only gain access through a
13974 machine with a keyboard. The idea of the always on, always connected
13975 Internet is mainly just an idea.
13978 But it will become a reality, and that means the way we get access to
13979 the Internet today is a technology in transition. Policy makers should
13980 not make policy on the basis of technology in transition. They should
13981 <!-- PAGE BREAK 303 -->
13982 make policy on the basis of where the technology is going. The
13983 question should not be, how should the law regulate sharing in this
13984 world? The question should be, what law will we require when the
13985 network becomes the network it is clearly becoming? That network is
13986 one in which every machine with electricity is essentially on the Net;
13987 where everywhere you are
—except maybe the desert or the
13988 Rockies
—you can instantaneously be connected to the
13989 Internet. Imagine the Internet as ubiquitous as the best cell-phone
13990 service, where with the flip of a device, you are connected.
13993 In that world, it will be extremely easy to connect to services
13994 that give you access to content on the fly
—such as Internet
13995 radio, content that is streamed to the user when the user
13996 demands. Here, then, is the critical point: When it is extremely easy
13997 to connect to services that give access to content, it will be easier
13998 to connect to services that give you access to content than it will be
13999 to download and store content on the many devices you will have for
14000 playing content. It will be easier, in other words, to subscribe than
14001 it will be to be a database manager, as everyone in the
14002 download-sharing world of Napster-like technologies essentially
14003 is. Content services will compete with content sharing, even if the
14004 services charge money for the content they give access to. Already
14005 cell-phone services in Japan offer music (for a fee) streamed over
14006 cell phones (enhanced with plugs for headphones). The Japanese are
14007 paying for this content even though "free" content is available in the
14008 form of MP3s across the Web.
<footnote><para>
14010 See, for example, "Music Media Watch," The J@pan Inc. Newsletter,
3
14011 April
2002, available at
14012 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
76</ulink>.
14017 This point about the future is meant to suggest a perspective on the
14018 present: It is emphatically temporary. The "problem" with file
14019 sharing
—to the extent there is a real problem
—is a problem
14020 that will increasingly disappear as it becomes easier to connect to
14021 the Internet. And thus it is an extraordinary mistake for policy
14022 makers today to be "solving" this problem in light of a technology
14023 that will be gone tomorrow. The question should not be how to
14024 regulate the Internet to eliminate file sharing (the Net will evolve
14025 that problem away). The question instead should be how to assure that
14026 artists get paid, during
14028 <!-- PAGE BREAK 304 -->
14029 this transition between twentieth-century models for doing business
14030 and twenty-first-century technologies.
14033 The answer begins with recognizing that there are different "problems"
14034 here to solve. Let's start with type D content
—uncopyrighted
14035 content or copyrighted content that the artist wants shared. The
14036 "problem" with this content is to make sure that the technology that
14037 would enable this kind of sharing is not rendered illegal. You can
14038 think of it this way: Pay phones are used to deliver ransom demands,
14039 no doubt. But there are many who need to use pay phones who have
14040 nothing to do with ransoms. It would be wrong to ban pay phones in
14041 order to eliminate kidnapping.
14044 Type C content raises a different "problem." This is content that was,
14045 at one time, published and is no longer available. It may be
14046 unavailable because the artist is no longer valuable enough for the
14047 record label he signed with to carry his work. Or it may be
14048 unavailable because the work is forgotten. Either way, the aim of the
14049 law should be to facilitate the access to this content, ideally in a
14050 way that returns something to the artist.
14053 Again, the model here is the used book store. Once a book goes out of
14054 print, it may still be available in libraries and used book
14055 stores. But libraries and used book stores don't pay the copyright
14056 owner when someone reads or buys an out-of-print book. That makes
14057 total sense, of course, since any other system would be so burdensome
14058 as to eliminate the possibility of used book stores' existing. But
14059 from the author's perspective, this "sharing" of his content without
14060 his being compensated is less than ideal.
14063 The model of used book stores suggests that the law could simply deem
14064 out-of-print music fair game. If the publisher does not make copies of
14065 the music available for sale, then commercial and noncommercial
14066 providers would be free, under this rule, to "share" that content,
14067 even though the sharing involved making a copy. The copy here would be
14068 incidental to the trade; in a context where commercial publishing has
14069 ended, trading music should be as free as trading books.
14073 <!-- PAGE BREAK 305 -->
14074 Alternatively, the law could create a statutory license that would
14075 ensure that artists get something from the trade of their work. For
14076 example, if the law set a low statutory rate for the commercial
14077 sharing of content that was not offered for sale by a commercial
14078 publisher, and if that rate were automatically transferred to a trust
14079 for the benefit of the artist, then businesses could develop around
14080 the idea of trading this content, and artists would benefit from this
14084 This system would also create an incentive for publishers to keep
14085 works available commercially. Works that are available commercially
14086 would not be subject to this license. Thus, publishers could protect
14087 the right to charge whatever they want for content if they kept the
14088 work commercially available. But if they don't keep it available, and
14089 instead, the computer hard disks of fans around the world keep it
14090 alive, then any royalty owed for such copying should be much less than
14091 the amount owed a commercial publisher.
14094 The hard case is content of types A and B, and again, this case is
14095 hard only because the extent of the problem will change over time, as
14096 the technologies for gaining access to content change. The law's
14097 solution should be as flexible as the problem is, understanding that
14098 we are in the middle of a radical transformation in the technology for
14099 delivering and accessing content.
14102 So here's a solution that will at first seem very strange to both sides
14103 in this war, but which upon reflection, I suggest, should make some sense.
14106 Stripped of the rhetoric about the sanctity of property, the basic
14107 claim of the content industry is this: A new technology (the Internet)
14108 has harmed a set of rights that secure copyright. If those rights are to
14109 be protected, then the content industry should be compensated for that
14110 harm. Just as the technology of tobacco harmed the health of millions
14111 of Americans, or the technology of asbestos caused grave illness to
14112 thousands of miners, so, too, has the technology of digital networks
14113 harmed the interests of the content industry.
14116 <!-- PAGE BREAK 306 -->
14117 I love the Internet, and so I don't like likening it to tobacco or
14118 asbestos. But the analogy is a fair one from the perspective of the
14119 law. And it suggests a fair response: Rather than seeking to destroy
14120 the Internet, or the p2p technologies that are currently harming
14121 content providers on the Internet, we should find a relatively simple
14122 way to compensate those who are harmed.
14125 The idea would be a modification of a proposal that has been
14126 floated by Harvard law professor William Fisher.
<footnote>
14127 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock
</primary></indexterm>
14128 <indexterm><primary>Fisher, William
</primary></indexterm>
14130 <!-- f9. --> William Fisher, Digital Music: Problems and Possibilities (last revised:
14131 10 October
2000), available at
14132 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
77</ulink>; William Fisher, Promises to Keep:
14133 Technology, Law, and the Future of Entertainment (forthcoming) (Stanford:
14134 Stanford University Press,
2004), ch.
6, available at
14135 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
78</ulink>. Professor
14136 Netanel has proposed a related idea that would exempt noncommercial
14137 sharing from the reach of copyright and would establish compensation
14138 to artists to balance any loss. See Neil Weinstock Netanel, "Impose a
14139 Noncommercial Use Levy to Allow Free P2P File Sharing," available at
14140 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
79</ulink>. For other proposals, see Lawrence Lessig, "Who's Holding Back
14141 Broadband?" Washington Post,
8 January
2002, A17; Philip S. Corwin on
14142 behalf of Sharman Networks, A Letter to Senator Joseph R. Biden, Jr.,
14143 Chairman of the Senate Foreign Relations Committee,
26 February
2002,
14145 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
80</ulink>; Serguei Osokine, A Quick Case for Intellectual Property
14146 Use Fee (IPUF),
3 March
2002, available at
14147 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
81</ulink>; Jefferson Graham,
14148 "Kazaa, Verizon Propose to Pay Artists Directly," USA Today,
13 May
14150 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
82</ulink>; Steven M. Cherry, "Getting Copyright Right,"
14151 IEEE Spectrum Online,
1 July
2002, available at
14152 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
83</ulink>; Declan
14154 "Verizon's Copyright Campaign," CNET News.com,
27 August
14156 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
84</ulink>.
14157 Fisher's proposal is very similar to Richard Stallman's proposal for
14158 DAT. Unlike Fisher's, Stallman's proposal would not pay artists directly
14159 proportionally, though more popular artists would get more than the less
14160 popular. As is typical with Stallman, his proposal predates the current
14162 by about a decade. See
14163 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
85</ulink>.
14166 very clever way around the current impasse of the Internet. Under his
14167 plan, all content capable of digital transmission would (
1) be marked
14168 with a digital watermark (don't worry about how easy it is to evade
14169 these marks; as you'll see, there's no incentive to evade them). Once the
14170 content is marked, then entrepreneurs would develop (
2) systems to
14171 monitor how many items of each content were distributed. On the
14173 of those numbers, then (
3) artists would be compensated. The
14175 would be paid for by (
4) an appropriate tax.
14178 Fisher's proposal is careful and comprehensive. It raises a million
14179 questions, most of which he answers well in his upcoming book,
14180 Promises to Keep. The modification that I would make is relatively
14182 Fisher imagines his proposal replacing the existing copyright
14184 I imagine it complementing the existing system. The aim of the
14185 proposal would be to facilitate compensation to the extent that harm
14186 could be shown. This compensation would be temporary, aimed at
14188 a transition between regimes. And it would require renewal
14189 after a period of years. If it continues to make sense to facilitate free
14191 of content, supported through a taxation system, then it can be
14192 continued. If this form of protection is no longer necessary, then the
14193 system could lapse into the old system of controlling access.
14196 Fisher would balk at the idea of allowing the system to lapse. His
14197 aim is not just to ensure that artists are paid, but also to ensure that the
14198 system supports the widest range of "semiotic democracy" possible. But
14199 the aims of semiotic democracy would be satisfied if the other changes
14200 I described were accomplished
—in particular, the limits on derivative
14202 <!-- PAGE BREAK 307 -->
14203 uses. A system that simply charges for access would not greatly burden
14204 semiotic democracy if there were few limitations on what one was
14206 to do with the content itself.
14209 No doubt it would be difficult to calculate the proper measure of
14210 "harm" to an industry. But the difficulty of making that calculation
14211 would be outweighed by the benefit of facilitating innovation. This
14212 background system to compensate would also not need to interfere with
14213 innovative proposals such as Apple's MusicStore. As experts predicted
14214 when Apple launched the MusicStore, it could beat "free" by being
14215 easier than free is. This has proven correct: Apple has sold millions
14216 of songs at even the very high price of
99 cents a song. (At
99 cents,
14217 the cost is the equivalent of a per-song CD price, though the labels
14218 have none of the costs of a CD to pay.) Apple's move was countered by
14219 Real Networks, offering music at just
79 cents a song. And no doubt
14220 there will be a great deal of competition to offer and sell music
14224 This competition has already occurred against the background of "free"
14225 music from p2p systems. As the sellers of cable television have known
14226 for thirty years, and the sellers of bottled water for much more than
14227 that, there is nothing impossible at all about "competing with free."
14228 Indeed, if anything, the competition spurs the competitors to offer
14229 new and better products. This is precisely what the competitive market
14230 was to be about. Thus in Singapore, though piracy is rampant, movie
14231 theaters are often luxurious
—with "first class" seats, and meals
14232 served while you watch a movie
—as they struggle and succeed in
14233 finding ways to compete with "free."
14236 This regime of competition, with a backstop to assure that artists
14237 don't lose, would facilitate a great deal of innovation in the
14238 delivery of content. That competition would continue to shrink type A
14239 sharing. It would inspire an extraordinary range of new
14240 innovators
—ones who would have a right to the content, and would
14241 no longer fear the uncertain and barbarically severe punishments of
14245 In summary, then, my proposal is this:
14249 <!-- PAGE BREAK 308 -->
14250 The Internet is in transition. We should not be regulating a
14251 technology in transition. We should instead be regulating to minimize
14252 the harm to interests affected by this technological change, while
14253 enabling, and encouraging, the most efficient technology we can
14257 We can minimize that harm while maximizing the benefit to innovation
14260 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
14263 guaranteeing the right to engage in type D sharing;
14267 permitting noncommercial type C sharing without liability,
14268 and commercial type C sharing at a low and fixed rate set by
14273 while in this transition, taxing and compensating for type A
14274 sharing, to the extent actual harm is demonstrated.
14278 But what if "piracy" doesn't disappear? What if there is a
14280 market providing content at a low cost, but a significant number of
14281 consumers continue to "take" content for nothing? Should the law do
14285 Yes, it should. But, again, what it should do depends upon how the
14286 facts develop. These changes may not eliminate type A sharing. But
14287 the real issue is not whether it eliminates sharing in the abstract.
14288 The real issue is its effect on the market. Is it better (a) to have a
14290 that is
95 percent secure and produces a market of size x, or
14291 (b) to have a technology that is
50 percent secure but produces a
14293 of five times x? Less secure might produce more unauthorized
14294 sharing, but it is likely to also produce a much bigger market in
14296 sharing. The most important thing is to assure artists'
14298 without breaking the Internet. Once that's assured, then it
14299 may well be appropriate to find ways to track down the petty pirates.
14302 But we're a long way away from whittling the problem down to this
14303 subset of type A sharers. And our focus until we're there should not be
14304 on finding ways to break the Internet. Our focus until we're there
14306 <!-- PAGE BREAK 309 -->
14307 should be on how to make sure the artists are paid, while protecting the
14308 space for innovation and creativity that the Internet is.
14312 <sect2 id=
"firelawyers">
14313 <title>5. Fire Lots of Lawyers
</title>
14315 I'm a lawyer. I make lawyers for a living. I believe in the law. I believe
14316 in the law of copyright. Indeed, I have devoted my life to working in
14317 law, not because there are big bucks at the end but because there are
14318 ideals at the end that I would love to live.
14321 Yet much of this book has been a criticism of lawyers, or the role
14322 lawyers have played in this debate. The law speaks to ideals, but it is
14323 my view that our profession has become too attuned to the client. And
14324 in a world where the rich clients have one strong view, the
14326 of the profession to question or counter that one strong view queers
14330 The evidence of this bending is compelling. I'm attacked as a
14332 by many within the profession, yet the positions that I am
14334 are precisely the positions of some of the most moderate and
14335 significant figures in the history of this branch of the law. Many, for
14337 thought crazy the challenge that we brought to the Copyright
14338 Term Extension Act. Yet just thirty years ago, the dominant scholar
14339 and practitioner in the field of copyright, Melville Nimmer, thought it
14340 obvious.
<footnote><para>
14341 <!-- f10. --> Lawrence Lessig, "Copyright's First Amendment" (Melville B. Nimmer
14342 Memorial Lecture), UCLA Law Review
48 (
2001):
1057,
1069–70.
14347 However, my criticism of the role that lawyers have played in this
14348 debate is not just about a professional bias. It is more importantly
14349 about our failure to actually reckon the costs of the law.
14352 Economists are supposed to be good at reckoning costs and
14354 But more often than not, economists, with no clue about how the
14355 legal system actually functions, simply assume that the transaction
14356 costs of the legal system are slight.
<footnote><para>
14357 <!-- f11. --> A good example is the work of Professor Stan Liebowitz. Liebowitz is to
14358 be commended for his careful review of data about infringement, leading
14359 him to question his own publicly stated position
—twice. He initially
14361 that downloading would substantially harm the industry. He then
14362 revised his view in light of the data, and he has since revised his view again.
14363 Compare Stan J. Liebowitz, Rethinking the Network Economy: The True
14364 Forces That Drive the Digital Marketplace (New York: Amacom,
2002),
14365 (reviewing his original view but expressing skepticism) with Stan J.
14366 Liebowitz, "Will MP3s Annihilate the Record Industry?" working paper,
14367 June
2003, available at
14368 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
86</ulink>.
14369 Liebowitz's careful analysis is extremely valuable in estimating the
14371 of file-sharing technology. In my view, however, he underestimates the
14372 costs of the legal system. See, for example, Rethinking,
174–76.
14374 They see a system that has been
14375 around for hundreds of years, and they assume it works the way their
14376 elementary school civics class taught them it works.
14379 <!-- PAGE BREAK 310 -->
14380 But the legal system doesn't work. Or more accurately, it doesn't
14381 work for anyone except those with the most resources. Not because the
14382 system is corrupt. I don't think our legal system (at the federal level, at
14383 least) is at all corrupt. I mean simply because the costs of our legal
14385 are so astonishingly high that justice can practically never be done.
14388 These costs distort free culture in many ways. A lawyer's time is
14389 billed at the largest firms at more than $
400 per hour. How much time
14390 should such a lawyer spend reading cases carefully, or researching
14392 strands of authority? The answer is the increasing reality: very
14394 The law depended upon the careful articulation and development
14395 of doctrine, but the careful articulation and development of legal
14397 depends upon careful work. Yet that careful work costs too much,
14398 except in the most high-profile and costly cases.
14401 The costliness and clumsiness and randomness of this system mock
14402 our tradition. And lawyers, as well as academics, should consider it
14403 their duty to change the way the law works
—or better, to change the
14404 law so that it works. It is wrong that the system works well only for the
14405 top
1 percent of the clients. It could be made radically more efficient,
14406 and inexpensive, and hence radically more just.
14409 But until that reform is complete, we as a society should keep the
14410 law away from areas that we know it will only harm. And that is
14412 what the law will too often do if too much of our culture is left
14416 Think about the amazing things your kid could do or make with
14417 digital technology
—the film, the music, the Web page, the blog. Or
14418 think about the amazing things your community could facilitate with
14419 digital technology
—a wiki, a barn raising, activism to change
14421 Think about all those creative things, and then imagine cold
14422 molasses poured onto the machines. This is what any regime that
14424 permission produces. Again, this is the reality of Brezhnev's
14428 The law should regulate in certain areas of culture
—but it should
14429 regulate culture only where that regulation does good. Yet lawyers
14431 <!-- PAGE BREAK 311 -->
14432 rarely test their power, or the power they promote, against this
14433 simple pragmatic question: "Will it do good?" When challenged about
14434 the expanding reach of the law, the lawyer answers, "Why not?"
14437 We should ask, "Why?" Show me why your regulation of culture is
14438 needed. Show me how it does good. And until you can show me both,
14439 keep your lawyers away.
14441 <!-- PAGE BREAK 312 -->
14445 <chapter id=
"c-notes">
14446 <title>NOTES
</title>
14448 Throughout this text, there are references to links on the World Wide
14449 Web. As anyone who has tried to use the Web knows, these links can be
14450 highly unstable. I have tried to remedy the instability by redirecting
14451 readers to the original source through the Web site associated with
14452 this book. For each link below, you can go to
14453 http://free-culture.cc/notes and locate the original source by
14454 clicking on the number after the # sign. If the original link remains
14455 alive, you will be redirected to that link. If the original link has
14456 disappeared, you will be redirected to an appropriate reference for
14459 <!-- PAGE BREAK 336 -->
14462 <chapter id=
"c-acknowledgments">
14463 <title>ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
</title>
14465 This book is the product of a long and as yet unsuccessful struggle that
14466 began when I read of Eric Eldred's war to keep books free. Eldred's
14467 work helped launch a movement, the free culture movement, and it is
14468 to him that this book is dedicated.
14471 I received guidance in various places from friends and academics,
14472 including Glenn Brown, Peter DiCola, Jennifer Mnookin, Richard Posner,
14473 Mark Rose, and Kathleen Sullivan. And I received correction and
14474 guidance from many amazing students at Stanford Law School and
14475 Stanford University. They included Andrew B. Coan, John Eden, James
14476 P. Fellers, Christopher Guzelian, Erica Goldberg, Robert Hallman,
14477 Andrew Harris, Matthew Kahn, Brian Link, Ohad Mayblum, Alina Ng, and
14478 Erica Platt. I am particularly grateful to Catherine Crump and Harry
14479 Surden, who helped direct their research, and to Laura Lynch, who
14480 brilliantly managed the army that they assembled, and provided her own
14481 critical eye on much of this.
14484 Yuko Noguchi helped me to understand the laws of Japan as well as
14485 its culture. I am thankful to her, and to the many in Japan who helped
14486 me prepare this book: Joi Ito, Takayuki Matsutani, Naoto Misaki,
14487 Michihiro Sasaki, Hiromichi Tanaka, Hiroo Yamagata, and Yoshihiro
14488 <!-- PAGE BREAK 337 -->
14489 Yonezawa. I am thankful as well as to Professor Nobuhiro Nakayama,
14490 and the Tokyo University Business Law Center, for giving me the
14491 chance to spend time in Japan, and to Tadashi Shiraishi and Kiyokazu
14492 Yamagami for their generous help while I was there.
14495 These are the traditional sorts of help that academics regularly draw
14496 upon. But in addition to them, the Internet has made it possible to
14497 receive advice and correction from many whom I have never even
14498 met. Among those who have responded with extremely helpful advice to
14499 requests on my blog about the book are Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli, David
14500 Gerstein, and Peter DiMauro, as well as a long list of those who had
14501 specific ideas about ways to develop my argument. They included
14502 Richard Bondi, Steven Cherry, David Coe, Nik Cubrilovic, Bob Devine,
14503 Charles Eicher, Thomas Guida, Elihu M. Gerson, Jeremy Hunsinger,
14504 Vaughn Iverson, John Karabaic, Jeff Keltner, James Lindenschmidt,
14505 K. L. Mann, Mark Manning, Nora McCauley, Jeffrey McHugh, Evan
14506 McMullen, Fred Norton, John Pormann, Pedro A. D. Rezende, Shabbir
14507 Safdar, Saul Schleimer, Clay Shirky, Adam Shostack, Kragen Sitaker,
14508 Chris Smith, Bruce Steinberg, Andrzej Jan Taramina, Sean Walsh, Matt
14509 Wasserman, Miljenko Williams, "Wink," Roger Wood, "Ximmbo da Jazz,"
14510 and Richard Yanco. (I apologize if I have missed anyone; with
14511 computers come glitches, and a crash of my e-mail system meant I lost
14512 a bunch of great replies.)
14515 Richard Stallman and Michael Carroll each read the whole book in
14516 draft, and each provided extremely helpful correction and advice.
14517 Michael helped me to see more clearly the significance of the
14518 regulation of derivitive works. And Richard corrected an
14519 embarrassingly large number of errors. While my work is in part
14520 inspired by Stallman's, he does not agree with me in important places
14521 throughout this book.
14524 Finally, and forever, I am thankful to Bettina, who has always
14525 insisted that there would be unending happiness away from these
14526 battles, and who has always been right. This slow learner is, as ever,
14527 grateful for her perpetual patience and love.
14529 <!-- PAGE BREAK 338 -->